MICROCHIP PIC18F8310I/PTQTP

PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Data Sheet
64/80-Pin Flash Microcontrollers
with nanoWatt Technology
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A
Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices:
•
Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet.
•
Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the
intended manner and under normal conditions.
•
There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our
knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data
Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property.
•
Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code.
•
Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not
mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our
products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts
allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act.
Information contained in this publication regarding device
applications and the like is intended through suggestion only
and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to
ensure that your application meets with your specifications.
No representation or warranty is given and no liability is
assumed by Microchip Technology Incorporated with respect
to the accuracy or use of such information, or infringement of
patents or other intellectual property rights arising from such
use or otherwise. Use of Microchip’s products as critical
components in life support systems is not authorized except
with express written approval by Microchip. No licenses are
conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any intellectual
property rights.
Trademarks
The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, Accuron,
dsPIC, KEELOQ, microID, MPLAB, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART,
PRO MATE, PowerSmart, rfPIC, and SmartShunt are
registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A. and other countries.
AmpLab, FilterLab, MXDEV, MXLAB, PICMASTER, SEEVAL,
SmartSensor and The Embedded Control Solutions Company
are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology
Incorporated in the U.S.A.
Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, dsPICDEM,
dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, ECAN, ECONOMONITOR,
FanSense, FlexROM, fuzzyLAB, In-Circuit Serial
Programming, ICSP, ICEPIC, Migratable Memory, MPASM,
MPLIB, MPLINK, MPSIM, PICkit, PICDEM, PICDEM.net,
PICLAB, PICtail, PowerCal, PowerInfo, PowerMate,
PowerTool, rfLAB, rfPICDEM, Select Mode, Smart Serial,
SmartTel and Total Endurance are trademarks of Microchip
Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries.
SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their
respective companies.
© 2004, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the
U.S.A., All Rights Reserved.
Printed on recycled paper.
Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2002 quality system certification for
its worldwide headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in
Chandler and Tempe, Arizona and Mountain View, California in
October 2003. The Company’s quality system processes and
procedures are for its PICmicro® 8-bit MCUs, KEELOQ® code hopping
devices, Serial EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and
analog products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design
and manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified.
DS39635A-page ii
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
64/80-Pin Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology
Power Managed Modes:
Peripheral Highlights:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Run: CPU on, peripherals on
Idle: CPU off, peripherals on
Sleep: CPU off, peripherals off
Idle mode currents down to 5.8 µA typical
Sleep mode currents down to 0.1 µA typical
Timer1 Oscillator: 1.8 µA, 32 kHz, 2V
Watchdog Timer: 2.1 µA
Two-Speed Oscillator Start-up
•
Flexible Oscillator Structure:
•
• Four Crystal modes:
- LP: up to 200 kHz
- XT: up to 4 MHz
- HS: up to 40 MHz
- HSPLL: 4-10 MHz (16-40 MHz internal)
• 4x Phase Lock Loop (available for crystal and
internal oscillators)
• Two External RC modes, up to 4 MHz
• Two External Clock modes, up to 40 MHz
• Internal oscillator block:
- 8 user selectable frequencies, from 31 kHz to 8 MHz
- Provides a complete range of clock speeds
from 31 kHz to 32 MHz when used with PLL
- User-tunable to compensate for frequency drift
• Secondary oscillator using Timer1 @ 32 kHz
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor:
- Allows for safe shut down of device if primary
or secondary clock fails
•
•
Special Microcontroller Features:
Data
Memory
Device
MSSP
I/O
10-bit
CCP
A/D (ch) (PWM)
Timers
8/16-bit
Ext.
Bus
1/1
2
1/3
N
2
1/3
N
1/1
2
1/3
Y
1/1
2
1/3
Y
Flash
(bytes)
# Single-Word
Instructions
SRAM
(bytes)
PIC18F6310
8K/0
4096/0
768
54
12
3
Y
Y
PIC18F6410
16K/0
8192/0
768
54
12
3
Y
Y
1/1
PIC18F8310
8K/2M
4096/1M
768
70
12
3
Y
Y
PIC18F8410 16K/2M
8192/1M
768
70
12
3
Y
Y
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
Master
SPI™
I2C™
Comparators
• Address capability of up to 2 Mbytes
• 16-bit/8-bit interface
EUSART/
AUSART
• C compiler optimized architecture:
- Optional extended instruction set designed to
optimize re-entrant code
• 1000 erase/write cycle Flash program memory typical
• Flash Retention: 100 years typical
• Priority levels for interrupts
• 8 x 8 Single-Cycle Hardware Multiplier
• Extended Watchdog Timer (WDT):
- Programmable period from 4 ms to 131s
- 2% stability over VDD and temperature
• In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) via two pins
• In-Circuit Debug (ICD) via two pins
• Wide operating voltage range: 2.0V to 5.5V
External Memory Interface
(PIC18F8310/8410 Devices only):
Program Memory
(On-Board/External)
High current sink/source 25 mA/25 mA
Four external interrupts
Four input change interrupts
Four 8-bit/16-bit Timer/Counter modules
Up to 3 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) modules
Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) module
supporting 3-wire SPI™ (all 4 modes) and I2C™
Master and Slave modes
Addressable USART module:
- Supports RS-485 and RS-232
Enhanced Addressable USART module:
- Supports RS-485, RS-232 and LIN 1.2
- Auto-Wake-up on Start bit
- Auto-Baud Detect
10-bit, up to 12-channel Analog-to-Digital
Converter module (A/D):
- Auto-acquisition capability
- Conversion available during Sleep
Dual analog comparators with input multiplexing
DS39635A-page 1
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Pin Diagrams
RD7/PSP7
RD6/PSP6
RD5/PSP5
RD4/PSP4
RD3/PSP3
RD2/PSP2
RD1/PSP1
VSS
VDD
RD0/PSP0
RE7/CCP2(1)
RE6
RE5
RE4
RE3
RE2/CS
64-Pin TQFP
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
RE1/WR
RE0/RD
RF4/AN9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
RF3/AN8
RF2/AN7/C1OUT
15
16
RG0/CCP3
RG1/TX2/CK2
RG2/RX2/DT2
RG3
RG5/MCLR/VPP
RG4
VSS
VDD
RF7/SS
RF6/AN11
RF5/AN10/CVREF
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
PIC18F6310
PIC18F6410
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
RB0/INT0
RB1/INT1
RB2/INT2
RB3/INT3
RB4/KBI0
RB5/KBI1
RB6/KBI2/PGC
VSS
OSC2/CLKO/RA6
OSC1/CLKI/RA7
VDD
RB7/KBI3/PGD
RC5/SDO
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC2/CCP1
RC7/RX1/DT1
RC6/TX1/CK1
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI
RA4/T0CKI
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2(1)
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN
VDD
VSS
RA0/AN0
RA1/AN1
RA2/AN2/VREF-
AVSS
RA3/AN3/VREF+
AVDD
RF0/AN5
RF1/AN6/C2OUT
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
Note 1: RE7 is the alternate pin for CCP2 multiplexing.
DS39635A-page 2
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
RJ1/OE
RJ0/ALE
RD7/AD7/PSP7
RD6/AD6/PSP6
RD5/AD5/PSP5
RD4/AD4/PSP4
RD3/AD3/PSP3
RD2/AD2/PSP2
RD1/AD1/PSP1
VSS
VDD
RE7/CCP2(1)/AD15
RD0/AD0/PSP0
RE6/AD14
RE5/AD13
RE4/AD12
RE3/AD11
RH0/A16
RE2/AD10/CS
RH1/A17
80-Pin TQFP
80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61
RH2/A18
RH3/A19
RE1/AD9/WR
RE0/AD8/RD
RG0/CCP3
RG1/TX2/CK2
RG2/RX2/DT2
RG3
RG5/MCLR/VPP
RG4
VSS
VDD
RF7/SS
RF6/AN11
RF5/AN10/CVREF
RF4/AN9
RF3/AN8
RF2/AN7/C1OUT
RH7
RH6
1
60
2
59
58
57
56
55
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
54
53
52
51
50
PIC18F8310
PIC18F8410
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
17
18
19
20
RJ2/WRL
RJ3/WRH
RB0/INT0
RB1/INT1
RB2/INT2
RB3/INT3/CCP2(1)
RB4/KBI0
RB5/KBI1
RB6/KBI2/PGC
VSS
OSC2/CLKO/RA6
OSC1/CLKI/RA7
VDD
RB7/KBI3/PGD
RC5/SDO
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC2/CCP1
RJ7/UB
RJ6/LB
RJ5/CE
RJ4/BA0
RC7/RX1/DT1
RC6/TX1/CK1
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI
RA4/T0CKI
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2(1)
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN
VDD
VSS
RA0/AN0
RA1/AN1
RA2/AN2/VREF-
AVSS
RA3/AN3/VREF+
AVDD
RF0/AN5
RF1/AN6/C2OUT
RH4
RH5
21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
Note 1: RE7 is the alternate pin for CCP2 multiplexing.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 3
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 7
2.0 Oscillator Configurations ............................................................................................................................................................ 29
3.0 Power Managed Modes ............................................................................................................................................................. 39
4.0 Reset .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 49
5.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................. 61
6.0 Program Memory........................................................................................................................................................................ 85
7.0 External Memory Interface ......................................................................................................................................................... 89
8.0 8 x 8 Hardware Multiplier............................................................................................................................................................ 99
9.0 Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................. 101
10.0 I/O Ports ................................................................................................................................................................................... 117
11.0 Timer0 Module ......................................................................................................................................................................... 143
12.0 Timer1 Module ......................................................................................................................................................................... 147
13.0 Timer2 Module ......................................................................................................................................................................... 153
14.0 Timer3 Module ......................................................................................................................................................................... 155
15.0 Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) Modules ................................................................................................................................. 159
16.0 Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) Module .................................................................................................................... 169
17.0 Enhanced Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (EUSART) ............................................................... 209
18.0 Addressable Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (AUSART) ........................................................... 231
19.0 10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (A/D) Module ..................................................................................................................... 245
20.0 Comparator Module.................................................................................................................................................................. 255
21.0 Comparator Voltage Reference Module ................................................................................................................................... 261
22.0 High/Low-Voltage Detect (HLVD)............................................................................................................................................. 265
23.0 Special Features of the CPU .................................................................................................................................................... 271
24.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 287
25.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 337
26.0 Electrical Characteristics .......................................................................................................................................................... 343
27.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Tables ....................................................................................................................... 379
28.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 381
Appendix A: Revision History............................................................................................................................................................. 385
Appendix B: Device Differences......................................................................................................................................................... 385
Appendix C: Conversion Considerations ........................................................................................................................................... 386
Appendix D: Migration from Baseline to Enhanced Devices.............................................................................................................. 386
Appendix E: Migration from Mid-Range to Enhanced Devices .......................................................................................................... 387
Appendix F: Migration from High-End to Enhanced Devices ............................................................................................................. 387
Index .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 389
On-Line Support................................................................................................................................................................................. 399
Systems Information and Upgrade Hot Line ...................................................................................................................................... 399
Reader Response .............................................................................................................................................................................. 400
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 Product Identification System ............................................................................................................ 401
DS39635A-page 4
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at [email protected] or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150.
We welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
• Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com
• Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
• The Microchip Corporate Literature Center; U.S. FAX: (480) 792-7277
When contacting a sales office or the literature center, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include
literature number) you are using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our web site at www.microchip.com/cn to receive the most current information on all of our products.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 5
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 6
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
1.1.2
This document contains device specific information for
the following devices:
• PIC18F6310
• PIC18LF6310
• PIC18F6410
• PIC18LF6410
• PIC18F8310
• PIC18LF8310
• PIC18F8410
• PIC18LF8410
This family offers the advantages of all PIC18
microcontrollers – namely, high computational
performance at an economical price. In addition to
these features, the PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
family introduces design enhancements that make
these microcontrollers a logical choice for many
high-performance, power sensitive applications.
1.1
1.1.1
New Core Features
nanoWatt TECHNOLOGY
All of the devices in the PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
family incorporate a range of features that can
significantly reduce power consumption during
operation. Key items include:
• Alternate Run Modes: By clocking the controller
from the Timer1 source or the internal oscillator
block, power consumption during code execution
can be reduced by as much as 90%.
• Multiple Idle Modes: The controller can also run
with its CPU core disabled, but the peripherals still
active. In these states, power consumption can be
reduced even further – to as little as 4% of normal
operation requirements.
• On-the-Fly Mode Switching: The power
managed modes are invoked by user code during
operation, allowing the user to incorporate
power-saving ideas into their application’s
software design.
• Lower Consumption in Key Modules: The
power requirements for both Timer1 and the
Watchdog Timer have been reduced by up to
80%, with typical values of 1.1 µA and 2.1 µA,
respectively.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
MULTIPLE OSCILLATOR OPTIONS
AND FEATURES
All of the devices in the PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
family offer nine different oscillator options, allowing
users a wide range of choices in developing application
hardware. These include:
• Four Crystal modes, using crystals or ceramic
resonators.
• Two External Clock modes, offering the option of
using two pins (oscillator input and a divide-by-4
clock output) or one pin (oscillator input, with the
second pin reassigned as general I/O).
• Two External RC Oscillator modes, with the same
pin options as the External Clock modes.
• An internal oscillator block which provides an
8 MHz clock (±2% accuracy) and an INTRC
source (approximately 31 kHz, stable over
temperature and VDD), as well as a range of six
user selectable clock frequencies between
125 kHz to 4 MHz for a total of eight clock
frequencies. This option frees the two oscillator
pins for use as additional general purpose I/O.
• A Phase Lock Loop (PLL) frequency multiplier,
available to both the High-Speed Crystal and
Internal Oscillator modes, which allows clock
speeds of up to 40 MHz. Used with the internal
oscillator, the PLL gives users a complete
selection of clock speeds from 31 kHz to 32 MHz
– all without using an external crystal or clock
circuit.
Besides its availability as a clock source, the internal
oscillator block provides a stable reference source that
gives the family additional features for robust
operation:
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor: This option constantly
monitors the main clock source against a
reference signal provided by the internal
oscillator. If a clock failure occurs, the controller is
switched to the internal oscillator block, allowing
for continued low-speed operation or a safe
application shutdown.
• Two-Speed Start-up: This option allows the
internal oscillator to serve as the clock source
from Power-on Reset or wake-up from Sleep
mode until the primary clock source is available.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 7
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
1.2
Other Special Features
1.3
• Memory Endurance: The Flash cells for program
memory are rated to last for approximately a
thousand erase/write cycles. Data retention
without refresh is conservatively estimated to be
greater than 100 years.
• External Memory Interface: For those
applications where more program or data storage
is needed, the PIC18F8310/8410 devices provide
the ability to access external memory devices.
The memory interface is configurable for both
8-bit and 16-bit data widths and uses a standard
range of control signals to enable communication
with a wide range of memory devices. With their
21-bit program counters, the 80-pin devices can
access a linear memory space of up to 2 Mbytes.
• Extended Instruction Set: The
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 family introduces
an optional extension to the PIC18 instruction set,
which adds 8 new instructions and an Indexed
Addressing mode. This extension, enabled as a
device configuration option, has been specifically
designed to optimize re-entrant application code
originally developed in high-level languages such
as ‘C’.
• Enhanced Addressable USART: This serial
communication module is capable of standard
RS-232 operation and provides support for the LIN
bus protocol. Other enhancements include
Automatic Baud Rate Detection and a 16-bit Baud
Rate Generator for improved resolution. When the
microcontroller is using the internal oscillator
block, the EUSART provides stable operation for
applications that talk to the outside world, without
using an external crystal (or its accompanying
power requirement).
• 10-bit A/D Converter: This module incorporates
programmable acquisition time, allowing for a
channel to be selected and a conversion to be
initiated without waiting for a sampling period and
thus, reduces code overhead.
• Extended Watchdog Timer (WDT): This
enhanced version incorporates a 16-bit prescaler,
allowing a time-out range from 4 ms to over
2 minutes that is stable across operating voltage
and temperature.
DS39635A-page 8
Details on Individual Family
Members
Devices in the PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 family are
available in 64-pin (PIC18F6310/8310) and 80-pin
(PIC18F6410/8410) packages. Block diagrams for the
two groups are shown in Figure 1-1 and Figure 1-2,
respectively.
The devices are differentiated from each other in three
ways:
1.
2.
3.
Flash Program Memory: 8 Kbytes in PIC18FX310
devices, 16 Kbytes in PIC18FX410 devices.
I/O Ports: 7 bidirectional ports on 64-pin
devices, 9 bidirectional ports on 80-pin devices.
External Memory Interface: present on 80-pin
devices only.
All other features for devices in this family are identical.
These are summarized in Table 1-1.
The pinouts for all devices are listed in Table 1-2 and
Table 1-3.
Like all Microchip PIC18 devices, members of the
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 family are available as
both standard and low-voltage devices. Standard
devices with Flash memory, designated with an “F” in
the part number (such as PIC18F6310), accommodate
an operating VDD range of 4.2V to 5.5V. Low-voltage
parts, designated by “LF” (such as PIC18LF6410),
function over an extended VDD range of 2.0V to 5.5V.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-1:
DEVICE FEATURES
Features
PIC18F6310
PIC18F6410
PIC18F8310
PIC18F8410
DC – 40 MHz
DC – 40 MHz
DC – 40 MHz
DC – 40 MHz
8K
16K
8K
16K
Program Memory (Instructions)
4096
8192
4096
8192
Data Memory (Bytes)
768
768
768
768
External Memory Interface
No
No
Yes
Yes
Interrupt Sources
22
22
22
22
Operating Frequency
Program Memory (Bytes)
I/O Ports
Ports A, B, C, D, E, Ports A, B, C, D, E, Ports A, B, C, D, E, Ports A, B, C, D, E,
F, G
F, G
F, G, H, J
F, G, H, J
Timers
4
4
4
4
Capture/Compare/PWM Modules
3
3
3
3
Serial Communications
Parallel Communications
MSSP, AUSART
MSSP, AUSART
MSSP, AUSART
MSSP, AUSART
Enhanced USART Enhanced USART Enhanced USART Enhanced USART
PSP
PSP
PSP
PSP
10-bit Analog-to-Digital Module
12 Input Channels 12 Input Channels 12 Input Channels 12 Input Channels
Resets (and Delays)
POR, BOR, RESET POR, BOR, RESET POR, BOR, RESET POR, BOR, RESET
Instruction,
Instruction,
Instruction,
Instruction,
Stack Full,
Stack Full,
Stack Full,
Stack Full,
Stack Underflow
Stack Underflow
Stack Underflow
Stack Underflow
(PWRT, OST),
(PWRT, OST),
(PWRT, OST),
(PWRT, OST),
MCLR (optional), MCLR (optional), MCLR (optional), MCLR (optional),
WDT
WDT
WDT
WDT
Programmable Low-Voltage Detect
Programmable Brown-out Reset
Instruction Set
Packages
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
75 Instructions;
83 with Extended
Instruction Set
enabled
75 Instructions;
83 with Extended
Instruction Set
enabled
75 Instructions;
83 with Extended
Instruction Set
enabled
75 Instructions;
83 with Extended
Instruction Set
enabled
64-pin TQFP
64-pin TQFP
80-pin TQFP
80-pin TQFP
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 9
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 1-1:
PIC18F6310/6410 (64-PIN) BLOCK DIAGRAM
PORTA
Data Bus<8>
Table Pointer<21>
Data Latch
8
8
inc/dec logic
Data Memory
(8/16 Kbytes)
PCLATU PCLATH
21
RA0/AN0
RA1/AN1
RA2/AN2/VREFRA3/AN3/VREF+
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN
OSC2/CLKO(3)/RA6
OSC1/CLKI(3)/RA7
Address Latch
20
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
PORTB
12
Data Address<12>
RB0/INT0
RB1/INT1
RB2/INT2
RB3/INT3
RB4/KBI0
RB5/KBI1
RB6/KBI2/PGC
RB7/KBI3/PGD
31 Level Stack
4
BSR
Address Latch
Program Memory
(48/64 Kbytes)
STKPTR
4
Access
Bank
12
FSR0
FSR1
FSR2
Data Latch
12
inc/dec
logic
8
Table Latch
PORTC
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2(1)
RC2/CCP1
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
RC6/TX1/CK1
RC7/RX1/DT1
Address
Decode
ROM Latch
Instruction Bus <16>
IR
8
Instruction
Decode and
Control
RD7/PSP7:RD0/PSP0
PRODH PRODL
3
8 x 8 Multiply
8
BITOP
W
Internal
Oscillator
Block
OSC2(3)
T1OSI
INTRC
Oscillator
T1OSO
8 MHz
Oscillator
Single-Supply
Programming
In-Circuit
Debugger
MCLR(2)
VDD, VSS
ADC
10-bit
BOR
HLVD
Comparators
Note
1:
CCP1
Timer0
CCP2
Power-up
Timer
8
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Power-on
Reset
PORTE
RE0/RD
RE1/WR
RE2/CS
RE3
RE4
RE5
RE6
RE7/CCP2(1)
8
8
8
OSC1(3)
PORTD
State Machine
Control Signals
8
ALU<8>
8
PORTF
RF0/AN5
RF1/AN6/C2OUT
RF2/AN7/C1OUT
RF3/AN8
RF4/AN9
RF5/AN10/CVREF
RF6/AN11
RF7/SS
Watchdog
Timer
Precision
Band Gap
Reference
Brown-out
Reset
Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor
Timer1
CCP3
Timer2
MSSP
Timer3
EUSART1
PORTG
RG0/CCP3
RG1/TX2/CK2
RG2/RX2/DT2
RG3
RG4
RG5(2)/MCLR/VPP
AUSART2
CCP2 is multiplexed with RC1 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set, or RE7 when CCP2MX is not set.
2:
RG5 is only available when MCLR functionality is disabled.
3:
OSC1/CLKI and OSC2/CLKO are only available in select oscillator modes and when these pins are not being used as digital I/O.
Refer to Section 2.0 “Oscillator Configurations” for additional information.
DS39635A-page 10
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 1-2:
PIC18F8310/8410 (80-PIN) BLOCK DIAGRAM
PORTA
RA0/AN0
RA1/AN1
RA2/AN2/VREFRA3/AN3/VREF+
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN
OSC2/CLKO(3)/RA6
OSC1/CLKI(3)/RA7
Data Bus<8>
Table Pointer<21>
8
inc/dec logic
21
Data Latch
8
Data Memory
(8/16 Kbytes)
PCLATU PCLATH
Address Latch
20
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
PORTB
RB0/INT0
RB1/INT1
RB2/INT2
RB3/INT3/CCP2(1)
RB4/KBI0
RB5/KBI1
RB6/KBI2/PGC
RB7/KBI3/PGD
12
Data Address<12>
31 Level Stack
4
System Bus Interface
Address Latch
Program Memory
(48/64 Kbytes)
12
BSR
STKPTR
Data Latch
4
Access
Bank
FSR0
FSR1
FSR2
PORTC
12
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2(1)
RC2/CCP1
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC5/SDO
RC6/TX1/CK1
RC7/RX1/DT1
inc/dec
logic
8
TABLE LATCH
Address
Decode
ROM LATCH
Instruction Bus <16>
PORTD
IR
AD15:AD0, A19:A16
(Multiplexed with PORTD,
PORTE and PORTH)
RD7/AD7/PSP7:
RD0/AD0/PSP0
8
PORTE
State Machine
Control Signals
PRODH PRODL
Instruction
Decode &
Control
8 x 8 Multiply
3
8
W
BITOP
8
OSC1(3)
Internal
Oscillator
Block
OSC2(3)
T1OSI
INTRC
Oscillator
T1OSO
8 MHz
Oscillator
Single-Supply
Programming
In-Circuit
Debugger
MCLR(2)
VDD, VSS
Power-up
Timer
8
8
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
Power-on
Reset
8
8
PORTF
RF0/AN5
RF1/AN6/C2OUT
RF2/AN7/C1OUT
RF3/AN8
RF4/AN9
RF5/AN10/CVREF
RF6/AN11
RF7/SS
ALU<8>
8
Watchdog
Timer
Precision
Band Gap
Reference
Brown-out
Reset
Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor
RE0/AD8/RD
RE1/AD9/WR
RE2/AD10/CS
RE3/AD11
RE4/AD12
RE5/AD13
RE6/AD14
RE7/CCP2(1)/AD15
PORTG
RG0/CCP3
RG1/TX2/CK2
RG2/RX2/DT2
RG3
RG4
RG5(2)/MCLR/VPP
PORTH
ADC
10-bit
BOR
HLVD
RH3/AD19:RH0/AD16
Timer0
Timer1
Timer2
Timer3
RH7:RH4
PORTJ
Comparators
Note
1:
2:
3:
CCP1
CCP2
CCP3
MSSP
EUSART1
AUSART2
RJ0/ALE
RJ1/OE
RJ2/WRL
RJ3/WRH
RJ4/BA0
RJ5/CE
RJ6/LB
RJ7/UB
CCP2 multiplexing is determined by the settings of the CCP2MX and PM1:PM0 configuration bits.
RG5 is only available when MCLR functionality is disabled.
OSC1/CLKI and OSC2/CLKO are only available in select oscillator modes and when these pins are not being used as digital I/O.
Refer to Section 2.0 “Oscillator Configurations” for additional information.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 11
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
RG5/MCLR/VPP
RG5
MCLR
I
I
ST
ST
P
39
I
CLKI
I
RA7
OSC2/CLKO/RA6
OSC2
Buffer
Type
7
VPP
OSC1/CLKI/RA7
OSC1
Pin
Type
I/O
Description
Master Clear (input) or programming voltage (input).
Digital input.
Master Clear (Reset) input. This pin is an active-low
Reset to the device.
Programming voltage input.
Oscillator crystal or external clock input.
Oscillator crystal input or external clock source input.
ST buffer when configured in RC mode, CMOS
otherwise.
CMOS
External clock source input. Always associated
with pin function OSC1. (See related OSC1/CLKI,
OSC2/CLKO pins.)
TTL
General purpose I/O pin.
ST
40
O
—
CLKO
O
—
RA6
I/O
TTL
Oscillator crystal or clock output.
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or
resonator in Crystal Oscillator mode.
In RC mode, OSC2 pin outputs CLKO, which has
1/4 the frequency of OSC1 and denotes the
instruction cycle rate.
General purpose I/O pin.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
DS39635A-page 12
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTA is a bidirectional I/O port.
RA0/AN0
RA0
AN0
24
RA1/AN1
RA1
AN1
23
RA2/AN2/VREFRA2
AN2
VREF-
22
RA3/AN3/VREF+
RA3
AN3
VREF+
21
RA4/T0CKI
RA4
T0CKI
28
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN
RA5
AN4
HLVDIN
27
I/O
I
TTL
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 0.
I/O
I
TTL
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 1.
I/O
I
I
TTL
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 2.
A/D reference voltage (low) input.
I/O
I
I
TTL
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 3.
A/D reference voltage (high) input.
I/O
I
ST/OD
ST
Digital I/O. Open-drain when configured as output.
Timer0 external clock input.
I/O
I
I
TTL
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 4.
High/Low-Voltage Detect input.
RA6
See the OSC2/CLKO/RA6 pin.
RA7
See the OSC1/CLKI/RA7 pin.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 13
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port. PORTB can be software
programmed for internal weak pull-ups on all inputs.
RB0/INT0
RB0
INT0
48
RB1/INT1
RB1
INT1
47
RB2/INT2
RB2
INT2
46
RB3/INT3
RB3
INT3
45
RB4/KBI0
RB4
KBI0
44
RB5/KBI1
RB5
KBI1
43
RB6/KBI2/PGC
RB6
KBI2
PGC
42
RB7/KBI3/PGD
RB7
KBI3
PGD
37
I/O
I
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 0.
I/O
I
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 1.
I/O
I
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 2.
I/O
I
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 3.
I/O
I
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
I/O
I
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
I/O
I
I/O
TTL
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP™ programming clock pin.
I/O
I
I/O
TTL
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP programming data pin.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
DS39635A-page 14
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTC is a bidirectional I/O port.
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI
RC0
T1OSO
T13CKI
30
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2
RC1
T1OSI
CCP2(1)
29
RC2/CCP1
RC2
CCP1
33
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC3
SCK
SCL
34
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC4
SDI
SDA
35
RC5/SDO
RC5
SDO
36
RC6/TX1/CK1
RC6
TX1
CK1
31
RC7/RX1/DT1
RC7
RX1
DT1
32
I/O
O
I
ST
—
ST
I/O
I
I/O
ST
CMOS
ST
Digital I/O.
Timer1 oscillator input.
Capture 2 input/Compare 2 output/PWM 2 output.
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
Capture 1 input/Compare 1 output/PWM 1 output.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI™ mode.
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C™ mode.
I/O
I
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
SPI data in.
I2C data I/O.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
SPI data out.
I/O
O
I/O
ST
—
ST
Digital I/O.
EUSART1 asynchronous transmit.
EUSART1 synchronous clock (see related RX1/DT1).
I/O
I
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
EUSART1 asynchronous receive.
EUSART1 synchronous data (see related TX1/CK1).
Digital I/O.
Timer1 oscillator output.
Timer1/Timer3 external clock input.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 15
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTD is a bidirectional I/O port.
RD0/PSP0
RD0
PSP0
58
RD1/PSP1
RD1
PSP1
55
RD2/PSP2
RD2
PSP2
54
RD3/PSP3
RD3
PSP3
53
RD4/PSP4
RD4
PSP4
52
RD5/PSP5
RD5
PSP5
51
RD6/PSP6
RD6
PSP6
50
RD7/PSP7
RD7
PSP7
49
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Parallel Slave Port data.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
DS39635A-page 16
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTE is a bidirectional I/O port.
RE0/RD
RE0
RD
2
RE1/WR
RE1
WR
1
RE2/CS
RE2
CS
64
RE3
I/O
I
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Read control for Parallel Slave Port.
I/O
I
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Write control for Parallel Slave Port.
I/O
I
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Chip select control for Parallel Slave Port.
63
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
RE4
62
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
RE5
61
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
RE6
60
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
RE7/CCP2
RE7
CCP2(2)
59
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
Capture 2 input/Compare 2 output/PWM 2 output.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 17
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTF is a bidirectional I/O port.
RF0/AN5
RF0
AN5
18
RF1/AN6/C2OUT
RF1
AN6
C2OUT
17
RF2/AN7/C1OUT
RF2
AN7
C1OUT
16
RF3/AN8
RF3
AN8
15
RF4/AN9
RF4
AN9
14
RF5/AN10/CVREF
RF5
AN10
CVREF
13
RF6/AN11
RF6
AN11
12
RF7/SS
RF7
SS
11
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 5.
I/O
I
O
ST
Analog
—
Digital I/O.
Analog input 6.
Comparator 2 output.
I/O
I
O
ST
Analog
—
Digital I/O.
Analog input 7.
Comparator 1 output.
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 8.
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 9.
I/O
I
O
ST
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 10.
Comparator reference voltage output.
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 11.
I/O
I
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
SPI slave select input.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
DS39635A-page 18
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F6310/6410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTG is a bidirectional I/O port.
RG0/CCP3
RG0
CCP3
3
RG1/TX2/CK2
RG1
TX2
CK2
4
RG2/RX2/DT2
RG2
RX2
DT2
5
RG3
RG4
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
Capture 3 input/Compare 3 output/PWM 3 output.
I/O
O
I/O
ST
—
ST
Digital I/O.
AUSART2 asynchronous transmit.
AUSART2 synchronous clock (see related RX2/DT2).
I/O
I
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
AUSART2 asynchronous receive.
AUSART2 synchronous data (see related TX2/CK2).
6
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
8
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
See RG5/MCLR/VPP pin.
RG5
VSS
9, 25, 41, 56
P
—
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
VDD
10, 26, 38, 57
P
—
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
AVSS
20
P
—
Ground reference for analog modules.
AVDD
19
P
—
Positive supply for analog modules.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Default assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is set.
2: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 19
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
RG5/MCLR/VPP
RG5
MCLR
I
I
ST
ST
P
49
I
CLKI
I
RA7
OSC2/CLKO/RA6
OSC2
Buffer
Type
9
VPP
OSC1/CLKI/RA7
OSC1
Pin
Type
I/O
Description
Master Clear (input) or programming voltage (input).
Digital input.
Master Clear (Reset) input. This pin is an active-low
Reset to the device.
Programming voltage input.
Oscillator crystal or external clock input.
Oscillator crystal input or external clock source input.
ST buffer when configured in RC mode, CMOS
otherwise.
CMOS
External clock source input. Always associated with
pin function OSC1. (See related OSC1/CLKI,
OSC2/CLKO pins.)
TTL
General purpose I/O pin.
ST
50
O
—
CLKO
O
—
RA6
I/O
TTL
Oscillator crystal or clock output.
Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or
resonator in Crystal Oscillator mode.
In RC mode, OSC2 pin outputs CLKO, which has
1/4 the frequency of OSC1 and denotes the
instruction cycle rate.
General purpose I/O pin.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
DS39635A-page 20
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTA is a bidirectional I/O port.
RA0/AN0
RA0
AN0
30
RA1/AN1
RA1
AN1
29
RA2/AN2/VREFRA2
AN2
VREF-
28
RA3/AN3/VREF+
RA3
AN3
VREF+
27
RA4/T0CKI
RA4
T0CKI
34
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN
RA5
AN4
HLVDIN
33
I/O
I
TTL
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 0.
I/O
I
TTL
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 1.
I/O
I
I
TTL
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 2.
A/D reference voltage (low) input.
I/O
I
I
TTL
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 3.
A/D reference voltage (high) input.
I/O
I
ST/OD
ST
Digital I/O. Open-drain when configured as output.
Timer0 external clock input.
I/O
I
I
TTL
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 4.
High/Low-Voltage Detect input.
RA6
See the OSC2/CLKO/RA6 pin.
RA7
See the OSC1/CLKI/RA7 pin.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 21
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port. PORTB can be software
programmed for internal weak pull-ups on all inputs.
RB0/INT0
RB0
INT0
58
RB1/INT1
RB1
INT1
57
RB2/INT2
RB2
INT2
56
RB3/INT3/CCP2
RB3
INT3
CCP2(1)
55
RB4/KBI0
RB4
KBI0
54
RB5/KBI1
RB5
KBI1
53
RB6/KBI2/PGC
RB6
KBI2
PGC
52
RB7/KBI3/PGD
RB7
KBI3
PGD
47
I/O
I
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 0.
I/O
I
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 1.
I/O
I
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 2.
I/O
I
O
TTL
ST
Analog
I/O
I
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
I/O
I
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
I/O
I
I/O
TTL
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP™ programming clock pin.
I/O
I
I/O
TTL
TTL
ST
Digital I/O.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP programming data pin.
Digital I/O.
External interrupt 3.
Capture 2 input/Compare 2 output/PWM 2 output.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
DS39635A-page 22
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTC is a bidirectional I/O port.
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI
RC0
T1OSO
T13CKI
36
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2
RC1
T1OSI
CCP2(2)
35
RC2/CCP1
RC2
CCP1
43
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC3
SCK
SCL
44
RC4/SDI/SDA
RC4
SDI
SDA
45
RC5/SDO
RC5
SDO
46
RC6/TX1/CK1
RC6
TX1
CK1
37
RC7/RX1/DT1
RC7
RX1
DT1
38
I/O
O
I
ST
—
ST
Digital I/O.
Timer1 oscillator output.
Timer1/Timer3 external clock input.
I/O
I
I/O
ST
CMOS
ST
Digital I/O.
Timer1 oscillator input.
Capture 2 input/Compare 2 output/PWM 2 output.
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
Capture 1 input/Compare 1 output/PWM 1 output.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI™ mode.
Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C™ mode.
I/O
I
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
SPI data in.
I2C data I/O.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
SPI data out.
I/O
O
I/O
ST
—
ST
Digital I/O.
EUSART1 asynchronous transmit.
EUSART1 synchronous clock (see related RX1/DT1).
I/O
I
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
EUSART1 asynchronous receive.
EUSART1 synchronous data (see related TX1/CK1).
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 23
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTD is a bidirectional I/O port.
RD0/AD0/PSP0
RD0
AD0
PSP0
72
RD1/AD1/PSP1
RD1
AD1
PSP1
69
RD2/AD2/PSP2
RD2
AD2
PSP2
68
RD3/AD3/PSP3
RD3
AD3
PSP3
67
RD4/AD4/PSP4
RD4
AD4
PSP4
66
RD5/AD5/PSP5
RD5
AD5
PSP5
65
RD6/AD6/PSP6
RD6
AD6
PSP6
64
RD7/AD7/PSP7
RD7
AD7
PSP7
63
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 0.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 1.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 2.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 3.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 4.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 5.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 6.
Parallel Slave Port data.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 7.
Parallel Slave Port data.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
DS39635A-page 24
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTE is a bidirectional I/O port.
RE0/AD8/RD
RE0
AD8
RD
4
RE1/AD9/WR
RE1
AD9
WR
3
RE2/AD10/CS
RE2
AD10
CS
78
RE3/AD11
RE3
AD11
77
RE4/AD12
RE4
AD12
76
RE5/AD13
RE5
AD13
75
RE6/AD14
RE6
AD14
74
RE7/CCP2/AD15
RE7
CCP2(3)
AD15
73
I/O
I/O
I
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 8.
Read control for Parallel Slave Port.
I/O
I/O
I
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 9.
Write control for Parallel Slave Port.
I/O
I/O
I
ST
TTL
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 10.
Chip Select control for Parallel Slave Port.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 11.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 12.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 13.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 14.
I/O
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
Capture 2 input/Compare 2 output/PWM 2 output.
External memory address/data 15.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 25
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTF is a bidirectional I/O port.
RF0/AN5
RF0
AN5
24
RF1/AN6/C2OUT
RF1
AN6
C2OUT
23
RF2/AN7/C1OUT
RF2
AN7
C1OUT
18
RF3/AN8
RF3
AN8
17
RF4/AN9
RF4
AN9
16
RF5/AN10/CVREF
RF5
AN10
CVREF
15
RF6/AN11
RF6
AN11
14
RF7/SS
RF7
SS
13
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 5.
I/O
I
O
ST
Analog
—
Digital I/O.
Analog input 6.
Comparator 2 output.
I/O
I
O
ST
Analog
—
Digital I/O.
Analog input 7.
Comparator 1 output.
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 8.
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 9.
I/O
I
O
ST
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 10.
Comparator reference voltage output.
I/O
I
ST
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 11.
I/O
I
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
SPI slave select input.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
DS39635A-page 26
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTG is a bidirectional I/O port.
RG0/CCP3
RG0
CCP3
5
RG1/TX2/CK2
RG1
TX2
CK2
6
RG2/RX2/DT2
RG2
RX2
DT2
7
RG3
RG4
I/O
I/O
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
Capture 3 input/Compare 3 output/PWM 3 output.
I/O
O
I/O
ST
—
ST
Digital I/O.
AUSART2 asynchronous transmit.
AUSART2 synchronous clock (see related RX2/DT2).
I/O
I
I/O
ST
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
AUSART2 asynchronous receive.
AUSART2 synchronous data (see related TX2/CK2).
8
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
10
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
See RG5/MCLR/VPP pin.
RG5
PORTH is a bidirectional I/O port.
RH0/AD16
RH0
AD16
79
RH1/AD17
RH1
AD17
80
RH2/AD18
RH2
AD18
1
RH3/AD19
RH3
AD19
2
RH4
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 16.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 17.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 18.
I/O
I/O
ST
TTL
Digital I/O.
External memory address/data 19.
22
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
RH5
21
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
RH6
20
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
RH7
19
I/O
ST
Digital I/O.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 27
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 1-3:
PIC18F8310/8410 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Name
TQFP
Pin
Type
Buffer
Type
Description
PORTJ is a bidirectional I/O port.
RJ0/ALE
RJ0
ALE
62
RJ1/OE
RJ1
OE
61
RJ2/WRL
RJ2
WRL
60
RJ3/WRH
RJ3
WRH
59
RJ4/BA0
RJ4
BA0
39
RJ5/CE
RJ4
CE
40
RJ6/LB
RJ6
LB
41
RJ7/UB
RJ7
UB
42
VSS
11, 31, 51, 70
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
External memory address latch enable.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
External memory output enable.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
External memory write low control.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
External memory write high control.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
External memory Byte Address 0 control.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O
External memory chip enable control.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
External memory low byte control.
I/O
O
ST
—
Digital I/O.
External memory high byte control.
P
—
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
VDD
12, 32, 48, 71
P
—
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
AVSS
26
P
—
Ground reference for analog modules.
AVDD
25
P
—
Positive supply for analog modules.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
Analog = Analog input
I
= Input
O
= Output
P
= Power
OD
= Open-Drain (no P diode to VDD)
Note 1: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when configuration bit CCP2MX is cleared (all operating modes except
Microcontroller mode).
2: Default assignment for CCP2 in all operating modes (CCP2MX is set).
3: Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX is cleared (Microcontroller mode only).
DS39635A-page 28
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
2.0
OSCILLATOR
CONFIGURATIONS
2.1
Oscillator Types
FIGURE 2-1:
C1(1)
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices can be operated
in ten different oscillator modes. The user can program
the configuration bits, FOSC3:FOSC0, in Configuration
Register 1H to select one of these ten modes:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Low-Power Crystal
Crystal/Resonator
High-Speed Crystal/Resonator
High-Speed Crystal/Resonator
with PLL enabled
5. RC
External Resistor/Capacitor with
FOSC/4 output on RA6
6. RCIO
External Resistor/Capacitor with I/O
on RA6
7. INTIO1 Internal Oscillator with FOSC/4 output
on RA6 and I/O on RA7
8. INTIO2 Internal Oscillator with I/O on RA6
and RA7
9. EC
External Clock with FOSC/4 output
10. ECIO
External Clock with I/O on RA6
To
Internal
Logic
RF(3)
Sleep
RS(2)
C2(1)
PIC18FXXXX
OSC2
Note 1:
See Table 2-1 and Table 2-2 for initial values of
C1 and C2.
2:
A series resistor (RS) may be required for AT
strip cut crystals.
3:
RF varies with the oscillator mode chosen.
TABLE 2-1:
CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
CERAMIC RESONATORS
Typical Capacitor Values Used:
Mode
Freq
OSC1
OSC2
XT
455 kHz
2.0 MHz
4.0 MHz
56 pF
47 pF
33 pF
56 pF
47 pF
33 pF
HS
8.0 MHz
16.0 MHz
27 pF
22 pF
27 pF
22 pF
Crystal Oscillator/Ceramic
Resonators
In XT, LP, HS or HSPLL Oscillator modes, a crystal or
ceramic resonator is connected to the OSC1 and
OSC2 pins to establish oscillation. Figure 2-1 shows
the pin connections.
The oscillator design requires the use of a parallel cut
crystal.
Note:
OSC1
XTAL
LP
XT
HS
HSPLL
2.2
CRYSTAL/CERAMIC
RESONATOR OPERATION
(XT, LP, HS OR HSPLL
CONFIGURATION)
Use of a series cut crystal may give a frequency out of the crystal manufacturer’s
specifications.
Capacitor values are for design guidance only.
These capacitors were tested with the resonators
listed below for basic start-up and operation. These
values are not optimized.
Different capacitor values may be required to produce
acceptable oscillator operation. The user should test
the performance of the oscillator over the expected
VDD and temperature range for the application.
See the notes following Table 2-2 for additional
information.
Resonators Used:
455 kHz
4.0 MHz
2.0 MHz
8.0 MHz
16.0 MHz
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 29
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 2-2:
Osc Type
LP
XT
HS
CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR
Crystal
Freq
Typical Capacitor Values
Tested:
C1
C2
32 kHz
33 pF
33 pF
200 kHz
15 pF
15 pF
1 MHz
33 pF
33 pF
4 MHz
27 pF
27 pF
4 MHz
27 pF
27 pF
8 MHz
22 pF
22 pF
20 MHz
15 pF
15 pF
FIGURE 2-2:
EXTERNAL CLOCK
INPUT OPERATION
(HS OSCILLATOR
CONFIGURATION)
OSC1
Clock from
Ext. System
PIC18FXXXX
Open
2.3
Capacitor values are for design guidance only.
These capacitors were tested with the crystals listed
below for basic start-up and operation. These values
are not optimized.
Different capacitor values may be required to produce
acceptable oscillator operation. The user should test
the performance of the oscillator over the expected
VDD and temperature range for the application.
See the notes following this table for additional
information.
Crystals Used:
32 kHz
An external clock source may also be connected to the
OSC1 pin in the HS mode, as shown in Figure 2-2.
External Clock Input
The EC and ECIO Oscillator modes require an external
clock source to be connected to the OSC1 pin. There is
no oscillator start-up time required after a Power-on
Reset or after an exit from Sleep mode.
In the EC Oscillator mode, the oscillator frequency
divided by 4 is available on the OSC2 pin. This signal
may be used for test purposes or to synchronize other
logic. Figure 2-3 shows the pin connections for the EC
Oscillator mode.
FIGURE 2-3:
EXTERNAL CLOCK
INPUT OPERATION
(EC CONFIGURATION)
4 MHz
200 kHz
8 MHz
1 MHz
20 MHz
OSC1/CLKI
Clock from
Ext. System
Note 1: Higher capacitance increases the stability
of oscillator, but also increases the
start-up time.
2: When operating below 3V VDD, or when
using certain ceramic resonators at any
voltage, it may be necessary to use the
HS mode or switch to a crystal oscillator.
3: Since each resonator/crystal has its own
characteristics, the user should consult
the resonator/crystal manufacturer for
appropriate
values
of
external
components.
(HS Mode)
OSC2
PIC18FXXXX
FOSC/4
OSC2/CLKO
The ECIO Oscillator mode functions like the EC mode,
except that the OSC2 pin becomes an additional general purpose I/O pin. The I/O pin becomes bit 6 of
PORTA (RA6). Figure 2-4 shows the pin connections
for the ECIO Oscillator mode.
FIGURE 2-4:
EXTERNAL CLOCK
INPUT OPERATION
(ECIO CONFIGURATION)
4: Rs may be required to avoid overdriving
crystals with low drive level specification.
5: Always verify oscillator performance over
the VDD and temperature range that is
expected for the application.
DS39635A-page 30
OSC1/CLKI
Clock from
Ext. System
Preliminary
PIC18FXXXX
RA6
I/O (OSC2)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
2.4
RC Oscillator
2.5
For timing insensitive applications, the “RC” and
“RCIO” device options offer additional cost savings.
The actual oscillator frequency is a function of several
factors:
• Supply voltage
• Values of the external resistor (REXT) and
capacitor (CEXT)
• Operating temperature
PLL Frequency Multiplier
A Phase Locked Loop (PLL) circuit is provided as an
option for users who want to use a lower frequency
oscillator circuit, or to clock the device up to its highest
rated frequency from a crystal oscillator. This may be
useful for customers who are concerned with EMI due
to high-frequency crystals, or users who require higher
clock speeds from an internal oscillator.
2.5.1
HSPLL OSCILLATOR MODE
Given the same device, operating voltage and
temperature and component values, there will also be
unit-to-unit frequency variations. These are due to
factors such as:
The HSPLL mode makes use of the HS Oscillator
mode for frequencies up to 10 MHz. A PLL then
multiplies the oscillator output frequency by 4 to
produce an internal clock frequency up to 40 MHz.
• Normal manufacturing variation
• Difference in lead frame capacitance between
package types (especially for low CEXT values)
• Variations within the tolerance of limits of REXT
and CEXT
The PLL is only available to the crystal oscillator when
the FOSC3:FOSC0 configuration bits are programmed
for HSPLL mode (= 0110).
FIGURE 2-7:
In the RC Oscillator mode, the oscillator frequency
divided by 4 is available on the OSC2 pin. This signal
may be used for test purposes or to synchronize other
logic. Figure 2-5 shows how the R/C combination is
connected.
FIGURE 2-5:
PLL BLOCK DIAGRAM
(HS MODE)
HS Oscillator Enable
PLL Enable
(from Configuration Register 1H)
OSC2
RC OSCILLATOR MODE
HS Mode
Crystal
OSC1
Oscillator
VDD
FIN
Phase
Comparator
FOUT
REXT
OSC1
Internal
Clock
Loop
Filter
CEXT
PIC18FXXXX
VSS
÷4
VCO
MUX
FOSC/4
OSC2/CLKO
Recommended values: 3 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ
CEXT > 20 pF
The RCIO Oscillator mode (Figure 2-6) functions like
the RC mode, except that the OSC2 pin becomes an
additional general purpose I/O pin. The I/O pin
becomes bit 6 of PORTA (RA6).
FIGURE 2-6:
RCIO OSCILLATOR MODE
VDD
2.5.2
SYSCLK
PLL AND INTOSC
The PLL is also available to the internal oscillator block
in selected oscillator modes. In this configuration, the
PLL is enabled in software and generates a clock output of up to 32 MHz. The operation of INTOSC with the
PLL is described in Section 2.6.4 “PLL in INTOSC
Modes”.
REXT
OSC1
Internal
Clock
CEXT
PIC18FXXXX
VSS
RA6
I/O (OSC2)
Recommended values: 3 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ
CEXT > 20 pF
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 31
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
2.6
Internal Oscillator Block
The PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices include an
internal oscillator block, which generates two different
clock signals; either can be used as the microcontroller’s clock source. This may eliminate the need for
external oscillator circuits on the OSC1 and/or OSC2
pins.
The main output (INTOSC) is an 8 MHz clock source,
which can be used to directly drive the device clock. It
also drives a postscaler, which can provide a range of
clock frequencies from 31 kHz to 4 MHz. The INTOSC
output is enabled when a clock frequency from 125 kHz
to 8 MHz is selected.
The other clock source is the internal RC oscillator
(INTRC), which provides a nominal 31 kHz output.
INTRC is enabled if it is selected as the device clock
source; it is also enabled automatically when any of the
following are enabled:
•
•
•
•
Power-up Timer
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
Watchdog Timer
Two-Speed Start-up
These features are discussed in greater detail in
Section 23.0 “Special Features of the CPU”.
The clock source frequency (INTOSC direct, INTRC
direct or INTOSC postscaler) is selected by configuring
the IRCF bits of the OSCCON register (Register 2-2).
2.6.1
INTIO MODES
Using the internal oscillator as the clock source eliminates the need for up to two external oscillator pins,
which can then be used for digital I/O. Two distinct
configurations are available:
• In INTIO1 mode, the OSC2 pin outputs FOSC/4,
while OSC1 functions as RA7 for digital input and
output.
• In INTIO2 mode, OSC1 functions as RA7 and
OSC2 functions as RA6, both for digital input and
output.
2.6.2
INTOSC OUTPUT FREQUENCY
The internal oscillator block is calibrated at the factory
to produce an INTOSC output frequency of 8.0 MHz.
The INTRC oscillator operates independently of the
INTOSC source. Any changes in INTOSC across
voltage and temperature are not necessarily reflected
by changes in INTRC and vice versa.
2.6.3
OSCTUNE REGISTER
When the OSCTUNE register is modified, the INTOSC
and INTRC frequencies will begin shifting to the new
frequency. The INTRC clock will reach the new
frequency within 8 clock cycles (approximately
8 * 32 µs = 256 µs). The INTOSC clock will stabilize
within 1 ms. Code execution continues during this shift.
There is no indication that the shift has occurred.
The OSCTUNE register also implements the INTSRC
and PLLEN bits, which control certain features of the
internal oscillator block. The INTSRC bit allows users
to select which internal oscillator provides the clock
source when the 31 kHz frequency option is selected.
This is covered in greater detail in Section 2.7.1
“Oscillator Control Register”.
The PLLEN bit controls the operation of the frequency
multiplier, PLL, in internal oscillator modes.
2.6.4
PLL IN INTOSC MODES
The 4x frequency multiplier can be used with the
internal oscillator block to produce faster device clock
speeds than are normally possible with an internal
oscillator. When enabled, the PLL produces a clock
speed of up to 32 MHz.
Unlike HSPLL mode, the PLL is controlled through
software. The control bit, PLLEN (OSCTUNE<6>), is
used to enable or disable its operation.
The PLL is available when the device is configured to use
the internal oscillator block as its primary clock source
(FOSC3:FOSC0 = 1001 or 1000). Additionally, the PLL
will only function when the selected output frequency is
either 4 MHz or 8 MHz (OSCCON<6:4> = 111 or 110). If
both of these conditions are not met, the PLL is disabled.
The PLLEN control bit is only functional in those internal oscillator modes where the PLL is available. In all
other modes, it is forced to ‘0’ and is effectively
unavailable.
2.6.5
INTOSC FREQUENCY DRIFT
The factory calibrates the internal oscillator block output (INTOSC) for 8 MHz. However, this frequency may
drift as VDD or temperature changes, which can affect
the controller operation in a variety of ways. It is possible to adjust the INTOSC frequency by modifying the
value in the OSTUNE register. This has no effect on the
INTRC clock source frequency.
Tuning the INTOSC source requires knowing when to
make the adjustment, in which direction it should be
made and in some cases, how large a change is
needed. Three examples follow, but other techniques
may be used.
The internal oscillator’s output has been calibrated at
the factory, but can be adjusted in the user’s application. This is done by writing to the OSCTUNE register
(Register 2-1). The tuning sensitivity is constant
throughout the tuning range.
DS39635A-page 32
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
2.6.5.1
Compensating with the AUSART
An adjustment may be required when the AUSART
begins to generate framing errors or receives data with
errors while in Asynchronous mode. Framing errors
indicate that the device clock frequency is too high; to
adjust for this, decrement the value in OSTUNE to
reduce the clock frequency. On the other hand, errors
in data may suggest that the clock speed is too low; to
compensate, increment OSTUNE to increase the clock
frequency.
2.6.5.2
Compensating with the Timers
This technique compares device clock speed to some
reference clock. Two timers may be used; one timer is
clocked by the peripheral clock, while the other is
clocked by a fixed reference source, such as the
Timer1 oscillator.
Both timers are cleared, but the timer clocked by the
reference generates interrupts. When an interrupt
occurs, the internally clocked timer is read and both
timers are cleared. If the internally clocked timer value
REGISTER 2-1:
is greater than expected, then the internal oscillator
block is running too fast. To adjust for this, decrement
the OSCTUNE register.
2.6.5.3
Compensating with the Timers
A CCP module can use free running Timer1 (or
Timer3), clocked by the internal oscillator block and an
external event with a known period (i.e., AC power
frequency). The time of the first event is captured in the
CCPRxH:CCPRxL registers and is recorded. When the
second event causes a capture, the time of the first
event is subtracted from the time of the second event.
Since the period of the external event is known, the
time difference between events can be calculated.
If the measured time is much greater than the
calculated time, then the internal oscillator block is
running too fast; to compensate, decrement the
OSTUNE register. If the measured time is much less
than the calculated time, then the internal oscillator
block is running too slow; to compensate, increment
the OSTUNE register.
OSCTUNE: OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0(1)
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
INTSRC
PLLEN(1)
—
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
INTSRC: Internal Oscillator Low-Frequency Source Select bit
1 = 31.25 kHz device clock derived from 8 MHz INTOSC source (divide-by-256 enabled)
0 = 31 kHz device clock derived directly from INTRC internal oscillator
bit 6
PLLEN: Frequency Multiplier PLL for INTOSC Enable bit(1)
1 = PLL enabled for INTOSC (4 MHz and 8 MHz only)
0 = PLL disabled
Note 1: Available only in certain oscillator configurations; otherwise, this bit is unavailable
and reads as ‘0’. See Section 2.6.4 “PLL in INTOSC Modes” for details.
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-0
TUN4:TUN0: Frequency Tuning bits
01111 = Maximum frequency
•
•
•
•
00001
00000 = Center frequency. Oscillator module is running at the calibrated frequency.
11111
•
•
•
•
10000 = Minimum frequency
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 33
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
2.7
Clock Sources and
Oscillator Switching
Like
previous
PIC18
devices,
the
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 family includes a feature
that allows the device clock source to be switched from
the main oscillator to an alternate low-frequency clock
source. PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices offer two
alternate clock sources. When an alternate clock source
is enabled, the various power managed operating
modes are available.
Essentially, there are three clock sources for these
devices:
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices offer the Timer1
oscillator as a secondary oscillator. This oscillator, in all
power managed modes, is often the time base for
functions such as a real-time clock.
Most often, a 32.768 kHz watch crystal is connected
between the RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI and RC1/T1OSI
pins. Like the LP mode oscillator circuit, loading
capacitors are also connected from each pin to ground.
The Timer1 oscillator is discussed in greater detail in
Section 12.3 “Timer1 Oscillator”.
• Primary oscillators
• Secondary oscillators
• Internal oscillator block
The primary oscillators include the External Crystal
and Resonator modes, the External RC modes, the
External Clock modes and the internal oscillator block.
The particular mode is defined by the FOSC3:FOSC0
configuration bits. The details of these modes are
covered earlier in this chapter.
FIGURE 2-8:
The secondary oscillators are those external sources
not connected to the OSC1 or OSC2 pins. These
sources may continue to operate even after the
controller is placed in a power managed mode.
In addition to being a primary clock source, the internal
oscillator block is available as a power managed
mode clock source. The INTRC source is also used as
the clock source for several special features, such as
the WDT and Fail-Safe Clock Monitor.
The clock sources for the PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
devices are shown in Figure 2-8. See Section 23.0
“Special Features of the CPU” for configuration
register details.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 CLOCK DIAGRAM
PIC18F6X10/8X10
Primary Oscillator
LP, XT, HS, RC, EC
OSC2
Sleep
4 x PLL
OSC1
OSCTUNE<6>
Secondary Oscillator
T1OSCEN
Enable
Oscillator
OSCCON<6:4>
8 MHz
OSCCON<6:4>
INTRC
Source
4 MHz
Internal Oscillator
CPU
111
110
2 MHz
31 kHz (INTRC)
1 MHz
500 kHz
250 kHz
125 kHz
IDLEN
101
100
011
MUX
8 MHz
(INTOSC)
Postscaler
Internal
Oscillator
Block
8 MHz
Source
Peripherals
MUX
T1OSC
T1OSO
T1OSI
HSPLL, INTOSC/PLL
010
001
1 31 kHz
000
0
Clock
Control
FOSC3:FOSC0
OSCCON<1:0>
Clock Source Option
for other Modules
OSCTUNE<7>
WDT, PWRT, FSCM
and Two-Speed Start-up
DS39635A-page 34
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
2.7.1
OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
The OSCCON register (Register 2-2) controls several
aspects of the device clock’s operation, both in full
power operation and in power managed modes.
The System Clock Select bits, SCS1:SCS0, select the
clock source. The available clock sources are the primary clock (defined by the FOSC:FOSC0 configuration
bits), the secondary clock (Timer1 oscillator) and the
internal oscillator block. The clock source changes
immediately after one or more of the bits is written to,
following a brief clock transition interval. The SCS bits
are cleared on all forms of Reset.
The Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits,
IRCF2:IRCF0, select the frequency output of the
internal oscillator block to drive the device clock. The
choices are the INTRC source, the INTOSC source
(8 MHz) or one of the frequencies derived from the
INTOSC postscaler (31.25 kHz to 4 MHz). If the internal
oscillator block is supplying the device clock, changing
the states of these bits will have an immediate change
on the internal oscillator’s output.
When an output frequency of 31 kHz is selected
(IRCF2:IRCF0 = 000), users may choose which internal oscillator acts as the source. This is done with the
INTSRC bit in the OSCTUNE register (OSCTUNE<7>).
Setting this bit selects INTOSC as a 31.25 kHz clock
source by enabling the divide-by-256 output of the
INTOSC postscaler. Clearing INTSRC selects INTRC
(nominally 31 kHz) as the clock source.
This option allows users to select the tunable and more
precise INTOSC as a clock source, while maintaining
power savings with a very low clock speed. Regardless
of the setting of INTSRC, INTRC always remains the
clock source for features such as the Watchdog Timer
and the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor.
The IDLEN bit determines if the device goes into Sleep
mode or one of the Idle modes when the SLEEP
instruction is executed.
The use of the flag and control bits in the OSCCON
register is discussed in more detail in Section 3.0
“Power Managed Modes”.
Note 1: The Timer1 oscillator must be enabled to
select the secondary clock source. The
Timer1 oscillator is enabled by setting the
T1OSCEN bit in the Timer1 Control register (T1CON<3>). If the Timer1 oscillator is
not enabled, then any attempt to select a
secondary clock source when executing a
SLEEP instruction will be ignored.
2: It is recommended that the Timer1
oscillator be operating and stable before
executing the SLEEP instruction or a very
long delay may occur while the Timer1
oscillator starts.
2.7.2
OSCILLATOR TRANSITIONS
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices contain circuitry
to prevent clock “glitches” when switching between
clock sources. A short pause in the device clock occurs
during the clock switch. The length of this pause is the
sum of two cycles of the old clock source and three to
four cycles of the new clock source. This formula
assumes that the new clock source is stable.
Clock transitions are discussed in greater detail in
Section 3.1.2 “Entering Power Managed Modes”.
The OSTS, IOFS and T1RUN bits indicate which clock
source is currently providing the device clock. The
OSTS bit indicates that the Oscillator Start-up Timer
has timed out and the primary clock is providing the
device clock in primary clock modes. The IOFS bit indicates when the internal oscillator block has stabilized
and is providing the device clock in RC Clock modes.
The T1RUN bit (T1CON<6>) indicates when the
Timer1 oscillator is providing the device clock in
secondary clock modes. In power managed modes,
only one of these three bits will be set at any time. If
none of these bits are set, the INTRC is providing the
clock, or the internal oscillator block has just started
and is not yet stable.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 35
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 2-2:
OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R(1)
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
IDLEN
IRCF2
IRCF1
IRCF0
OSTS
IOFS
SCS1
SCS0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
IDLEN: Idle Enable bit
1 = Device enters Idle mode on SLEEP instruction
0 = Device enters Sleep mode on SLEEP instruction
bit 6-4
IRCF2:IRCF0: Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits
111 = 8 MHz (INTOSC drives clock directly)
110 = 4 MHz
101 = 2 MHz
100 = 1 MHz(3)
011 = 500 kHz
010 = 250 kHz
001 = 125 kHz
000 = 31 kHz (from either INTOSC/256 or INTRC directly)(2)
bit 3
OSTS: Oscillator Start-up Time-out Status bit(1)
1 = Oscillator Start-up Timer time-out has expired; primary oscillator is running
0 = Oscillator Start-up Timer time-out is running; primary oscillator is not ready
bit 2
IOFS: INTOSC Frequency Stable bit
1 = INTOSC frequency is stable
0 = INTOSC frequency is not stable
bit 1-0
SCS1:SCS0: System Clock Select bits
1x = Internal oscillator block
01 = Timer1 oscillator
00 = Primary oscillator
Note 1: Depends on state of the IESO configuration bit.
2: Source selected by the INTSRC bit (OSCTUNE<7>), see
Section 2.6.3 “OSCTUNE Register”.
3: Default output frequency of INTOSC on Reset.
Legend:
DS39635A-page 36
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
2.8
Effects of Power Managed Modes
on the Various Clock Sources
When PRI_IDLE mode is selected, the designated
primary oscillator continues to run without interruption.
For all other power managed modes, the oscillator
using the OSC1 pin is disabled. The OSC1 pin (and
OSC2 pin, if used by the oscillator) will stop oscillating.
In Secondary Clock modes (SEC_RUN and
SEC_IDLE), the Timer1 oscillator is operating and
providing the device clock. The Timer1 oscillator may
also run in all power managed modes if required to
clock Timer1 or Timer3.
In Internal Oscillator modes (RC_RUN and RC_IDLE),
the internal oscillator block provides the device clock
source. The 31 kHz INTRC output can be used directly
to provide the clock and may be enabled to support various special features, regardless of the power managed
mode (see Section 23.2 “Watchdog Timer (WDT)”
through Section 23.4 “Fail-Safe Clock Monitor” for
more information on WDT, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor and
Two-Speed Start-up). The INTOSC output at 8 MHz may
be used directly to clock the device, or may be divided
down by the postscaler. The INTOSC output is disabled
if the clock is provided directly from the INTRC output.
If the Sleep mode is selected, all clock sources are
stopped. Since all the transistor switching currents
have been stopped, Sleep mode achieves the lowest
current consumption of the device (only leakage
currents).
2.9
Power-up Delays
Power-up delays are controlled by two timers, so that no
external Reset circuitry is required for most applications.
The delays ensure that the device is kept in Reset until
the device power supply is stable under normal
circumstances and the primary clock is operating and
stable. For additional information on power-up delays,
see Section 4.5 “Device Reset Timers”.
The first timer is the Power-up Timer (PWRT), which
provides a fixed delay on power-up (parameter 33,
Table 26-12). It is enabled by clearing (= 0) the
PWRTEN configuration bit.
The second timer is the Oscillator Start-up Timer
(OST), intended to keep the chip in Reset until the
crystal oscillator is stable (LP, XT and HS modes). The
OST does this by counting 1024 oscillator cycles
before allowing the oscillator to clock the device.
When the HSPLL Oscillator mode is selected, the
device is kept in Reset for an additional 2 ms, following
the HS mode OST delay, so the PLL can lock to the
incoming clock frequency.
There is a delay of interval TCSD (parameter 38,
Table 26-12) following POR while the controller
becomes ready to execute instructions. This delay runs
concurrently with any other delays. This may be the
only delay that occurs when any of the EC, RC or INTIO
modes are used as the primary clock source.
Enabling any on-chip feature that will operate during
Sleep will increase the current consumed during Sleep.
The INTRC is required to support WDT operation. The
Timer1 oscillator may be operating to support a
real-time clock. Other features may be operating that
do not require a device clock source (i.e., SSP slave,
PSP, INTn pins and others). Peripherals that may add
significant current consumption are listed in
Section 26.2 “DC Characteristics: Power-Down and
Supply Current”.
TABLE 2-3:
OSC1 AND OSC2 PIN STATES IN SLEEP MODE
Oscillator Mode
OSC1 Pin
OSC2 Pin
RC, INTIO1
Floating, external resistor should pull high
At logic low (clock/4 output)
RCIO, INTIO2
Floating, external resistor should pull high
Configured as PORTA, bit 6
ECIO
Floating, pulled by external clock
Configured as PORTA, bit 6
EC
Floating, pulled by external clock
At logic low (clock/4 output)
LP, XT and HS
Feedback inverter disabled at quiescent
voltage level
Feedback inverter disabled at quiescent
voltage level
Note:
See Table 4-2 in Section 4.0 “Reset” for time-outs due to Sleep and MCLR Reset.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 37
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 38
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
3.0
POWER MANAGED MODES
3.1.1
CLOCK SOURCES
The SCS1:SCS0 bits allow the selection of one of three
clock sources for power managed modes. They are:
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices offer a total of
seven operating modes for more efficient power
management. These modes provide a variety of
options for selective power conservation in applications
where resources may be limited (i.e., battery-powered
devices).
• the primary clock, as defined by the
FOSC3:FOSC0 configuration bits
• the secondary clock (the Timer1 oscillator)
• the internal oscillator block (for RC modes)
There are three categories of power managed modes:
3.1.2
• Sleep mode
• Idle modes
• Run modes
Entering Power Managed Run mode, or switching from
one power managed mode to another, begins by
loading the OSCCON register. The SCS1:SCS0 bits
select the clock source and determine which Run or
Idle mode is being used. Changing these bits causes
an immediate switch to the new clock source,
assuming that it is running. The switch may also be
subject to clock transition delays. These are discussed
in Section 3.1.3 “Clock Transitions and Status
Indicators” and subsequent sections.
These categories define which portions of the device
are clocked and sometimes, what speed. The Run and
Idle modes may use any of the three available clock
sources (primary, secondary or INTOSC multiplexer);
the Sleep mode does not use a clock source.
The power managed modes include several
power-saving features. One of these is the clock
switching feature, offered in other PIC18 devices,
allowing the controller to use the Timer1 oscillator in
place of the primary oscillator. Also included is the
Sleep mode, offered by all PICmicro® devices, where
all device clocks are stopped.
3.1
Entry to the Power Managed Idle or Sleep modes is
triggered by the execution of a SLEEP instruction. The
actual mode that results depends on the status of the
IDLEN bit.
Depending on the current mode and the mode being
switched to, a change to a power managed mode does
not always require setting all of these bits. Many transitions may be done by changing the oscillator select
bits, or changing the IDLEN bit prior to issuing a SLEEP
instruction. If the IDLEN bit is already configured
correctly, it may only be necessary to perform a SLEEP
instruction to switch to the desired mode.
Selecting Power Managed Modes
Selecting a power managed mode requires deciding if
the CPU is to be clocked or not and selecting a clock
source. The IDLEN bit controls CPU clocking, while the
SCS1:SCS0 bits select a clock source. The individual
modes, bit settings, clock sources and affected
modules are summarized in Table 3-1.
TABLE 3-1:
POWER MANAGED MODES
OSCCON bits
Mode
ENTERING POWER MANAGED
MODES
(1)
Module Clocking
Available Clock and Oscillator Source
SCS1:SCS0
<1:0>
CPU
Peripherals
0
N/A
Off
Off
PRI_RUN
N/A
00
Clocked
Clocked
SEC_RUN
N/A
01
Clocked
Clocked
Secondary – Timer1 Oscillator
RC_RUN
N/A
1x
Clocked
Clocked
Internal Oscillator Block(2)
IDLEN
<7>
Sleep
None – All clocks are disabled
Primary – LP, XT, HS, HSPLL, RC, EC, INTRC(2)
This is the normal full power execution mode.
PRI_IDLE
1
00
Off
Clocked
Primary – LP, XT, HS, HSPLL, RC, EC
SEC_IDLE
1
01
Off
Clocked
Secondary – Timer1 Oscillator
RC_IDLE
1
1x
Off
Clocked
Internal Oscillator Block(2)
Note 1:
2:
IDLEN reflects its value when the SLEEP instruction is executed.
Includes INTOSC and INTOSC postscaler, as well as the INTRC source.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 39
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
3.1.3
CLOCK TRANSITIONS AND
STATUS INDICATORS
3.2
The length of the transition between clock sources is
the sum of two cycles of the old clock source and three
to four cycles of the new clock source. This formula
assumes that the new clock source is stable.
Three bits indicate the current clock source and its
status. They are:
• OSTS (OSCCON<3>)
• IOFS (OSCCON<2>)
• T1RUN (T1CON<6>)
In general, only one of these bits will be set while in a
given power managed mode. When the OSTS bit is
set, the primary clock is providing the device clock.
When the IOFS bit is set, the INTOSC output is providing a stable 8 MHz clock source to a divider that actually drives the device clock. When the T1RUN bit is set,
the Timer1 oscillator is providing the clock. If none of
these bits are set, then either the INTRC clock source
is clocking the device or the INTOSC source is not yet
stable.
If the internal oscillator block is configured as the
primary clock source by the FOSC3:FOSC0
configuration bits, then both the OSTS and IOFS bits
may be set when in PRI_RUN or PRI_IDLE modes.
This indicates that the primary clock (INTOSC output)
is generating a stable 8 MHz output. Entering another
Power Managed RC mode at the same frequency
would clear the OSTS bit.
In the Run modes, clocks to both the core and
peripherals are active. The difference between these
modes is the clock source.
3.2.1
3.1.4
MULTIPLE SLEEP COMMANDS
The power managed mode that is invoked with the
SLEEP instruction is determined by the setting of the
IDLEN bit at the time the instruction is executed. If
another SLEEP instruction is executed, the device will
enter the power managed mode specified by IDLEN at
that time. If IDLEN has changed, the device will enter
the new power managed mode specified by the new
setting.
DS39635A-page 40
PRI_RUN MODE
The PRI_RUN mode is the normal full power execution
mode of the microcontroller. This is also the default
mode upon a device Reset unless Two-Speed Start-up
is enabled (see Section 23.3 “Two-Speed Start-up”
for details). In this mode, the OSTS bit is set. The IOFS
bit may be set if the internal oscillator block is the
primary clock source (see Section 2.7.1 “Oscillator
Control Register”).
3.2.2
SEC_RUN MODE
The SEC_RUN mode is the compatible mode to the
“clock switching” feature offered in other PIC18
devices. In this mode, the CPU and peripherals are
clocked from the Timer1 oscillator. This gives users the
option of lower power consumption while still using a
high accuracy clock source.
SEC_RUN mode is entered by setting the SCS1:SCS0
bits to ‘01’. The device clock source is switched to the
Timer1 oscillator (see Figure 3-1), the primary
oscillator is shut down, the T1RUN bit (T1CON<6>) is
set and the OSTS bit is cleared.
Note:
Note 1: Caution should be used when modifying a
single IRCF bit. If VDD is less than 3V, it is
possible to select a higher clock speed
than is supported by the low VDD.
Improper device operation may result if
the VDD/FOSC specifications are violated.
2: Executing a SLEEP instruction does not
necessarily place the device into Sleep
mode. It acts as the trigger to place the
controller into either the Sleep mode or
one of the Idle modes, depending on the
setting of the IDLEN bit.
Run Modes
The Timer1 oscillator should already be
running prior to entering SEC_RUN mode.
If the T1OSCEN bit is not set when the
SCS1:SCS0 bits are set to ‘01’, entry to
SEC_RUN mode will not occur. If the
Timer1 oscillator is enabled, but not yet
running, peripheral clocks will be delayed
until the oscillator has started; in such
situations, initial oscillator operation is far
from stable and unpredictable operation
may result.
On transitions from SEC_RUN mode to PRI_RUN, the
peripherals and CPU continue to be clocked from the
Timer1 oscillator while the primary clock is started.
When the primary clock becomes ready, a clock switch
back to the primary clock occurs (see Figure 3-2).
When the clock switch is complete, the T1RUN bit is
cleared, the OSTS bit is set and the primary clock is
providing the clock. The IDLEN and SCS bits are not
affected by the wake-up; the Timer1 oscillator
continues to run.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 3-1:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR ENTRY TO SEC_RUN MODE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q2
1
T1OSI
2
3
n-1
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
n
Clock Transition
OSC1
CPU
Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
FIGURE 3-2:
PC + 2
PC + 4
TRANSITION TIMING FROM SEC_RUN MODE TO PRI_RUN MODE (HSPLL)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3
T1OSI
OSC1
TOST(1)
TPLL(1)
PLL Clock
Output
1
2
n-1
Clock
Transition
n
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
SCS1:SCS0 bits Changed
PC + 2
PC
PC + 4
OSTS bit Set
Note 1: TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 41
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
3.2.3
If the IRCF bits and the INTSRC bit are all clear, the
INTOSC output is not enabled and the IOFS bit will
remain clear; there will be no indication of the current
clock source. The INTRC source is providing the
device clocks.
RC_RUN MODE
In RC_RUN mode, the CPU and peripherals are
clocked from the internal oscillator block using the
INTOSC multiplexer and the primary clock is shut
down. When using the INTRC source, this mode
provides the best power conservation of all the Run
modes, while still executing code. It works well for user
applications which are not highly timing sensitive, or do
not require high-speed clocks at all times.
If the IRCF bits are changed from all clear (thus,
enabling the INTOSC output), or if INTSRC is set, the
IOFS bit becomes set after the INTOSC output
becomes stable. Clocks to the device continue while
the INTOSC source stabilizes after an interval of
TIOBST.
If the primary clock source is the internal oscillator block
(either INTRC or INTOSC), there are no distinguishable
differences between PRI_RUN and RC_RUN modes during execution. However, a clock switch delay will occur
during entry to and exit from RC_RUN mode. Therefore,
if the primary clock source is the internal oscillator block,
the use of RC_RUN mode is not recommended.
If the IRCF bits were previously at a non-zero value, or
if INTSRC was set before setting SCS1 and the
INTOSC source was already stable, the IOFS bit will
remain set.
On transitions from RC_RUN mode to PRI_RUN, the
device continues to be clocked from the INTOSC
multiplexer while the primary clock is started. When the
primary clock becomes ready, a clock switch to the
primary clock occurs (see Figure 3-4). When the clock
switch is complete, the IOFS bit is cleared, the OSTS
bit is set and the primary clock is providing the device
clock. The IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the
switch. The INTRC source will continue to run if either
the WDT or the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled.
This mode is entered by setting the SCS1 bit to ‘1’.
Although it is ignored, it is recommended that the SCS0
bit also be cleared; this is to maintain software
compatibility with future devices. When the clock
source is switched to the INTOSC multiplexer (see
Figure 3-3), the primary oscillator is shut down and the
OSTS bit is cleared.The IRCF bits may be modified at
any time to immediately change the clock speed.
Note:
Caution should be used when modifying a
single IRCF bit. If VDD is less than 3V, it is
possible to select a higher clock speed
than is supported by the low VDD.
Improper device operation may result if
the VDD/FOSC specifications are violated.
FIGURE 3-3:
TRANSITION TIMING TO RC_RUN MODE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q2
1
INTRC
2
3
n-1
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
n
Clock Transition
OSC1
CPU
Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
FIGURE 3-4:
PC + 2
PC + 4
TRANSITION TIMING FROM RC_RUN MODE TO PRI_RUN MODE
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3
Q1
INTOSC
Multiplexer
OSC1
TOST(1)
TPLL(1)
1
PLL Clock
Output
2
n-1 n
Clock
Transition
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
SCS1:SCS0 bits Changed
PC + 2
PC
PC + 4
OSTS bit Set
Note 1: TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
DS39635A-page 42
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
3.3
Sleep Mode
3.4
The Power Managed Sleep mode in the
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices is identical to
the Legacy Sleep mode offered in all other PICmicro®
devices. It is entered by clearing the IDLEN bit (the
default state on device Reset) and executing the
SLEEP instruction. This shuts down the selected
oscillator (see Figure 3-5). All clock source status bits
are cleared.
Idle Modes
The Idle modes allow the controller’s CPU to be
selectively shut down while the peripherals continue to
operate. Selecting a particular Idle mode allows users
to further manage power consumption.
If the IDLEN bit is set to a ‘1’ when a SLEEP instruction
is executed, the peripherals will be clocked from the
clock source selected using the SCS1:SCS0 bits;
however, the CPU will not be clocked. The clock source
status bits are not affected. Setting IDLEN and executing SLEEP provides a quick method of switching from a
given Run mode to its corresponding Idle mode.
Entering the Sleep mode from any other mode does not
require a clock switch. This is because no clocks are
needed once the controller has entered Sleep. If the
WDT is selected, the INTRC source will continue to
operate. If the Timer1 oscillator is enabled, it will also
continue to run.
If the WDT is selected, the INTRC source will continue
to operate. If the Timer1 oscillator is enabled, it will also
continue to run.
When a wake event occurs in Sleep mode (by interrupt,
Reset or WDT time-out), the device will not be clocked
until the primary clock source becomes ready (see
Figure 3-6), or it will be clocked from the internal
oscillator block if either the Two-Speed Start-up or the
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor are enabled (see Section 23.0
“Special Features of the CPU”). In either case, the
OSTS bit is set when the primary clock is providing the
device clocks. The IDLEN and SCS bits are not
affected by the wake-up.
Since the CPU is not executing instructions, the only
exits from any of the Idle modes are by interrupt, WDT
time-out or a Reset. When a wake event occurs, CPU
execution is delayed by an interval of TCSD
(parameter 38, Table 26-12), while it becomes ready to
execute code. When the CPU begins executing code,
it resumes with the same clock source for the current
Idle mode. For example, when waking from RC_IDLE
mode, the internal oscillator block will clock the CPU
and peripherals (in other words, RC_RUN mode). The
IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the wake-up.
While in any Idle mode or the Sleep mode, a WDT
time-out will result in a WDT wake-up to the Run mode
currently specified by the SCS1:SCS0 bits.
FIGURE 3-5:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR ENTRY TO SLEEP MODE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
OSC1
CPU
Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Sleep
Program
Counter
PC
FIGURE 3-6:
PC + 2
TRANSITION TIMING FOR WAKE FROM SLEEP (HSPLL)
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Q1
OSC1
TOST(1)
PLL Clock
Output
TPLL(1)
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
Wake Event
PC + 2
PC + 4
PC + 6
OSTS bit Set
Note 1: TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 43
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
3.4.1
PRI_IDLE MODE
This mode is unique among the three Low-Power Idle
modes, in that it does not disable the primary device
clock. For timing sensitive applications, this allows for
the fastest resumption of device operation with its more
accurate primary clock source, since the clock source
does not have to “warm up” or transition from another
oscillator.
When a wake event occurs, the CPU is clocked from the
primary clock source. A delay of interval TCSD is
required between the wake event and when code
execution starts. This is required to allow the CPU to
become ready to execute instructions. After the
wake-up, the OSTS bit remains set. The IDLEN and
SCS bits are not affected by the wake-up (see
Figure 3-8).
PRI_IDLE mode is entered from PRI_RUN mode by
setting the IDLEN bit and executing a SLEEP instruction. If the device is in another Run mode, set IDLEN
first, then clear the SCS bits and execute SLEEP.
Although the CPU is disabled, the peripherals continue
to be clocked from the primary clock source specified
by the FOSC3:FOSC0 configuration bits. The OSTS bit
remains set (see Figure 3-7).
FIGURE 3-7:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR ENTRY TO PRI_IDLE MODE
Q1
Q4
Q3
Q2
Q1
OSC1
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
FIGURE 3-8:
PC + 2
TRANSITION TIMING FOR WAKE FROM IDLE TO RUN MODE
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
OSC1
TCSD
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
Wake Event
DS39635A-page 44
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
3.4.2
SEC_IDLE MODE
3.4.3
In SEC_IDLE mode, the CPU is disabled, but the
peripherals continue to be clocked from the Timer1
oscillator. This mode is entered from SEC_RUN by setting the IDLEN bit and executing a SLEEP instruction. If
the device is in another Run mode, set IDLEN first, then
set SCS1:SCS0 to ‘01’ and execute SLEEP. When the
clock source is switched to the Timer1 oscillator, the
primary oscillator is shut down, the OSTS bit is cleared
and the T1RUN bit is set.
When a wake event occurs, the peripherals continue to
be clocked from the Timer1 oscillator. After an interval
of TCSD following the wake event, the CPU begins executing code being clocked by the Timer1 oscillator. The
IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the wake-up;
the Timer1 oscillator continues to run (see Figure 3-8).
Note:
The Timer1 oscillator should already be
running prior to entering SEC_IDLE mode.
If the T1OSCEN bit is not set when the
SLEEP instruction is executed, the SLEEP
instruction will be ignored and entry to
SEC_IDLE mode will not occur. If the
Timer1 oscillator is enabled, but not yet
running, peripheral clocks will be delayed
until the oscillator has started. In such
situations, initial oscillator operation is far
from stable and unpredictable operation
may result.
RC_IDLE MODE
In RC_IDLE mode, the CPU is disabled, but the peripherals continue to be clocked from the internal oscillator
block using the INTOSC multiplexer. This mode allows
for controllable power conservation during Idle periods.
From RC_RUN, this mode is entered by setting the
IDLEN bit and executing a SLEEP instruction. If the
device is in another Run mode, first set IDLEN, then set
the SCS1 bit and execute SLEEP. Although its value is
ignored, it is recommended that SCS0 also be cleared;
this is to maintain software compatibility with future
devices. The INTOSC multiplexer may be used to
select a higher clock frequency by modifying the IRCF
bits before executing the SLEEP instruction. When the
clock source is switched to the INTOSC multiplexer, the
primary oscillator is shut down and the OSTS bit is
cleared.
If the IRCF bits are set to any non-zero value, or the
INTSRC bit is set, the INTOSC output is enabled. The
IOFS bit becomes set after the INTOSC output
becomes stable, after an interval of TIOBST
(parameter 39, Table 26-12). Clocks to the peripherals
continue while the INTOSC source stabilizes. If the
IRCF bits were previously at a non-zero value, or
INTSRC was set before the SLEEP instruction was
executed and the INTOSC source was already stable,
the IOFS bit will remain set. If the IRCF bits and
INTSRC are all clear, the INTOSC output will not be
enabled; the IOFS bit will remain clear and there will be
no indication of the current clock source.
When a wake event occurs, the peripherals continue to
be clocked from the INTOSC multiplexer. After a delay
of TCSD following the wake event, the CPU begins executing code, being clocked by the INTOSC multiplexer.
The IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the
wake-up. The INTRC source will continue to run if
either the WDT or the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is
enabled.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 45
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
3.5
3.5.3
Exiting Idle and Sleep Modes
An exit from Sleep mode or any of the Idle modes is
triggered by an interrupt, a Reset or a WDT time-out.
This section discusses the triggers that cause exits
from power managed modes. The clocking subsystem
actions are discussed in each of the power managed
modes (see Section 3.2 “Run Modes” through
Section 3.4 “Idle Modes”).
3.5.1
EXIT BY INTERRUPT
Any of the available interrupt sources can cause the
device to exit from an Idle or Sleep mode to a Run
mode. To enable this functionality, an interrupt source
must be enabled by setting its enable bit in one of the
INTCON or PIE registers. The exit sequence is initiated
when the corresponding interrupt flag bit is set.
On all exits from Idle or Sleep modes by interrupt, code
execution branches to the interrupt vector if the
GIE/GIEH bit (INTCON<7>) is set. Otherwise, code
execution continues or resumes without branching
(see Section 9.0 “Interrupts”).
A fixed delay of interval TCSD, following the wake event,
is required when leaving Sleep and Idle modes. This
delay is required for the CPU to prepare for execution.
Instruction execution resumes on the first clock cycle
following this delay.
3.5.2
Normally, the device is held in Reset by the Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST) until the primary clock becomes
ready. At that time, the OSTS bit is set and the device
begins executing code. If the internal oscillator block is
the new clock source, the IOFS bit is set instead.
The exit delay time from Reset to the start of code
execution depends on both the clock sources before
and after the wake-up and the type of oscillator if the
new clock source is the primary clock. Exit delays are
summarized in Table 3-2.
Code execution can begin before the primary clock
becomes ready. If either the Two-Speed Start-up (see
Section 23.3 “Two-Speed Start-up”) or Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor (see Section 23.4 “Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor”) is enabled, the device may begin execution
as soon as the Reset source has cleared. Execution is
clocked by the INTOSC multiplexer driven by the
internal oscillator block. Execution is clocked by the
internal oscillator block until either the primary clock
becomes ready, or a power managed mode is entered
before the primary clock becomes ready; the primary
clock is then shut down.
3.5.4
EXIT WITHOUT AN OSCILLATOR
START-UP DELAY
Certain exits from power managed modes do not
invoke the OST at all. There are two cases:
EXIT BY WDT TIME-OUT
A WDT time-out will cause different actions depending
on which power managed mode the device is in when
the time-out occurs.
If the device is not executing code (all Idle modes and
Sleep mode), the time-out will result in an exit from the
power managed mode (see Section 3.2 “Run Modes”
and Section 3.3 “Sleep Mode”). If the device is
executing code (all Run modes), the time-out will result
in a WDT Reset (see Section 23.2 “Watchdog Timer
(WDT)”).
The WDT timer and postscaler are cleared by executing a SLEEP or CLRWDT instruction, losing a currently
selected clock source (if the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is
enabled) and modifying the IRCF bits in the OSCCON
register if the internal oscillator block is the device clock
source.
DS39635A-page 46
EXIT BY RESET
• PRI_IDLE mode, where the primary clock source
is not stopped; and
• the primary clock source is not any of the LP, XT,
HS or HSPLL modes.
In these instances, the primary clock source either
does not require an oscillator start-up delay since it is
already running (PRI_IDLE), or normally does not
require an oscillator start-up delay (RC, EC and INTIO
Oscillator modes). However, a fixed delay of interval
TCSD, following the wake event, is still required when
leaving Sleep and Idle modes to allow the CPU to
prepare for execution. Instruction execution resumes
on the first clock cycle following this delay.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 3-2:
EXIT DELAY ON WAKE-UP BY RESET FROM SLEEP MODE OR ANY IDLE MODE
(BY CLOCK SOURCES)
Clock Source
before Wake-up
Clock Source
after Wake-up
Exit Delay
LP, XT, HS
Primary Device Clock
(PRI_IDLE mode)
HSPLL
EC, RC, INTRC(1)
OSTS
TCSD(2)
INTOSC(3)
(1)
T1OSC or INTRC
INTOSC(3)
None
(Sleep mode)
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
Clock Ready Status
bit (OSCCON)
—
IOFS
LP, XT, HS
TOST(4)
HSPLL
TOST + trc(4)
EC, RC, INTRC(1)
TCSD(2)
—
INTOSC(2)
TIOBST(5)
IOFS
LP, XT, HS
TOST(5)
HSPLL
TOST + trc(4)
EC, RC, INTRC(1)
TCSD(2)
—
INTOSC(2)
None
IOFS
LP, XT, HS
TOST(4)
HSPLL
TOST + trc(4)
EC, RC, INTRC(1)
TCSD(2)
—
INTOSC(2)
TIOBST(5)
IOFS
OSTS
OSTS
OSTS
In this instance, refers specifically to the 31 kHz INTRC clock source.
TCSD (parameter 38) is a required delay when waking from Sleep and all Idle modes and runs concurrently
with any other required delays (see Section 3.4 “Idle Modes”).
Includes both the INTOSC 8 MHz source and postscaler derived frequencies.
TOST is the Oscillator Start-up Timer (parameter 32). trc is the PLL Lock-out Timer (parameter F12); it is
also designated as TPLL.
Execution continues during TIOBST (parameter 39), the INTOSC stabilization period.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 47
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 48
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
4.0
RESET
4.1
The PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices differentiate
between various kinds of Reset:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
h)
Power-on Reset (POR)
MCLR Reset during normal operation
MCLR Reset during power managed modes
Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset (during
execution)
Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
RESET Instruction
Stack Full Reset
Stack Underflow Reset
This section discusses Resets generated by MCLR,
POR and BOR and covers the operation of the various
start-up timers. Stack Reset events are covered in
Section 5.1.3.4 “Stack Full and Underflow Resets”.
WDT Resets are covered in Section 23.2 “Watchdog
Timer (WDT)”.
RCON Register
Device Reset events are tracked through the RCON
register (Register 4-1). The lower five bits of the
register indicate that a specific Reset event has
occurred. In most cases, these bits can only be set by
the event and must be cleared by the application after
the event. The state of these flag bits, taken together,
can be read to indicate the type of Reset that just
occurred. This is described in more detail in
Section 4.6 “Reset State of Registers”.
The RCON register also has control bits for setting
interrupt priority (IPEN) and software control of the
BOR (SBOREN). Interrupt priority is discussed in
Section 9.0 “Interrupts”. BOR is covered in
Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
A simplified block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit
is shown in Figure 4-1.
FIGURE 4-1:
SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT
RESET
Instruction
Stack Full/Underflow Reset
Stack
Pointer
External Reset
MCLRE
MCLR
( )_IDLE
Sleep
WDT
Time-out
VDD Rise
Detect
POR Pulse
VDD
Brown-out
Reset
S
BOREN
OST/PWRT
OST
1024 Cycles
Chip_Reset
10-bit Ripple Counter
R
Q
OSC1
32 µs
INTRC(1)
PWRT
65.5 ms
11-bit Ripple Counter
Enable PWRT
Enable OST(2)
Note 1:
2:
This is the INTRC source from the internal oscillator block and is separate from the RC oscillator of the CLKI pin.
See Table 4-2 for time-out situations.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 49
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 4-1:
RCON: RESET CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-1(1)
U-0
R/W-1
R-1
R-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
IPEN
SBOREN
—
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
IPEN: Interrupt Priority Enable bit
1 = Enable priority levels on interrupts
0 = Disable priority levels on interrupts (PIC16CXXX Compatibility mode)
bit 6
SBOREN: BOR Software Enable bit
If BOREN1:BOREN0 = 01:
1 = BOR is enabled
0 = BOR is disabled
If BOREN1:BOREN0 = 00, 10 or 11:
Bit is disabled and read as ‘0’.
Note 1: If SBOREN is enabled, its Reset state is ‘1’; otherwise, it is ‘0’.
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
RI: RESET Instruction Flag bit
1 = The RESET instruction was not executed (set by firmware only)
0 = The RESET instruction was executed causing a device Reset (must be set in software after
a Brown-out Reset occurs)
bit 3
TO: Watchdog Timer Time-out Flag bit
1 = Set by power-up, CLRWDT instruction or SLEEP instruction
0 = A WDT time-out occurred
bit 2
PD: Power-Down Detection Flag bit
1 = Set by power-up or by the CLRWDT instruction
0 = Set by execution of the SLEEP instruction
bit 1
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit
1 = A Power-on Reset has not occurred (set by firmware only)
0 = A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs)
bit 0
BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit
1 = A Brown-out Reset has not occurred (set by firmware only)
0 = A Brown-out Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Brown-out Reset occurs)
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
Note 1: It is recommended that the POR bit be set after a Power-on Reset has been
detected, so that subsequent Power-on Resets may be detected.
2: Brown-out Reset is said to have occurred when BOR is ‘0’ and POR is ‘1’ (assuming
that POR was set to ‘1’ by software immediately after POR).
DS39635A-page 50
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
4.2
FIGURE 4-2:
Master Clear (MCLR)
The MCLR pin provides a method for triggering a hard
external Reset of the device. A Reset is generated by
holding the pin low. PIC18 Extended MCU devices
have a noise filter in the MCLR Reset path which
detects and ignores small pulses.
In PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices, the MCLR
input can be disabled with the MCLRE configuration bit.
When MCLR is disabled, the pin becomes a digital
input. See Section 10.7 “PORTG, TRISG and LATG
Registers” for more information.
4.3
VDD
VDD
The MCLR pin is not driven low by any internal Resets,
including the WDT.
EXTERNAL POWER-ON
RESET CIRCUIT (FOR
SLOW VDD POWER-UP)
D
R
R1
MCLR
C
PIC18FXXXX
Note 1:
External Power-on Reset circuit is required
only if the VDD power-up slope is too slow.
The diode D helps discharge the capacitor
quickly when VDD powers down.
2:
R < 40 kΩ is recommended to make sure that
the voltage drop across R does not violate
the device’s electrical specification.
3:
R1 ≥ 1 kΩ will limit any current flowing into
MCLR from external capacitor C, in the event
of MCLR/VPP pin breakdown, due to
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) or Electrical
Overstress (EOS).
Power-on Reset (POR)
A Power-on Reset pulse is generated on-chip
whenever VDD rises above a certain threshold. This
allows the device to start in the initialized state when
VDD is adequate for operation.
To take advantage of the POR circuitry, tie the MCLR
pin through a resistor (1 kΩ to 10 kΩ) to VDD. This will
eliminate external RC components usually needed to
create a Power-on Reset delay. A minimum rise rate for
VDD is specified (parameter D004). For a slow rise
time, see Figure 4-2.
When the device starts normal operation (i.e., exits the
Reset condition), device operating parameters
(voltage, frequency, temperature, etc.) must be met to
ensure operation. If these conditions are not met, the
device must be held in Reset until the operating
conditions are met.
POR events are captured by the POR bit (RCON<1>).
The state of the bit is set to ‘0’ whenever a POR occurs;
it does not change for any other Reset event. POR is
not reset to ‘1’ by any hardware event. To capture
multiple events, the user manually resets the bit to ‘1’
in software following any POR.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 51
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
4.4
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices implement a
BOR circuit that provides the user with a number of
configuration and power-saving options. The BOR is
controlled
by
the
BORV1:BORV0
and
BOREN1:BOREN0 configuration bits. There are a total
of four BOR configurations, which are summarized in
Table 4-1.
The BOR threshold is set by the BORV1:BORV0 bits. If
BOR is enabled (any values of BOREN1:BOREN0
except ‘00’), any drop of VDD below VBOR
(parameter D005) for greater than TBOR (parameter 35)
will reset the device. A Reset may or may not occur if
VDD falls below VBOR for less than TBOR. The chip will
remain in Brown-out Reset until VDD rises above VBOR.
Placing the BOR under software control gives the user
the additional flexibility of tailoring the application to its
environment without having to reprogram the device to
change the BOR configuration. It also allows the user
to tailor device power consumption in software by
eliminating the incremental current that the BOR
consumes. While the BOR current is typically very
small, it may have some impact in low-power
applications.
Note:
4.4.2
Even when BOR is under software control,
the BOR Reset voltage level is still set by
the BORV1:BORV0 configuration bits. It
cannot be changed in software.
DETECTING BOR
If the Power-up Timer is enabled, it will be invoked after
VDD rises above VBOR; it then will keep the chip in
Reset for an additional time delay, TPWRT
(parameter 33). If VDD drops below VBOR while the
Power-up Timer is running, the chip will go back into a
Brown-out Reset and the Power-up Timer will be
initialized. Once VDD rises above VBOR, the Power-up
Timer will execute the additional time delay.
When BOR is enabled, the BOR bit always resets to ‘0’
on any BOR or POR event. This makes it difficult to
determine if a BOR event has occurred just by reading
the state of BOR alone. A more reliable method is to
simultaneously check the state of both POR and BOR.
This assumes that the POR bit is reset to ‘1’ in software
immediately after any POR event. IF BOR is ‘0’ while
POR is ‘1’, it can be reliably assumed that a BOR event
has occurred.
BOR and the Power-up Timer (PWRT) are
independently configured. Enabling the BOR Reset
does not automatically enable the PWRT.
4.4.3
4.4.1
SOFTWARE ENABLED BOR
When BOREN1:BOREN0 = 01, the BOR can be
enabled or disabled by the user in software. This is
done with the control bit, SBOREN (RCON<6>).
Setting SBOREN enables the BOR to function as
previously described. Clearing SBOREN disables the
BOR entirely. The SBOREN bit operates only in this
mode; otherwise, it is read as ‘0’.
TABLE 4-1:
DISABLING BOR IN SLEEP MODE
When BOREN1:BOREN0 = 10, the BOR remains
under hardware control and operates as previously
described. Whenever the device enters Sleep mode,
however, the BOR is automatically disabled. When the
device returns to any other operating mode, BOR is
automatically re-enabled.
This mode allows for applications to recover from
brown-out situations, while actively executing code,
when the device requires BOR protection the most. At
the same time, it saves additional power in Sleep mode
by eliminating the small incremental BOR current.
BOR CONFIGURATIONS
BOR Configuration
BOREN1
BOREN0
Status of
SBOREN
(RCON<6>)
0
0
Unavailable
0
1
Available
1
0
Unavailable
BOR is enabled in hardware and active during the Run and Idle modes,
disabled during Sleep mode.
1
1
Unavailable
BOR is enabled in hardware; must be disabled by reprogramming the
configuration bits.
DS39635A-page 52
BOR Operation
BOR is disabled; must be enabled by reprogramming the configuration bits.
BOR is enabled in software; operation controlled by SBOREN.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
4.5
4.5.3
Device Reset Timers
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices incorporate
three separate on-chip timers that help regulate the
Power-on Reset process. Their main function is to
ensure that the device clock is stable before code is
executed. These timers are:
• Power-up Timer (PWRT)
• Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
• PLL Lock Time-out
4.5.1
With the PLL enabled in its PLL mode, the time-out
sequence following a Power-on Reset is slightly
different from other oscillator modes. A separate timer
is used to provide a fixed time-out that is sufficient for
the PLL to lock to the main oscillator frequency. This
PLL lock time-out (TPLL) is typically 2 ms and follows
the oscillator start-up time-out.
4.5.4
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE
On power-up, the time-out sequence is as follows:
POWER-UP TIMER (PWRT)
The
Power-up
Timer
(PWRT)
of
the
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices is an 11-bit
counter which uses the INTRC source as the clock
input. This yields an approximate time interval of
2048 x 32 µs = 65.6 ms. While the PWRT is counting,
the device is held in Reset.
The power-up time delay depends on the INTRC clock
and will vary from chip to chip due to temperature and
process variation. See DC parameter 33 for details.
The PWRT is enabled by clearing the PWRTEN
configuration bit.
4.5.2
PLL LOCK TIME-OUT
OSCILLATOR START-UP
TIMER (OST)
The Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) provides a 1024
oscillator cycle (from OSC1 input) delay after the
PWRT delay is over (parameter 33). This ensures that
the crystal oscillator or resonator has started and is
stabilized.
1.
2.
After the POR pulse has cleared, PWRT
time-out is invoked (if enabled).
Then, the OST is activated.
The total time-out will vary based on oscillator
configuration and the status of the PWRT. Figure 4-3,
Figure 4-4, Figure 4-5, Figure 4-6 and Figure 4-7 all
depict time-out sequences on power-up, with the
Power-up Timer enabled and the device operating in
HS Oscillator mode. Figures 4-3 through 4-6 also apply
to devices operating in XT or LP modes. For devices in
RC mode and with the PWRT disabled, on the other
hand, there will be no time-out at all.
Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR
is kept low long enough, all time-outs will expire.
Bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately
(Figure 4-5). This is useful for testing purposes or to
synchronize more than one PIC18FXXXX device
operating in parallel.
The OST time-out is invoked only for XT, LP, HS and
HSPLL modes and only on Power-on Reset, or on exit
from most power managed modes.
TABLE 4-2:
TIME-OUT IN VARIOUS SITUATIONS
Power-up(2) and Brown-out
Oscillator
Configuration
HSPLL
PWRTEN = 1
Exit from
Power Managed Mode
1024 TOSC + 2 ms(2)
1024 TOSC + 2 ms(2)
PWRTEN = 0
66
ms(1)
+ 1024 TOSC + 2
ms(2)
HS, XT, LP
66 ms(1) + 1024 TOSC
1024 TOSC
1024 TOSC
EC, ECIO
66 ms(1)
—
—
RC, RCIO
ms(1)
—
—
(1)
—
—
66
INTIO1, INTIO2
Note 1:
2:
66 ms
66 ms (65.5 ms) is the nominal Power-up Timer (PWRT) delay.
2 ms is the nominal time required for the PLL to lock.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 53
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 4-3:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR TIED TO VDD, VDD RISE < TPWRT)
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 1
FIGURE 4-4:
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 2
FIGURE 4-5:
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
DS39635A-page 54
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 4-6:
SLOW RISE TIME (MCLR TIED TO VDD, VDD RISE > TPWRT)
5V
VDD
1V
0V
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POR W/PLL ENABLED (MCLR TIED TO VDD)
FIGURE 4-7:
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
TPLL
OST TIME-OUT
PLL TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
Note: TOST = 1024 clock cycles.
TPLL ≈ 2 ms max. First three stages of the PWRT timer.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 55
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
4.6
Reset State of Registers
Most registers are unaffected by a Reset. Their status
is unknown on POR and unchanged by all other
Resets. The other registers are forced to a “Reset
state” depending on the type of Reset that occurred.
Table 4-4 describes the Reset states for all of the
Special Function Registers. These are categorized by
Power-on and Brown-out Resets, Master Clear and
WDT Resets and WDT wake-ups.
Most registers are not affected by a WDT wake-up,
since this is viewed as the resumption of normal
operation. Status bits from the RCON register, RI, TO,
PD, POR and BOR, are set or cleared differently in
different Reset situations, as indicated in Table 4-3.
These bits are used in software to determine the nature
of the Reset.
TABLE 4-3:
STATUS BITS, THEIR SIGNIFICANCE AND THE INITIALIZATION CONDITION FOR
RCON REGISTER
RCON Register
STKPTR Register
Program
Counter
SBOREN
RI
TO
PD
0000h
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
RESET Instruction
0000h
u(2)
0
u
u
u
u
u
u
Brown-out Reset
0000h
u(2)
1
1
1
u
0
u
u
MCLR Reset during Power
Managed Run Modes
0000h
u(2)
u
1
u
u
u
u
u
MCLR Reset during Power
Managed Idle Modes and Sleep
0000h
u(2)
u
1
0
u
u
u
u
WDT Time-out during Full Power
or Power Managed Run Modes
0000h
u(2)
u
0
u
u
u
u
u
MCLR Reset during Full Power
Execution
0000h
u(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
Stack Full Reset (STVREN = 1)
0000h
u(2)
u
u
u
u
u
1
u
Stack Underflow Reset
(STVREN = 1)
0000h
u(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
Stack Underflow Error (not an
actual Reset, STVREN = 0)
0000h
u(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
WDT Time-out during Power
Managed Idle or Sleep Modes
PC + 2
u(2)
u
0
0
u
u
u
u
PC + 2(1)
u(2)
u
u
0
u
u
u
u
Condition
Power-on Reset
Interrupt Exit from Power
Managed Modes
POR BOR STKFUL
STKUNF
Legend: u = unchanged
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEH or GIEL bits are set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (008h or 0018h).
2: Reset state is ‘1’ for POR and unchanged for all other Resets when software BOR is enabled
(BOREN1:BOREN0 configuration bits = 01 and SBOREN = 1). Otherwise, the Reset state is ‘0’.
DS39635A-page 56
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 4-4:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
MCLR Resets
WDT Reset
RESET Instruction
Stack Resets
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
TOSU
6X10
8X10
---0 0000
---0 0000
---0 uuuu(3)
TOSH
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
TOSL
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(3)
STKPTR
6X10
8X10
uu-0 0000
00-0 0000
uu-u uuuu(3)
PCLATU
6X10
8X10
---0 0000
---0 0000
---u uuuu
PCLATH
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PCL
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
PC + 2(2)
TBLPTRU
6X10
8X10
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
TBLPTRH
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TBLPTRL
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TABLAT
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PRODH
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PRODL
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
INTCON
6X10
8X10
0000 000x
0000 000u
uuuu uuuu(1)
INTCON2
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu(1)
INTCON3
6X10
8X10
1100 0000
1100 0000
uuuu uuuu(1)
INDF0
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTINC0
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTDEC0
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
PREINC0
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
PLUSW0
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
FSR0H
6X10
8X10
---- xxxx
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
FSR0L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
WREG
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
INDF1
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTINC1
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTDEC1
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
PREINC1
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
PLUSW1
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
FSR1H
6X10
8X10
---- xxxx
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
FSR1L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
BSR
6X10
8X10
---- 0000
---- 0000
---- uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt
vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 57
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 4-4:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
MCLR Resets
WDT Reset
RESET Instruction
Stack Resets
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
INDF2
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTINC2
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTDEC2
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
PREINC2
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
PLUSW2
6X10
8X10
N/A
N/A
N/A
FSR2H
6X10
8X10
---- xxxx
---- uuuu
---- uuuu
FSR2L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
STATUS
6X10
8X10
---x xxxx
---u uuuu
---u uuuu
TMR0H
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TMR0L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T0CON
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
OSCCON
6X10
8X10
0100 q000
0100 00q0
uuuu uuqu
HLVDCON
6X10
8X10
--00 0101
--00 0101
--uu uuuu
WDTCON
6X10
8X10
---- ---0
---- ---0
---- ---u
RCON
6X10
8X10
0q-1 11q0
0q-q qquu
uq-u qquu
TMR1H
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR1L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T1CON
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
u0uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR2
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
PR2
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111
T2CON
6X10
8X10
-000 0000
-000 0000
-uuu uuuu
SSPBUF
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
SSPADD
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSPSTAT
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSPCON1
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
SSPCON2
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
ADRESH
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ADRESL
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
ADCON0
6X10
8X10
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
ADCON1
6X10
8X10
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
ADCON2
6X10
8X10
0-00 0000
0-00 0000
u-uu uuuu
(4)
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt
vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
DS39635A-page 58
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 4-4:
Register
CCPR1H
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
MCLR Resets
WDT Reset
RESET Instruction
Stack Resets
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCPR1L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCP1CON
6X10
8X10
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CCPR2H
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCPR2L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCP2CON
6X10
8X10
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CCPR3H
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCPR3L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
CCP3CON
6X10
8X10
--00 0000
--00 0000
--uu uuuu
CVRCON
6X10
8X10
000- 0000
000- 0000
uuu- uuuu
CMCON
6X10
8X10
0000 0111
0000 0111
uuuu uuuu
TMR3H
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
TMR3L
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
T3CON
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PSPCON
6X10
8X10
0000 ----
0000 ----
uuuu ----
SPBRG1
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCREG1
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXREG1
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXSTA1
6X10
8X10
0000 0010
0000 0010
uuuu uuuu
RCSTA1
6X10
8X10
0000 000x
0000 000x
uuuu uuuu
IPR3
6X10
8X10
--11 ---1
--11 ---1
--uu ---u
PIR3
6X10
8X10
--00 ---0
--00 ---0
--uu ---u(1)
PIE3
6X10
8X10
--00 ---0
--00 ---0
--uu ---u
IPR2
6X10
8X10
11-- 1111
11-- 1111
uu-- uuuu
PIR2
6X10
8X10
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
uu-- uuuu(1)
PIE2
6X10
8X10
00-- 0000
00-- 0000
uu-- uuuu
IPR1
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
PIR1
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu(1)
PIE1
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
MEMCON
6X10
8X10
0-00 --00
0-00 --00
u-uu --uu
OSCTUNE
6X10
8X10
00-0 0000
00-0 0000
uu-u uuuu
TRISJ
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISH
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt
vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 59
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 4-4:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
MCLR Resets
WDT Reset
RESET Instruction
Stack Resets
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
TRISG
6X10
8X10
---1 1111
---1 1111
---u uuuu
TRISF
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISE
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISD
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISC
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
uuuu uuuu
TRISB
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
1111 1111
(5)
(5)
uuuu uuuu
(5)
uuuu uuuu(5)
TRISA
6X10
8X10
1111 1111
LATJ
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATH
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATG
6X10
8X10
---x xxxx
---u uuuu
---u uuuu
LATF
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATE
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATD
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATC
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATB
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
LATA(5)
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx(5)
uuuu uuuu(5)
uuuu uuuu(5)
1111 1111
PORTJ
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTH
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTG
6X10
8X10
--xx xxxx
--uu uuuu
--uu uuuu
PORTF
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTE
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTD
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTC
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PORTB
6X10
8X10
xxxx xxxx
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
(5)
0000(5)
0000(5)
uuuu uuuu(5)
PORTA
6X10
8X10
xx0x
SPBRGH1
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
BAUDCON1
6X10
8X10
01-0 0-00
01-0 0-00
uu-u u-uu
SPBRG2
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
RCREG2
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXREG2
6X10
8X10
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
TXSTA2
6X10
8X10
0000 0010
0000 0010
uuuu uuuu
RCSTA2
6X10
8X10
0000 000x
0000 000x
uuuu uuuu
uu0u
Legend: u = unchanged, x = unknown, - = unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q = value depends on condition.
Shaded cells indicate conditions do not apply for the designated device.
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the interrupt
vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
DS39635A-page 60
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.0
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
5.1
There are two types of memory in PIC18 Flash
Microcontroller devices:
• Program Memory
• Data RAM
As Harvard architecture devices, the data and program
memories use separate busses; this allows for
concurrent access of the two memory spaces.
Additional detailed information on the operation of the
Flash program memory is provided in Section 6.0
“Program Memory”.
Program Memory Organization
PIC18 microcontrollers implement a 21-bit program
counter, which is capable of addressing a 2-Mbyte
program memory space. Accessing a location between
the upper boundary of the physically implemented
memory and the 2-Mbyte address will return all ‘0’s (a
NOP instruction).
The PIC18F6310 and PIC18F8310 each have
8 Kbytes of Flash memory and can store up to 4,096
single-word instructions. The PIC18F6410 and
PIC18F8410 each have 16 Kbytes of Flash memory
and can store up to 8,192 single-word instructions.
PIC18 devices have two interrupt vectors. The Reset
vector address is at 0000h and the interrupt vector
addresses are at 0008h and 0018h.
The
program
memory
maps
for
the
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices are shown in
Figure 5-1.
FIGURE 5-1:
PROGRAM MEMORY MAP AND STACK FOR PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 DEVICES
PIC18FX310
PIC18FX410
PC<20:0>
21
CALL,RCALL,RETURN
RETFIE,RETLW
Stack Level 1
PC<20:0>
21
CALL,RCALL,RETURN
RETFIE,RETLW
Stack Level 1
•
•
•
•
•
•
Stack Level 31
Stack Level 31
Reset Vector
0000h
Reset Vector
0000h
High Priority Interrupt Vector 0008h
High Priority Interrupt Vector 0008h
Low Priority Interrupt Vector 0018h
Low Priority Interrupt Vector 0018h
On-Chip
Program Memory
3FFFh
4000h
Read ‘0’
Read ‘0’
1FFFFFh
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
User Memory Space
On-Chip
Program Memory
User Memory Space
1FFFh
2000h
1FFFFFh
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 61
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.1.1
PIC18F8310/8410 PROGRAM
MEMORY MODES
• The Extended Microcontroller Mode allows
access to both internal and external program
memories as a single block. The device can
access its entire on-chip Flash memory; above
this, the device accesses external program
memory up to the 2-Mbyte program space limit.
As with Boot Block mode, execution automatically
switches between the two memories as required.
• The Microprocessor Mode permits access only
to external program memory; the contents of the
on-chip Flash memory is ignored. The 21-bit
program counter permits access to the entire
2-Mbyte linear program memory space.
• The Microprocessor with Boot Block Mode
accesses on-chip Flash memory from addresses
000000h to 0007FFh. Above this, external program
memory is accessed all the way up to the 2-Mbyte
limit. Program execution automatically switches
between the two memories as required.
In addition to available on-chip FLASH program
memory, 80-pin devices in this family can also address
up to 2 Mbytes of external program memory through an
external memory interface. There are four distinct
operating modes available to the controllers:
•
•
•
•
Microprocessor (MP)
Microprocessor with Boot Block (MPBB)
Extended Microcontroller (EMC)
Microcontroller (MC)
The program memory mode is determined by setting
the two Least Significant bits of the CONFIG3L configuration byte, as shown in Register 5-1. (See also
Section 23.1 “Configuration Bits” for additional
details on the device configuration bits.)
The program memory modes operate as follows:
• The Microcontroller Mode accesses only on-chip
Flash memory. Attempts to read above the physical
limit of the on-chip Flash (3FFFh) causes a read of
all ‘0’s (a NOP instruction). The Microcontroller mode
is also the only operating mode available to
PIC18F6310 and PIC18F6410 devices.
REGISTER 5-1:
In all modes, the microcontroller has complete access
to data RAM.
Figure 5-2 compares the memory maps of the different
program memory modes. The differences between
on-chip and external memory access limitations are
more fully explained in Table 5-1.
CONFIG3L: CONFIGURATION BYTE REGISTER 3 LOW
R/P-1
R/P-1
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/P-1
R/P-1
WAIT
BW
—
—
—
—
PM1
PM0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
WAIT: External Bus Data Wait Enable bit
1 = Wait selections unavailable, device will not wait
0 = Wait programmed by WAIT1 and WAIT0 bits of MEMCOM register (MEMCOM<5:4>)
bit 6
BW: External Bus Data Width Select bit
1 = 16-bit external bus data width
0 = 8-bit external bus data width
bit 5-2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1-0
PM1:PM0: Processor Data Memory Mode Select bits
11 = Microcontroller mode
10 = Microprocessor mode(1)
01 = Microcontroller with Boot Block mode(1)
00 = Extended Microcontroller mode(1)
Note 1: This mode is available only on PIC18F8410 devices.
Legend:
DS39635A-page 62
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value after erase
‘1’ = Bit is set
Preliminary
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 5-2:
MEMORY MAPS FOR PIC18FX310/X410 PROGRAM MEMORY MODES
Microcontroller Mode(1)
Extended Microcontroller Mode(2)
000000h
000000h
On-Chip
Program
Memory
On-Chip
Program
Memory
(Top of Memory)
(Top of Memory) + 1
(Top of Memory)
(Top of Memory) + 1
Reads
‘0’s
External
Program
Memory
1FFFFFh
1FFFFFh
On-Chip
Flash
External
Memory
Microprocessor Mode(2)
000000h
On-Chip
Flash
Microprocessor with Boot Block Mode(2)
On-Chip
Program
Memory
000000h
0007FFh
000800h
(No
access)
On-Chip
Program
Memory
(No
access)
(Top of Memory) + 1
External
Program
Memory
External
Program
Memory
1FFFFFh
1FFFFFh
External
Memory
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
External
Memory
On-Chip
Flash
On-Chip
Flash
(Top of Memory) represents upper boundary of on-chip program memory space (1FFFh for PIC18FX310, 3FFFh
for PIC18FX410). Shaded areas represent unimplemented or inaccessible areas, depending on the mode.
This mode is the only available mode on 64-pin devices and the default on 80-pin devices.
These modes are only available on 80-pin devices.
TABLE 5-1:
MEMORY ACCESS FOR PIC18F8310/8410 PROGRAM MEMORY MODES
Internal Program Memory
Operating
Mode
Execution
From
Table Read
From
External Program Memory
Table Write
To
Execution
From
Table Read
From
Table Write
To
Microcontroller
Yes
Yes
Yes
No Access
No Access
No Access
Extended
Microcontroller
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Microprocessor
No Access
No Access
No Access
Yes
Yes
Yes
Microprocessor
w/ Boot Block
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 63
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.1.2
PROGRAM COUNTER
The Program Counter (PC) specifies the address of the
instruction to fetch for execution. The PC is 21 bits wide
and is contained in three separate 8-bit registers. The
low byte, known as the PCL register, is both readable
and writable. The high byte, or PCH register, contains
the PC<15:8> bits; it is not directly readable or writable.
Updates to the PCH register are performed through the
PCLATH register. The upper byte is called PCU. This
register contains the PC<20:16> bits; it is also not
directly readable or writable. Updates to the PCU
register are performed through the PCLATU register.
The contents of PCLATH and PCLATU are transferred
to the program counter by any operation that writes
PCL. Similarly, the upper two bytes of the program
counter are transferred to PCLATH and PCLATU by an
operation that reads PCL. This is useful for computed
offsets to the PC (see Section 5.1.5.1 “Computed
GOTO”).
The PC addresses bytes in the program memory. To
prevent the PC from becoming misaligned with word
instructions, the Least Significant bit of PCL is fixed to
a value of ‘0’. The PC increments by 2 to address
sequential instructions in the program memory.
The CALL, RCALL, GOTO and program branch
instructions write to the program counter directly. For
these instructions, the contents of PCLATH and
PCLATU are not transferred to the program counter.
5.1.3
RETURN ADDRESS STACK
The return address stack allows any combination of up
to 31 program calls and interrupts to occur. The PC is
pushed onto the stack when a CALL or RCALL instruction is executed, or an interrupt is Acknowledged. The
PC value is pulled off the stack on a RETURN, RETLW or
a RETFIE instruction. PCLATU and PCLATH are not
affected by any of the RETURN or CALL instructions.
FIGURE 5-3:
The stack operates as a 31-word by 21-bit RAM and a
5-bit Stack Pointer register, STKPTR. The stack space
is not part of either program or data space. The Stack
Pointer is readable and writable and the address on the
top of the stack is readable and writable through the
Top-of-Stack Special File Registers. Data can also be
pushed to or popped from the stack using these
registers.
A CALL type instruction causes a push onto the stack;
the Stack Pointer is first incremented and the location
pointed to by the Stack Pointer is written with the
contents of the PC (already pointing to the instruction
following the CALL). A RETURN type instruction causes
a pop from the stack; the contents of the location
pointed to by the STKPTR are transferred to the PC
and then the Stack Pointer is decremented.
The Stack Pointer is initialized to ‘00000’ after all
Resets. There is no RAM associated with the location
corresponding to a Stack Pointer value of ‘00000’; this
is only a Reset value. Status bits indicate if the stack is
full, has overflowed or has underflowed.
5.1.3.1
Top-of-Stack Access
Only the top of the return address stack (TOS) is
readable and writable. A set of three registers,
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL, hold the contents of the stack
location pointed to by the STKPTR register
(Figure 5-3). This allows users to implement a software
stack if necessary. After a CALL, RCALL or interrupt, the
software can read the pushed value by reading the
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL registers. These values can be
placed on a user defined software stack. At return time,
the software can return these values to
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL and do a return.
The user must disable the global interrupt enable bits
while accessing the stack to prevent inadvertent stack
corruption.
RETURN ADDRESS STACK AND ASSOCIATED REGISTERS
Return Address Stack <20:0>
Stack Pointer
Top-of-Stack Registers
TOSU
00h
TOSH
1Ah
11111
11110
11101
TOSL
34h
Top-of-Stack
DS39635A-page 64
001A34h
000D58h
Preliminary
STKPTR<4:0>
00010
00011
00010
00001
00000
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.1.3.2
Return Stack Pointer (STKPTR)
When the stack has been popped enough times to
unload the stack, the next pop will return a value of zero
to the PC and sets the STKUNF bit, while the Stack
Pointer remains at zero. The STKUNF bit will remain
set until cleared by software, or until a POR occurs.
The STKPTR register (Register 5-2) contains the Stack
Pointer value, the STKFUL (Stack Full) status bit and
the STKUNF (Stack Underflow) status bit. The value of
the Stack Pointer can be 0 through 31. The Stack
Pointer increments before values are pushed onto the
stack and decrements after values are popped off the
stack. On Reset, the Stack Pointer value will be zero.
The user may read and write the Stack Pointer value.
This feature can be used by a Real-Time Operating
System for return stack maintenance.
Note:
After the PC is pushed onto the stack 31 times (without
popping any values off the stack), the STKFUL bit is
set. The STKFUL bit is cleared by software or by a
POR.
5.1.3.3
PUSH and POP Instructions
Since the Top-of-Stack is readable and writable, the
ability to push values onto the stack and pull values off
the stack, without disturbing normal program execution, is a desirable feature. The PIC18 instruction set
includes two instructions, PUSH and POP, that permit
the TOS to be manipulated under software control.
TOSU, TOSH and TOSL can be modified to place data
or a return address on the stack.
The action that takes place when the stack becomes
full depends on the state of the STVREN (Stack
Overflow Reset Enable) configuration bit. (Refer to
Section 23.1 “Configuration Bits” for a description of
the device configuration bits.) If STVREN is set
(default), the 31st push will push the (PC + 2) value
onto the stack, set the STKFUL bit and reset the
device. The STKFUL bit will remain set and the Stack
Pointer will be set to zero.
The PUSH instruction places the current PC value onto
the stack. This increments the Stack Pointer and loads
the current PC value onto the stack.
If STVREN is cleared, the STKFUL bit will be set on the
31st push and the Stack Pointer will increment to 31.
Any additional pushes will not overwrite the 31st push
and STKPTR will remain at 31.
REGISTER 5-2:
Returning a value of zero to the PC on an
underflow has the effect of vectoring the
program to the Reset vector where the
stack conditions can be verified and
appropriate actions can be taken. This is
not the same as a Reset, as the contents
of the SFRs are not affected.
The POP instruction discards the current TOS by
decrementing the Stack Pointer. The previous value
pushed onto the stack then becomes the TOS value.
STKPTR: STACK POINTER REGISTER
R/C-0
R/C-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
STKFUL
STKUNF
—
SP4
SP3
SP2
SP1
SP0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
STKFUL: Stack Full Flag bit(1)
1 = Stack became full or overflowed
0 = Stack has not become full or overflowed
bit 6
STKUNF: Stack Underflow Flag bit(1)
1 = Stack underflow occurred
0 = Stack underflow did not occur
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-0
SP4:SP0: Stack Pointer Location bits
Note 1: Bit 7 and bit 6 are cleared by user software or by a POR.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented
C = Clearable only bit
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 65
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.1.3.4
Stack Full and Underflow Resets
5.1.5
Device Resets on stack overflow and stack underflow
conditions are enabled by setting the STVREN bit in
Configuration Register 4L. When STVREN is set, a full
or underflow condition will set the appropriate STKFUL
or STKUNF bit and then cause a device Reset. When
STVREN is cleared, a full or underflow condition will set
the appropriate STKFUL or STKUNF bit, but not cause
a device Reset. The STKFUL or STKUNF bits are
cleared by the user software or a Power-on Reset.
5.1.4
FAST REGISTER STACK
A fast register stack is provided for the Status, WREG
and BSR registers to provide a “fast return” option for
interrupts. This stack is only one level deep and is
neither readable nor writable. It is loaded with the
current value of the corresponding register when the
processor vectors for an interrupt. All interrupt sources
will push values into the stack registers. The values in
the registers are then loaded back into the working
registers if the RETFIE, FAST instruction is used to
return from the interrupt.
LOOK-UP TABLES IN
PROGRAM MEMORY
There may be programming situations that require the
creation of data structures, or look-up tables, in
program memory. For PIC18 devices, look-up tables
can be implemented in two ways:
• Computed GOTO
• Table Reads
5.1.5.1
Computed GOTO
A computed GOTO is accomplished by adding an offset
to the program counter. An example is shown in
Example 5-2.
A look-up table can be formed with an ADDWF PCL
instruction and a group of RETLW nn instructions. The
W register is loaded with an offset into the table before
executing a call to that table. The first instruction of the
called routine is the ADDWF PCL instruction. The next
instruction executed will be one of the RETLW nn
instructions that returns the value ‘nn’ to the calling
function.
If both low and high priority interrupts are enabled, the
stack registers cannot be used reliably to return from
low priority interrupts. If a high priority interrupt occurs
while servicing a low priority interrupt, the stack register
values stored by the low priority interrupt will be
overwritten. In these cases, users must save the key
registers in software during a low priority interrupt.
The offset value (in WREG) specifies the number of
bytes that the program counter should advance and
should be multiples of 2 (LSb = 0).
If interrupt priority is not used, all interrupts may use the
fast register stack for returns from interrupt. If no
interrupts are used, the fast register stack can be used
to restore the Status, WREG and BSR registers at the
end of a subroutine call. To use the fast register stack
for a subroutine call, a CALL label, FAST instruction
must be executed to save the Status, WREG and BSR
registers to the fast register stack. A RETURN, FAST
instruction is then executed to restore these registers
from the fast register stack.
EXAMPLE 5-2:
Example 5-1 shows a source code example that uses
the fast register stack during a subroutine call and
return.
EXAMPLE 5-1:
CALL
SUB1, FAST
FAST REGISTER STACK
CODE EXAMPLE
;STATUS, WREG, BSR
;SAVED IN FAST REGISTER
;STACK
•
•
SUB1
•
•
RETURN FAST
DS39635A-page 66
;RESTORE VALUES SAVED
;IN FAST REGISTER STACK
In this method, only one data byte may be stored in
each instruction location and room on the return
address stack is required.
ORG
TABLE
5.1.5.2
MOVF
CALL
nn00h
ADDWF
RETLW
RETLW
RETLW
.
.
.
COMPUTED GOTO USING
AN OFFSET VALUE
OFFSET, W
TABLE
PCL
nnh
nnh
nnh
Table Reads
A better method of storing data in program memory
allows two bytes of data to be stored in each instruction
location.
Look-up table data may be stored two bytes per
program word while programming. The Table Pointer
(TBLPTR) register specifies the byte address and the
Table Latch (TABLAT) register contains the data that is
read from the program memory. Data is transferred
from program memory one byte at a time.
Table read operation is discussed further
Section 6.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
Preliminary
in
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.2
5.2.2
PIC18 Instruction Cycle
5.2.1
An “Instruction Cycle” consists of four Q cycles, Q1
through Q4. The instruction fetch and execute are pipelined in such a manner that a fetch takes one instruction cycle, while the decode and execute take another
instruction cycle. However, due to the pipelining, each
instruction effectively executes in one cycle. If an
instruction causes the program counter to change (e.g.,
GOTO), then two cycles are required to complete the
instruction (Example 5-3).
CLOCKING SCHEME
The microcontroller clock input, whether from an
internal or external source, is internally divided by four
to generate four non-overlapping quadrature clocks
(Q1, Q2, Q3 and Q4). Internally, the program counter is
incremented on every Q1; the instruction is fetched
from the program memory and latched into the instruction register during Q4. The instruction is decoded and
executed during the following Q1 through Q4. The
clocks and instruction execution flow are shown in
Figure 5-4.
FIGURE 5-4:
INSTRUCTION FLOW/PIPELINING
A fetch cycle begins with the Program Counter (PC)
incrementing in Q1.
In the execution cycle, the fetched instruction is latched
into the Instruction Register (IR) in cycle Q1. This
instruction is then decoded and executed during the
Q2, Q3 and Q4 cycles. Data memory is read during Q2
(operand read) and written during Q4 (destination
write).
CLOCK/INSTRUCTION CYCLE
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
OSC1
Q1
Q2
Internal
Phase
Clock
Q3
Q4
PC
PC
PC + 2
PC + 4
OSC2/CLKO
(RC mode)
Execute INST (PC – 2)
Fetch INST (PC)
EXAMPLE 5-3:
TCY0
TCY1
Fetch 1
Execute 1
2. MOVWF PORTB
4. BSF
Execute INST (PC + 2)
Fetch INST (PC + 4)
INSTRUCTION PIPELINE FLOW
1. MOVLW 55h
3. BRA
Execute INST (PC)
Fetch INST (PC + 2)
SUB_1
Fetch 2
TCY2
TCY3
TCY4
TCY5
Execute 2
Fetch 3
Execute 3
Fetch 4
PORTA, BIT3 (Forced NOP)
Flush (NOP)
Fetch SUB_1 Execute SUB_1
5. Instruction @ address SUB_1
All instructions are single cycle, except for any program branches. These take two cycles since the fetch instruction
is “flushed” from the pipeline, while the new instruction is being fetched and then executed.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 67
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.2.3
INSTRUCTIONS IN PROGRAM
MEMORY
The program memory is addressed in bytes. Instructions are stored as two bytes or four bytes in program
memory. The Least Significant Byte of an instruction
word is always stored in a program memory location
with an even address (LSb = 0). To maintain alignment
with instruction boundaries, the PC increments in steps
of 2 and the LSb will always read ‘0’ (see Section 5.1.2
“Program Counter”).
Figure 5-5 shows an example of how instruction words
are stored in the program memory.
FIGURE 5-5:
The CALL and GOTO instructions have the absolute
program memory address embedded into the instruction. Since instructions are always stored on word
boundaries, the data contained in the instruction is a
word address. The word address is written to PC<20:1>,
which accesses the desired byte address in program
memory. Instruction #2 in Figure 5-5 shows how the
instruction, GOTO 0006h, is encoded in the program
memory. Program branch instructions, which encode a
relative address offset, operate in the same manner. The
offset value stored in a branch instruction represents the
number of single-word instructions that the PC will be
offset by. Section 24.0 “Instruction Set Summary”
provides further details of the instruction set.
INSTRUCTIONS IN PROGRAM MEMORY
LSB = 1
LSB = 0
0Fh
EFh
F0h
C1h
F4h
55h
03h
00h
23h
56h
Program Memory
Byte Locations →
5.2.4
Instruction 1:
Instruction 2:
MOVLW
GOTO
055h
0006h
Instruction 3:
MOVFF
123h, 456h
TWO-WORD INSTRUCTIONS
The standard PIC18 instruction set has four two-word
instructions: CALL, MOVFF, GOTO and LSFR. In all
cases, the second word of the instructions always has
‘1111’ as its four Most Significant bits; the other 12 bits
are literal data, usually a data memory address.
The use of ‘1111’ in the 4 MSbs of an instruction
specifies a special form of NOP. If the instruction is
executed in proper sequence – immediately after the
first word – the data in the second word is accessed
EXAMPLE 5-4:
Word Address
↓
000000h
000002h
000004h
000006h
000008h
00000Ah
00000Ch
00000Eh
000010h
000012h
000014h
and used by the instruction sequence. If the first word
is skipped for some reason and the second word is
executed by itself, a NOP is executed instead. This is
necessary for cases when the two-word instruction is
preceded by a conditional instruction that changes the
PC. Example 5-4 shows how this works.
Note:
See Section 5.5 “Program Memory and
the Extended Instruction Set” for
information on two-word instructions in the
extended instruction set.
TWO-WORD INSTRUCTIONS
CASE 1:
Object Code
Source Code
0110 0110 0000 0000
TSTFSZ
REG1
; is RAM location 0?
1100 0001 0010 0011
MOVFF
REG1, REG2
; No, skip this word
1111 0100 0101 0110
0010 0100 0000 0000
; Execute this word as a NOP
ADDWF
REG3
; continue code
CASE 2:
Object Code
Source Code
0110 0110 0000 0000
TSTFSZ
REG1
; is RAM location 0?
1100 0001 0010 0011
MOVFF
REG1, REG2
; Yes, execute this word
ADDWF
REG3
1111 0100 0101 0110
0010 0100 0000 0000
DS39635A-page 68
; 2nd word of instruction
; continue code
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.3
Note:
5.3.1
Data Memory Organization
The operation of some aspects of data
memory are changed when the PIC18
extended instruction set is enabled. See
Section 5.6 “Data Memory and the
Extended Instruction Set” for more
information.
The data memory in PIC18 devices is implemented as
static RAM. Each register in the data memory has a
12-bit address, allowing up to 4096 bytes of data
memory. The memory space is divided into as many as
16
banks
that
contain
256
bytes
each.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices implement only
3 complete banks, for a total of 768 bytes. Figure 5-6
shows the data memory organization for the devices.
The data memory contains Special Function Registers
(SFRs) and General Purpose Registers (GPRs). The
SFRs are used for control and status of the controller
and peripheral functions, while GPRs are used for data
storage and scratchpad operations in the user’s
application. Any read of an unimplemented location will
read as ‘0’s.
The instruction set and architecture allow operations
across all banks. The entire data memory may be
accessed by Direct, Indirect or Indexed Addressing
modes. Addressing modes are discussed later in this
section.
To ensure that commonly used registers (SFRs and
select GPRs) can be accessed in a single cycle, PIC18
devices implement an Access Bank. This is a 256-byte
memory space that provides fast access to SFRs and
the lower portion of GPR Bank 0 without using the
BSR. Section 5.3.2 “Access Bank” provides a
detailed description of the Access RAM.
BANK SELECT REGISTER
Large areas of data memory require an efficient
addressing scheme to make rapid access to any
address possible. Ideally, this means that an entire
address does not need to be provided for each read or
write operation. For PIC18 devices, this is accomplished with a RAM banking scheme. This divides the
memory space into16 contiguous banks of 256 bytes.
Depending on the instruction, each location can be
addressed directly by its full 12-bit address, or an 8-bit
low-order address and a 4-bit bank pointer.
Most instructions in the PIC18 instruction set make use
of the bank pointer, known as the Bank Select Register
(BSR). This SFR holds the 4 Most Significant bits of a
location’s address; the instruction itself includes the
8 Least Significant bits. Only the four lower bits of the
BSR are implemented (BSR3:BSR0). The upper four
bits are unused; they will always read ‘0’ and cannot be
written to. The BSR can be loaded directly by using the
MOVLB instruction.
The value of the BSR indicates the bank in data
memory; the 8 bits in the instruction show the location
in the bank and can be thought of as an offset from the
bank’s lower boundary. The relationship between the
BSR’s value and the bank division in data memory is
shown in Figure 5-7.
Since up to 16 registers may share the same low-order
address, the user must always be careful to ensure that
the proper bank is selected before performing a data
read or write. For example, writing what should be
program data to an 8-bit address of F9h while the BSR
is 0Fh will end up resetting the program counter.
While any bank can be selected, only those banks that
are actually implemented can be read or written to.
Writes to unimplemented banks are ignored, while
reads from unimplemented banks will return ‘0’s. Even
so, the Status register will still be affected as if the
operation was successful. The data memory map in
Figure 5-6 indicates which banks are implemented.
In the core PIC18 instruction set, only the MOVFF
instruction fully specifies the 12-bit address of the
source and target registers. This instruction ignores the
BSR completely when it executes. All other instructions
include only the low-order address as an operand and
must use either the BSR or the Access Bank to locate
their target registers.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 69
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 5-6:
DATA MEMORY MAP FOR PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 DEVICES
BSR<3:0>
00h
= 0000
Access RAM
Bank 0
FFh
00h
= 0001
GPR
1FFh
200h
FFh
00h
Bank 2
The BSR is ignored and the
Access Bank is used.
The first 128 bytes are
general purpose RAM
(from Bank 0).
The second 128 bytes are
Special Function Registers
(from Bank 15).
When a = 1:
GPR
FFh
00h
= 0011
000h
05Fh
060h
0FFh
100h
GPR
Bank 1
= 0010
When a = 0:
Data Memory Map
2FFh
300h
The BSR specifies the bank
used by the instruction.
Bank 3
Access Bank
00h
to
= 1110
5Fh
Access RAM High 60h
(SFRs)
FFh
Bank 14
= 1111
FFh
00h
Unused
FFh
SFR
Bank 15
DS39635A-page 70
Access RAM Low
Unused
Read as 00h
EFFh
F00h
F3Fh
F40h
FFFh
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 5-7:
USE OF THE BANK SELECT REGISTER (DIRECT ADDRESSING)
BSR(1)
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
000h
Data Memory
Bank 0
0
100h
Bank 1
Bank Select(2)
00h
7
FFh
00h
11
From Opcode(2)
11
11
11
11
1
0
1
1
FFh
00h
200h
Bank 2
FFh
00h
300h
Bank 3
through
Bank 13
FFh
00h
E00h
Bank 14
FFh
00h
F00h
Bank 15
FFFh
Note 1:
2:
5.3.2
FFh
The Access RAM bit of the instruction can be used to force an override of the selected bank (BSR<3:0>)
to the registers of the Access Bank.
The MOVFF instruction embeds the entire 12-bit address in the instruction.
ACCESS BANK
While the use of the BSR with an embedded 8-bit
address allows users to address the entire range of
data memory, it also means that the user must always
ensure that the correct bank is selected. Otherwise,
data may be read from or written to the wrong location.
This can be disastrous if a GPR is the intended target
of an operation but an SFR is written to instead.
Verifying and/or changing the BSR for each read or
write to data memory can become very inefficient.
To streamline access for the most commonly used data
memory locations, the data memory is configured with
an Access Bank, which allows users to access a
mapped block of memory without specifying a BSR.
The Access Bank consists of the first 96 bytes of
memory (00h-5Fh) in Bank 0 and the last 160 bytes of
memory (60h-FFh) in Block 15. The lower half is known
as the “Access RAM” and is composed of GPRs. This
upper half is where the device’s SFRs are mapped.
These two areas are mapped contiguously in the
Access Bank and can be addressed in a linear fashion
by an 8-bit address (Figure 5-6).
The Access Bank is used by core PIC18 instructions
that include the Access RAM bit (the ‘a’ parameter in
the instruction). When ‘a’ is equal to ‘1’, the instruction
uses the BSR and the 8-bit address included in the
opcode for the data memory address. When ‘a’ is ‘0’,
however, the instruction is forced to use the Access
Bank address map; the current value of the BSR is
ignored entirely.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Using this “forced” addressing allows the instruction to
operate on a data address in a single cycle without
updating the BSR first. For 8-bit addresses of 80h and
above, this means that users can evaluate and operate
on SFRs more efficiently. The Access RAM below 60h
is a good place for data values that the user might need
to access rapidly, such as immediate computational
results or common program variables. Access RAM
also allows for faster and more code efficient context
saving and switching of variables.
The mapping of the Access Bank is slightly different
when the extended instruction set is enabled (XINST
configuration bit = 1). This is discussed in more detail
in Section 5.6.3 “Mapping the Access Bank in
Indexed Literal Offset Mode”.
5.3.3
GENERAL PURPOSE
REGISTER FILE
PIC18 devices may have banked memory in the GPR
area. This is data RAM, which is available for use by all
instructions. GPRs start at the bottom of Bank 0
(address 000h) and grow upwards towards the bottom
of the SFR area. GPRs are not initialized by a
Power-on Reset and are unchanged on all other
Resets.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 71
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.3.4
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS
The Special Function Registers (SFRs) are registers
used by the CPU and peripheral modules for controlling
the desired operation of the device. These registers are
implemented as static RAM. SFRs start at the top of
data memory (FFFh) and extend downward to occupy
more than the top half of Bank 15 (F60h to FFFh). A list
of these registers is given in Table 5-2 and Table 5-3.
The SFRs can be classified into two sets: those
associated with the “core” device functionality (ALU,
Resets and interrupts) and those related to the
peripheral functions. The Reset and interrupt registers
are described in their respective chapters, while the
ALU’s Status register is described later in this section.
Registers related to the operation of the peripheral
features are described in the chapter for that
peripheral.
The SFRs are typically distributed among the
peripherals whose functions they control. Unused SFR
locations are unimplemented and read as ‘0’s.
TABLE 5-2:
Address
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTER MAP FOR PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 DEVICES
Name
Address
Name
Name
Address
Name
Address
Name
FFFh
TOSU
FDFh
FBFh
CCPR1H
F9Fh
IPR1
F7Fh
SPBRGH1
FFEh
TOSH
FDEh POSTINC2(1)
FBEh
CCPR1L
F9Eh
PIR1
F7Eh
BAUDCON1
FFDh
TOSL
FDDh POSTDEC2(1)
FBDh
CCP1CON
F9Dh
PIE1
F7Dh
—(2)
F7Ch
—(2)
FFCh
FFBh
STKPTR
FDCh
PCLATU
FDBh
INDF2
Address
(1)
(1)
FBCh
CCPR2H
F9Ch
(1)
FBBh
CCPR2L
F9Bh
OSCTUNE
F7Bh
—(2)
F7Ah
—(2)
PREINC2
PLUSW2
MEMCON
(3)
FFAh
PCLATH
FDAh
FSR2H
FBAh
CCP2CON
F9Ah
TRISJ(3)
FF9h
PCL
FD9h
FSR2L
FB9h
CCPR3H
F99h
TRISH(3)
F79h
—(2)
FF8h
TBLPTRU
FD8h
STATUS
FB8h
CCPR3L
F98h
TRISG
F78h
—(2)
FF7h
TBLPTRH
FD7h
TMR0H
FB7h
CCP3CON
F97h
TRISF
F77h
—(2)
F96h
TRISE
F76h
—(2)
(2)
FF6h
TBLPTRL
FD6h
TMR0L
FB6h
—
FF5h
TABLAT
FD5h
T0CON
FB5h
CVRCON
F95h
TRISD
F75h
—(2)
FB4h
CMCON
F94h
TRISC
F74h
—(2)
FF4h
PRODH
FD4h
—(2)
FF3h
PRODL
FD3h
OSCCON
FB3h
TMR3H
F93h
TRISB
F73h
—(2)
FF2h
INTCON
FD2h
HLVDCON
FB2h
TMR3L
F92h
TRISA
F72h
—(2)
FF1h
INTCON2
FD1h
WDTCON
FB1h
T3CON
F91h
LATJ(3)
F71h
—(2)
F90h
(3)
F70h
—(2)
FF0h
FEFh
INTCON3
INDF0
(1)
FD0h
RCON
FB0h
PSPCON
LATH
FCFh
TMR1H
FAFh
SPBRG1
F8Fh
LATG
F6Fh
SPBRG2
FEEh POSTINC0(1)
FCEh
TMR1L
FAEh
RCREG1
F8Eh
LATF
F6Eh
RCREG2
FEDh POSTDEC0(1)
TXREG1
F8Dh
LATE
F6Dh
TXREG2
FCDh
T1CON
FADh
FECh
PREINC0
(1)
FCCh
TMR2
FACh
TXSTA1
F8Ch
LATD
F6Ch
TXSTA2
FEBh
PLUSW0(1)
FCBh
PR2
FABh
RCSTA1
F8Bh
LATC
F6Bh
RCSTA2
FEAh
FSR0H
FCAh
T2CON
FAAh
—(2)
F8Ah
LATB
F6Ah
—(2)
FE9h
FSR0L
FC9h
SSPBUF
FA9h
—(2)
F89h
LATA
F69h
—(2)
FA8h
—(2)
F88h
PORTJ(3)
F68h
—(2)
FA7h
(2)
F87h
(3)
F67h
—(2)
(2)
FE8h
FE7h
WREG
INDF1
FC8h
(1)
FC7h
SSPADD
SSPSTAT
—
PORTH
(1)
FC6h
SSPCON1
FA6h
—
F86h
PORTG
F66h
—(2)
FE5h POSTDEC1(1)
FE6h
POSTINC1
FC5h
SSPCON2
FA5h
IPR3
F85h
PORTF
F65h
—(2)
FE4h
PREINC1
(1)
FC4h
ADRESH
FA4h
PIR3
F84h
PORTE
F64h
—(2)
FE3h
PLUSW1(1)
FC3h
ADRESL
FA3h
PIE3
F83h
PORTD
F63h
—(2)
FE2h
FSR1H
FC2h
ADCON0
FA2h
IPR2
F82h
PORTC
F62h
—(2)
FE1h
FSR1L
FC1h
ADCON1
FA1h
PIR2
F81h
PORTB
F61h
—(2)
FE0h
BSR
FC0h
ADCON2
FA0h
PIE2
F80h
PORTA
F60h
—(2)
Note 1:
2:
3:
This is not a physical register.
Unimplemented registers are read as ‘0’.
This register is not available on 64-pin devices.
DS39635A-page 72
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 5-3:
File Name
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
—
—
—
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Details
on page:
---0 0000
57, 64
TOSH
Top-of-Stack High Byte (TOS<15:8>)
0000 0000
57, 64
TOSL
Top-of-Stack Low Byte (TOS<7:0>)
0000 0000
57, 64
TOSU
STKPTR
PCLATU
Top-of-Stack Upper Byte (TOS<20:16>)
Value on
POR, BOR
STKFUL(6)
STKUNF(6)
—
Return Stack Pointer
00-0 0000
57, 65
—
—
—
Holding Register for PC<20:16>
---0 0000
57, 64
PCLATH
Holding Register for PC<15:8>
0000 0000
57, 64
PCL
PC Low Byte (PC<7:0>)
0000 0000
57, 64
--00 0000
57, 88
TBLPTRU
—
—
bit 21
Program Memory Table Pointer Upper Byte (TBLPTR<20:16>)
TBLPTRH
Program Memory Table Pointer High Byte (TBLPTR<15:8>)
0000 0000
57, 88
TBLPTRL
Program Memory Table Pointer Low Byte (TBLPTR<7:0>)
0000 0000
57, 88
TABLAT
Program Memory Table Latch
0000 0000
57, 88
PRODH
Product Register High Byte
xxxx xxxx
57, 99
PRODL
Product Register Low Byte
xxxx xxxx
57, 99
RBIF
0000 000x
57, 103
INTCON
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
INTCON2
RBPU
INTEDG0
INTEDG1
INTEDG2
INTEDG3
TMR0IP
INT3IP
RBIP
1111 1111
57, 104
INTCON3
INT2IP
INT1IP
INT3IE
INT2IE
INT1IE
INT3IF
INT2IF
INT1IF
1100 0000
57, 105
INDF0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 not changed (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 79
POSTINC0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 post-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 80
POSTDEC0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 post-decremented (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 80
PREINC0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 80
PLUSW0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 pre-incremented (not a physical register),
value of FSR0 offset by W
N/A
57, 80
FSR0H
---- xxxx
57, 79
FSR0L
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 0 Low Byte
—
xxxx xxxx
57, 79
WREG
Working Register
xxxx xxxx
57
INDF1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 not changed (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 79
POSTINC1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 post-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 80
POSTDEC1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 post-decremented (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 80
PREINC1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
57, 80
PLUSW1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 pre-incremented (not a physical register),
value of FSR1 offset by W
N/A
57, 80
---- xxxx
57, 79
FSR1H
—
FSR1L
—
—
—
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 0 High
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 1 High
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 1 Low Byte
BSR
—
—
—
—
Bank Select Register
xxxx xxxx
57, 79
---- 0000
57, 69
INDF2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 not changed (not a physical register)
N/A
58, 79
POSTINC2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 post-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
58, 80
POSTDEC2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 post-decremented (not a physical register)
N/A
58, 80
PREINC2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
58, 80
PLUSW2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 pre-incremented (not a physical register),
value of FSR2 offset by W
N/A
58, 80
---- xxxx
58, 79
FSR2H
—
FSR2L
—
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 2 High
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 2 Low Byte
STATUS
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
—
—
—
N
OV
Z
DC
C
xxxx xxxx
58, 79
---x xxxx
58, 77
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, q = value depends on condition. Shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 configuration bits = 01; otherwise it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
These registers and/or bits are not implemented on 64-pin devices, read as ‘0’.
The PLLEN bit is only available in specific oscillator configuration; otherwise, it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See Section 2.6.4 “PLL in
INTOSC Modes”.
The RG5 bit is only available when Master Clear is disabled (MCLRE configuration bit = 0); otherwise, RG5 reads as ‘0’. This bit is
read-only.
RA6/RA7 and their associated latch and direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary oscillator modes.
When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
STKFUL and STKUNF bits are cleared by user software or by a POR.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 73
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 5-3:
File Name
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410) (CONTINUED)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Details
on page:
TMR0H
Timer0 Register High Byte
0000 0000
58, 145
TMR0L
Timer0 Register Low Byte
xxxx xxxx
58, 145
58, 143
T0CON
TMR0ON
T08BIT
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
T0PS2
T0PS1
T0PS0
1111 1111
OSCCON
IDLEN
IRCF2
IRCF1
IRCF0
OSTS
IOFS
SCS1
SCS0
0100 q000
36, 58
HLVDCON
VDIRMAG
—
IRVST
HLVDEN
HLVDL3
HLVDL2
HLVDL1
HLVDL0
0-00 0101
58, 265
WDTCON
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SWDTEN
---- ---0
58, 280
—
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
0q-1 11q0
50, 58,
115
RCON
IPEN
SBOREN
(1)
TMR1H
Timer1 Register High Byte
xxxx xxxx
58, 151
TMR1L
Timer1 Register Low Byte
0000 0000
58, 151
0000 0000
58, 147
58, 154
T1CON
RD16
T1RUN
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
TMR2
Timer2 Register
1111 1111
PR2
Timer2 Period Register
-000 0000
58, 154
-000 0000
58, 153
0000 0000
58, 170,
178
T2CON
—
T2OUTPS3
T2OUTPS2
T2OUTPS1
T2OUTPS0
TMR2ON
T2CKPS1
T2CKPS0
SSPBUF
SSP Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
SSPADD
SSP Address Register in I2C™ Slave Mode. SSP Baud Rate Reload Register in I2C Master Mode.
0000 0000
58, 178
SSPSTAT
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
0000 0000
58, 170,
179
SSPCON1
WCOL
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
SSPM3
SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
0000 0000
58, 171,
180
GCEN
ACKSTAT
ACKDT
ACKEN
RCEN
PEN
RSEN
SEN
SSPCON2
0000 0000
58, 181
ADRESH
A/D Result Register High Byte
xxxx xxxx
58, 254
ADRESL
A/D Result Register Low Byte
0000 0000
58, 254
ADCON0
—
—
CHS3
CHS2
CHS1
CHS0
GO/DONE
ADON
--00 0000
58, 245
ADCON1
—
—
VCFG1
VCFG0
PCFG3
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
--00 qqqq
58, 246
ADFM
—
ACQT2
ACQT1
ACQT0
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
ADCON2
0-00 0000
58, 247
CCPR1H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 High Byte
xxxx xxxx
59, 160
CCPR1L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 Low Byte
xxxx xxxx
59, 160
--00 0000
59, 159
59, 160
CCP1CON
—
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0
CCPR2H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 2 High Byte
xxxx xxxx
CCPR2L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 2 Low Byte
0000 0000
59, 160
--00 0000
59, 159
59, 160
CCP2CON
—
—
DC2B1
DC2B0
CCP2M3
CCP2M2
CCP2M1
CCP2M0
CCPR3H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 3 High Byte
xxxx xxxx
CCPR3L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 3 Low Byte
0000 0000
59, 160
CCP3CON
—
—
CVRCON
CVREN
CMCON
C2OUT
DC3B1
DC3B0
CCP3M3
CCP3M2
CCP3M1
CCP3M0
--00 0000
59, 159
CVROE
CVRR
CVRSS
CVR3
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
0000 0000
59, 261
C1OUT
C2INV
C1INV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
0000 0111
59, 255
TMR3H
Timer3 Register High Byte
0000 0000
59, 157
TMR3L
Timer3 Register Low Byte
0000 0000
59, 157
T3CON
PSPCON
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
RD16
T3CCP2
T3CKPS1
T3CKPS0
T3CCP1
T3SYNC
TMR3CS
TMR3ON
0000 0000
59, 155
IBF
OBF
IBOV
PSPMODE
—
—
—
—
0000 ----
59, 141
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, q = value depends on condition. Shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 configuration bits = 01; otherwise it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
These registers and/or bits are not implemented on 64-pin devices, read as ‘0’.
The PLLEN bit is only available in specific oscillator configuration; otherwise, it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See Section 2.6.4 “PLL in
INTOSC Modes”.
The RG5 bit is only available when Master Clear is disabled (MCLRE configuration bit = 0); otherwise, RG5 reads as ‘0’. This bit is
read-only.
RA6/RA7 and their associated latch and direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary oscillator modes.
When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
STKFUL and STKUNF bits are cleared by user software or by a POR.
DS39635A-page 74
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 5-3:
File Name
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410) (CONTINUED)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
Details
on page:
SPBRG1
EUSART1 Baud Rate Generator
0000 0000
59, 213
RCREG1
EUSART1 Receive Register
0000 0000
59, 220
TXREG1
EUSART1 Transmit Register
xxxx xxxx
59, 218
59, 210
TXSTA1
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
xxxx xxxx
RCSTA1
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
0000 0000
59, 211
IPR3
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
--00 ---1
59, 114
59, 108
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
--00 ---1
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
--00 ---1
59, 111
IPR2
OSCFIP
CMIP
—
—
BCLIP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
CCP2IP
11-- 1111
59, 113
PIR2
OSCFIF
CMIF
—
—
BCLIF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
CCP2IF
00-- 0000
59, 107
PIE2
OSCFIE
CMIE
—
—
BCLIE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
CCP2IE
00-- 0000
59, 110
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
1111 1111
59, 112
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
0000 0000
59, 106
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
0000 0000
59, 109
MEMCON(2)
EBDIS
—
WAIT1
WAIT0
—
—
WM1
WM0
0-00 --00
59, 89
INTSRC
PLLEN(3)
—
TUN4
TUN3
TUN2
TUN1
TUN0
00-0 0000
33, 59
OSCTUNE
TRISJ(2)
Data Direction Control Register for PORTJ
1111 1111
59, 139
TRISH(2)
Data Direction Control Register for PORTH
1111 1111
59, 137
---1 1111
60, 135
TRISG
—
—
—
Data Direction Control Register for PORTG
TRISF
Data Direction Control Register for PORTF
1111 1111
60, 133
TRISE
Data Direction Control Register for PORTE
1111 1111
60, 131
TRISD
Data Direction Control Register for PORTD
1111 1111
60, 128
TRISC
Data Direction Control Register for PORTC
1111 1111
60, 125
TRISB
Data Direction Control Register for PORTB
1111 1111
60, 122
TRISA7(5)
TRISA
TRISA6(5)
Data Direction Control Register for PORTA
1111 1111
60, 119
LATJ(2)
Read PORTJ Data Latch, Write PORTJ Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 139
LATH(2)
Read PORTH Data Latch, Write PORTH Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 137
---x xxxx
60, 135
LATG
—
—
—
Read PORTG Data Latch, Write PORTG Data Latch
LATF
Read PORTF Data Latch, Write PORTF Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 133
LATE
Read PORTE Data Latch, Write PORTE Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 131
LATD
Read PORTD Data Latch, Write PORTD Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 128
LATC
Read PORTC Data Latch, Write PORTC Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 125
LATB
Read PORTB Data Latch, Write PORTB Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 122
LATA7(5)
LATA
LATA6(5)
Read PORTA Data Latch, Write PORTA Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 119
PORTJ(2)
Read PORTJ pins, Write PORTJ Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 139
PORTH(2)
Read PORTH pins, Write PORTH Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 137
--xx xxxx
60, 135
PORTG
—
—
RG5(4)
Read PORTG pins <4:0>, Write PORTG Data Latch <4:0>
PORTF
Read PORTF pins, Write PORTF Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 133
PORTE
Read PORTE pins, Write PORTE Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 131
PORTD
Read PORTD pins, Write PORTD Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 128
PORTC
Read PORTC pins, Write PORTC Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 125
PORTB
Read PORTB pins, Write PORTB Data Latch
xxxx xxxx
60, 122
xx0x 0000
60, 119
RA7(5)
PORTA
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
RA6(5)
Read PORTA pins, Write PORTA Data Latch
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, q = value depends on condition. Shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 configuration bits = 01; otherwise it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
These registers and/or bits are not implemented on 64-pin devices, read as ‘0’.
The PLLEN bit is only available in specific oscillator configuration; otherwise, it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See Section 2.6.4 “PLL in
INTOSC Modes”.
The RG5 bit is only available when Master Clear is disabled (MCLRE configuration bit = 0); otherwise, RG5 reads as ‘0’. This bit is
read-only.
RA6/RA7 and their associated latch and direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary oscillator modes.
When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
STKFUL and STKUNF bits are cleared by user software or by a POR.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 75
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 5-3:
File Name
SPBRGH1
BAUDCON1
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410) (CONTINUED)
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Value on
POR, BOR
0000 0000
60, 213
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
01-0 0-00
60, 212
EUSART1 Baud Rate Generator High Byte
ABDOVF
RCIDL
—
Details
on page:
SPBRG2
AUSART2 Baud Rate Generator
0000 0000
60, 234
RCREG2
AUSART2 Receive Register
0000 0000
60, 238
TXREG2
AUSART2 Transmit Register
xxxx xxxx
60, 236
TXSTA2
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
0000 -010
60, 232
RCSTA2
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
0000 000x
60, 233
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, q = value depends on condition. Shaded locations are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 configuration bits = 01; otherwise it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
These registers and/or bits are not implemented on 64-pin devices, read as ‘0’.
The PLLEN bit is only available in specific oscillator configuration; otherwise, it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See Section 2.6.4 “PLL in
INTOSC Modes”.
The RG5 bit is only available when Master Clear is disabled (MCLRE configuration bit = 0); otherwise, RG5 reads as ‘0’. This bit is
read-only.
RA6/RA7 and their associated latch and direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary oscillator modes.
When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
STKFUL and STKUNF bits are cleared by user software or by a POR.
DS39635A-page 76
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.3.5
STATUS REGISTER
The Status register, shown in Register 5-3, contains the
arithmetic status of the ALU. As with any other SFR, it
can be the operand for any instruction.
If the Status register is the destination for an instruction
that affects the Z, DC, C, OV or N bits, the results of the
instruction are not written; instead, the status is
updated according to the instruction performed. Therefore, the result of an instruction with the Status register
as its destination may be different than intended. As an
example, CLRF STATUS, will set the Z bit and leave the
remaining Status bits unchanged (‘000u u1uu’).
REGISTER 5-3:
It is recommended that only BCF, BSF, SWAPF, MOVFF
and MOVWF instructions are used to alter the Status
register, because these instructions do not affect the Z,
C, DC, OV or N bits in the Status register.
For other instructions that do not affect Status bits, see
the instruction set summaries in Table 24-2 and
Table 24-3.
Note:
The C and DC bits operate as a borrow and
digit borrow bit, respectively, in subtraction.
STATUS REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
R/W-x
—
—
—
N
OV
Z
DC
C
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
N: Negative bit
This bit is used for signed arithmetic (2’s complement). It indicates whether the result was
negative (ALU MSB = 1).
1 = Result was negative
0 = Result was positive
bit 3
OV: Overflow bit
This bit is used for signed arithmetic (2’s complement). It indicates an overflow of the
7-bit magnitude, which causes the sign bit (bit 7) to change state.
1 = Overflow occurred for signed arithmetic (in this arithmetic operation)
0 = No overflow occurred
bit 2
Z: Zero bit
1 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero
0 = The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero
bit 1
DC: Digit carry/borrow bit
For ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW and SUBWF instructions:
1 = A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result
Note:
bit 0
For borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the
2’s complement of the second operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit
is loaded with either bit 4 or bit 3 of the source register.
C: Carry/borrow bit
For ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLW and SUBWF instructions:
1 = A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
0 = No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
Note:
For borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the
2’s complement of the second operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit
is loaded with either the high or low-order bit of the source register.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 77
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.4
Data Addressing Modes
Note:
The execution of some instructions in the
core PIC18 instruction set are changed
when the PIC18 extended instruction set is
enabled. See Section 5.6 “Data Memory
and the Extended Instruction Set” for
more information.
While the program memory can be addressed in only
one way – through the program counter – information
in the data memory space can be addressed in several
ways. For most instructions, the addressing mode is
fixed. Other instructions may use up to three modes,
depending on which operands are used and whether or
not the extended instruction set is enabled.
The addressing modes are:
•
•
•
•
Inherent
Literal
Direct
Indirect
An additional addressing mode, Indexed Literal Offset,
is available when the extended instruction set is
enabled (XINST configuration bit = 1). Its operation is
discussed in greater detail in Section 5.6.1 “Indexed
Addressing with Literal Offset”.
5.4.1
INHERENT AND LITERAL
ADDRESSING
Many PIC18 control instructions do not need any
argument at all; they either perform an operation that
globally affects the device, or they operate implicitly on
one register. This addressing mode is known as
Inherent Addressing. Examples include SLEEP, RESET
and DAW.
Other instructions work in a similar way but require an
additional explicit argument in the opcode. This is
known as Literal Addressing mode, because they
require some literal value as an argument. Examples
include ADDLW and MOVLW, which respectively, add or
move a literal value to the W register. Other examples
include CALL and GOTO, which include a 20-bit
program memory address.
Purpose Register File”), or a location in the Access
Bank (Section 5.3.2 “Access Bank”) as the data
source for the instruction.
The Access RAM bit ‘a’ determines how the address is
interpreted. When ‘a’ is ‘1’, the contents of the BSR
(Section 5.3.1 “Bank Select Register”) are used with
the address to determine the complete 12-bit address
of the register. When ‘a’ is ‘0’, the address is interpreted
as being a register in the Access Bank. Addressing that
uses the Access RAM is sometimes also known as
Direct Forced Addressing mode.
A few instructions, such as MOVFF, include the entire
12-bit address (either source or destination) in their
opcodes. In these cases, the BSR is ignored entirely.
The destination of the operation’s results is determined
by the destination bit ‘d’. When ‘d’ is ‘1’, the results are
stored back in the source register, overwriting its original contents. When ‘d’ is ‘0’, the results are stored in
the W register. Instructions without the ‘d’ argument
have a destination that is implicit in the instruction; their
destination is either the target register being operated
on, or the W register.
5.4.3
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
Indirect addressing allows the user to access a location
in data memory without giving a fixed address in the
instruction. This is done by using File Select Registers
(FSRs) as pointers to the locations to be read or written
to. Since the FSRs are themselves located in RAM as
Special File Registers, they can also be directly manipulated under program control. This makes FSRs very
useful in implementing data structures, such as tables
and arrays in data memory.
The registers for indirect addressing are also
implemented with Indirect File Operands (INDFs) that
permit automatic manipulation of the pointer value with
auto-incrementing, auto-decrementing or offsetting
with another value. This allows for efficient code using
loops, such as the example of clearing an entire RAM
bank in Example 5-5. It also enables users to perform
indexed addressing and other Stack Pointer operations
for program memory in data memory.
EXAMPLE 5-5:
5.4.2
DIRECT ADDRESSING
Direct addressing specifies all or part of the source
and/or destination address of the operation within the
opcode itself. The options are specified by the
arguments accompanying the instruction.
In the core PIC18 instruction set, bit-oriented and
byte-oriented instructions use some version of direct
addressing by default. All of these instructions include
some 8-bit literal address as their Least Significant
Byte. This address specifies either a register address in
one of the banks of data RAM (Section 5.3.3 “General
DS39635A-page 78
NEXT
LFSR
CLRF
BTFSS
BRA
CONTINUE
Preliminary
HOW TO CLEAR RAM
(BANK 1) USING
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
FSR0, 100h ;
POSTINC0
; Clear INDF
; register then
; inc pointer
FSR0H, 1
; All done with
; Bank1?
NEXT
; NO, clear next
; YES, continue
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.4.3.1
FSR Registers and the
INDF Operand
mapped in the SFR space but are not physically implemented. Reading or writing to a particular INDF register
actually accesses its corresponding FSR register pair.
A read from INDF1, for example, reads the data at the
address indicated by FSR1H:FSR1L. Instructions that
use the INDF registers as operands actually use the
contents of their corresponding FSR as a pointer to the
instruction’s target. The INDF operand is just a
convenient way of using the pointer.
At the core of indirect addressing are three sets of
registers: FSR0, FSR1 and FSR2. Each represents a
pair of 8-bit registers, FSRnH and FSRnL. The four
upper bits of the FSRnH register are not used, so each
FSR pair holds a 12-bit value. This represents a value
that can address the entire range of the data memory
in a linear fashion. The FSR register pairs, then, serve
as pointers to data memory locations.
Because indirect addressing uses a full 12-bit address,
data RAM banking is not necessary. Thus, the current
contents of the BSR and the Access RAM bit have no
effect on determining the target address.
Indirect addressing is accomplished with a set of
Indirect File Operands, INDF0 through INDF2. These
can be thought of as “virtual” registers: they are
FIGURE 5-8:
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
000h
Using an instruction with one of the
indirect addressing registers as the
operand....
Bank 0
ADDWF, INDF1, 1
100h
Bank 1
200h
Bank 2
...uses the 12-bit address stored in
the FSR pair associated with that
register....
300h
FSR1H:FSR1L
7
0
x x x x 1 1 1 1
7
0
Bank 3
through
Bank 13
1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0
...to determine the data memory
location to be used in that operation.
E00h
In this case, the FSR1 pair contains
FCCh. This means the contents of
location FCCh will be added to that
of the W register and stored back in
FCCh.
Bank 14
F00h
Bank 15
FFFh
Data Memory
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 79
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.4.3.2
FSR Registers and POSTINC,
POSTDEC, PREINC and PLUSW
In addition to the INDF operand, each FSR register pair
also has four additional indirect operands. Like INDF,
these are “virtual” registers that cannot be indirectly
read or written to. Accessing these registers actually
accesses the associated FSR register pair, but also
performs a specific action on its stored value. They are:
• POSTDEC: accesses the FSR value, then
automatically decrements it by ‘1’ afterwards
• POSTINC: accesses the FSR value, then
automatically increments it by ‘1’ afterwards
• PREINC: increments the FSR value by ‘1’, then
uses it in the operation
• PLUSW: adds the signed value of the W register
(range of -127 to 128) to that of the FSR and uses
the new value in the operation.
In this context, accessing an INDF register uses the
value in the FSR registers without changing them.
Similarly, accessing a PLUSW register gives the FSR
value offset by the value in the W register; neither value
is actually changed in the operation. Accessing the
other virtual registers changes the value of the FSR
registers.
Operations on the FSRs with POSTDEC, POSTINC
and PREINC affect the entire register pair; that is,
rollovers of the FSRnL register from FFh to 00h carry
over to the FSRnH register. On the other hand, results
of these operations do not change the value of any
flags in the Status register (e.g., Z, N, OV, etc.).
5.4.3.3
Operations by FSRs on FSRs
Indirect addressing operations that target other FSRs
or virtual registers represent special cases. For example, using an FSR to point to one of the virtual registers
will not result in successful operations. As a specific
case, assume that FSR0H:FSR0L contains FE7h, the
address of INDF1. Attempts to read the value of the
INDF1, using INDF0 as an operand, will return 00h.
Attempts to write to INDF1, using INDF0 as the
operand, will result in a NOP.
On the other hand, using the virtual registers to write to
an FSR pair may not occur as planned. In these cases,
the value will be written to the FSR pair, but without any
incrementing or decrementing. Thus, writing to INDF2
or POSTDEC2 will write the same value to the
FSR2H:FSR2L.
Since the FSRs are physical registers mapped in the
SFR space, they can be manipulated through all direct
operations. Users should proceed cautiously when
working on these registers, particularly if their code
uses indirect addressing.
Similarly, operations by indirect addressing are generally permitted on all other SFRs. Users should exercise
the appropriate caution that they do not inadvertently
change settings that might affect the operation of the
device.
The PLUSW register can be used to implement a form
of indexed addressing in the data memory space. By
manipulating the value in the W register, users can
reach addresses that are fixed offsets from pointer
addresses. In some applications, this can be used to
implement some powerful program control structure,
such as software stacks, inside of data memory.
DS39635A-page 80
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.5
Program Memory and the
Extended Instruction Set
When using the extended instruction set, this
addressing mode requires the following:
The operation of program memory is unaffected by the
use of the extended instruction set.
Enabling the extended instruction set adds five
additional two-word commands to the existing PIC18
instruction set: ADDFSR, CALLW, MOVSF, MOVSS and
SUBFSR. These instructions are executed as described
in Section 5.2.4 “Two-Word Instructions”.
5.6
Data Memory and the Extended
Instruction Set
Enabling the PIC18 extended instruction set (XINST
configuration bit = 1) significantly changes certain
aspects of data memory and its addressing. Specifically, the use of the Access Bank for many of the core
PIC18 instructions is different; this is due to the
introduction of a new addressing mode for the data
memory space. This mode also alters the behavior of
indirect addressing using FSR2 and its associated
operands.
What does not change is just as important. The size of
the data memory space is unchanged, as well as its
linear addressing. The SFR map remains the same.
Core PIC18 instructions can still operate in both Direct
and Indirect Addressing mode; inherent and literal
instructions do not change at all. Indirect addressing
with FSR0 and FSR1 also remain unchanged.
5.6.1
INDEXED ADDRESSING WITH
LITERAL OFFSET
Enabling the PIC18 extended instruction set changes
the behavior of indirect addressing using the FSR2
register pair and its associated file operands. Under the
proper conditions, instructions that use the Access
Bank – that is, most bit-oriented and byte-oriented
instructions – can invoke a form of indexed addressing
using an offset specified in the instruction. This special
addressing mode is known as Indexed Addressing with
Literal Offset, or Indexed Literal Offset mode.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
• The use of the Access Bank is forced (‘a’ = 0);
and
• The file address argument is less than or equal to
5Fh.
Under these conditions, the file address of the
instruction is not interpreted as the lower byte of an
address (used with the BSR in direct addressing), or as
an 8-bit address in the Access Bank. Instead, the value
is interpreted as an offset value to an address pointer
specified by FSR2. The offset and the contents of
FSR2 are added to obtain the target address of the
operation.
5.6.2
INSTRUCTIONS AFFECTED BY
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
Any of the core PIC18 instructions that can use direct
addressing are potentially affected by the Indexed
Literal Offset Addressing mode. This includes all
byte-oriented and bit-oriented instructions, or almost
one-half of the standard PIC18 instruction set. Instructions that only use Inherent or Literal Addressing
modes are unaffected.
Additionally, byte-oriented and bit-oriented instructions
are not affected if they use the Access Bank (Access
RAM bit is ‘1’), or include a file address of 60h or above.
Instructions meeting these criteria will continue to
execute as before. A comparison of the different possible addressing modes when the extended instruction
set is enabled is shown in Figure 5-9.
Those who desire to use byte-oriented or bit-oriented
instructions in the Indexed Literal Offset mode should
note the changes to assembler syntax for this mode.
This is described in more detail in Section 24.2.1
“Extended Instruction Syntax”.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 81
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 5-9:
COMPARING ADDRESSING OPTIONS FOR BIT-ORIENTED AND
BYTE-ORIENTED INSTRUCTIONS (EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SET ENABLED)
EXAMPLE INSTRUCTION: ADDWF, f, d, a (Opcode: 0010 01da ffff ffff)
When a = 0 and f ≥ 60h:
The instruction executes in
Direct Forced mode. ‘f’ is
interpreted as a location in the
Access RAM between 060h
and FFFh. This is the same as
locations F60h to FFFh
(Bank 15) of data memory.
Locations below 060h are not
available in this addressing
mode.
000h
060h
Bank 0
100h
00h
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
60h
Valid Range
for ‘f’
FFh
F00h
Access RAM
Bank 15
F40h
SFRs
FFFh
Data Memory
When a = 0 and f ≤ 5Fh:
The instruction executes in
Indexed Literal Offset mode. ‘f’
is interpreted as an offset to the
address value in FSR2. The
two are added together to
obtain the address of the target
register for the instruction. The
address can be anywhere in
the data memory space.
Note that in this mode, the
correct syntax is now:
ADDWF [k], d
where ‘k’ is the same as ‘f’.
000h
Bank 0
060h
100h
001001da ffffffff
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
FSR2H
FSR2L
F00h
Bank 15
F40h
SFRs
FFFh
Data Memory
When a = 1 (all values of f):
The instruction executes in
Direct mode (also known as
Direct Long mode). ‘f’ is
interpreted as a location in
one of the 16 banks of the data
memory space. The bank is
designated by the Bank Select
Register (BSR). The address
can be in any implemented
bank in the data memory
space.
BSR
00000000
000h
Bank 0
060h
100h
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
001001da ffffffff
F00h
Bank 15
F40h
SFRs
FFFh
Data Memory
DS39635A-page 82
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
5.6.3
MAPPING THE ACCESS BANK IN
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
The use of Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
effectively changes how the lower part of Access RAM
(00h to 5Fh) is mapped. Rather than containing just the
contents of the bottom part of Bank 0, this mode maps
the contents from Bank 0 and a user defined “window”
that can be located anywhere in the data memory
space. The value of FSR2 establishes the lower boundary of the addresses mapped into the window, while the
upper boundary is defined by FSR2 plus 95 (5Fh).
Addresses in the Access RAM above 5Fh are mapped
as previously described (see Section 5.3.2 “Access
Bank”). An example of Access Bank remapping in this
addressing mode is shown in Figure 5-10.
FIGURE 5-10:
Remapping of the Access Bank applies only to operations using the Indexed Literal Offset mode. Operations
that use the BSR (Access RAM bit is ‘1’) will continue
to use direct addressing as before. Any indirect or
indexed operation that explicitly uses any of the indirect
file operands (including FSR2) will continue to operate
as standard indirect addressing. Any instruction that
uses the Access Bank, but includes a register address
of greater than 05Fh, will use direct addressing and the
normal Access Bank map.
5.6.4
BSR IN INDEXED LITERAL
OFFSET MODE
Although the Access Bank is remapped when the
extended instruction set is enabled, the operation of the
BSR remains unchanged. Direct addressing, using the
BSR to select the data memory bank, operates in the
same manner as previously described.
REMAPPING THE ACCESS BANK WITH INDEXED LITERAL
OFFSET ADDRESSING
Example Situation:
ADDWF f, d, a
FSR2H:FSR2L = 120h
Locations in the region
from the FSR2 pointer
(120h) to the pointer plus
05Fh (17Fh) are mapped
to the bottom of the
Access RAM (000h-05Fh).
000h
05Fh
Bank 0
100h
120h
17Fh
200h
Window
00h
Bank 1
Bank 1 “Window”
5Fh
60h
Special File Registers at
F60h through FFFh are
mapped to 60h through
FFh, as usual.
Bank 0 addresses below
5Fh are not available in
this mode. They can still
be addressed by using the
BSR.
Not Accessible
Bank 2
through
Bank 14
SFRs
FFh
Access Bank
F00h
Bank 15
F60h
SFRs
FFFh
Data Memory
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 83
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 84
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
6.0
PROGRAM MEMORY
For PIC18FX310/X410 devices, the on-chip program
memory is implemented as read-only memory. It is
readable over the entire VDD range during normal
operation; it cannot be written to or erased. Reads from
program memory are executed one byte at a time.
PIC18F8410 devices also implement the ability to read,
write to and execute code from external memory
devices using the external memory interface. In this
implementation, external memory is used as all or part
of the program memory space. The operation of the
physical interface is discussed in Section 7.0 “External
Memory Interface”.
In all devices, a value written to the program memory
space does not need to be a valid instruction.
Executing a program memory location that forms an
invalid instruction results in a NOP.
6.1
Table Reads and Table Writes
The program memory space is 16 bits wide, while the
data RAM space is 8 bits wide. Table reads and table
writes move data between these two memory spaces
through an 8-bit register (TABLAT).
Table read operations retrieve data from program
memory and places it into the data RAM space. Table
write operations place data from the data memory
space on the external data bus. The actual process of
writing the data to the particular memory device is
determined by the requirements of the device itself.
Figure 6-1 shows the table operations as they relate to
program memory and data RAM.
Table operations work with byte entities. A table block
containing data, rather than program instructions, is not
required to be word-aligned. Therefore, a table block
can start and end at any byte address. If a table write is
being used to write executable code into an external
program memory, program instructions will need to be
word-aligned.
Note:
To read and write to the program memory space, there
are two operations that allow the processor to move
bytes between the program memory space and the
data RAM: table read (TBLRD) and table write (TBLWT).
FIGURE 6-1:
Although it cannot be used in PIC18F6310
devices in normal operation, the TBLWT
instruction is still implemented in the
instruction set. Executing the instruction
takes two instruction cycles, but effectively
results in a NOP.
The TBLWT instruction is available in
programming modes and is used during
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP).
TABLE READ AND TABLE WRITE OPERATIONS
Instruction: TBLRD*
Program Memory Space
Table Pointer(1)
TBLPTRU TBLPTRH TBLPTRL
Data Memory Space
Table Latch (8-bit)
TABLAT
Instruction: TBLWT*
Program Memory Space
Pointer(1)
Table
TBLPTRU TBLPTRH TBLPTRL
Data Memory Space
Table Latch (8-bit)(2)
TABLAT
Note 1:
2:
Table Pointer register points to a byte in the program memory space.
Data is actually written to the memory location by the memory write algorithm. See Section 6.4
“Writing to Program Memory Space (PIC18F8310/8410 only)” for more information.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 85
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
6.2
TABLE 6-1:
Control Registers
Two control registers are used in conjunction with the
TBLRD and TBLWT instructions: the TABLAT register
and the TBLPTR register set.
6.2.1
Example
6.2.2
TBLPTR – TABLE POINTER
REGISTER
The Table Pointer register (TBLPTR) addresses a byte
within the program memory. It is comprised of three
SFR registers: Table Pointer Upper Byte, Table Pointer
High Byte and Table Pointer Low Byte
(TBLPTRU:TBLPTRH:TBLPTRL). Only the lower six bits
of TBLPTRU are used with TBLPTRH and TBLPTRL to
form a 22-bit wide pointer.
The contents of TBLPTR indicate a location in program
memory space. The low-order 21 bits allow the device
to address the full 2 Mbytes of program memory space.
The 22nd bit allows access to the configuration space,
including the device ID, user ID locations and the
configuration bits.
The TBLPTR register set is updated when executing a
TBLRD or TBLWT operation in one of four ways, based
on the instruction’s arguments. These are detailed in
Table 6-1. These operations on the TBLPTR only affect
the low-order 21 bits.
Operation on Table Pointer
TBLRD*
TBLWT*
TBLPTR is not modified
TBLRD*+
TBLWT*+
TBLPTR is incremented after the
read/write
TBLRD*TBLWT*-
TBLPTR is decremented after the
read/write
TBLRD+*
TBLWT+*
TBLPTR is incremented before the
read/write
TABLAT – TABLE LATCH REGISTER
The Table Latch (TABLAT) is an 8-bit register mapped
into the SFR space. The Table Latch register is used to
hold 8-bit data during data transfers between the
program memory space and data RAM.
TABLE POINTER
OPERATIONS WITH TBLRD
AND TBLWT INSTRUCTIONS
6.3
Reading the Flash Program
Memory
The TBLRD instruction is used to retrieve data from the
program memory space and places it into data RAM.
Table reads from program memory are performed one
byte at a time.
TBLPTR points to a byte address in program space.
Executing TBLRD places the byte pointed to into
TABLAT.
The internal program memory is typically organized by
words. The Least Significant bit of the address selects
between the high and low bytes of the word. Figure 6-2
shows the interface between the internal program
memory and the TABLAT.
A typical method for reading data from program memory
is shown in Example 6-1.
When a TBLRD or TBLWT is executed, all 22 bits of the
TBLPTR determine which address in the program
memory space is to be read or written to.
FIGURE 6-2:
READS FROM PROGRAM MEMORY
Program Memory Space
(Even Byte Address)
(Odd Byte Address)
TBLPTR = xxxxx1
Instruction Register
(IR)
DS39635A-page 86
FETCH
TBLRD
Preliminary
TBLPTR = xxxxx0
TABLAT
Read Register
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
EXAMPLE 6-1:
READING A FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY WORD
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
; Load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the word
READ_WORD
TBLRD*+
MOVF
MOVWF
TBLRD*+
MOVFW
MOVF
6.4
; read into TABLAT and increment
; get data
TABLAT, W
WORD_EVEN
; read into TABLAT and increment
; get data
TABLAT, W
WORD_ODD
Writing to Program Memory Space
(PIC18F8310/8410 only)
The table write operation outputs the contents of the
TBLPTR and TABLAT registers to the external address
and data busses of the external memory interface.
Depending on the program memory mode selected, the
operation may target any byte address in the device’s
memory space. What happens to this data depends
largely on the external memory device being used.
For PIC18 devices with Enhanced Flash memory, a
single algorithm is used for writing to the on-chip
program array. In the case of external devices, however,
the algorithm is determined by the type of memory
device and its requirements. In some cases, a specific
instruction sequence must be sent before data can be
written or erased. Address and data demultiplexing,
chip select operation and write time requirements must
all be considered in creating the appropriate code.
The connection of the data and address busses to the
memory device are dictated by the interface being
used, the data bus width and the target device. When
using a 16-bit data path, the algorithm must take into
account the width of the target memory.
memory interface, refer to Microchip application note
AN869, “External Memory Interfacing Techniques for
the PIC18F8XXX” (DS00869).
6.4.1
WRITE VERIFY
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the
memory should be verified against the original value.
This should be used in applications where excessive
writes can stress bits near the specification limit.
6.4.2
UNEXPECTED TERMINATION OF
WRITE OPERATION
If a write is terminated by an unplanned event, such as
loss of power or an unexpected Reset, the memory
location just programmed should be verified and reprogrammed if needed. If the application writes to external
memory on a frequent basis, it may be necessary to
implement an error trapping routine to handle these
unplanned events.
6.5
Erasing External Memory
(PIC18F8310/8410 only)
Another important consideration is the write time
requirement of the target device. If this is longer than
the time that a TBLWT operation makes data available
on the interface, the algorithm must be adjusted to
lengthen this time. It may be possible, for example, to
buy enough time by increasing the length of the wait
state on table operations.
Erasure is implemented in different ways on different
devices. In many cases, it is possible to erase all or part
of the memory by issuing a specific command. In some
devices, it may be necessary to write ‘0’s to the locations
to be erased. For specific information, consult the
external memory device’s data sheet for clarification.
In all cases, it is important to remember that instructions in the program memory space are word-aligned,
with the Least Significant bit always being written to an
even-numbered address (LSb = 0). If data is being
stored in the program memory space, word alignment
of the data is not required.
6.6
A complete overview of interface algorithms is beyond
the scope of this data sheet. The best place for timing
and instruction sequence requirements is the data
sheet of the memory device in question. For additional
information on algorithm design for the external
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Writing and Erasing On-Chip
Program Memory (ICSP Mode)
While the on-chip program memory is read-only in
normal operating mode, it can be written to and erased
as a function of In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP). In
this mode, the TBLWT operation is used in all devices to
write to blocks of 64 bytes (32 words) at one time. Write
blocks are boundary-aligned with the code protection
blocks. Special commands are used to erase one or
more code blocks of the program memory, or the entire
device.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 87
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
The TBLWT operation on write blocks is somewhat
different than the word write operations for
PIC18F8310/8410 devices described here. A more
complete description of block write operations is
provided in the Microchip document “Programming
Specifications for PIC18FX410/X490 Flash MCUs”
(DS39624).
TABLE 6-2:
Name
Flash Program Operation During
Code Protection
See Section 23.5 “Program Verification and Code
Protection” for details on code protection of Flash
program memory.
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
—
—
bit 21
TBLPTRU
TBLPTRH
6.7
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Program Memory Table Pointer Upper Byte
(TBLPTR<20:16>)
Reset
Values on
Page
57
Program Memory Table Pointer High Byte (TBLPTR<15:8>)
57
TBLPTRL
Program Memory Table Pointer Low Byte (TBLPTR<7:0>)
57
TABLAT
Program Memory Table Latch
57
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used during Flash/EEPROM access.
DS39635A-page 88
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
7.0
Note:
EXTERNAL MEMORY
INTERFACE
The external memory interface is not
implemented on PIC18F6310 and
PIC18F6410 (64-pin) devices.
The external memory interface allows the device to
access external memory devices (such as Flash,
EPROM, SRAM, etc.) as program or data memory. It is
implemented with 28 pins, multiplexed across four I/O
ports. Three ports (PORTD, PORTE and PORTH) are
multiplexed with the address/data bus for a total of 20
available lines, while PORTJ is multiplexed with the
bus control signals. A list of the pins and their functions
is provided in Table 7-1.
REGISTER 7-1:
As implemented here, the interface is similar to that
introduced on PIC18F8X20 microcontrollers. The most
notable difference is that the interface on
PIC18F8310/8410 devices supports both 16-bit and
Multiplexed 8-bit Data Width modes; it does not support
the 8-bit Demultiplexed mode. The bus width mode is
set by the BW configuration bit when the device is
programmed and cannot be changed in software.
The operation of the interface is controlled by the
MEMCON register (Register 7-1). Clearing the EBDIS
bit (MEMCON<7>) enables the interface and disables
the I/O functions of the ports, as well as any other multiplexed functions. Setting the bit disables the interface
and enables the ports.
For a more complete discussion of the operating
modes that use the external memory interface, refer to
Section 7.1 “Program Memory Modes and the
External Memory Interface”.
MEMCON: MEMORY CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
EBDIS
—
WAIT1
WAIT0
—
—
WM1
WM0
bit7
bit0
bit 7
EBDIS: External Bus Disable bit
1 = External system bus disabled, all external bus drivers are mapped as I/O ports
0 = External system bus enabled, I/O ports are disabled
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
WAIT1:WAIT0: Table Reads and Writes Bus Cycle Wait Count bits
11 = Table reads and writes will wait 0 TCY
10 = Table reads and writes will wait 1 TCY
01 = Table reads and writes will wait 2 TCY
00 = Table reads and writes will wait 3 TCY
bit 3-2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1-0
WM1:WM0: TBLWRT Operation with 16-bit Bus Width bits
1x = Word Write mode: TABLAT0 and TABLAT1 word output, WRH active when TABLAT1
is written
01 = Byte Select mode: TABLAT data copied on both MSB and LSB, WRH and (UB or LB)
will activate
00 = Byte Write mode: TABLAT data copied on both MSB and LSB, WRH or WRL will activate
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 89
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 7-1:
Name
PIC18F8310/8410 EXTERNAL BUS – I/O PORT FUNCTIONS
Port
Bit
Function
RD0/AD0/PSP0
PORTD
0
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 0 or Data bit 0 or Parallel Slave Port bit 0
RD1/AD1/PSP1
PORTD
1
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 1 or Data bit 1 or Parallel Slave Port bit 1
RD2/AD2/PSP2
PORTD
2
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 2 or Data bit 2 or Parallel Slave Port bit 2
RD3/AD3/PSP3
PORTD
3
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 3 or Data bit 3 or Parallel Slave Port bit 3
RD4/AD4/PSP4
PORTD
4
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 4 or Data bit 4 or Parallel Slave Port bit 4
RD5/AD5/PSP5
PORTD
5
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 5 or Data bit 5 or Parallel Slave Port bit 5
RD6/AD6/PSP6
PORTD
6
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 6 or Data bit 6 or Parallel Slave Port bit 6
RD7/AD7/PSP7
PORTD
7
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 7 or Data bit 7 or Parallel Slave Port bit 7
RE0/AD8/RD
PORTE
0
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 8 or Data bit 8 or Parallel Slave Port Read Control pin
RE1/AD9/WR
PORTE
1
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 9 or Data bit 9 or Parallel Slave Port Write Control pin
RE2/AD10/CS
PORTE
2
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 10 or Data bit 10 or Parallel Slave Port Chip Select pin
RE3/AD11
PORTE
3
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 11 or Data bit 11
RE4/AD12
PORTE
4
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 12 or Data bit 12
RE5/AD13
PORTE
5
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 13 or Data bit 13
RE6/AD14
PORTE
6
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 14 or Data bit 14
RE7/CCP2(1)/AD15
PORTE
7
Input/Output or Capture 2 Input/Compare 2 Output/PWM 2 Output pin or System Bus
Address bit 15 or Data bit 15
RH0/AD16
PORTH
0
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 16
RH1/AD17
PORTH
1
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 17
RH2/AD18
PORTH
2
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 18
RH3/AD19
PORTH
3
Input/Output or System Bus Address bit 19
RJ0/ALE
PORTJ
0
Input/Output or System Bus Address Latch Enable (ALE) Control pin
RJ1/OE
PORTJ
1
Input/Output or System Bus Output Enable (OE) Control pin
RJ2/WRL
PORTJ
2
Input/Output or System Bus Write Low (WRL) Control pin
RJ3/WRH
PORTJ
3
Input/Output or System Bus Write High (WRH) Control pin
RJ4/BA0
PORTJ
4
Input/Output or System Bus Byte Address bit 0
RJ5/CE
PORTJ
5
Input/Output or System Bus Chip Enable (CE) Control pin
RJ6/LB
PORTJ
6
Input/Output or System Bus Lower Byte Enable (LB) Control pin
PORTJ
7
Input/Output or System Bus Upper Byte Enable (UB) Control pin
RJ7/UB
Note 1:
7.1
Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX configuration bit is cleared (all devices in Microcontroller mode).
Program Memory Modes and the
External Memory Interface
As previously noted, PIC18F8310/8410 devices are
capable of operating in any one of four program memory modes, using combinations of on-chip and external
program memory. The functions of the multiplexed port
pins depends on the program memory mode selected,
as well as the setting of the EBDIS bit.
In Microcontroller mode, the bus is not active and the
pins have their port functions only. Writes to the
MEMCOM register are not permitted.
In Microprocessor mode, the external bus is always
active and the port pins have only the external bus
function.
In Microprocessor with Boot Block or Extended
Microcontroller mode, the external program memory
bus shares I/O port functions on the pins. When the
device is fetching or doing table read/table write
DS39635A-page 90
operations on the external program memory space, the
pins will have the external bus function. If the device is
fetching and accessing internal program memory
locations only, the EBDIS control bit will change the
pins from external memory to I/O port functions. When
EBDIS = 0, the pins function as the external bus. When
EBDIS = 1, the pins function as I/O ports.
If the device fetches or accesses external memory while
EBDIS = 1, the pins will switch to external bus. If the
EBDIS bit is set by a program executing from external
memory, the action of setting the bit will be delayed until
the program branches into the internal memory. At that
time, the pins will change from external bus to I/O ports.
When the device is executing out of internal memory
(EBDIS = 0) in Microprocessor with Boot Block mode or
Extended Microcontroller mode, the control signals will
NOT be active. They will go to a state where the
AD<15:0> and A<19:16> are tri-state; the CE, OE, WRH,
WRL, UB and LB signals are ‘1’; ALE and BA0 are ‘0’.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
7.2
16-Bit Mode
In 16-bit mode, the external memory interface can be
connected to external memories in three different
configurations:
• 16-bit Byte Write
• 16-bit Word Write
• 16-bit Byte Select
The configuration to be used is determined by the
WM1:WM0 bits
in the MEMCON register
(MEMCON<1:0>). These three different configurations
allow the designer maximum flexibility in using both
8-bit and 16-bit devices with 16-bit data.
For all 16-bit modes, the Address Latch Enable (ALE)
pin indicates that the address bits, A<15:0>, are available on the external memory interface bus. Following the
address latch, the Output Enable signal (OE) will enable
both bytes of program memory at once to form a 16-bit
instruction word. The Chip Enable signal (CE) is active
FIGURE 7-1:
at any time that the microcontroller accesses external
memory, whether reading or writing; it is inactive
(asserted high) whenever the device is in Sleep mode.
In Byte Select mode, JEDEC standard Flash memories
will require BA0 for the byte address line and one I/O line
to select between Byte and Word mode. The other 16-bit
modes do not need BA0. JEDEC standard static RAM
memories will use the UB or LB signals for byte selection.
7.2.1
16-BIT BYTE WRITE MODE
Figure 7-1 shows an example of 16-bit Byte Write
mode for PIC18F8310/8410 devices. This mode is
used for two separate 8-bit memories connected for
16-bit operation. This generally includes basic EPROM
and Flash devices. It allows table writes to byte-wide
external memories.
During a TBLWT instruction cycle, the TABLAT data is
presented on the upper and lower bytes of the
AD15:AD0 bus. The appropriate WRH or WRL control
line is strobed on the LSb of the TBLPTR.
16-BIT BYTE WRITE MODE EXAMPLE
D<7:0>
PIC18F8410
(MSB)
AD<7:0>
373
A<19:0>
D<15:8>
AD<15:8>
373
(LSB)
A<x:0>
A<x:0>
D<7:0>
D<7:0>
D<7:0>
CE
CE
OE
WR(1)
OE
WR(1)
ALE
A<19:16>
CE
OE
WRH
WRL
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1: This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 6.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 91
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
7.2.2
16-BIT WORD WRITE MODE
Figure 7-2 shows an example of 16-bit Word Write
mode for PIC18F6410 devices. This mode is used for
word-wide memories, which includes some of the
EPROM and Flash type memories. This mode allows
opcode fetches and table reads from all forms of 16-bit
memory and table writes to any type of word-wide
external memories. This method makes a distinction
between TBLWT cycles to even or odd addresses.
During a TBLWT cycle to an even address
(TBLPTR<0> = 0), the TABLAT data is transferred to a
holding latch and the external address data bus is
tri-stated for the data portion of the bus cycle. No write
signals are activated.
FIGURE 7-2:
During a TBLWT cycle to an odd address
(TBLPTR<0> = 1), the TABLAT data is presented on
the upper byte of the AD15:AD0 bus. The contents of
the holding latch are presented on the lower byte of the
AD15:AD0 bus.
The WRH signal is strobed for each write cycle; the
WRL pin is unused. The signal on the BA0 pin indicates
the LSb of TBLPTR, but it is left unconnected. Instead,
the UB and LB signals are active to select both bytes.
The obvious limitation to this method is that the table
write must be done in pairs on a specific word boundary
to correctly write a word location.
16-BIT WORD WRITE MODE EXAMPLE
PIC18F8410
AD<7:0>
373
A<20:1>
D<15:0>
A<x:0>
D<15:0>
CE
AD<15:8>
JEDEC Word
EPROM Memory
OE
WR(1)
373
ALE
A<19:16>
CE
OE
WRH
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1:
DS39635A-page 92
This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 6.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
7.2.3
16-BIT BYTE SELECT MODE
Figure 7-3 shows an example of 16-bit Byte Select
mode. This mode allows table write operations to
word-wide external memories with byte selection
capability. This generally includes both word-wide
Flash and SRAM devices.
During a TBLWT cycle, the TABLAT data is presented
on the upper and lower byte of the AD15:AD0 bus. The
WRH signal is strobed for each write cycle; the WRL
pin is not used. The BA0 or UB/LB signals are used to
select the byte to be written, based on the Least
Significant bit of the TBLPTR register.
FIGURE 7-3:
Flash and SRAM devices use different control signal
combinations to implement Byte Select mode. JEDEC
standard Flash memories require that a controller I/O
port pin be connected to the memory’s BYTE/WORD
pin to provide the select signal. They also use the BA0
signal from the controller as a byte address. JEDEC
standard static RAM memories, on the other hand, use
the UB or LB signals to select the byte.
16-BIT BYTE SELECT MODE EXAMPLE
PIC18F8410
AD<7:0>
373
A<20:1>
A<x:1>
JEDEC Word
FLASH Memory
D<15:0>
D<15:0>
138(2)
AD<15:8>
373
ALE
CE
A0
BYTE/WORD
OE WR(1)
A<19:16>
OE
WRH
WRL
A<20:1>
A<x:1>
BA0
JEDEC Word
SRAM Memory
I/O
D<15:0>
D<15:0>
CE
LB
LB
UB
UB
OE
WR(1)
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1:
2:
This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 6.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
Demultiplexing is only required when multiple memory devices are accessed.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 93
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
7.2.4
16-BIT MODE TIMING
The presentation of control signals on the external
memory bus is different for the various operating
modes. Typical signal timing diagrams are shown in
Figure 7-4 through Figure 7-6.
FIGURE 7-4:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR TBLRD (MICROPROCESSOR MODE)
Apparent Q
Actual Q
Q1
Q1
Q2
Q2
Q3
Q3
Q4
Q4
Q1
Q1
Q2
Q2
Q3
Q3
Q4
Q4
00h
A<19:16>
3AABh
AD<15:0>
Q4
Q1
Q4
Q2
Q4
Q3
Q4
Q4
0Ch
0E55h
9256h
CF33h
BA0
ALE
OE
WRH
‘1’
‘1’
WRL
‘1’
‘1’
CE
‘0’
‘0’
1 TCY Wait
Memory
Cycle
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 007556h
Table Read
of 92h
from 199E67h
Instruction
Execution
TBLRD Cycle 1
TBLRD Cycle 2
FIGURE 7-5:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR TBLRD (EXTENDED
MICROCONTROLLER MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
0Ch
A<19:16>
CF33h
AD<15:0>
9256h
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Opcode Fetch
TBLRD *
from 000100h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 000102h
TBLRD 92h
from 199E67h
Opcode Fetch
ADDLW 55h
from 000104h
Instruction
Execution
INST(PC – 2)
TBLRD Cycle 1
TBLRD Cycle 2
MOVLW
DS39635A-page 94
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 7-6:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR SLEEP (MICROPROCESSOR MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q4
Q1
Q2
3AAAh
Q3
Q4
Q1
00h
00h
A<19:16>
AD<15:0>
Q3
0003h
3AABh
0E55h
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Instruction
Execution
Opcode Fetch
SLEEP
from 007554h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 007556h
INST(PC – 2)
SLEEP
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
Sleep Mode, Bus Inactive
DS39635A-page 95
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
7.3
8-Bit Mode
The Address Latch Enable (ALE) pin indicates that the
address bits A<15:0> are available on the external
memory interface bus. The Output Enable signal (OE)
will enable one byte of program memory for a portion of
the instruction cycle, then BA0 will change and the
second byte will be enabled to form the 16-bit instruction word. The Least Significant bit of the address, BA0,
must be connected to the memory devices in this
mode. The Chip Enable signal (CE) is active at any
time that the microcontroller accesses external
memory, whether reading or writing; it is inactive
(asserted high) whenever the device is in Sleep mode.
The external memory interface implemented in
PIC18F6410 devices operates only in Multiplexed 8-bit
mode; data shares the 8 Least Significant bits of the
address bus.
Figure 7-1 shows an example of 8-bit Multiplexed
mode for PIC18F8310/8410 devices. This mode is
used for a single 8-bit memory connected for 16-bit
operation. The instructions will be fetched as two 8-bit
bytes on a shared data/address bus. The two bytes are
sequentially fetched within one instruction cycle (TCY).
Therefore, the designer must choose external memory
devices according to timing calculations based on 1/2
TCY (2 times the instruction rate). For proper memory
speed selection, glue logic propagation delay times
must be considered along with setup and hold times.
FIGURE 7-7:
This generally includes basic EPROM and Flash devices.
It allows table writes to byte-wide external memories.
During a TBLWT instruction cycle, the TABLAT data is
presented on the upper and lower bytes of the
AD15:AD0 bus. The appropriate level of the BA0
control line is strobed on the LSb of the TBLPTR.
8-BIT MULTIPLEXED MODE EXAMPLE
D<7:0>
PIC18F8410
AD<7:0>
373
ALE
A<19:0>
A<x:1>
A0
D<15:8>
D<7:0>
AD<15:8>
CE
A<19:16>
OE
WR(1)
BA0
CE
OE
WRL
Address Bus
Data Bus
Control Lines
Note 1:
DS39635A-page 96
This signal only applies to table writes. See Section 6.1 “Table Reads and Table Writes”.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
7.3.1
8-BIT MODE TIMING
The presentation of control signals on the external
memory bus is different for the various operating
modes. Typical signal timing diagrams are shown in
Figure 7-4 through Figure 7-6.
FIGURE 7-8:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR TBLRD (MICROPROCESSOR MODE)
Apparent Q
Actual Q
Q1
Q1
Q2
Q2
Q3
Q3
Q4
Q4
Q1
Q1
Q2
Q2
Q3
Q3
Q4
Q4
Q4
Q1
A<19:16>
00h
0Ch
AD<15:8>
3Ah
CFh
ABh
AD<7:0>
0Eh
55h
Q4
Q2
Q4
Q3
Q4
Q4
92h
33h
BA0
ALE
OE
WRL ‘1’
‘1’
CE ‘0’
‘0’
1 TCY Wait
Memory
Cycle
Instruction
Execution
FIGURE 7-9:
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 007556h
Table Read
of 92h
from 199E67h
TBLRD Cycle 1
TBLRD Cycle 2
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR TBLRD (EXTENDED
MICROCONTROLLER MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
A<19:16>
0Ch
AD<15:8>
CFh
33h
AD<7:0>
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
92h
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Opcode Fetch
TBLRD *
from 000100h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 000102h
TBLRD 92h
from 199E67h
Opcode Fetch
ADDLW 55h
from 000104h
Instruction
Execution
INST(PC – 2)
TBLRD Cycle 1
TBLRD Cycle 2
MOVLW
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 97
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 7-10:
EXTERNAL MEMORY BUS TIMING FOR SLEEP (MICROPROCESSOR MODE)
Q1
Q2
Q4
Q1
Q2
AD<15:8>
00h
Q4
Q1
3Ah
3Ah
AAh
Q3
00h
00h
A<19:16>
AD<7:0>
Q3
03h
ABh
0Eh
55h
CE
ALE
OE
Memory
Cycle
Instruction
Execution
DS39635A-page 98
Opcode Fetch
SLEEP
from 007554h
Opcode Fetch
MOVLW 55h
from 007556h
INST(PC – 2)
SLEEP
Preliminary
Sleep Mode, Bus Inactive
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
8.0
8 x 8 HARDWARE MULTIPLIER
8.1
Introduction
EXAMPLE 8-1:
MOVF
MULWF
All PIC18 devices include an 8 x 8 hardware multiplier as
part of the ALU. The multiplier performs an unsigned
operation and yields a 16-bit result that is stored in the
product register pair PRODH:PRODL. The multiplier’s
operation does not affect any flags in the Status register.
ARG1, W
ARG2
EXAMPLE 8-2:
Making multiplication a hardware operation allows it to
be completed in a single instruction cycle. This has the
advantages of higher computational throughput and
reduced code size for multiplication algorithms and
allows the PIC18 devices to be used in many applications previously reserved for digital signal processors.
A comparison of various hardware and software
multiply operations, along with the savings in memory
and execution time, is shown in Table 8-1.
8.2
8 x 8 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
;
; ARG1 * ARG2 ->
; PRODH:PRODL
8 x 8 SIGNED MULTIPLY
ROUTINE
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1, W
ARG2
BTFSC
SUBWF
ARG2, SB
PRODH, F
MOVF
BTFSC
SUBWF
ARG2, W
ARG1, SB
PRODH, F
;
;
;
;
;
ARG1 * ARG2 ->
PRODH:PRODL
Test Sign Bit
PRODH = PRODH
- ARG1
; Test Sign Bit
; PRODH = PRODH
;
- ARG2
Operation
Example 8-1 shows the instruction sequence for an
8 x 8 unsigned multiplication. Only one instruction is
required when one of the arguments is already loaded
in the WREG register.
Example 8-2 shows the sequence to do an 8 x 8 signed
multiplication. To account for the sign bits of the
arguments, each argument’s Most Significant bit (MSb)
is tested and the appropriate subtractions are done.
TABLE 8-1:
PERFORMANCE COMPARISON FOR VARIOUS MULTIPLY OPERATIONS
Routine
8 x 8 unsigned
8 x 8 signed
16 x 16 unsigned
16 x 16 signed
Multiply Method
Without hardware multiply
Program
Memory
(Words)
Cycles
(Max)
Time
@ 40 MHz
@ 10 MHz
@ 4 MHz
13
69
6.9 µs
27.6 µs
69 µs
Hardware multiply
1
1
100 ns
400 ns
1 µs
Without hardware multiply
33
91
9.1 µs
36.4 µs
91 µs
Hardware multiply
6
6
600 ns
2.4 µs
6 µs
Without hardware multiply
21
242
24.2 µs
96.8 µs
242 µs
Hardware multiply
28
28
2.8 µs
11.2 µs
28 µs
Without hardware multiply
52
254
25.4 µs
102.6 µs
254 µs
Hardware multiply
35
40
4.0 µs
16.0 µs
40 µs
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 99
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Example 8-3 shows the sequence to do a 16 x 16
unsigned multiplication. Equation 8-1 shows the
algorithm that is used. The 32-bit result is stored in four
registers (RES3:RES0).
EQUATION 8-1:
RES3:RES0
=
=
EXAMPLE 8-3:
16 x 16 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLICATION
ALGORITHM
ARG1H:ARG1L • ARG2H:ARG2L
(ARG1H • ARG2H • 216) +
(ARG1H • ARG2L • 28) +
(ARG1L • ARG2H • 28) +
(ARG1L • ARG2L)
EQUATION 8-2:
RES3:RES0= ARG1H:ARG1L • ARG2H:ARG2L
= (ARG1H • ARG2H • 216) +
(ARG1H • ARG2L • 28) +
(ARG1L • ARG2H • 28) +
(ARG1L • ARG2L) +
(-1 • ARG2H<7> • ARG1H:ARG1L • 216) +
(-1 • ARG1H<7> • ARG2H:ARG2L • 216)
EXAMPLE 8-4:
16 x 16 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2L
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES1
PRODL, RES0
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2H
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES3
PRODL, RES2
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2H
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2L
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
; ARG1L * ARG2L->
; PRODH:PRODL
;
;
ARG1L * ARG2H->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
ARG1H * ARG2L->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES1
PRODL, RES0
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2H
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES3
PRODL, RES2
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2H
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2L
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC
CLRF
ADDWFC
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
RES2, F
WREG
RES3, F
BTFSS
BRA
MOVF
SUBWF
MOVF
SUBWFB
ARG2H, 7
SIGN_ARG1
ARG1L, W
RES2
ARG1H, W
RES3
; ARG2H:ARG2L neg?
; no, check ARG1
;
;
;
ARG1H, 7
CONT_CODE
ARG2L, W
RES2
ARG2H, W
RES3
; ARG1H:ARG1L neg?
; no, done
;
;
;
; ARG1L * ARG2L ->
; PRODH:PRODL
;
;
; ARG1H * ARG2H ->
; PRODH:PRODL
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
ARG1L * ARG2H ->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
ARG1H * ARG2L ->
PRODH:PRODL
Add cross
products
;
Example 8-4 shows the sequence to do a 16 x 16
signed multiply. Equation 8-2 shows the algorithm
used. The 32-bit result is stored in four registers
(RES3:RES0). To account for the sign bits of the
arguments, the MSb for each argument pair is tested
and the appropriate subtractions are done.
DS39635A-page 100
ARG1L, W
ARG2L
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
MOVF
MULWF
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
16 x 16 SIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
;
;
; ARG1H * ARG2H->
; PRODH:PRODL
;
;
16 x 16 SIGNED
MULTIPLICATION
ALGORITHM
;
SIGN_ARG1
BTFSS
BRA
MOVF
SUBWF
MOVF
SUBWFB
;
CONT_CODE
:
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
9.0
INTERRUPTS
The PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices have
multiple interrupt sources and an interrupt priority feature that allows most interrupt sources to be assigned
a high priority level or a low priority level. The high
priority interrupt vector is at 0008h and the low priority
interrupt vector is at 0018h. High priority interrupt
events will interrupt any low priority interrupts that may
be in progress.
There are ten registers which are used to control
interrupt operation. These registers are:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
RCON
INTCON
INTCON2
INTCON3
PIR1, PIR2, PIR3
PIE1, PIE2, PIE3
IPR1, IPR2, IPR3
It is recommended that the Microchip header files supplied with MPLAB® IDE be used for the symbolic bit
names in these registers. This allows the assembler/
compiler to automatically take care of the placement of
these bits within the specified register.
In general, interrupt sources have three bits to control
their operation. They are:
• Flag bit to indicate that an interrupt event
occurred
• Enable bit that allows program execution to
branch to the interrupt vector address when the
flag bit is set
• Priority bit to select high priority or low priority
When the IPEN bit is cleared (default state), the
interrupt priority feature is disabled and interrupts are
compatible with PICmicro® mid-range devices. In
Compatibility mode, the interrupt priority bits for each
source have no effect. INTCON<6> is the PEIE bit,
which enables/disables all peripheral interrupt sources.
INTCON<7> is the GIE bit, which enables/disables all
interrupt sources. All interrupts branch to address
0008h in Compatibility mode.
When an interrupt is responded to, the global interrupt
enable bit is cleared to disable further interrupts. If the
IPEN bit is cleared, this is the GIE bit. If interrupt priority
levels are used, this will be either the GIEH or GIEL bit.
High priority interrupt sources can interrupt a low
priority interrupt. Low priority interrupts are not
processed while high priority interrupts are in progress.
The return address is pushed onto the stack and the
PC is loaded with the interrupt vector address (0008h
or 0018h). Once in the Interrupt Service Routine, the
source(s) of the interrupt can be determined by polling
the interrupt flag bits. The interrupt flag bits must be
cleared in software before re-enabling interrupts to
avoid recursive interrupts.
The “return from interrupt” instruction, RETFIE, exits
the interrupt routine and sets the GIE bit (GIEH or GIEL
if priority levels are used), which re-enables interrupts.
For external interrupt events, such as the INT pins or
the PORTB input change interrupt, the interrupt latency
will be three to four instruction cycles. The exact
latency is the same for one or two-cycle instructions.
Individual interrupt flag bits are set, regardless of the
status of their corresponding enable bit or the GIE bit.
Note:
The interrupt priority feature is enabled by setting the
IPEN bit (RCON<7>). When interrupt priority is
enabled, there are two bits which enable interrupts
globally. Setting the GIEH bit (INTCON<7>) enables all
interrupts that have the priority bit set (high priority).
Setting the GIEL bit (INTCON<6>) enables all
interrupts that have the priority bit cleared (low priority).
When the interrupt flag, enable bit and appropriate
global interrupt enable bit are set, the interrupt will
vector immediately to address 0008h or 0018h,
depending on the priority bit setting. Individual
interrupts can be disabled through their corresponding
enable bits.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
Do not use the MOVFF instruction to modify
any of the interrupt control registers while
any interrupt is enabled. Doing so may
cause erratic microcontroller behavior.
DS39635A-page 101
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 9-1:
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 INTERRUPT LOGIC
Wake-up if in
Idle or Sleep modes
TMR0IF
TMR0IE
TMR0IP
RBIF
RBIE
RBIP
INT0IF
INT0IE
INT1IF
INT1IE
INT1IP
INT2IF
INT2IE
INT2IP
INT3IF
INT3IE
INT3IP
PIR1<7:0>
PIE1<7:0>
IPR1<7:0>
PIR2<7:6, 3:0>
PIE2<7:6, 3:0>
IPR2<7:6, 3:0>
Interrupt to CPU
Vector to Location
0008h
GIEH/GIE
IPE
PIR3<5:4, 0>
PIE3<5:4, 0>
IPR3<5:4, 0>
IPEN
GIEL/PEIE
IPEN
High Priority Interrupt Generation
Low Priority Interrupt Generation
PIR1<7:0>
PIE1<7:0>
IPR1<7:0>
PIR2<7:6, 3:0>
PIE2<7:6, 3:0>
IPR2<7:6, 3:0>
PIR3<5:4, 0>
PIE3<5:4, 0>
IPR3<5:4, 0>
TMR0IF
TMR0IE
TMR0IP
RBIF
RBIE
RBIP
Interrupt to CPU
Vector to Location
0018h
IPEN
GIEH/GIE
GIEL/PEIE
INT1IF
INT1IE
INT1IP
INT2IF
INT2IE
INT2IP
INT3IF
INT3IE
INT3IP
DS39635A-page 102
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
9.1
INTCON Registers
Note:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the global
interrupt enable bit. User software should
ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt.
This feature allows for software polling.
The INTCON registers are readable and writable
registers which contain various enable, priority and flag
bits.
REGISTER 9-1:
INTCON: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-x
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
GIE/GIEH: Global Interrupt Enable bit
When IPEN = 0:
1 = Enables all unmasked interrupts
0 = Disables all interrupts
When IPEN = 1:
1 = Enables all high priority interrupts
0 = Disables all interrupts
bit 6
PEIE/GIEL: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
When IPEN = 0:
1 = Enables all unmasked peripheral interrupts
0 = Disables all peripheral interrupts
When IPEN = 1:
1 = Enables all low priority peripheral interrupts
0 = Disables all low priority peripheral interrupts
bit 5
TMR0IE: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR0 overflow interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR0 overflow interrupt
bit 4
INT0IE: INT0 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT0 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT0 external interrupt
bit 3
RBIE: RB Port Change Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the RB port change interrupt
0 = Disables the RB port change interrupt
bit 2
TMR0IF: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR0 register did not overflow
bit 1
INT0IF: INT0 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT0 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT0 external interrupt did not occur
bit 0
RBIF: RB Port Change Interrupt Flag bit
1 = At least one of the RB7:RB4 pins changed state (must be cleared in software)
0 = None of the RB7:RB4 pins have changed state
Note:
A mismatch condition will continue to set this bit. Reading PORTB will end the
mismatch condition and allow the bit to be cleared.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 103
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-2:
INTCON2: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
RBPU
INTEDG0
INTEDG1
INTEDG2
INTEDG3
TMR0IP
INT3IP
RBIP
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
RBPU: PORTB Pull-up Enable bit
1 = All PORTB pull-ups are disabled
0 = PORTB pull-ups are enabled by individual port latch values
bit 6
INTEDG0: External Interrupt 0 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 5
INTEDG1: External Interrupt 1 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 4
INTEDG2: External Interrupt 2 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 3
INTEDG3: External Interrupt 3 Edge Select bit
1 = Interrupt on rising edge
0 = Interrupt on falling edge
bit 2
TMR0IP: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
INT3IP: INT3 External Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
RBIP: RB Port Change Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Note:
DS39635A-page 104
x = Bit is unknown
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state
of its corresponding enable bit or the global interrupt enable bit. User software should
ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. This
feature allows for software polling.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-3:
INTCON3: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 3
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
INT2IP
INT1IP
INT3IE
INT2IE
INT1IE
INT3IF
INT2IF
INT1IF
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
INT2IP: INT2 External Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
INT1IP: INT1 External Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
INT3IE: INT3 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT3 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT3 external interrupt
bit 4
INT2IE: INT2 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT2 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT2 external interrupt
bit 3
INT1IE: INT1 External Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the INT1 external interrupt
0 = Disables the INT1 external interrupt
bit 2
INT3IF: INT3 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT3 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT3 external interrupt did not occur
bit 1
INT2IF: INT2 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT2 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT2 external interrupt did not occur
bit 0
INT1IF: INT1 External Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The INT1 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The INT1 external interrupt did not occur
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Note:
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
x = Bit is unknown
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state
of its corresponding enable bit or the global interrupt enable bit. User software
should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits are clear prior to enabling an
interrupt. This feature allows for software polling.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 105
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
9.2
PIR Registers
Note 1: Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state
of its corresponding enable bit or the
Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE
(INTCON<7>).
The PIR registers contain the individual flag bits for the
peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of peripheral
interrupt sources, there are three Peripheral Interrupt
Request (Flag) registers (PIR1, PIR2, PIR3).
2: User software should ensure the
appropriate interrupt flag bits are cleared
prior to enabling an interrupt and after
servicing that interrupt.
REGISTER 9-4:
PIR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
PSPIF: Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A read or a write operation has taken place (must be cleared in software)
0 = No read or write has occurred
bit 6
ADIF: A/D Converter Interrupt Flag bit
1 = An A/D conversion completed (must be cleared in software)
0 = The A/D conversion is not complete
bit 5
RC1IF: EUSART Receive Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART receive buffer, RCREG, is full (cleared when RCREG is read)
0 = The EUSART receive buffer is empty
bit 4
TX1IF: EUSART Transmit Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The EUSART transmit buffer, TXREG, is empty (cleared when TXREG is written)
0 = The EUSART transmit buffer is full
bit 3
SSPIF: Master Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The transmission/reception is complete (must be cleared in software)
0 = Waiting to transmit/receive
bit 2
CCP1IF: CCP1 Interrupt Flag bit
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 1
TMR2IF: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR2 to PR2 match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR2 to PR2 match occurred
bit 0
TMR1IF: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR1 register overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR1 register did not overflow
Legend:
DS39635A-page 106
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-5:
PIR2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
OSCFIF
CMIF
—
—
BCLIF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
CCP2IF
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
OSCFIF: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Device oscillator failed, clock input has changed to INTOSC (must be cleared in software)
0 = Device clock operating
bit 6
CMIF: Comparator Interrupt Flag bit
1 = Comparator input has changed (must be cleared in software)
0 = Comparator input has not changed
bit 5-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
BCLIF: Bus Collision Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A bus collision occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No bus collision occurred
bit 2
HLVDIF: High/Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Flag bit
1 = A low-voltage condition occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = The device voltage is above the Low-Voltage Detect trip point
bit 1
TMR3IF: TMR3 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1 = TMR3 register overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0 = TMR3 register did not overflow
bit 0
CCP2IF: CCP2 Interrupt Flag bit
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Unused in this mode.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 107
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-6:
PIR3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 3
U-0
U-0
R-0
R-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
RC2IF: AUSART Receive Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The AUSART receive buffer, RCREG, is full (cleared when RCREG is read)
0 = The AUSART receive buffer is empty
bit 4
TX2IF: AUSART Transmit Interrupt Flag bit
1 = The AUSART transmit buffer, TXREG, is empty (cleared when TXREG is written)
0 = The AUSART transmit buffer is full
bit 3-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
CCP3IF: CCP3 Interrupt Flag bit
Capture mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register capture occurred
Compare mode:
1 = A TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred (must be cleared in software)
0 = No TMR1/TMR3 register compare match occurred
PWM mode:
Unused in this mode.
Legend:
DS39635A-page 108
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
9.3
PIE Registers
The PIE registers contain the individual enable bits for
the peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of
peripheral interrupt sources, there are three Peripheral
Interrupt Enable registers (PIE1, PIE2, PIE3). When
IPEN = 0, the PEIE bit must be set to enable any of
these peripheral interrupts.
REGISTER 9-7:
PIE1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
PSPIE: Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the PSP read/write interrupt
0 = Disables the PSP read/write interrupt
bit 6
ADIE: A/D Converter Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the A/D interrupt
0 = Disables the A/D interrupt
bit 5
RC1IE: EUSART Receive Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the EUSART receive interrupt
0 = Disables the EUSART receive interrupt
bit 4
TX1IE: EUSART Transmit Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the EUSART transmit interrupt
0 = Disables the EUSART transmit interrupt
bit 3
SSPIE: Master Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the MSSP interrupt
0 = Disables the MSSP interrupt
bit 2
CCP1IE: CCP1 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the CCP1 interrupt
0 = Disables the CCP1 interrupt
bit 1
TMR2IE: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR2 to PR2 match interrupt
bit 0
TMR1IE: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
0 = Disables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 109
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-8:
PIE2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 2
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
OSCFIE
CMIE
—
—
BCLIE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
CCP2IE
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
OSCFIE: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 6
CMIE: Comparator Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 5-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
BCLIE: Bus Collision Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 2
HLVDIE: High/Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 1
TMR3IE: TMR3 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 0
CCP2IE: CCP2 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
Legend:
DS39635A-page 110
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-9:
PIE3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 3
U-0
U-0
R-0
R-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
RC2IE: AUSART Receive Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 4
TX2IE: AUSART Transmit Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
bit 3-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
CCP3IE: CCP3 Interrupt Enable bit
1 = Enabled
0 = Disabled
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 111
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
9.4
IPR Registers
The IPR registers contain the individual priority bits for
the peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of
peripheral interrupt sources, there are three Peripheral
Interrupt Priority registers (IPR1, IPR2, IPR3). Using
the priority bits requires that the Interrupt Priority
Enable (IPEN) bit be set.
REGISTER 9-10:
IPR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
PSPIP: Parallel Slave Port Read/Write Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
ADIP: A/D Converter Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5
RC1IP: EUSART Receive Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
TX1IP: EUSART Transmit Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3
SSPIP: Master Synchronous Serial Port Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 2
CCP1IP: CCP1 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
TMR2IP: TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
TMR1IP: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
Legend:
DS39635A-page 112
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-11:
IPR2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 2
R/W-1
R/W-1
U-0
U-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
OSCFIP
CMIP
—
—
BCLIP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
CCP2IP
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
OSCFIP: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 6
CMIP: Comparator Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 5-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3
BCLIP: Bus Collision Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 2
HLVDIP: High/Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 1
TMR3IP: TMR3 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 0
CCP2IP: CCP2 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 113
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 9-12:
IPR3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 3
U-0
U-0
R-0
R-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-1
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
RC2IP: AUSART Receive Priority Flag bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 4
TX2IP: AUSART Transmit Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
bit 3-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
CCP3IP: CCP3 Interrupt Priority bit
1 = High priority
0 = Low priority
Legend:
DS39635A-page 114
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
9.5
RCON Register
The RCON register contains bits used to determine the
cause of the last Reset or wake-up from Idle or Sleep
modes. RCON also contains the bit that enables
interrupt priorities (IPEN).
REGISTER 9-13:
RCON REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-1
U-0
R/W-1
R-1
R-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
IPEN
SBOREN
—
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
IPEN: Interrupt Priority Enable bit
1 = Enable priority levels on interrupts
0 = Disable priority levels on interrupts (PIC16CXXX Compatibility mode)
bit 6
SBOREN: Software BOR Enable bit
For details of bit operation and Reset state, see Register 4-1.
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
RI: RESET Instruction Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
bit 3
TO: Watchdog Timer Time-out Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
bit 2
PD: Power-Down Detection Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
bit 1
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
bit 0
BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 115
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
9.6
INTn Pin Interrupts
9.7
TMR0 Interrupt
External interrupts on the RB0/INT0, RB1/INT1, RB2/
INT2 and RB3/INT3 pins are edge-triggered. If the
corresponding INTEDGx bit in the INTCON2 register is
set (= 1), the interrupt is triggered by a rising edge; if
the bit is clear, the trigger is on the falling edge. When
a valid edge appears on the RBx/INTx pin, the
corresponding flag bit, INTxF, is set. This interrupt can
be disabled by clearing the corresponding enable bit,
INTxE. Flag bit, INTxF, must be cleared in software in
the Interrupt Service Routine before re-enabling the
interrupt.
In 8-bit mode (which is the default), an overflow in the
TMR0 register (FFh → 00h) will set flag bit, TMR0IF. In
16-bit mode, an overflow in the TMR0H:TMR0L register
pair (FFFFh → 0000h) will set TMR0IF. The interrupt can
be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing enable bit,
TMR0IE (INTCON<5>). Interrupt priority for Timer0 is
determined by the value contained in the interrupt priority bit, TMR0IP (INTCON2<2>). See Section 11.0
“Timer0 Module” for further details on the Timer0
module.
All external interrupts (INT0, INT1, INT2 and INT3) can
wake-up the processor from the power managed
modes if bit INTxE was set prior to going into power
managed modes. If the Global Interrupt Enable bit,
GIE, is set, the processor will branch to the interrupt
vector following wake-up.
9.8
Interrupt priority for INT1, INT2 and INT3 is determined
by the value contained in the interrupt priority bits,
INT1IP (INTCON3<6>), INT2IP (INTCON3<7>) and
INT3IP (INTCON2<1>). There is no priority bit
associated with INT0. It is always a high priority
interrupt source.
EXAMPLE 9-1:
An input change on PORTB<7:4> sets flag bit, RBIF
(INTCON<0>). The interrupt can be enabled/disabled
by setting/clearing enable bit, RBIE (INTCON<3>).
Interrupt priority for PORTB interrupt-on-change is
determined by the value contained in the interrupt
priority bit, RBIP (INTCON2<0>).
9.9
Context Saving During Interrupts
During interrupts, the return PC address is saved on
the stack. Additionally, the WREG, Status and BSR
registers are saved on the fast return stack. If a fast
return from interrupt is not used (see Section 5.3
“Data Memory Organization”), the user may need to
save the WREG, Status and BSR registers on entry to
the Interrupt Service Routine. Depending on the user’s
application, other registers may also need to be saved.
Example 9-1 saves and restores the WREG, Status
and BSR registers during an Interrupt Service Routine.
SAVING STATUS, WREG AND BSR REGISTERS IN RAM
MOVWF
W_TEMP
MOVFF
STATUS, STATUS_TEMP
MOVFF
BSR, BSR_TEMP
;
; USER ISR CODE
;
MOVFF
BSR_TEMP, BSR
MOVF
W_TEMP, W
MOVFF
STATUS_TEMP, STATUS
DS39635A-page 116
PORTB Interrupt-on-Change
; W_TEMP is in virtual bank
; STATUS_TEMP located anywhere
; BSR_TMEP located anywhere
; Restore BSR
; Restore WREG
; Restore STATUS
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.0
I/O PORTS
10.1
Depending on the device selected and features
enabled, there are up to nine ports available. Some
pins of the I/O ports are multiplexed with an alternate
function from the peripheral features on the device. In
general, when a peripheral is enabled, that pin may not
be used as a general purpose I/O pin.
Each port has three registers for its operation. These
registers are:
The Data Latch (LAT register) is useful for
read-modify-write operations on the value that the I/O
pins are driving.
A simplified model of a generic I/O port, without the
interfaces to other peripherals, is shown in Figure 10-1.
GENERIC I/O PORT
OPERATION
RD LAT
Data
Bus
WR LAT
or Port
D
Q
I/O pin(1)
D
The RA4 pin is multiplexed with the Timer0 module
clock input to become the RA4/T0CKI pin. Pins RA6
and RA7 are multiplexed with the main oscillator pins;
they are enabled as oscillator or I/O pins by the selection of the main oscillator in the configuration register
(see Section 23.1 “Configuration Bits” for details).
When they are not used as port pins, RA6 and RA7 and
their associated TRIS and LAT bits are read as ‘0’.
The other PORTA pins are multiplexed with the analog
VREF+ and VREF- inputs. The operation of pins
RA5:RA0 as A/D converter inputs is selected by
clearing or setting the PCFG3:PCFG0 control bits in the
ADCON1 register.
Note:
Q
CK
TRIS Latch
Input
Buffer
RD TRIS
Q
D
ENEN
The TRISA register controls the direction of the PORTA
pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs.
The user must ensure the bits in the TRISA register are
maintained set when using them as analog inputs.
EXAMPLE 10-1:
I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS.
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVWF
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
On a Power-on Reset, RA5 and RA3:RA0
are configured as analog inputs and read
as ‘0’. RA4 is configured as a digital input.
The RA4/T0CKI pin is a Schmitt Trigger input and an
open-drain output. All other PORTA pins have TTL
input levels and full CMOS output drivers.
CLRF
RD Port
Note 1:
The Data Latch register (LATA) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATA
register read and write the latched output value for
PORTA.
CK
Data Latch
WR TRIS
PORTA is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISA. Setting a
TRISA bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTA pin
an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in a
high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISA bit (= 0) will
make the corresponding PORTA pin an output (i.e., put
the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
Reading the PORTA register reads the status of the
pins, whereas writing to it, will write to the port latch.
• TRIS register (data direction register)
• Port register (reads the levels on the pins of the
device)
• LAT register (output latch)
FIGURE 10-1:
PORTA, TRISA and
LATA Registers
Preliminary
PORTA
;
;
;
LATA
;
;
;
07h
;
ADCON1 ;
07h
;
CMCON
;
0CFh
;
;
;
TRISA
;
;
INITIALIZING PORTA
Initialize PORTA by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Configure A/D
for digital inputs
Configure comparators
for digital input
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RA<3:0> as inputs
RA<5:4> as outputs
DS39635A-page 117
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-1:
Pin Name
PORTA FUNCTIONS
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
RA0
0
O
DIG
1
I
TTL
PORTA<0> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
AN0
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 0. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
RA1
0
O
DIG
LATA<1> data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
TTL
PORTA<1> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
AN1
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 1. Default input configuration on POR; does not
affect digital output.
RA2
0
O
DIG
LATA<2> data output; not affected by analog input. Disabled when
CVREF output enabled.
1
I
TTL
PORTA<2> data input. Disabled when analog functions enabled;
disabled when CVREF output enabled.
AN2
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 2. Default input configuration on POR; not affected
by analog output.
VREF-
1
I
ANA
Comparator voltage reference low input and A/D voltage reference low
input.
RA3
0
O
DIG
LATA<3> data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
TTL
PORTA<3> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
RA0/AN0
RA1/AN1
RA2/AN2/VREF-
RA3/AN3/VREF+
RA4/T0CKI
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN
Description
LATA<0> data output; not affected by analog input.
AN3
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 3. Default input configuration on POR.
VREF+
1
I
ANA
Comparator voltage reference high input and A/D voltage reference
high input.
RA4
0
O
DIG
LATA<4> data output
1
I
ST
PORTA<4> data input; default configuration on POR.
T0CKI
x
I
ST
Timer0 clock input.
RA5
0
O
DIG
LATA<5> data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
TTL
PORTA<5> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
AN4
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 4. Default configuration on POR.
HLVDIN
1
I
ANA
High/Low-Voltage Detect external trip point input.
OSC2
x
O
ANA
Main oscillator feedback output connection (XT, HS and LP modes).
CLKO
x
O
DIG
System cycle clock output (FOSC/4) in all oscillator modes except
RCIO, INTIO2 and ECIO.
RA6
0
O
DIG
LATA<6> data output. Enabled in RCIO, INTIO2 and ECIO modes only.
1
I
TTL
PORTA<6> data input. Enabled in RCIO, INTIO2 and ECIO modes
only.
OSC1
x
I
ANA
Main oscillator input connection.
CLKI
x
I
ANA
Main clock input connection.
RA7
0
O
DIG
LATA<7> data output. Disabled in external oscillator modes.
1
I
TTL
PORTA<7> data input. Disabled in external oscillator modes.
OSC2/CLKO/RA6
OSC1/CLKI/RA7
Legend:
I/O
Type
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST= Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
DS39635A-page 118
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-2:
Name
PORTA
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTA
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
RA7(1)
RA6(1)
RA5
RA4
RA3
RA2
RA1
RA0
(1)
LATA6(1) LATA Data Output Register
LATA
LATA7
TRISA
TRISA7(1) TRISA6(1) PORTA Data Direction Register
ADCON1
—
—
VCFG1
VCFG0
PCFG3
Reset
Values
on Page
60
60
60
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
58
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTA.
Note 1: RA7:RA6 and their associated latch and data direction bits are enabled as I/O pins based on oscillator
configuration; otherwise, they are read as ‘0’.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 119
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.2
PORTB, TRISB and
LATB Registers
PORTB is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISB. Setting a
TRISB bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTB
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISB bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTB pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The Data Latch register (LATB) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATB
register read and write the latched output value for
PORTB.
EXAMPLE 10-2:
CLRF
PORTB
CLRF
LATB
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISB
INITIALIZING PORTB
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
This interrupt can wake the device from power
managed modes. The user, in the Interrupt Service
Routine, can clear the interrupt in the following manner:
a)
b)
Initialize PORTB by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RB<3:0> as inputs
RB<5:4> as outputs
RB<7:6> as inputs
Any read or write of PORTB (except with the
MOVFF (ANY), PORTB instruction). This will
end the mismatch condition.
Clear flag bit RBIF.
A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit RBIF.
Reading PORTB will end the mismatch condition and
allow flag bit RBIF to be cleared.
The interrupt-on-change feature is recommended for
wake-up on key depression operation and operations
where PORTB is only used for the interrupt-on-change
feature. Polling of PORTB is not recommended while
using the interrupt-on-change feature.
Each of the PORTB pins has a weak internal pull-up. A
single control bit can turn on all the pull-ups. This is
performed by clearing bit RBPU (INTCON2<7>). The
weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port
pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on a Power-on Reset.
DS39635A-page 120
Four of the PORTB pins (RB7:RB4) have an
interrupt-on-change feature. Only pins configured as
inputs can cause this interrupt to occur (i.e., any
RB7:RB4 pin configured as an output is excluded from
the interrupt-on-change comparison). The input pins (of
RB7:RB4) are compared with the old value latched on
the last read of PORTB. The “mismatch” outputs of
RB7:RB4 are ORed together to generate the RB Port
Change Interrupt with Flag bit, RBIF (INTCON<0>).
For 80-pin devices, RB3 can be configured as the
alternate peripheral pin for the CCP2 module by
clearing the CCP2MX configuration bit. This applies
only when the device is in one of the operating modes
other than the default Microcontroller mode. If the
device is in Microcontroller mode, the alternate
assignment for CCP2 is RE7. As with other CCP2 configurations, the user must ensure that the TRISB<3> bit
is set appropriately for the intended operation.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-3:
Pin Name
RB0/INT0
RB1/INT1
RB2/INT2
RB3/INT3/
CCP2
RB4/KBI0
RB5/KBI1
RB6/KBI2/PGC
RB7/KBI3/PGD
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
PORTB FUNCTIONS
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RB0
0
O
DIG
LATB<0> data output.
1
I
TTL
PORTB<0> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
INT0
1
I
ST
External Interrupt 0 input.
RB1
0
O
DIG
LATB<1> data output.
PORTB<1> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
Description
1
I
TTL
INT1
1
I
ST
External Interrupt 1 input.
RB2
0
O
DIG
LATB<2> data output.
PORTB<2> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
1
I
TTL
INT2
1
I
ST
External Interrupt 2 input.
RB3
0
O
DIG
LATB<3> data output.
PORTB<3> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
1
I
TTL
INT3
1
I
ST
External Interrupt 3 input.
CCP2(1)
0
O
DIG
CCP2 compare output and CCP2 PWM output; takes priority over port
data.
1
I
ST
CCP2 capture input.
RB4
0
O
DIG
LATB<4> data output.
1
I
TTL
PORTB<4> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
KBI0
1
I
TTL
Interrupt on pin change.
RB5
0
O
DIG
LATB<5> data output
1
I
TTL
PORTB<5> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
KBI1
1
I
TTL
Interrupt on pin change.
RB6
0
O
DIG
LATB<6> data output
1
I
TTL
PORTB<6> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
KBI2
1
I
TTL
Interrupt on pin change.
PGC
x
I
ST
Serial execution (ICSP™) clock input for ICSP and ICD operation(2).
RB7
0
O
DIG
LATB<7> data output.
1
I
TTL
PORTB<7> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
KBI3
1
I
TTL
Interrupt on pin change.
PGD
x
O
DIG
Serial execution data output for ICSP and ICD operation(2).
x
I
ST
Serial execution data input for ICSP and ICD operation(2).
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
Alternate assignment for CCP2 when the CCP2MX configuration bit is cleared (Microprocessor, Extended
Microcontroller and Microcontroller with Boot Block modes, 80-pin devices only). Default assignment is RC1.
All other pin functions are disabled when ICSP or ICD operations are enabled.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 121
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-4:
Name
PORTB
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTB
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
RB7
RB6
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
60
LATB
LATB Data Output Register
60
TRISB
PORTB Data Direction Register
60
INTCON
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
INTCON2
RBPU
INTCON3
INT2IP
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
INTEDG0 INTEDG1 INTEDG2 INTEDG3 TMR0IP
INT3IP
RBIP
57
INT2IF
INT1IF
57
INT1IP
TMR0IE
INT3IE
INT0IE
INT2IE
RBIE
INT1IE
INT3IF
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by PORTB.
DS39635A-page 122
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.3
PORTC, TRISC and
LATC Registers
Note:
PORTC is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISC. Setting a
TRISC bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTC
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISC bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTC pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The Data Latch register (LATC) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATC
register read and write the latched output value for
PORTC.
PORTC is multiplexed with several peripheral functions
(Table 10-5). The pins have Schmitt Trigger input
buffers. RC1 is normally configured by configuration bit
CCP2MX as the default peripheral pin of the CCP2
module (default/erased state, CCP2MX = 1).
The contents of the TRISC register are affected by
peripheral overrides. Reading TRISC always returns
the current contents, even though a peripheral device
may be overriding one or more of the pins.
EXAMPLE 10-3:
CLRF
PORTC
CLRF
LATC
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISC
When enabling peripheral functions, care should be
taken in defining TRIS bits for each PORTC pin. Some
peripherals override the TRIS bit to make a pin an output,
while other peripherals override the TRIS bit to make a
pin an input. The user should refer to the corresponding
peripheral section for the correct TRIS bit settings.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
On a Power-on Reset, these pins are
configured as digital inputs.
Preliminary
INITIALIZING PORTC
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTC by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RC<3:0> as inputs
RC<5:4> as outputs
RC<7:6> as inputs
DS39635A-page 123
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-5:
PORTC FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
Function
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI
RC0
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2
RC2/CCP1
RC3/SCK/SCL
RC7/RX1/DT1
Legend:
Note 1:
Description
O
DIG
I
ST
T1OSO
x
O
ANA
T13CKI
1
I
ST
Timer1/Timer3 counter input.
RC1
0
O
DIG
LATC<1> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC<1> data input.
T1OSI
x
I
ANA
Timer1 oscillator input; enabled when Timer1 oscillator enabled.
Disables digital I/O.
CCP2(1)
0
O
DIG
CCP2 compare output and CCP2 PWM output; takes priority over port
data.
LATC<0> data output.
PORTC<0> data input.
Timer1 oscillator output; enabled when Timer1 oscillator enabled.
Disables digital I/O.
1
I
ST
CCP2 capture input
RC2
0
O
DIG
LATC<2> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC<2> data input.
CCP1
0
O
DIG
CCP1 compare output and CCP1 PWM output; takes priority over port
data.
1
I
ST
CCP1 capture input.
RC3
0
O
DIG
LATC<3> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC<3> data input.
0
O
DIG
SPI™ clock output (MSSP module); takes priority over port data.
1
I
ST
SPI clock input (MSSP module).
0
O
DIG
I2C™ clock output (MSSP module); takes priority over port data.
1
I
ST
I2C clock input (MSSP module); input type depends on module setting.
RC4
0
O
DIG
LATC<4> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC<4> data input.
SDI
1
I
ST
SPI data input (MSSP module).
SDA
1
O
DIG
I2C data output (MSSP module); takes priority over port data.
1
I
ST
I2C data input (MSSP module); input type depends on module setting.
0
O
DIG
LATC<5> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC<5> data input.
SDO
0
O
DIG
SPI data output (MSSP module); takes priority over port data.
RC6
0
O
DIG
LATC<6> data output.
RC5
RC6/TX1/CK1
I/O
Type
0
SCL
RC5/SDO
I/O
1
SCK
RC4/SDI/SDA
TRIS
Setting
1
I
ST
PORTC<6> data input.
TX1
1
O
DIG
Synchronous serial data output (EUSART module); takes priority over
port data.
CK1
1
O
DIG
Synchronous serial data input (EUSART module). User must
configure as an input.
1
I
ST
Synchronous serial clock input (EUSART module).
0
O
DIG
LATC<7> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTC<7> data input.
RX1
1
I
ST
Asynchronous serial receive data input (EUSART module)
DT1
1
O
DIG
Synchronous serial data output (EUSART module); takes priority over
port data.
1
I
ST
Synchronous serial data input (EUSART module). User must
configure as an input.
RC7
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
Default assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX configuration bit is set.
DS39635A-page 124
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-6:
Name
PORTC
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTC
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
RC7
RC6
RC5
RC4
RC3
RC2
RC1
RC0
60
LATC
LATC Data Output Register
60
TRISC
PORTC Data Direction Register
60
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by PORTC.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 125
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.4
PORTD, TRISD and
LATD Registers
PORTD is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISD. Setting a
TRISD bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTD
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISD bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTD pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The Data Latch register (LATD) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATD
register read and write the latched output value for
PORTD.
All pins on PORTD are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
Note:
On a Power-on Reset, these pins are
configured as digital inputs.
PORTD can also be configured to function as an 8-bit
wide parallel microprocessor port by setting the
PSPMODE control bit (PSPCON<4>). In this mode,
parallel port data takes priority over other digital I/O (but
not the external memory interface). When the parallel
port is active, the input buffers are TTL. For more
information, refer to Section 10.10 “Parallel Slave
Port”.
EXAMPLE 10-4:
CLRF
PORTD
CLRF
LATD
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISD
In 80-pin devices, PORTD is multiplexed with the
system bus as part of the external memory interface.
I/O port and other functions are only available when the
interface is disabled by setting the EBDIS bit
(MEMCON<7>). When the interface is enabled,
PORTD is the low-order byte of the multiplexed
address/data bus (AD7:AD0). The TRISD bits are also
overridden.
DS39635A-page 126
Preliminary
INITIALIZING PORTD
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTD by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RD<3:0> as inputs
RD<5:4> as outputs
RD<7:6> as inputs
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-7:
PORTD FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RD0/AD0/PSP0
RD0
0
O
DIG
LATD<0> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<0> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 0 output(1).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 0 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<0>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
0
O
DIG
LATD<1> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<1> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 1 output(1).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 1 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<1>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
0
O
DIG
LATD<2> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<2> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 2 output(1).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 2 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<2>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
0
O
DIG
LATD<3> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<3> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 3 output(1).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 3 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<3>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
0
O
DIG
LATD<4> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<4> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 4 output(1).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 4 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<4>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
0
O
DIG
LATD<5> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<5> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 5 output(1).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 5 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<5>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
0
O
DIG
LATD<6> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<6> data input.
x
O
DIG-3
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 6 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<6>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
(2)
AD0
PSP0
RD1/AD1/PSP1
RD1
AD1(2)
PSP1
RD2/AD2/PSP2
RD2
(2)
AD2
PSP2
RD3/AD3/PSP3
RD3
AD3(2)
PSP3
RD4/AD4/PSP4
RD4
(2)
AD4
PSP4
RD5/AD5/PSP5
RD5
AD5(2)
PSP5
RD6/AD6/PSP6
RD6
(2)
AD6
PSP6
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
Description
External memory interface, address/data bit 6 output(1).
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
External memory interface I/O takes priority over all other digital and PSP I/O.
Implemented on 80-pin devices only.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 127
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-7:
PORTD FUNCTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Name
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RD7/AD7/PSP7
RD7
0
O
DIG
LATD<7> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTD<7> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 7 output(1).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 7 input(1).
x
O
DIG
PSP read data output (LATD<7>); takes priority over port data.
x
I
TTL
PSP write data input.
AD7(2)
PSP7
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
External memory interface I/O takes priority over all other digital and PSP I/O.
Implemented on 80-pin devices only.
TABLE 10-8:
Name
PORTD
Description
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTD
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
RD7
RD6
RD5
RD4
RD3
RD2
RD1
RD0
Reset
Values
on Page
60
LATD
LATD Data Output Register
60
TRISD
PORTD Data Direction Register
60
DS39635A-page 128
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.5
PORTE, TRISE and
LATE Registers
PORTE is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding data direction register is TRISE. Setting
a TRISE bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTE
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISE bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTE pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The Data Latch register (LATE) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATE
register read and write the latched output value for
PORTE.
All pins on PORTE are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
Note:
On a Power-on Reset, these pins are
configured as digital inputs.
When the Parallel Slave Port is active on PORTD, three
of the PORTE pins (RE0/AD8/RD, RE1/AD9/WR and
RE2/AD10/CS) are configured as digital control inputs
for the port. The control functions are summarized in
Table 10-9. The reconfiguration occurs automatically
when the PSPMODE control bit (PSPCON<4>) is set.
Users must still make certain the the corresponding
TRISE bits are set to configure these pins as digital
inputs.
EXAMPLE 10-5:
CLRF
PORTE
CLRF
LATE
MOVLW
03h
MOVWF
TRISE
INITIALIZING PORTE
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTE by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RE<1:0> as inputs
RE<7:2> as outputs
When the device is operating in Microcontroller mode,
pin RE7 can be configured as the alternate peripheral
pin for the CCP2 module. This is done by clearing the
CCP2MX configuration bit.
In 80-pin devices, PORTE is multiplexed with the
system bus as part of the external memory interface.
I/O port and other functions are only available when the
interface is disabled by setting the EBDIS bit
(MEMCON<7>). When the interface is enabled (80-pin
devices only), PORTE is the high-order byte of the
multiplexed address/data bus (AD15:AD8). The TRISE
bits are also overridden.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 129
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-9:
Pin Name
PORTE FUNCTIONS
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RE0
0
O
DIG
LATE<0> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE<0> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 8 output(2).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 8 input(2).
RD
1
I
TTL
Parallel Slave Port read enable control input.
RE1
0
O
DIG
LATE<1> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE<1> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 9 output(2).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 9 input(2).
RE0/AD8/RD
AD8(3)
RE1/AD9/WR
AD9(3)
RE2/AD10/CS
WR
1
I
TTL
Parallel Slave Port write enable control input.
RE2
0
O
DIG
LATE<2> data output.
AD10(3)
RE3/AD11
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 10 input(2).
I
TTL
Parallel Slave Port chip select control input.
DIG
LATE<3> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE<3> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 11 output(2).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 11 input(2).
0
O
DIG
LATE<4> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE<4> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 12 output(2).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 12 input(2).
0
O
DIG
LATE<5> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE<5> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 13 output(2).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 13 input(2).
0
O
DIG
LATE<6> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE<6> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 14 output(2).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 14 input(2).
0
O
DIG
LATE<7> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTE<7> data input.
0
O
DIG
CCP2 compare output and CCP2 PWM output; takes priority over port
data.
1
I
ST
CCP2 capture input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address/data bit 15 output(2).
x
I
TTL
External memory interface, data bit 15 input(2).
(3)
RE6
AD14(3)
RE7
CCP2(1)
AD15
Note 1:
2:
3:
External memory interface, address/data bit 10 output(2).
O
AD13(3)
Legend:
PORTE<2> data input.
DIG
0
RE5
RE7/CCP2/AD15
ST
O
1
AD12(3)
RE6/AD14
I
x
CS
RE4
RE5/AD13
1
RE3
AD11
RE4/AD12
Description
(3)
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
Alternate assignment for CCP2 when CCP2MX configuration bit is cleared (all devices in Microcontroller mode).
External memory interface I/O takes priority over all other digital and PSP I/O.
Implemented on 80-pin devices only.
DS39635A-page 130
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-10: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTE
Name
PORTE
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
RE7
RE6
RE5
RE4
RE3
RE2
RE1
RE0
Reset
Values
on Page
60
LATE
LATE Data Output Register
60
TRISE
PORTE Data Direction bits
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTE.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 131
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.6
PORTF, LATF and TRISF Registers
PORTF is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISF. Setting a
TRISF bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTF pin
an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in a
high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISF bit (= 0) will
make the corresponding PORTF pin an output (i.e., put
the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The Data Latch register (LATF) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATF
register read and write the latched output value for
PORTF.
All pins on PORTF are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
PORTF is multiplexed with several analog peripheral
functions, including the A/D converter and comparator
inputs, as well as the comparator outputs. Pins RF2
through RF6 may be used as comparator inputs or
outputs by setting the appropriate bits in the CMCON
register. To use RF3:RF6 as digital inputs, it is also
necessary to turn off the comparators.
Note:
Note 1: On a Power-on Reset, the RF6:RF0 pins
are configured as inputs and read as ‘0’.
2: To configure PORTF as digital I/O, turn off
comparators and set ADCON1 value.
EXAMPLE 10-6:
CLRF
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
PORTF
;
;
;
LATF
;
;
;
0x07
;
CMCON
;
0x0F
;
ADCON1 ;
0xCF
;
;
;
TRISF
;
;
;
INITIALIZING PORTF
Initialize PORTF by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Turn off comparators
Set PORTF as digital I/O
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RF3:RF0 as inputs
RF5:RF4 as outputs
RF7:RF6 as inputs
On a Power-on Reset, RA5 and RA3:RA0
are configured as analog inputs and read
as ‘0’. RA4 is configured as a digital input.
DS39635A-page 132
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-11: PORTF FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RF0
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
AN5
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 5. Default configuration on POR.
RF1
0
O
DIG
LATF<1> data output; not affected by analog input.
RF0/AN5
RF1/AN6/C2OUT
LATF<0> data output; not affected by analog input.
PORTF<0> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
1
I
ST
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 6. Default configuration on POR.
C2OUT
0
O
DIG
Comparator 2 output; takes priority over port data.
RF2
0
O
DIG
LATF<2> data output; not affected by analog input.
AN6
RF2/AN7/C1OUT
PORTF<1> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
1
I
ST
1
I
ANA
C1OUT
0
O
TTL
Comparator 1 output; takes priority over port data.
RF3
0
O
DIG
LATF<3> data output; not affected by analog input.
AN7
RF3/AN8
AN8
RF4/AN9
RF4
PORTF<2> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
A/D input channel 7. Default configuration on POR.
1
I
ST
PORTF<3> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 8 and Comparator C2+ input. Default input
configuration on POR; not affected by analog output.
LATF<4> data output; not affected by analog input.
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTF<4> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
AN9
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 9 and Comparator C2- input. Default input
configuration on POR; does not affect digital output.
RF5
0
O
DIG
LATF<5> data output; not affected by analog input. Disabled when
CVREF output enabled.
1
I
ST
PORTF<5> data input; disabled when analog input enabled. Disabled
when CVREF output enabled
AN10
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 10 and Comparator C1+ input. Default input
configuration on POR.
CVREF
x
O
ANA
Comparator voltage reference output. Enabling this feature disables
digital I/O.
RF6
0
O
DIG
LATF<6> data output; not affected by analog input.
1
I
ST
AN11
1
I
ANA
A/D input channel 11 and Comparator C1- input. Default input
configuration on POR; does not affect digital output.
RF7
0
O
DIG
LATF<7> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTF<7> data input.
SS
1
I
TTL
Slave select input for SSP (MSSP module).
RF5/AN10/CVREF
RF6/AN11
RF7/SS
Legend:
Description
PORTF<6> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
TABLE 10-12: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTF
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset Values
on Page
TRISF
PORTF Data Direction Control Register
60
PORTF
Read PORTF pin/Write PORTF Data Latch
60
LATF
Read PORTF Data Latch/Write PORTF Data Latch
ADCON1
—
—
VCFG1
VCFG0
PCFG3
60
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
58
CMCON
C2OUT
C1OUT
C2INV
C1INV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
59
CVRCON
CVREN
CVROE
CVRR
CVRSS
CVR3
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTF.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 133
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.7
PORTG, TRISG and
LATG Registers
PORTG is a 6-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISG. Setting a
TRISG bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTG
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISG bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTG pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The sixth pin of PORTG (RG5/MCLR/VPP) is an input
only pin. Its operation is controlled by the MCLRE
configuration bit. When selected as a port pin
(MCLRE = 0), it functions as a digital input only pin; as
such, it does not have TRIS or LAT bits associated with
its operation. Otherwise, it functions as the device’s
Master Clear input. In either configuration, RG5 also
functions as the programming voltage input during
programming.
Note:
The Data Latch register (LATG) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATG
register, read and write the latched output value for
PORTG.
PORTG is multiplexed with USART functions
(Table 10-13). PORTG pins have Schmitt Trigger input
buffers.
When enabling peripheral functions, care should be
taken in defining TRIS bits for each PORTG pin. Some
peripherals override the TRIS bit to make a pin an
output, while other peripherals override the TRIS bit to
make a pin an input. The user should refer to the
corresponding peripheral section for the correct TRIS
bit settings. The pin override value is not loaded into
the TRIS register. This allows read-modify-write of the
TRIS register without concern due to peripheral
overrides.
DS39635A-page 134
On a Power-on Reset, RG5 is enabled as
a digital input only if Master Clear
functionality is disabled. All other 5 pins
are configured as digital inputs.
EXAMPLE 10-7:
CLRF
PORTG
CLRF
LATG
MOVLW
0x04
MOVWF
TRISG
Preliminary
INITIALIZING PORTG
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTG by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RG1:RG0 as outputs
RG2 as input
RG4:RG3 as inputs
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-13: PORTG FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RG0/CCP3
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RG0
0
O
DIG
LATG<0> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTG<0> data input.
0
O
DIG
CCP3 compare and PWM output; takes priority over port data.
1
I
ST
CCP3 capture input.
0
O
DIG
LATG<1> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTG<1> data input.
TX2
1
O
DIG
Synchronous serial data output (AUSART module); takes priority over
port data.
CK2
1
O
DIG
Synchronous serial data input (AUSART module). User must
configure as an input.
CCP3
RG1/TX2/CK2
RG2/RX2/DT2
RG3
R21
RG2
Legend:
Note 1:
I
ST
Synchronous serial clock input (AUSART module).
0
O
DIG
LATG<2> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTG<2> data input.
1
I
ST
Asynchronous serial receive data input (AUSART module).
DT2
1
O
DIG
Synchronous serial data output (AUSART module); takes priority over
port data.
1
I
ST
Synchronous serial data input (AUSART module). User must
configure as an input.
0
O
DIG
LATG<3> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTG<3> data input.
0
O
DIG
LATG<4> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTG<4> data input.
RG5
—(1)
I
ST
PORTG<5> data input; enabled when MCLRE configuration bit is
clear.
MCLR
—
I
ST
External Master Clear input; enabled when MCLRE configuration bit is
set.
VPP
—
I
ANA
High-voltage detection; used for ICSP™ mode entry detection. Always
available, regardless of pin mode.
RG4
RG5/MCLR/VPP
1
RX2
RG3
RG4
Description
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
RG5 does not have a corresponding TRISG bit.
TABLE 10-14: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTG
Name
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values on
Page
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
PORTG
—
—
RG5(1)
Read PORTG pin/Write PORTG Data Latch
60
LATG
—
—
—
LATG Data Output Register
60
TRISG
—
—
—
Data Direction Control Register for PORTG
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTG.
Note 1: RG5 is available as an input only when MCLR is disabled.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 135
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.8
Note:
PORTH, LATH and
TRISH Registers
PORTH
is
available
PIC18F8310/8410 devices.
only
on
PORTH is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional I/O port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISH. Setting a
TRISH bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTH
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISH bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTH pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The Data Latch register (LATH) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATH
register, read and write the latched output value for
PORTH.
When the external memory interface is enabled, four of
the PORTH pins function as the high-order address
lines for the interface. The address output from the
interface takes priority over other digital I/O. The
corresponding TRISH bits are also overridden.
EXAMPLE 10-8:
CLRF
PORTH
CLRF
LATH
MOVLW
0CFh
MOVWF
TRISH
All pins on PORTH are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
Note:
INITIALIZING PORTH
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTH by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RH3:RH0 as inputs
RH5:RH4 as outputs
RH7:RH6 as inputs
On a Power-on Reset, these pins are
configured as digital inputs.
DS39635A-page 136
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-15: PORTH FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RH0/AD16
RH1/AD17
RH2/AD18
RH3/AD19
RH4
RH5
RH6
RH7
Legend:
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RH0
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTH<0> data input.
AD16
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address line 16. Takes priority over port
data.
RH1
0
O
DIG
LATH<1> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTH<1> data input.
AD17
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address line 17. Takes priority over port
data.
RH2
0
O
DIG
LATH<2> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTH<2> data input.
AD18
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address line 18. Takes priority over port
data.
RH3
0
O
DIG
LATH<3> data output.
Description
LATH<0> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTH<3> data input.
AD19
x
O
DIG
External memory interface, address line 19. Takes priority over port
data.
RH4
0
O
DIG
LATH<4> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTH<4> data input.
0
O
DIG
LATH<5> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTH<5> data input.
0
O
DIG
LATH<6> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTH<6> data input.
0
O
DIG
LATH<7> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTH<7> data input.
RH5
RH6
RH7
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
TABLE 10-16: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTH
Name
TRISH
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset Values
on Page
PORTH Data Direction Control Register
59
PORTH
Read PORTH pin/Write PORTH Data Latch
60
LATH
Read PORTH Data Latch/Write PORTH Data Latch
60
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 137
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
10.9
Note:
PORTJ, TRISJ and
LATJ Registers
PORTJ
is
available
PIC18F8310/8410 devices.
only
on
PORTJ is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The corresponding data direction register is TRISJ. Setting a
TRISJ bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTJ pin
an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in a
high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISJ bit (= 0) will
make the corresponding PORTJ pin an output (i.e., put
the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
The Data Latch register (LATJ) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATJ
register, read and write the latched output value for
PORTJ.
When the external memory interface is enabled, all of
the PORTJ pins function as control outputs for the
interface. This occurs automatically when the interface
is enabled by clearing the EBDIS control bit
(MEMCON<7>). The TRISJ bits are also overridden.
EXAMPLE 10-9:
CLRF
PORTJ
CLRF
LATJ
MOVLW 0xCF
MOVWF TRISJ
All pins on PORTJ are implemented with Schmitt
Trigger input buffers. Each pin is individually
configurable as an input or output.
Note:
INITIALIZING PORTJ
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
;
Initialize PORTG by
clearing output
data latches
Alternate method
to clear output
data latches
Value used to
initialize data
direction
Set RJ3:RJ0 as inputs
RJ5:RJ4 as output
RJ7:RJ6 as inputs
On a Power-on Reset, these pins are
configured as digital inputs.
DS39635A-page 138
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 10-17: PORTJ FUNCTIONS
Pin Name
RJ0/ALE
RJ1/OE
RJ2/WRL
RJ3/WRH
RJ4/BA0
RJ5/CE
RJ6/LB
RJ7/UB
Function
TRIS
Setting
I/O
I/O
Type
RJ0
0
O
DIG
1
I
ST
PORTJ<0> data input.
ALE
x
O
DIG
External memory interface address latch enable control output; takes
priority over digital I/O.
RJ1
0
O
DIG
LATJ<1> data output.
LATJ<0> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTJ<1> data input.
OE
x
O
DIG
External memory interface output enable control output; takes priority
over digital I/O.
RJ2
0
O
DIG
LATJ<2> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTJ<2> data input.
WRL
x
O
DIG
External memory bus write low byte control; takes priority over digital
I/O.
RJ3
0
O
DIG
LATJ<3> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTJ<3> data input.
WRH
x
O
DIG
External memory interface write high byte control output; takes priority
over digital I/O.
RJ4
0
O
DIG
LATJ<4> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTJ<4> data input.
BA0
x
O
DIG
External memory interface byte address 0 control output; takes priority
over digital I/O.
RJ5
0
O
DIG
LATJ<5> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTJ<5> data input.
CE
x
O
DIG
External memory interface chip enable control output; takes priority
over digital I/O.
RJ6
0
O
DIG
LATJ<6> data output.
1
I
ST
PORTJ<6> data input.
LB
x
O
DIG
External memory interface lower byte enable control output; takes
priority over digital I/O.
RJ7
0
O
DIG
LATJ<7> data output.
UB
Legend:
Description
1
I
ST
PORTJ<7> data input.
x
O
DIG
External memory interface upper byte enable control output; takes
priority over digital I/O.
PWR = Power Supply, O = Output, I = Input, ANA = Analog Signal, DIG = Digital Output, ST = Schmitt Buffer Input,
TTL = TTL Buffer Input, x = Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
TABLE 10-18: SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTJ
Name
PORTJ
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset Values
on Page
Read PORTJ pin/Write PORTJ Data Latch
60
LATJ
LATJ Data Output Register
60
TRISJ
Data Direction Control Register for PORTJ
59
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 139
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 10-2:
10.10 Parallel Slave Port
PORTD can also function as an 8-bit wide Parallel
Slave Port, or microprocessor port, when control bit
PSPMODE (PSPCON<4>) is set. It is asynchronously
readable and writable by the external world through RD
control input pin, RE0/RD and WR control input pin,
RE1/WR.
Note:
Data Bus
D
WR LATD
or
PORTD
For PIC18F8310/8410 devices, the Parallel
Slave Port is available only in
Microcontroller mode.
RDx
pin
TTL
Data Latch
RD PORTD
D
ENEN
TRIS Latch
RD LATD
One bit of PORTD
A read from the PSP occurs when both the CS and RD
lines are first detected low. The data in PORTD is read
out and the OBF bit is set. If the user writes new data
to PORTD to set OBF, the data is immediately read out;
however, the OBF bit is not set.
When either the CS or RD lines are detected high, the
PORTD pins return to the input state and the PSPIF bit
is set. User applications should wait for PSPIF to be set
before servicing the PSP; when this happens, the IBF
and OBF bits can be polled and the appropriate action
taken.
The timing for the control signals in Write and Read
modes is shown in Figure 10-3 and Figure 10-4,
respectively.
DS39635A-page 140
Q
CK
Q
The PSP can directly interface to an 8-bit microprocessor data bus. The external microprocessor can
read or write the PORTD latch as an 8-bit latch. Setting
bit PSPMODE enables port pin RE0/RD to be the RD
input, RE1/WR to be the WR input and RE2/CS to be
the CS (Chip Select) input. For this functionality, the
corresponding data direction bits of the TRISE register
(TRISE<2:0>) must be configured as inputs (set).
A write to the PSP occurs when both the CS and WR
lines are first detected low and ends when either are
detected high. The PSPIF and IBF flag bits are both set
when the write ends.
PORTD AND PORTE
BLOCK DIAGRAM
(PARALLEL SLAVE
PORT)
Preliminary
Set Interrupt Flag
PSPIF (PIR1<7>)
Read
TTL
RD
Chip Select
TTL
CS
Write
TTL
WR
Note: I/O pin has protection diodes to VDD and VSS.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 10-1:
PSPCON: PARALLEL SLAVE PORT CONTROL REGISTER
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
IBF
OBF
IBOV
PSPMODE
—
—
—
—
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
IBF: Input Buffer Full Status bit
1 = A word has been received and is waiting to be read by the CPU
0 = No word has been received
bit 6
OBF: Output Buffer Full Status bit
1 = The output buffer still holds a previously written word
0 = The output buffer has been read
bit 5
IBOV: Input Buffer Overflow Detect bit
1 = A write occurred when a previously input word has not been read
(must be cleared in software)
0 = No overflow occurred
bit 4
PSPMODE: Parallel Slave Port Mode Select bit
1 = Parallel Slave Port mode
0 = General Purpose I/O mode
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Legend:
FIGURE 10-3:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
PARALLEL SLAVE PORT WRITE WAVEFORMS
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
CS
WR
RD
PORTD<7:0>
IBF
OBF
PSPIF
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 141
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 10-4:
PARALLEL SLAVE PORT READ WAVEFORMS
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
CS
WR
RD
PORTD<7:0>
IBF
OBF
PSPIF
TABLE 10-19: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PARALLEL SLAVE PORT
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
PORTD
PORTD Data Latch when written; Port pins when read
60
LATD
LATD Data Output bits
60
TRISD
PORTD Data Direction bits
60
PORTE
PORTE Data Latch when written; Port pins when read
60
LATE
LATE Data Output bits
60
TRISE
PORTE Data Direction bits
PSPCON
IBF
OBF
60
IBOV
PSPMODE
—
—
—
—
59
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
INTCON
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Parallel Slave Port.
DS39635A-page 142
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
11.0
TIMER0 MODULE
The Timer0 module incorporates the following features:
• Software selectable operation as a timer or
counter in both 8-bit or 16-bit modes
• Readable and writable registers
• Dedicated 8-bit software programmable prescaler
• Selectable clock source (internal or external)
• Edge select for external clock
• Interrupt-on-overflow
REGISTER 11-1:
The T0CON register (Register 11-1) controls all
aspects of the module’s operation, including the
prescale selection. It is both readable and writable.
A simplified block diagram of the Timer0 module in
8-bit mode is shown in Figure 11-1. Figure 11-2
shows a simplified block diagram of the Timer0
module in 16-bit mode.
T0CON: TIMER0 CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
TMR0ON
T08BIT
T0CS
T0SE
PSA
T0PS2
T0PS1
T0PS0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
TMR0ON: Timer0 On/Off Control bit
1 = Enables Timer0
0 = Stops Timer0
bit 6
T08BIT: Timer0 8-bit/16-bit Control bit
1 = Timer0 is configured as an 8-bit timer/counter
0 = Timer0 is configured as a 16-bit timer/counter
bit 5
T0CS: Timer0 Clock Source Select bit
1 = Transition on T0CKI pin
0 = Internal instruction cycle clock (CLKO)
bit 4
T0SE: Timer0 Source Edge Select bit
1 = Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin
0 = Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin
bit 3
PSA: Timer0 Prescaler Assignment bit
1 = TImer0 prescaler is not assigned. Timer0 clock input bypasses prescaler.
0 = Timer0 prescaler is assigned. Timer0 clock input comes from prescaler output.
bit 2-0
T0PS2:T0PS0: Timer0 Prescaler Select bits
111 = 1:256 Prescale value
110 = 1:128 Prescale value
101 = 1:64 Prescale value
100 = 1:32 Prescale value
011 = 1:16 Prescale value
010 = 1:8 Prescale value
001 = 1:4 Prescale value
000 = 1:2 Prescale value
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 143
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
11.1
Timer0 Operation
Timer0 can operate as either a timer or a counter; the
mode is selected by clearing the T0CS bit (T0CON<5>).
In Timer mode (T0CS = 0), the module increments on
every clock by default, unless a different prescaler value
is selected (see Section 11.3 “Prescaler”). If the TMR0
register is written to, the increment is inhibited for the following two instruction cycles. The user can work around
this by writing an adjusted value to the TMR0 register.
The Counter mode is selected by setting the T0CS bit
(= 1). In Counter mode, Timer0 increments either on
every rising or falling edge of pin RA4/T0CKI. The
incrementing edge is determined by the Timer0 Source
Edge Select bit, T0SE (T0CON<4>); clearing this bit
selects the rising edge. Restrictions on the external
clock input are discussed below.
An external clock source can be used to drive Timer0;
however, it must meet certain requirements to ensure
that the external clock can be synchronized with the
FIGURE 11-1:
internal phase clock (TOSC). There is a delay between
synchronization and the onset of incrementing the
timer/counter.
11.2
Timer0 Reads and Writes in
16-Bit Mode
TMR0H is not the actual high byte of Timer0 in 16-bit
mode; it is actually a buffered version of the real high
byte of Timer0, which is not directly readable nor
writable (refer to Figure 11-2). TMR0H is updated with
the contents of the high byte of Timer0 during a read of
TMR0L. This provides the ability to read all 16 bits of
Timer0, without having to verify that the read of the high
and low byte were valid, due to a rollover between
successive reads of the high and low byte.
Similarly, a write to the high byte of Timer0 must also
take place through the TMR0H Buffer register. The high
byte is updated with the contents of TMR0H when a
write occurs to TMR0L. This allows all 16 bits of Timer0
to be updated at once.
TIMER0 BLOCK DIAGRAM (8-BIT MODE)
FOSC/4
0
0
1
Programmable
Prescaler
T0CKI pin
T0SE
1
Sync with
Internal
Clocks
(2 TCY Delay)
8
3
T0CS
Set
TMR0IF
on Overflow
TMR0L
8
T0PS2:T0PS0
Internal Data Bus
PSA
Note: Upon Reset, Timer0 is enabled in 8-bit mode with clock input from T0CKI maximum prescale.
FIGURE 11-2:
TIMER0 BLOCK DIAGRAM (16-BIT MODE)
FOSC/4
0
0
1
T0CKI pin
T0SE
T0CS
Programmable
Prescaler
1
Sync with
Internal
Clocks
TMR0
High Byte
TMR0L
8
Set
TMR0IF
on Overflow
(2 TCY Delay)
3
Read TMR0L
T0PS2:T0PS0
Write TMR0L
PSA
8
8
TMR0H
8
8
Internal Data Bus
Note: Upon Reset, Timer0 is enabled in 8-bit mode with clock input from T0CKI maximum prescale.
DS39635A-page 144
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
11.3
11.3.1
Prescaler
An 8-bit counter is available as a prescaler for the Timer0
module. The prescaler is not directly readable or writable;
its value is set by the PSA and T0PS2:T0PS0 bits
(T0CON<3:0>), which determine the prescaler
assignment and prescale ratio.
Clearing the PSA bit assigns the prescaler to the
Timer0 module. When it is assigned, prescale values
from 1:2 through 1:256 in power-of-2 increments are
selectable.
When assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions
writing to the TMR0 register (e.g., CLRF TMR0, MOVWF
TMR0, BSF TMR0,etc.) clear the prescaler count.
Note:
Writing to TMR0 when the prescaler is
assigned to Timer0 will clear the prescaler
count, but will not change the prescaler
assignment.
TABLE 11-1:
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Timer0 Module Low Byte Register
TMR0H
Timer0 Module High Byte Register
INTCON
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
TRISA
The prescaler assignment is fully under software
control and can be changed “on-the-fly” during program
execution.
11.4
Timer0 Interrupt
The TMR0 interrupt is generated when the TMR0
register overflows from FFh to 00h in 8-bit mode, or
from FFFFh to 0000h in 16-bit mode. This overflow sets
the TMR0IF flag bit. The interrupt can be masked by
clearing the TMR0IE bit (INTCON<5>). Before reenabling the interrupt, the TMR0IF bit must be cleared
in software by the Interrupt Service Routine.
Since Timer0 is shut down in Sleep mode, the TMR0
interrupt cannot awaken the processor from Sleep.
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER0
TMR0L
T0CON
SWITCHING PRESCALER
ASSIGNMENT
TMR0ON
T08BIT
T0CS
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
58
58
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
T0SE
PSA
T0PS2
T0PS1
T0PS0
PORTA Data Direction Register
57
58
60
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by Timer0.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 145
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 146
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
12.0
TIMER1 MODULE
The Timer1 timer/counter module incorporates these
features:
• Software selectable operation as a 16-bit timer or
counter
• Readable and writable 8-bit registers (TMR1H
and TMR1L)
• Selectable clock source (internal or external) with
device clock or Timer1 oscillator internal options
• Interrupt-on-overflow
• Reset on CCP special event trigger
• Device clock status flag (T1RUN)
REGISTER 12-1:
A simplified block diagram of the Timer1 module is
shown in Figure 12-1. A block diagram of the module’s
operation in Read/Write mode is shown in Figure 12-2.
The module incorporates its own low-power oscillator
to provide an additional clocking option. The Timer1
oscillator can also be used as a low-power clock source
for the microcontroller in power managed operation.
Timer1 can also be used to provide Real-Time Clock
(RTC) functionality to applications with only a minimal
addition of external components and code overhead.
Timer1 is controlled through the T1CON Control
register (Register 12-1). It also contains the Timer1
Oscillator Enable bit (T1OSCEN). Timer1 can be
enabled or disabled by setting or clearing control bit,
TMR1ON (T1CON<0>).
T1CON: TIMER1 CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RD16
T1RUN
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
RD16: 16-bit Read/Write Mode Enable bit
1 = Enables register read/write of TImer1 in one 16-bit operation
0 = Enables register read/write of Timer1 in two 8-bit operations
bit 6
T1RUN: Timer1 System Clock Status bit
1 = Device clock is derived from Timer1 oscillator
0 = Device clock is derived from another source
bit 5-4
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits
11 = 1:8 Prescale value
10 = 1:4 Prescale value
01 = 1:2 Prescale value
00 = 1:1 Prescale value
bit 3
T1OSCEN: Timer1 Oscillator Enable bit
1 = Timer1 oscillator is enabled
0 = Timer1 oscillator is shut off
The oscillator inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain.
bit 2
T1SYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Select bit
When TMR1CS = 1:
1 = Do not synchronize external clock input
0 = Synchronize external clock input
When TMR1CS = 0:
This bit is ignored. Timer1 uses the internal clock when TMR1CS = 0.
bit 1
TMR1CS: Timer1 Clock Source Select bit
1 = External clock from pin RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI (on the rising edge)
0 = Internal clock (FOSC/4)
bit 0
TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit
1 = Enables Timer1
0 = Stops Timer1
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 147
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
12.1
Timer1 Operation
cycle (FOSC/4). When the bit is set, Timer1 increments
on every rising edge of the Timer1 external clock input
or the Timer1 oscillator, if enabled.
Timer1 can operate in one of these modes:
• Timer
• Synchronous Counter
• Asynchronous Counter
When Timer1 is enabled, the RC1/T1OSI and RC0/
T1OSO/T13CKI pins become inputs. This means the
values of TRISC<1:0> are ignored and the pins are
read as ‘0’.
The operating mode is determined by the clock select
bit, TMR1CS (T1CON<1>). When TMR1CS is cleared
(= 0), Timer1 increments on every internal instruction
FIGURE 12-1:
TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Timer1 Oscillator
On/Off
T1OSO/T13CKI
1
1
T1OSI
Synchronize
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
0
Detect
0
2
T1OSCEN
(1)
Sleep Input
Timer1
On/Off
TMR1CS
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0
T1SYNC
TMR1ON
Clear TMR1
(CCP Special Event Trigger)
Set
TMR1IF
on Overflow
TMR1
High Byte
TMR1L
Note 1: When enable bit, T1OSCEN, is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain.
FIGURE 12-2:
TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM (16-BIT READ/WRITE MODE)
Timer1 Oscillator
1
T1OSO/T13CKI
1
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
T1OSI
Synchronize
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
0
Detect
0
2
Sleep Input
TMR1CS
T1OSCEN(1)
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0
Timer1
On/Off
T1SYNC
TMR1ON
Clear TMR1
(CCP Special Event Trigger)
TMR1
High Byte
TMR1L
8
Set
TMR1IF
on Overflow
Read TMR1L
Write TMR1L
8
8
TMR1H
8
8
Internal Data Bus
Note 1: When enable bit, T1OSCEN, is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain.
DS39635A-page 148
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
12.2
TABLE 12-1:
Timer1 16-Bit Read/Write Mode
Timer1 can be configured for 16-bit reads and writes
(see Figure 12-2). When the RD16 control bit
(T1CON<7>) is set, the address for TMR1H is mapped
to a buffer register for the high byte of Timer1. A read
from TMR1L will load the contents of the high byte of
Timer1 into the Timer1 high byte buffer. This provides
the user with the ability to accurately read all 16 bits of
Timer1 without having to determine whether a read of
the high byte, followed by a read of the low byte, has
become invalid due to a rollover between reads.
Osc Type
LP
12.3
Timer1 Oscillator
An on-chip crystal oscillator circuit is incorporated
between pins T1OSI (input) and T1OSO (amplifier
output). It is enabled by setting the Timer1 Oscillator
Enable bit, T1OSCEN (T1CON<3>). The oscillator is a
low-power circuit rated for 32 kHz crystals. It will
continue to run during all power managed modes. The
circuit for a typical LP oscillator is shown in Figure 12-3.
Table 12-1 shows the capacitor selection for the Timer1
oscillator.
The user must provide a software time delay to ensure
proper start-up of the Timer1 oscillator.
FIGURE 12-3:
EXTERNAL
COMPONENTS FOR THE
TIMER1 LP OSCILLATOR
C1
33 pF
PIC18FXXXX
XTAL
32.768 kHz
T1OSO
C2
33 pF
Note:
See the Notes with Table 12-1 for additional
information about capacitor selection.
32 kHz
C1
27
pF(1)
C2
27 pF(1)
2: Higher capacitance increases the stability
of the oscillator, but also increases the
start-up time.
3: Since each resonator/crystal has its own
characteristics, the user should consult
the resonator/crystal manufacturer for
appropriate
values
of
external
components.
4: Capacitor values are for design guidance
only.
12.3.1
USING TIMER1 AS A CLOCK
SOURCE
The Timer1 oscillator is also available as a clock source
in power managed modes. By setting the clock select
bits, SCS1:SCS0 (OSCCON<1:0>), to ‘01’, the device
switches to SEC_RUN mode; both the CPU and
peripherals are clocked from the Timer1 oscillator. If the
IDLEN bit (OSCCON<7>) is cleared and a SLEEP
instruction is executed, the device enters SEC_IDLE
mode. Additional details are available in Section 3.0
“Power Managed Modes”.
Whenever the Timer1 oscillator is providing the clock
source, the Timer1 system clock status flag, T1RUN
(T1CON<6>), is set. This can be used to determine the
controller’s current clocking mode. It can also indicate
the clock source being currently used by the Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor. If the Clock Monitor is enabled and the
Timer1 oscillator fails while providing the clock, polling
the T1RUN bit will indicate whether the clock is being
provided by the Timer1 oscillator or another source.
12.3.2
T1OSI
Freq
Note 1: Microchip suggests these values as a
starting point in validating the oscillator
circuit.
A write to the high byte of Timer1 must also take place
through the TMR1H Buffer register. The Timer1 high
byte is updated with the contents of TMR1H when a
write occurs to TMR1L. This allows a user to write all
16 bits to both the high and low bytes of Timer1 at once.
The high byte of Timer1 is not directly readable or
writable in this mode. All reads and writes must take
place through the Timer1 High Byte Buffer register.
Writes to TMR1H do not clear the Timer1 prescaler.
The prescaler is only cleared on writes to TMR1L.
CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
THE TIMER OSCILLATOR
LOW-POWER TIMER1 OPTION
The Timer1 oscillator can operate at two distinct levels
of power consumption based on device configuration.
When the LPT1OSC configuration bit is set, the Timer1
oscillator operates in a low-power mode. When
LPT1OSC is not set, Timer1 operates at a higher power
level. Power consumption for a particular mode is relatively constant, regardless of the device’s operating
mode. The default Timer1 configuration is the higher
power mode.
As the Low-Power Timer1 mode tends to be more
sensitive to interference, high noise environments may
cause some oscillator instability. The low-power option
is therefore best suited for low noise applications where
power conservation is an important design
consideration.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 149
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
12.3.3
TIMER1 OSCILLATOR LAYOUT
CONSIDERATIONS
12.5
The Timer1 oscillator circuit draws very little power
during operation. Due to the low-power nature of the
oscillator, it may also be sensitive to rapidly changing
signals in close proximity.
The oscillator circuit, shown in Figure 12-3, should be
located as close as possible to the microcontroller.
There should be no circuits passing within the oscillator
circuit boundaries other than VSS or VDD.
If a high-speed circuit must be located near the oscillator (such as the CCP1 pin in Output Compare or PWM
mode, or the primary oscillator using the OSC2 pin), a
grounded guard ring around the oscillator circuit, as
shown in Figure 12-4, may be helpful when used on a
single sided PCB, or in addition to a ground plane.
FIGURE 12-4:
OSCILLATOR CIRCUIT
WITH GROUNDED
GUARD RING
If CCP1 or CCP2 is configured in Compare mode to
generate a special event trigger (CCP1M3:CCP1M0 or
CCP2M3:CCP2M0 = 1011), this signal will reset
Timer1. The trigger from CCP2 will also start an A/D
conversion if the A/D module is enabled (see
Section 15.3.4 “Special Event Triggers” for more
information.).
The module must be configured as either a timer or a
synchronous counter to take advantage of this feature.
When used this way, the CCPRH:CCPRL register pair
effectively becomes a period register for Timer1.
If Timer1 is running in Asynchronous Counter mode,
this Reset operation may not work.
In the event that a write to Timer1 coincides with a
special event trigger, the write operation will take
precedence.
Note:
VDD
VSS
12.6
OSC1
OSC2
The special event triggers from the CCP2
module will not set the TMR1IF interrupt
flag bit (PIR1<0>).
Using Timer1 as a
Real-Time Clock
Adding an external LP oscillator to Timer1 (such as the
one described in Section 12.3 “Timer1 Oscillator”,
above), gives users the option to include RTC functionality to their applications. This is accomplished with an
inexpensive watch crystal to provide an accurate time
base and several lines of application code to calculate
the time. When operating in Sleep mode and using a
battery or supercapacitor as a power source, it can
completely eliminate the need for a separate RTC
device and battery backup.
RC0
RC1
RC2
Note: Not drawn to scale.
12.4
Resetting Timer1 Using the CCP
Special Event Trigger
Timer1 Interrupt
The TMR1 register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) increments
from 0000h to FFFFh and rolls over to 0000h. The
Timer1 interrupt, if enabled, is generated on overflow,
which is latched in interrupt flag bit, TMR1IF
(PIR1<0>). This interrupt can be enabled or disabled
by setting or clearing the Timer1 Interrupt Enable bit,
TMR1IE (PIE1<0>).
The application code routine, RTCisr, shown in
Example 12-1, demonstrates a simple method to
increment a counter at one-second intervals using an
Interrupt Service Routine. Incrementing the TMR1 register pair to overflow triggers the interrupt and calls the
routine, which increments the seconds counter by one;
additional counters for minutes and hours are
incremented as the previous counter overflow.
Since the register pair is 16 bits wide, counting up to
overflow the register directly from a 32.768 kHz clock
would take 2 seconds. To force the overflow at the
required one-second intervals, it is necessary to
preload it; the simplest method is to set the Most Significant bit of TMR1H with a BSF instruction. Note that
the TMR1L register is never preloaded or altered; doing
so may introduce cumulative error over many cycles.
For this method to be accurate, Timer1 must operate in
Asynchronous mode and the Timer1 overflow interrupt
must be enabled (PIE1<0> = 1), as shown in the
routine RTCinit. The Timer1 oscillator must also be
enabled and running at all times.
DS39635A-page 150
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
EXAMPLE 12-1:
IMPLEMENTING A REAL-TIME CLOCK USING A TIMER1 INTERRUPT SERVICE
RTCinit
MOVLW
MOVWF
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
CLRF
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
RETURN
80h
TMR1H
TMR1L
b’00001111’
T1OSC
secs
mins
.12
hours
PIE1, TMR1IE
; Preload TMR1 register pair
; for 1 second overflow
BSF
BCF
INCF
MOVLW
CPFSGT
RETURN
CLRF
INCF
MOVLW
CPFSGT
RETURN
CLRF
INCF
MOVLW
CPFSGT
RETURN
MOVLW
MOVWF
RETURN
TMR1H, 7
PIR1, TMR1IF
secs, F
.59
secs
;
;
;
;
Preload for 1 sec overflow
Clear interrupt flag
Increment seconds
60 seconds elapsed?
;
;
;
;
No, done
Clear seconds
Increment minutes
60 minutes elapsed?
;
;
;
;
No, done
clear minutes
Increment hours
24 hours elapsed?
; Configure for external clock,
; Asynchronous operation, external oscillator
; Initialize timekeeping registers
;
; Enable Timer1 interrupt
RTCisr
TABLE 12-2:
Name
INTCON
secs
mins, F
.59
mins
mins
hours, F
.23
hours
.01
hours
; No, done
; Reset hours to 1
; Done
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1 AS A TIMER/COUNTER
Bit 7
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
IPR1
59
TMR1L
Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
58
TMR1H
Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
58
T1CON
RD16
T1RUN
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
58
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer1 module.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 151
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 152
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
13.0
TIMER2 MODULE
13.1
The Timer2 timer module incorporates the following
features:
• 8-bit timer and period registers (TMR2 and PR2,
respectively)
• Readable and writable (both registers)
• Software programmable prescaler (1:1, 1:4 and
1:16)
• Software programmable postscaler (1:1 through
1:16)
• Interrupt on TMR2-to-PR2 match
• Optional use as the shift clock for the MSSP
module
The module is controlled through the T2CON register
(Register 13-1), which enables or disables the timer
and configures the prescaler and postscaler. Timer2
can be shut off by clearing control bit, TMR2ON
(T2CON<2>), to minimize power consumption.
A simplified block diagram of the module is shown in
Figure 13-1.
Timer2 Operation
In normal operation, TMR2 is incremented from 00h on
each clock (FOSC/4). A 2-bit counter/prescaler on the
clock input gives direct input, divide-by-4 and divide-by-16
prescale options; these are selected by the prescaler
control bits, T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0 (T2CON<1:0>). The
value of TMR2 is compared to that of the period register, PR2, on each clock cycle. When the two values
match, the comparator generates a match signal as the
timer output. This signal also resets the value of TMR2
to 00h on the next cycle and drives the output counter/
postscaler (see Section 13.2 “Timer2 Interrupt”).
The TMR2 and PR2 registers are both directly readable
and writable. The TMR2 register is cleared on any
device Reset, while the PR2 register initializes at FFh.
Both the prescaler and postscaler counters are cleared
on the following events:
• a write to the TMR2 register
• a write to the T2CON register
• any device Reset (Power-on Reset, MCLR Reset,
Watchdog Timer Reset, or Brown-out Reset)
TMR2 is not cleared when T2CON is written.
REGISTER 13-1:
T2CON: TIMER2 CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
T2OUTPS3 T2OUTPS2 T2OUTPS1 T2OUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-3
T2OUTPS3:T2OUTPS0: Timer2 Output Postscale Select bits
0000 = 1:1 Postscale
0001 = 1:2 Postscale
•
•
•
1111 = 1:16 Postscale
bit 2
TMR2ON: Timer2 On bit
1 = Timer2 is on
0 = Timer2 is off
bit 1-0
T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0: Timer2 Clock Prescale Select bits
00 = Prescaler is 1
01 = Prescaler is 4
1x = Prescaler is 16
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 153
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
13.2
Timer2 Interrupt
13.3
Timer2 also can generate an optional device interrupt.
The Timer2 output signal (TMR2-to-PR2 match) provides the input for the 4-bit output counter/postscaler.
This counter generates the TMR2 match interrupt flag
which is latched in TMR2IF (PIR1<1>). The interrupt is
enabled by setting the TMR2 Match Interrupt Enable
bit, TMR2IE (PIE1<1>).
TMR2 Output
The unscaled output of TMR2 is available primarily to
the CCP modules, where it is used as a time base for
operations in PWM mode.
Timer2 can be optionally used as the shift clock source
for the MSSP module operating in SPI mode. Additional information is provided in Section 16.0 “Master
Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) Module”.
A range of 16 postscale options (from 1:1 through 1:16
inclusive) can be selected with the postscaler control
bits, T2OUTPS3:T2OUTPS0 (T2CON<6:3>).
FIGURE 13-1:
TIMER2 BLOCK DIAGRAM
4
1:1 to 1:16
Postscaler
T2OUTPS3:T2OUTPS0
Set TMR2IF
2
TMR2 Output
(to PWM or MSSP)
T2CKPS1:T2CKPS0
1:1, 1:4, 1:16
Prescaler
FOSC/4
TMR2/PR2
Match
Reset
TMR2
Comparator
8
PR2
8
8
Internal Data Bus
TABLE 13-1:
Name
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER2 AS A TIMER/COUNTER
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
INTCON GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
TMR2
T2CON
PR2
Timer2 Module Register
—
58
T2OUTPS3 T2OUTPS2 T2OUTPS1 T2OUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
Timer2 Period Register
58
58
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer2 module.
DS39635A-page 154
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
14.0
TIMER3 MODULE
The Timer3 timer/counter module incorporates these
features:
• Software selectable operation as a 16-bit timer or
counter
• Readable and writable 8-bit registers (TMR3H
and TMR3L)
• Selectable clock source (internal or external), with
device clock or Timer1 oscillator internal options
• Interrupt-on-overflow
• Module Reset on CCP special event trigger
REGISTER 14-1:
A simplified block diagram of the Timer3 module is
shown in Figure 14-1. A block diagram of the module’s
operation in Read/Write mode is shown in Figure 14-2.
The Timer3 module is controlled through the T3CON
register (Register 14-1). It also selects the clock source
options for the CCP modules (see Section 15.1.1
“CCP Modules and Timer Resources” for more
information).
T3CON: TIMER3 CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
RD16
R/W-0
T3CCP2
R/W-0
T3CKPS1
R/W-0
T3CKPS0
R/W-0
T3CCP1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
T3SYNC
TMR3CS
TMR3ON
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
RD16: 16-bit Read/Write Mode Enable bit
1 = Enables register read/write of Timer3 in one 16-bit operation
0 = Enables register read/write of Timer3 in two 8-bit operations
bit 6, 3
T3CCP2:T3CCCP1: Timer3 and Timer1 to CCPx Enable bits
11 = Timer3 is the clock source for compare/capture of all CCP modules
10 = Timer3 is the clock source for compare/capture of CCP3,
Timer1 is the clock source for compare/capture of CCP1 and CCP2
01 = Timer3 is the clock source for compare/capture of CCP2 and CCP3,
Timer1 is the clock source for compare/capture of CCP1
00 = Timer1 is the clock source for compare/capture of all CCP modules
bit 5-4
T3CKPS1:T3CKPS0: Timer3 Input Clock Prescale Select bits
11 = 1:8 Prescale value
10 = 1:4 Prescale value
01 = 1:2 Prescale value
00 = 1:1 Prescale value
bit 2
T3SYNC: Timer3 External Clock Input Synchronization Control bit
(Not usable if the device clock comes from Timer1/Timer3.)
When TMR3CS = 1:
1 = Do not synchronize external clock input
0 = Synchronize external clock input
When TMR3CS = 0:
This bit is ignored. Timer3 uses the internal clock when TMR3CS = 0.
bit 1
TMR3CS: Timer3 Clock Source Select bit
1 = External clock input from Timer1 oscillator or T13CKI (on the rising edge after the
first falling edge)
0 = Internal clock (FOSC/4)
bit 0
TMR3ON: Timer3 On bit
1 = Enables Timer3
0 = Stops Timer3
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 155
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
14.1
Timer3 Operation
cycle (FOSC/4). When the bit is set, Timer3 increments
on every rising edge of the Timer1 external clock input
or the Timer1 oscillator, if enabled.
Timer3 can operate in one of three modes:
• Timer
• Synchronous counter
• Asynchronous counter
As with Timer1, the RC1/T1OSI and RC0/T1OSO/
T13CKI pins become inputs when the Timer1 oscillator
is enabled. This means the values of TRISC<1:0> are
ignored and the pins are read as ‘0’.
The operating mode is determined by the clock select
bit, TMR3CS (T3CON<1>). When TMR3CS is cleared
(= 0), Timer3 increments on every internal instruction
FIGURE 14-1:
TIMER3 BLOCK DIAGRAM
Timer1 Oscillator
1
T1OSO/T13CKI
1
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
T1OSI
Synchronize
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
0
Detect
0
2
T1OSCEN(1)
Sleep Input
Timer3
On/Off
TMR3CS
T3CKPS1:T3CKPS0
T3SYNC
TMR3ON
CCP1/CCP2 Special Event Trigger
TCCPx
Clear TMR3
Set
TMR3IF
on Overflow
TMR3
High Byte
TMR3L
Note 1: When enable bit, T1OSCEN, is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain.
FIGURE 14-2:
TIMER3 BLOCK DIAGRAM (16-BIT READ/WRITE MODE)
Timer1 Oscillator
Timer1 clock input
1
T1OSO/T13CKI
1
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
T1OSI
Synchronize
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
0
Detect
0
2
T1OSCEN(1)
Sleep Input
Timer3
On/Off
TMR3CS
T3CKPS1:T3CKPS0
T3SYNC
TMR3ON
CCP1/CCP2 Special Event Trigger
TCCPx
Clear TMR3
Set
TMR3IF
on Overflow
TMR3
High Byte
TMR3L
8
Read TMR3L
Write TMR3L
8
8
TMR3H
8
8
Internal Data Bus
Note 1: When enable bit, T1OSCEN, is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain.
DS39635A-page 156
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
14.2
Timer3 16-Bit Read/Write Mode
14.4
Timer3 Interrupt
Timer3 can be configured for 16-bit reads and writes
(see Figure 14-2). When the RD16 control bit
(T3CON<7>) is set, the address for TMR3H is mapped
to a buffer register for the high byte of Timer3. A read
from TMR3L will load the contents of the high byte of
Timer3 into the Timer3 High Byte Buffer register. This
provides the user with the ability to accurately read all
16 bits of Timer1 without having to determine whether
a read of the high byte, followed by a read of the low
byte, has become invalid due to a rollover between
reads.
The TMR3 register pair (TMR3H:TMR3L) increments
from 0000h to FFFFh and overflows to 0000h. The
Timer3 interrupt, if enabled, is generated on overflow
and is latched in interrupt flag bit, TMR3IF (PIR2<1>).
This interrupt can be enabled or disabled by setting or
clearing the Timer3 Interrupt Enable bit, TMR3IE
(PIE2<1>).
A write to the high byte of Timer3 must also take place
through the TMR3H Buffer register. The Timer3 high
byte is updated with the contents of TMR3H when a
write occurs to TMR3L. This allows a user to write all
16 bits to both the high and low bytes of Timer3 at once.
If either the CCP1 or CCP2 modules is configured to
generate a special event trigger in Compare mode
(CCP1M3:CCP1M0 or CCP2M3:CCP2M0 = 1011), this
signal will reset Timer3. The trigger of CCP2 will also
start an A/D conversion if the A/D module is enabled
(see Section 15.3.4 “Special Event Triggers” for more
information).
The high byte of Timer3 is not directly readable or
writable in this mode. All reads and writes must take
place through the Timer3 High Byte Buffer register.
14.5
Resetting Timer3 Using the CCP
Special Event Trigger
Writes to TMR3H do not clear the Timer3 prescaler.
The prescaler is only cleared on writes to TMR3L.
The module must be configured as either a timer or
synchronous counter to take advantage of this feature.
When used this way, the CCPR2H:CCPR2L register
pair effectively becomes a period register for Timer3.
14.3
If Timer3 is running in Asynchronous Counter mode,
the Reset operation may not work.
Using the Timer1 Oscillator as the
Timer3 Clock Source
The Timer1 internal oscillator may be used as the clock
source for Timer3. The Timer1 oscillator is enabled by
setting the T1OSCEN (T1CON<3>) bit. To use it as the
Timer3 clock source, the TMR3CS bit must also be set.
As previously noted, this also configures Timer3 to
increment on every rising edge of the oscillator source.
In the event that a write to Timer3 coincides with a
special event trigger from a CCP module, the write will
take precedence.
Note:
The special event triggers from the CCP2
module will not set the TMR3IF interrupt
flag bit (PIR1<0>).
The Timer1 oscillator is described in Section 12.0
“Timer1 Module”.
TABLE 14-1:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER3 AS A TIMER/COUNTER
Bit 7
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR2
OSCFIF
CMIF
—
—
BCLIF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
CCP2IF
59
PIE2
OSCFIE
CMIE
—
—
BCLIE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
CCP2IE
59
IPR2
OSCFIP
CMIP
—
—
BCLIP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
CCP2IP
59
TMR3L
Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR3 Register
59
TMR3H
Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR3 Register
59
T1CON
RD16
T1RUN
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
58
T3CON
RD16
T3CCP2
T3CKPS1 T3CKPS0
TMR3CS
TMR3ON
59
T3CCP1
T3SYNC
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Timer3 module.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 157
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 158
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
15.0
CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM
(CCP) MODULES
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices have three CCP
(Capture/Compare/PWM) modules, labelled CCP1,
CCP2 and CCP3. All modules implement standard
Capture, Compare and Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM)
modes.
REGISTER 15-1:
Each CCP module contains a 16-bit register which can
operate as a 16-bit Capture register, a 16-bit Compare
register or a PWM Master/Slave Duty Cycle register.
For the sake of clarity, all CCP module operation in the
following sections is described with respect to CCP2,
but are equally applicable to CCP1 and CCP3.
CCPXCON: CCP1/CCP2/CCP3 CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
DCxB1
DCxB0
CCPxM3
CCPxM2
R/W-0
R/W-0
CCPxM1 CCPxM0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-4
DCxB1:DCxB0: PWM Duty Cycle bit 1 and bit 0 for CCP Module x
Capture mode:
Unused.
Compare mode:
Unused.
PWM mode:
These bits are the two Least Significant bits (bit 1 and bit 0) of the 10-bit PWM Duty Cycle
register. The eight Most Significant bits (DCx9:DCx2) of the PWM Duty Cycle are found in
CCPRxL.
bit 3-0
CCPxM3:CCPxM0: CCP Module x Mode Select bits
0000 = Capture/Compare/PWM disabled (resets CCPx module)
0001 = Reserved
0010 = Compare mode, toggle output on match (CCPxIF bit is set)
0011 = Reserved
0100 = Capture mode, every falling edge
0101 = Capture mode, every rising edge
0110 = Capture mode, every 4th rising edge
0111 = Capture mode, every 16th rising edge
1000 = Compare mode: initialize CCP pin low; on compare match, force CCP pin high
(CCPIF bit is set)
1001 = Compare mode: initialize CCP pin high; on compare match, force CCP pin low
(CCPIF bit is set)
1010 = Compare mode: generate software interrupt on compare match (CCPIF bit is set,
CCP pin reflects I/O state)
1011 = Compare mode: trigger special event, reset timer, start A/D conversion on
CCP2 match (CCPIF bit is set)(1,2)
11xx = PWM mode
Note 1: The special event trigger on CCP1 will reset the timer but not start an A/D
conversion on a CCP1 match.
2: For CCP3, the special event trigger is not available. This mode functions the same
as Compare Generate Interrupt mode (CCP3M3:CCP3M0 = 1010).
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 159
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
15.1
CCP Module Configuration
Each Capture/Compare/PWM module is associated
with a control register (generically, CCPxCON) and a
data register (CCPRx). The data register, in turn, is
comprised of two 8-bit registers: CCPRxL (low byte)
and CCPRxH (high byte). All registers are both
readable and writable.
15.1.1
CCP MODULES AND TIMER
RESOURCES
CCP MODE – TIMER
RESOURCE
CCP Mode
Timer Resource
Capture
Compare
PWM
Timer1 or Timer3
Timer1 or Timer3
Timer2
The CCP2MX configuration bit determines if CCP2 is
multiplexed to its default or alternate assignment. By
default, CCP2 is assigned to RC1 (CCP2MX = 1). If
CCP2MX is cleared, CCP2 is multiplexed with either
RE7 or RB3 (RE7 is the only alternative assignment for
64-pin devices).
Changing the pin assignment of CCP2 does not automatically change any requirements for configuring the
port pin. Users must always verify that the appropriate
TRIS register is configured correctly for CCP2
operation, regardless of where it is located.
CCP AND TIMER INTERCONNECT CONFIGURATIONS
T3CCP2:TCCP1 = 00
TMR1
CCP2 PIN ASSIGNMENT
For any device in Microcontroller mode, the alternate
CCP2 assignment is RE7. For 80-pin devices in
Microcprocessor, Extended Microcontroller or Microcontroller with Boot Block mode, the alternate assignment is
RB3. Note that RE7 is the only alternative assignment for
64-pin devices.
The assignment of a particular timer to a module is
determined by the Timer-to-CCP enable bits in the
T3CON register (Register 14-1). All three modules may
be active at any given time and may share the same
FIGURE 15-1:
Depending on the configuration selected, up to three
timers may be active at once, with modules in the same
configuration (Capture/Compare or PWM) sharing
timer resources. The possible configurations are
shown in Figure 15-1.
15.1.2
The CCP modules utilize Timers 1, 2 or 3, depending
on the mode selected. Timer1 and Timer3 are available
to modules in Capture or Compare modes, while
Timer2 is available for modules in PWM mode.
TABLE 15-1:
timer resource if they are configured to operate in the
same mode (Capture/Compare or PWM) at the same
time.
TMR3
CCP1
T3CCP2:TCCP1 = 01
TMR1
TMR3
CCP1
CCP2
CCP2
CCP3
CCP3
TMR2
Timer1 is used for all
Capture and Compare
operations for all three
CCP modules. Timer2
is used for PWM operations for all three CCP
modules. Timer3 is not
used.
All modules may share
Timer1 and Timer2
resources as common
time bases.
DS39635A-page 160
T3CCP2:TCCP1 = 10
TMR1
TMR3
T3CCP2:TCCP1 = 11
TMR1
TMR3
CCP1
CCP1
CCP2
CCP2
CCP3
TMR2
TMR2
Timer1 is used for
Capture and Compare
operations for CCP1
and Timer 3 is used for
CCP2 and CCP3.
Timer1 is used for
Capture and Compare
operations for CCP1
and CCP2. Timer 3 is
used for CCP3.
All three modules
share Timer2 as a
common time base for
PWM operation.
All three modules
share Timer2 as a
common time base for
PWM operation.
Preliminary
CCP3
TMR2
Timer3 is used for all
Capture and Compare
operations for all three
CCP modules. Timer2
is used for PWM operations for all three CCP
modules. Timer1 is not
used.
All modules may share
Timer2 and Timer3
resources as common
time bases.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
15.2
15.2.1
Capture Mode
In Capture mode, the appropriate CCPx pin should be
configured as an input by setting the corresponding
TRIS direction bit.
In Capture mode, the CCPR2H:CCPR2L register pair
captures the 16-bit value of the TMR1 or TMR3
registers when an event occurs on the CCP2 pin (RC1
or RE7, depending on device configuration). An event
is defined as one of the following:
•
•
•
•
Note:
every falling edge
every rising edge
every 4th rising edge
every 16th rising edge
15.2.2
If RC1/CCP2 or RE7/CCP2 is configured
as an output, a write to the port can cause
a capture condition.
TIMER1/TIMER3 MODE SELECTION
The timers that are to be used with the capture feature
(Timer1 and/or Timer3) must be running in Timer mode
or Synchronized Counter mode. In Asynchronous
Counter mode, the capture operation may not work. The
timer to be used with each CCP module is selected in the
T3CON register (see Section 15.1.1 “CCP Modules
and Timer Resources”).
The event is selected by the mode select bits,
CCP2M3:CCP2M0 (CCP2CON<3:0>). When a capture is made, the interrupt request flag bit, CCP2IF
(PIR2<1>), is set; it must be cleared in software. If
another capture occurs before the value in register
CCPR2 is read, the old captured value is overwritten by
the new captured value.
FIGURE 15-2:
CCP PIN CONFIGURATION
CAPTURE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM
TMR3H
TMR3L
Set CCP1IF
T3CCP2
CCP1 pin
Prescaler
÷ 1, 4, 16
and
Edge Detect
CCPR1H
T3CCP2
4
CCP1CON<3:0>
Q1:Q4
4
TMR1
Enable
TMR1H
TMR1L
TMR3H
TMR3L
Set CCP2IF
T3CCP1
CCP2 pin
Prescaler
÷ 1, 4, 16
and
Edge Detect
TMR3
Enable
CCPR2H
T3CCP1
CCP3CON<3:0>
CCPR1L
4
CCP2CON<3:0>
Q1:Q4
TMR3
Enable
CCPR2L
TMR1
Enable
TMR1H
TMR1L
TMR3H
TMR3L
Set CCP3IF
4
4
T3CCP1
T3CCP2
TMR3
Enable
CCP3 pin
Prescaler
÷ 1, 4, 16
and
Edge Detect
CCPR3H
CCPR3L
TMR1
Enable
T3CCP2
T3CCP1
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
TMR1H
TMR1L
DS39635A-page 161
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
15.2.3
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT
15.3.1
When the Capture mode is changed, a false capture
interrupt may be generated. The user should keep bit
CCP2IE (PIE2<1>) clear to avoid false interrupts and
should clear the flag bit, CCP2IF, following any such
change in operating mode.
15.2.4
Switching from one capture prescaler to another may
generate an interrupt. Also, the prescaler counter will
not be cleared, therefore, the first capture may be from
a non-zero prescaler. Example 15-1 shows the
recommended method for switching between capture
prescalers. This example also clears the prescaler
counter and will not generate the “false” interrupt.
EXAMPLE 15-1:
CLRF
MOVLW
MOVWF
15.3
CHANGING BETWEEN
CAPTURE PRESCALERS
CCP2CON
; Turn CCP module off
NEW_CAPT_PS ; Load WREG with the
; new prescaler mode
; value and CCP ON
CCP2CON
; Load CCP2CON with
; this value
Compare Mode
In Compare mode, the 16-bit CCPR2 register value is
constantly compared against either the TMR1 or TMR3
register pair value. When a match occurs, the CCP2
pin can be:
•
•
•
•
The user must configure the CCPx pin as an output by
clearing the appropriate TRIS bit.
Note:
CCP PRESCALER
There are four prescaler settings in Capture mode; they
are specified as part of the operating mode selected by
the mode select bits (CCP2M3:CCP2M0). Whenever
the CCP module is turned off, or the CCP module is not
in Capture mode, the prescaler counter is cleared. This
means that any Reset will clear the prescaler counter.
driven high
driven low
toggled (high-to-low or low-to-high)
remain unchanged (that is, reflects the state of the
I/O latch)
The action on the pin is based on the value of the mode
select bits (CCP2M3:CCP2M0). At the same time, the
interrupt flag bit, CCP2IF, is set.
DS39635A-page 162
CCP PIN CONFIGURATION
15.3.2
Clearing the CCP2CON register will force
the RC1 or RE7 compare output latch
(depending on device configuration) to the
default low level. This is not the PORTC or
PORTE I/O data latch.
TIMER1/TIMER3 MODE SELECTION
Timer1 and/or Timer3 must be running in Timer mode,
or Synchronized Counter mode, if the CCP module is
using the compare feature. In Asynchronous Counter
mode, the compare operation may not work.
15.3.3
SOFTWARE INTERRUPT MODE
When the Generate Software Interrupt mode is chosen
(CCP2M3:CCP2M0 = 1010), the CCP2 pin is not
affected. Only a CCP interrupt is generated if enabled
and the CCP2IE bit is set.
15.3.4
SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGERS
CCP1 and CCP2 are both equipped with a special
event trigger. This is an internal hardware signal,
generated in Compare mode, to trigger actions by other
modules. The special event trigger is enabled by
selecting the Compare Special Event Trigger mode
(CCP2M3:CCP2M0 = 1011).
For either CCP module, the special event trigger resets
the timer register pair for whichever timer resource is
currently assigned as the module’s time base. This
allows the CCPRx registers to serve as a programmable
period register for either timer.
The special event trigger for CCP2 can also start an
A/D conversion. In order to do this, the A/D converter
must already be enabled.
Note:
The special event trigger of CCP1 only
resets Timer1/Timer3 and cannot start an
A/D conversion even when the A/D
converter is enabled.
CCP3 is not equipped with a special event trigger.
Selecting the Compare Special Event Trigger mode for
this device (CCP3M3:CCP3M0 = 1011) is functionally
the same as selecting the Generate Software Interrupt
mode (CCP3M3:CCP3M0 = 1010).
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 15-3:
COMPARE MODE OPERATION BLOCK DIAGRAM
Special Event Trigger
(Timer1/Timer3 Reset)
T3CCP2
Comparator
1
CCPR1H
TMR1H
TMR1L
T3CCP1
TMR3H
TMR3L
0
CCP1 pin
Set CCP1IF
0
Output
Logic
Compare
Match
S
Q
R
TRIS
Output Enable
4
CCP1CON<3:0>
CCPR1L
Special Event Trigger
(Timer1/Timer3 Reset, A/D Trigger)
Set CCP2IF
Comparator
1
CCPR2H
Compare
Match
CCP2 pin
Output
Logic
S
Q
R
TRIS
Output Enable
4
CCP2CON<3:0>
CCPR2L
T3CCP1
T3CCP2
Set CCP3IF
0
Comparator
1
CCPR3H
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Compare
Match
CCPR3L
Preliminary
CCP3 pin
Output
Logic
4
CCP3CON<3:0>
S
Q
R
TRIS
Output Enable
DS39635A-page 163
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 15-2:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH CAPTURE, COMPARE, TIMER1 AND TIMER3
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
RCON
IPEN
SBOREN
—
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
58
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
PIR2
OSCFIF
CMIF
—
—
BCLIF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
CCP2IF
59
PIE2
OSCFIE
CMIE
—
—
BCLIE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
CCP2IE
59
IPR2
OSCFIP
CMIP
—
—
BCLIP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
CCP2IP
59
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
59
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
59
IPR3
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
59
TRISB
PORTB Data Direction Register
60
TRISC
PORTC Data Direction Register
60
TRISE
PORTE Data Direction Register
60
TMR1L
Holding Register for the Least Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
58
TMR1H
Holding Register for the Most Significant Byte of the 16-bit TMR1 Register
58
T1CON
RD16
T1RUN
T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC
TMR3H
Timer3 Register High Byte
TMR3L
Timer3 Register Low Byte
T3CON
RD16
T3CCP2
TMR1CS TMR1ON
58
59
59
T3CKPS1 T3CKPS0
T3CCP1
T3SYNC
TMR3CS TMR3ON
59
CCPR1L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 (LSB)
59
CCPR1H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 (MSB)
59
—
CCP1CON
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
CCPR2L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 2 (LSB)
CCPR2H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 2 (MSB)
—
CCP2CON
—
DC2B1
DC2B0
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1
CCP1M0
59
59
59
CCP2M3
CCP2M2
CCP2M1
CCP2M0
59
CCPR3L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 3 (LSB)
59
CCPR3H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 3 (MSB)
59
CCP3CON
—
—
DC3B1
DC3B0
CCP3M3
CCP3M2
CCP3M1
CCP3M0
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by Capture/Compare, Timer1 or Timer3.
Note 1: These bits are unimplemented on 64-pin devices; always maintain these bits clear.
DS39635A-page 164
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
15.4
PWM Mode
In Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) mode, the CCP2 pin
produces up to a 10-bit resolution PWM output. Since
the CCP2 pin is multiplexed with a PORTC or PORTE
data latch, the appropriate TRIS bit must be cleared to
make the CCP2 pin an output.
A PWM output (Figure 15-5) has a time base (period)
and a time that the output stays high (duty cycle). The
frequency of the PWM is the inverse of the period
(1/period).
FIGURE 15-5:
PWM OUTPUT
Period
Note:
Clearing the CCP2CON register will force
the RC1 or RE7 output latch (depending
on device configuration) to the default low
level. This is not the PORTC or PORTE
I/O data latch.
Duty Cycle
TMR2 = PR2
Figure 15-4 shows a simplified block diagram of the
CCP module in PWM mode.
For a step-by-step procedure on how to set up the CCP
module for PWM operation, see Section 15.4.3
“Setup for Pwm Operation”.
FIGURE 15-4:
SIMPLIFIED PWM BLOCK
DIAGRAM
Duty Cycle Registers
TMR2 = Duty Cycle
TMR2 = PR2
15.4.1
PWM PERIOD
The PWM period is specified by writing to the PR2
register. The PWM period can be calculated using the
following formula:
CCP1CON<5:4>
EQUATION 15-1:
CCPR1L
PWM Period = (PR2) + 1] • 4 • TOSC •
(TMR2 Prescale Value)
PWM frequency is defined as 1/[PWM period].
CCPR1H (Slave)
R
Comparator
When TMR2 is equal to PR2, the following three events
occur on the next increment cycle:
Q
RC2/CCP1
TMR2
(Note 1)
S
TRISC<2>
Comparator
PR2
Clear Timer,
CCP1 pin and
latch D.C.
• TMR2 is cleared
• The CCP2 pin is set (exception: if PWM duty
cycle = 0%, the CCP2 pin will not be set)
• The PWM duty cycle is latched from CCPR2L into
CCPR2H
Note:
Note 1: The 8-bit TMR2 value is concatenated with the 2-bit
internal Q clock, or 2 bits of the prescaler, to create the
10-bit time base.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
The Timer2 postscalers (see Section 13.0
“Timer2 Module”) are not used in the
determination of the PWM frequency. The
postscaler could be used to have a servo
update rate at a different frequency than
the PWM output.
DS39635A-page 165
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
15.4.2
PWM DUTY CYCLE
The PWM duty cycle is specified by writing to the
CCPR2L register and to the CCP2CON<5:4> bits. Up
to 10-bit resolution is available. The CCPR2L contains
the eight MSbs and the CCP2CON<5:4> contains the
two LSbs. This 10-bit value is represented by
CCPR2L:CCP2CON<5:4>. The following equation is
used to calculate the PWM duty cycle in time:
The maximum PWM resolution (bits) for a given PWM
frequency is given by the equation:
EQUATION 15-3:
F OSC
log  ---------------
 F PWM
PWM Resolution (max) = -----------------------------bits
log ( 2 )
Note:
EQUATION 15-2:
PWM Duty Cycle = (CCPR2L:CCP2CON<5:4>) •
TOSC • (TMR2 Prescale Value)
CCPR2L and CCP2CON<5:4> can be written to at any
time, but the duty cycle value is not latched into
CCPR2H until after a match between PR2 and TMR2
occurs (i.e., the period is complete). In PWM mode,
CCPR2H is a read-only register.
The CCPR2H register and a 2-bit internal latch are
used to double-buffer the PWM duty cycle. This
double-buffering is essential for glitchless PWM
operation.
When the CCPR2H and 2-bit latch match TMR2,
concatenated with an internal 2-bit Q clock or 2 bits of
the TMR2 prescaler, the CCP2 pin is cleared.
TABLE 15-3:
15.4.3
If the PWM duty cycle value is longer than
the PWM period, the CCP2 pin will not be
cleared.
SETUP FOR PWM OPERATION
The following steps should be taken when configuring
the CCP module for PWM operation:
1.
Set the PWM period by writing to the PR2
register.
Set the PWM duty cycle by writing to the
CCPR2L register and CCP2CON<5:4> bits.
Make the CCP2 pin an output by clearing the
appropriate TRIS bit.
Set the TMR2 prescale value, then enable
Timer2 by writing to T2CON.
Configure the CCP2 module for PWM operation.
2.
3.
4.
5.
EXAMPLE PWM FREQUENCIES AND RESOLUTIONS AT 40 MHz
PWM Frequency
Timer Prescaler (1, 4, 16)
PR2 Value
Maximum Resolution (bits)
DS39635A-page 166
2.44 kHz
9.77 kHz
39.06 kHz
156.25 kHz
312.50 kHz
416.67 kHz
16
4
1
1
1
1
FFh
FFh
FFh
3Fh
1Fh
17h
14
12
10
8
7
6.58
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 15-4:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PWM AND TIMER2
Bit 7
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
RCON
IPEN
SBOREN
—
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
58
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
TRISB
PORTB Data Direction Register
60
TRISC
PORTC Data Direction Register
60
TRISE
PORTE Data Direction Register
60
TMR2
Timer2 Module Register
58
PR2
Timer2 Module Period Register
T2CON
—
58
T2OUTPS3 T2OUTPS2 T2OUTPS1 T2OUTPS0 TMR2ON T2CKPS1 T2CKPS0
58
CCPR1L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 (LSB)
59
CCPR1H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 1 (MSB)
59
CCP1CON
—
—
DC1B1
DC1B0
CCPR2L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 2 (LSB)
CCPR2H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 2 (MSB)
CCP2CON
—
—
DC2B1
DC2B0
CCP1M3
CCP1M2
CCP1M1 CCP1M0
59
59
59
CCP2M3
CCP2M2
CCP2M1 CCP2M0
59
CCPR3L
Capture/Compare/PWM Register 3 (LSB)
59
CCPR3H
Capture/Compare/PWM Register3 (MSB)
59
CCP3CON
—
—
DC3B1
DC3B0
CCP3M3
CCP3M2
CCP3M1 CCP3M0
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PWM or Timer2.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 167
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 168
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.0
16.1
MASTER SYNCHRONOUS
SERIAL PORT (MSSP)
MODULE
16.3
SPI Mode
The SPI mode allows 8 bits of data to be synchronously
transmitted and received simultaneously. All four
modes of SPI are supported. To accomplish
communication, typically three pins are used:
Master SSP (MSSP) Module
Overview
The Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP) module is
a serial interface, useful for communicating with other
peripheral or microcontroller devices. These peripheral
devices may be serial EEPROMs, shift registers, display drivers, A/D converters, etc. The MSSP module
can operate in one of two modes:
• Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
• Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C)
- Full Master mode
- Slave mode (with general address call)
• Serial Data Out (SDO) – RC5/SDO
• Serial Data In (SDI) – RC4/SDI/SDA
• Serial Clock (SCK) – RC3/SCK/SCL
Additionally, a fourth pin may be used when in a Slave
mode of operation:
• Slave Select (SS) – RF7/SS
Figure 16-1 shows the block diagram of the MSSP
module when operating in SPI mode.
FIGURE 16-1:
MSSP BLOCK DIAGRAM
(SPI™ MODE)
The I2C interface supports the following modes in
hardware:
Internal
Data Bus
Read
• Master mode
• Multi-Master mode
• Slave mode
16.2
Write
SSPBUF reg
Control Registers
RC4/SDI/SDA
The MSSP module has three associated registers.
These include a status register (SSPSTAT) and two
control registers (SSPCON1 and SSPCON2). The use
of these registers and their individual configuration bits
differ significantly depending on whether the MSSP
module is operated in SPI or I2C mode.
SSPSR reg
RC5/SDO
RF7/SS
Additional details are provided under the individual
sections.
Shift
Clock
bit 0
SS Control
Enable
Edge
Select
2
Clock Select
RC3/SCK/
SCL
SSPM3:SSPM0
SMP:CKE 4
TMR2 Output
2
2
Edge
Select
Prescaler TOSC
4, 16, 64
(
)
Data to TX/RX in SSPSR
TRIS bit
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 169
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.3.1
REGISTERS
The MSSP module has four registers for SPI mode
operation. These are:
•
•
•
•
MSSP Control Register 1 (SSPCON1)
MSSP Status Register (SSPSTAT)
Serial Receive/Transmit Buffer Register (SSPBUF)
MSSP Shift Register (SSPSR) – Not directly
accessible
SSPCON1 and SSPSTAT are the control and status
registers in SPI mode operation. The SSPCON1
register is readable and writable. The lower 6 bits of
the SSPSTAT are read-only. The upper 2 bits of the
SSPSTAT are read/write.
REGISTER 16-1:
SSPSR is the shift register used for shifting data in or
out. SSPBUF is the buffer register to which data bytes
are written to or read from.
In receive operations, SSPSR and SSPBUF together
create a double-buffered receiver. When SSPSR
receives a complete byte, it is transferred to SSPBUF
and the SSPIF interrupt is set.
During transmission, the SSPBUF is not doublebuffered. A write to SSPBUF will write to both SSPBUF
and SSPSR.
SSPSTAT: MSSP STATUS REGISTER (SPI MODE)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
R-0
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
SMP: Sample bit
SPI Master mode:
1 = Input data sampled at end of data output time
0 = Input data sampled at middle of data output time
SPI Slave mode:
SMP must be cleared when SPI is used in Slave mode.
bit 6
CKE: SPI Clock Edge Select bit
When CKP = 0:
1 = Data transmitted on rising edge of SCK
0 = Data transmitted on falling edge of SCK
When CKP = 1:
1 = Data transmitted on falling edge of SCK
0 = Data transmitted on rising edge of SCK
bit 5
D/A: Data/Address bit
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 4
P: Stop bit
Used in I2C mode only. This bit is cleared when the MSSP module is disabled, SSPEN is
cleared.
bit 3
S: Start bit
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 2
R/W: Read/Write bit Information
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 1
UA: Update Address bit
Used in I2C mode only.
bit 0
BF: Buffer Full Status bit (Receive mode only)
1 = Receive complete, SSPBUF is full
0 = Receive not complete, SSPBUF is empty
Legend:
DS39635A-page 170
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 16-2:
SSPCON1: MSSP CONTROL REGISTER 1 (SPI MODE)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
WCOL
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
SSPM3
SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
WCOL: Write Collision Detect bit (Transmit mode only)
1 = The SSPBUF register is written while it is still transmitting the previous word
(must be cleared in software)
0 = No collision
bit 6
SSPOV: Receive Overflow Indicator bit
SPI Slave mode:
1 = A new byte is received while the SSPBUF register is still holding the previous data. In case
of overflow, the data in SSPSR is lost. Overflow can only occur in Slave mode. The user
must read the SSPBUF, even if only transmitting data, to avoid setting overflow (must be
cleared in software).
0 = No overflow
Note:
bit 5
In Master mode, the overflow bit is not set, since each new reception (and
transmission) is initiated by writing to the SSPBUF register.
SSPEN: Synchronous Serial Port Enable bit
1 = Enables serial port and configures SCK, SDO, SDI and SS as serial port pins
0 = Disables serial port and configures these pins as I/O port pins
Note:
When enabled, these pins must be properly configured as input or output.
bit 4
CKP: Clock Polarity Select bit
1 = Idle state for clock is a high level
0 = Idle state for clock is a low level
bit 3-0
SSPM3:SSPM0: Synchronous Serial Port Mode Select bits
0101 = SPI Slave mode, clock = SCK pin, SS pin control disabled, SS can be used as I/O pin
0100 = SPI Slave mode, clock = SCK pin, SS pin control enabled
0011 = SPI Master mode, clock = TMR2 output/2
0010 = SPI Master mode, clock = FOSC/64
0001 = SPI Master mode, clock = FOSC/16
0000 = SPI Master mode, clock = FOSC/4
Note:
Bit combinations not specifically listed here are either reserved or implemented in
I2C mode only.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 171
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.3.2
OPERATION
When initializing the SPI, several options need to be
specified. This is done by programming the appropriate
control bits (SSPCON1<5:0> and SSPSTAT<7:6>).
These control bits allow the following to be specified:
•
•
•
•
Master mode (SCK is the clock output)
Slave mode (SCK is the clock input)
Clock Polarity (Idle state of SCK)
Data Input Sample Phase (middle or end of data
output time)
• Clock Edge (output data on rising/falling edge of
SCK)
• Clock Rate (Master mode only)
• Slave Select mode (Slave mode only)
The MSSP consists of a transmit/receive shift register
(SSPSR) and a buffer register (SSPBUF). The SSPSR
shifts the data in and out of the device, MSb first. The
SSPBUF holds the data that was written to the SSPSR
until the received data is ready. Once the 8 bits of data
have been received, that byte is moved to the SSPBUF
register. Then, the Buffer Full detect bit, BF
(SSPSTAT<0>) and the interrupt flag bit, SSPIF, are
set. This double-buffering of the received data
(SSPBUF) allows the next byte to start reception before
EXAMPLE 16-1:
LOOP
reading the data that was just received. Any write to the
SSPBUF register during transmission/reception of data
will be ignored and the write collision detect bit, WCOL
(SSPCON1<7>), will be set. User software must clear
the WCOL bit so that it can be determined if the following write(s) to the SSPBUF register completed
successfully.
When the application software is expecting to receive
valid data, the SSPBUF should be read before the next
byte of data to transfer is written to the SSPBUF. The
Buffer Full bit, BF (SSPSTAT<0>), indicates when
SSPBUF has been loaded with the received data
(transmission is complete). When the SSPBUF is read,
the BF bit is cleared. This data may be irrelevant if the
SPI is only a transmitter. Generally, the MSSP interrupt
is used to determine when the transmission/reception
has completed. The SSPBUF must be read and/or
written. If the interrupt method is not going to be used,
then software polling can be done to ensure that a write
collision does not occur. Example 16-1 shows the
loading of the SSPBUF (SSPSR) for data transmission.
The SSPSR is not directly readable or writable and can
only be accessed by addressing the SSPBUF register.
Additionally, the MSSP Status register (SSPSTAT)
indicates the various status conditions.
LOADING THE SSPBUF (SSPSR) REGISTER
BTFSS
BRA
MOVF
SSPSTAT, BF
LOOP
SSPBUF, W
;Has data been received (transmit complete)?
;No
;WREG reg = contents of SSPBUF
MOVWF
RXDATA
;Save in user RAM, if data is meaningful
MOVF
MOVWF
TXDATA, W
SSPBUF
;W reg = contents of TXDATA
;New data to xmit
DS39635A-page 172
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.3.3
ENABLING SPI I/O
16.3.4
To enable the serial port, SSP Enable bit, SSPEN
(SSPCON1<5>), must be set. To reset or reconfigure
SPI mode, clear the SSPEN bit, reinitialize the
SSPCON registers and then set the SSPEN bit. This
configures the SDI, SDO, SCK and SS pins as serial
port pins. For the pins to behave as the serial port function, some must have their data direction bits (in the
TRIS register) appropriately programmed as follows:
• SDI is automatically controlled by the SPI module
• SDO must have TRISC<5> bit cleared
• SCK (Master mode) must have TRISC<3> bit
cleared
• SCK (Slave mode) must have TRISC<3> bit set
• SS must have TRISF<7> bit set
TYPICAL CONNECTION
Figure 16-2 shows a typical connection between two
microcontrollers. The master controller (Processor 1)
initiates the data transfer by sending the SCK signal.
Data is shifted out of both shift registers on their programmed clock edge and latched on the opposite edge
of the clock. Both processors should be programmed to
the same Clock Polarity (CKP), then both controllers
would send and receive data at the same time.
Whether the data is meaningful (or dummy data)
depends on the application software. This leads to
three scenarios for data transmission:
• Master sends data – Slave sends dummy data
• Master sends data – Slave sends data
• Master sends dummy data – Slave sends data
Any serial port function that is not desired may be
overridden by programming the corresponding Data
Direction (TRIS) register to the opposite value.
FIGURE 16-2:
SPI™ MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION
SPI Master SSPM3:SSPM0 = 00xxb
SPI Slave SSPM3:SSPM0 = 010xb
SDO
SDI
Serial Input Buffer
(SSPBUF)
SDI
Shift Register
(SSPSR)
MSb
Serial Input Buffer
(SSPBUF)
SDO
LSb
MSb
SCK
Serial Clock
PROCESSOR 1
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Shift Register
(SSPSR)
LSb
SCK
PROCESSOR 2
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 173
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.3.5
MASTER MODE
The master can initiate the data transfer at any time
because it controls the SCK. The master determines
when the slave (Processor 2, Figure 16-2) is to
broadcast data by the software protocol.
In Master mode, the data is transmitted/received as
soon as the SSPBUF register is written to. If the SPI is
only going to receive, the SDO output could be disabled (programmed as an input). The SSPSR register
will continue to shift in the signal present on the SDI pin
at the programmed clock rate. As each byte is
received, it will be loaded into the SSPBUF register as
if a normal received byte (interrupts and status bits
appropriately set). This could be useful in receiver
applications as a “Line Activity Monitor” mode.
FIGURE 16-3:
The clock polarity is selected by appropriately
programming the CKP bit (SSPCON1<4>). This then,
would give waveforms for SPI communication as
shown in Figure 16-3, Figure 16-5 and Figure 16-6,
where the MSB is transmitted first. In Master mode, the
SPI clock rate (bit rate) is user programmable to be one
of the following:
•
•
•
•
FOSC/4 (or TCY)
FOSC/16 (or 4 • TCY)
FOSC/64 (or 16 • TCY)
Timer2 output/2
This allows a maximum data rate (at 40 MHz) of
10.00 Mbps.
Figure 16-3 shows the waveforms for Master mode.
When the CKE bit is set, the SDO data is valid before
there is a clock edge on SCK. The change of the input
sample is shown based on the state of the SMP bit. The
time when the SSPBUF is loaded with the received
data is shown.
SPI™ MODE WAVEFORM (MASTER MODE)
Write to
SSPBUF
SCK
(CKP = 0
CKE = 0)
SCK
(CKP = 1
CKE = 0)
4 Clock
Modes
SCK
(CKP = 0
CKE = 1)
SCK
(CKP = 1
CKE = 1)
SDO
(CKE = 0)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
SDO
(CKE = 1)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
SDI
(SMP = 0)
bit 0
bit 7
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SDI
(SMP = 1)
bit 0
bit 7
Input
Sample
(SMP = 1)
SSPIF
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2↓
SSPSR to
SSPBUF
DS39635A-page 174
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.3.6
SLAVE MODE
In Slave mode, the data is transmitted and received as
the external clock pulses appear on SCK. When the
last bit is latched, the SSPIF interrupt flag bit is set.
the SS pin goes high, the SDO pin is no longer driven,
even if in the middle of a transmitted byte and becomes
a floating output. External pull-up/pull-down resistors
may be desirable, depending on the application.
While in Slave mode, the external clock is supplied by
the external clock source on the SCK pin. This external
clock must meet the minimum high and low times as
specified in the electrical specifications.
Note 1: When the SPI is in Slave mode with SS pin
control enabled (SSPCON<3:0> = 0100),
the SPI module will reset if the SS pin is set
to VDD.
While in Sleep mode, the slave can transmit/receive
data. When a byte is received, the device will wake-up
from Sleep.
2: If the SPI is used in Slave mode with CKE
set, then the SS pin control must be
enabled.
16.3.7
When the SPI module resets, the bit counter is forced
to ‘0’. This can be done by either forcing the SS pin to
a high level or clearing the SSPEN bit.
SLAVE SELECT
SYNCHRONIZATION
The SS pin allows a Synchronous Slave mode. The
SPI must be in Slave mode with SS pin control enabled
(SSPCON1<3:0> = 04h). The pin must not be driven
low for the SS pin to function as an input. The data latch
must be high. When the SS pin is low, transmission and
reception are enabled and the SDO pin is driven. When
FIGURE 16-4:
To emulate two-wire communication, the SDO pin can
be connected to the SDI pin. When the SPI needs to
operate as a receiver, the SDO pin can be configured
as an input. This disables transmissions from the SDO.
The SDI can always be left as an input (SDI function)
since it cannot create a bus conflict.
SLAVE SYNCHRONIZATION WAVEFORM
SS
SCK
(CKP = 0
CKE = 0)
SCK
(CKP = 1
CKE = 0)
Write to
SSPBUF
SDO
SDI
(SMP = 0)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 7
bit 0
bit 0
bit 7
bit 7
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SSPIF
Interrupt
Flag
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2↓
SSPSR to
SSPBUF
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 175
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 16-5:
SPI™ MODE WAVEFORM (SLAVE MODE WITH CKE = 0)
SS
Optional
SCK
(CKP = 0
CKE = 0)
SCK
(CKP = 1
CKE = 0)
Write to
SSPBUF
SDO
SDI
(SMP = 0)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
bit 0
bit 7
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SSPIF
Interrupt
Flag
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2↓
SSPSR to
SSPBUF
FIGURE 16-6:
SPI™ MODE WAVEFORM (SLAVE MODE WITH CKE = 1)
SS
Not Optional
SCK
(CKP = 0
CKE = 1)
SCK
(CKP = 1
CKE = 1)
Write to
SSPBUF
SDO
bit 7
SDI
(SMP = 0)
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
bit 0
Input
Sample
(SMP = 0)
SSPIF
Interrupt
Flag
Next Q4 Cycle
after Q2↓
SSPSR to
SSPBUF
DS39635A-page 176
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.3.8
SLEEP OPERATION
16.3.9
In SPI Master mode, module clocks may be operating
at a different speed than when in Full Power mode; in
the case of the Sleep mode, all clocks are halted.
In most power managed modes, a clock is provided to
the peripherals. That clock should be from the primary
clock source, the secondary clock (Timer1 oscillator at
32.768 kHz) or the INTOSC source. See Section 2.7
“Clock Sources and Oscillator Switching” for
additional information.
In most cases, the speed that the master clocks SPI
data is not important; however, this should be
evaluated for each system.
A Reset disables the MSSP module and terminates the
current transfer.
16.3.10
BUS MODE COMPATIBILITY
Table 16-1 shows the compatibility between the
standard SPI modes and the states of the CKP and
CKE control bits.
TABLE 16-1:
SPI™ BUS MODES
Control Bits State
Standard SPI Mode
Terminology
CKP
CKE
0, 0
0
1
0, 1
0
0
1, 0
1
1
1, 1
1
0
If MSSP interrupts are enabled, they can wake the controller from Sleep mode, or one of the Idle modes, when
the master completes sending data. If an exit from
Sleep or Idle mode is not desired, MSSP interrupts
should be disabled.
If the Sleep mode is selected, all module clocks are
halted and the transmission/reception will remain in
that state until the devices wakes. After the device
returns to Run mode, the module will resume
transmitting and receiving data.
EFFECTS OF A RESET
There is also an SMP bit which controls when the data
is sampled.
In SPI Slave mode, the SPI Transmit/Receive Shift
register operates asynchronously to the device. This
allows the device to be placed in any power managed
mode and data to be shifted into the SPI Transmit/
Receive Shift register. When all 8 bits have been
received, the MSSP interrupt flag bit will be set and if
enabled, will wake the device.
TABLE 16-2:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SPI™ OPERATION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
IPR1
TRISC
PORTC Data Direction Register
60
TRISF
PORTF Data Direction Register
60
SSPBUF
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
58
SSPCON1
WCOL
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
SSPM3
SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
58
SSPSTAT
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
58
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the MSSP in SPI mode.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 177
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4
I2C Mode
16.4.1
The MSSP module in I 2C mode fully implements all
master and slave functions (including general call
support) and provides interrupts on Start and Stop bits
in hardware to determine a free bus (multi-master
function). The MSSP module implements the standard
mode specifications as well as 7-bit and 10-bit
addressing.
Two pins are used for data transfer:
• Serial clock (SCL) – RC3/SCK/SCL
• Serial data (SDA) – RC4/SDI/SDA
The user must configure these pins as inputs through
the TRISC<4:3> bits.
FIGURE 16-7:
MSSP BLOCK DIAGRAM
(I2C™ MODE)
Write
Shift
Clock
MSb
Match Detect
LSb
Addr Match
SSPADD reg
Start and
Stop bit Detect
DS39635A-page 178
MSSP Control Register 1 (SSPCON1)
MSSP Control Register 2 (SSPCON2)
MSSP Status Register (SSPSTAT)
Serial Receive/Transmit Buffer Register
(SSPBUF)
• MSSP Shift Register (SSPSR) – Not directly
accessible
• MSSP Address Register (SSPADD)
SSPCON1, SSPCON2 and SSPSTAT are the control
and status registers in I2C mode operation. The
SSPCON1 and SSPCON2 registers are readable and
writable. The lower 6 bits of the SSPSTAT are read-only.
The upper 2 bits of the SSPSTAT are read/write.
In receive operations, SSPSR and SSPBUF together
create a double-buffered receiver. When SSPSR
receives a complete byte, it is transferred to SSPBUF
and the SSPIF interrupt is set.
SSPSR reg
RC4/
SDI/
SDA
•
•
•
•
SSPADD register holds the slave device address
when the SSP is configured in I2C Slave mode. When
the SSP is configured in Master mode, the lower 7 bits
of SSPADD act as the Baud Rate Generator reload
value.
SSPBUF reg
RC3/SCK/SCL
The MSSP module has six registers for I2C operation.
These are:
SSPSR is the shift register used for shifting data in or
out. SSPBUF is the buffer register to which data bytes
are written to, or read from.
Internal
Data Bus
Read
REGISTERS
During transmission, the SSPBUF is not doublebuffered. A write to SSPBUF will write to both SSPBUF
and SSPSR.
Set, Reset
S, P bits
(SSPSTAT reg)
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 16-3:
SSPSTAT: MSSP STATUS REGISTER (I2C MODE)
R/W-0
SMP
R/W-0
CKE
R-0
R-0
R-0
D/A
(1)
(1)
P
S
R-0
R/W
(2,3)
R-0
R-0
UA
BF
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
SMP: Slew Rate Control bit
In Master or Slave mode:
1 = Slew rate control disabled for Standard Speed mode (100 kHz and 1 MHz)
0 = Slew rate control enabled for High-Speed mode (400 kHz)
bit 6
CKE: SMBus Select bit
In Master or Slave mode:
1 = Enable SMBus specific inputs
0 = Disable SMBus specific inputs
bit 5
D/A: Data/Address bit
In Master mode:
Reserved.
In Slave mode:
1 = Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was data
0 = Indicates that the last byte received or transmitted was address
bit 4
P: Stop bit(1)
1 = Indicates that a Stop bit has been detected last
0 = Stop bit was not detected last
bit 3
S: Start bit(1)
1 = Indicates that a Start bit has been detected last
0 = Start bit was not detected last
bit 2
R/W: Read/Write bit Information (I2C mode only)
In Slave mode:(2)
1 = Read
0 = Write
In Master mode:(3)
1 = Transmit is in progress
0 = Transmit is not in progress
bit 1
UA: Update Address bit (10-bit Slave mode only)
1 = Indicates that the user needs to update the address in the SSPADD register
0 = Address does not need to be updated
bit 0
BF: Buffer Full Status bit
In Transmit mode:
1 = Receive complete, SSPBUF is full
0 = Receive not complete, SSPBUF is empty
In Receive mode:
1 = Data transmit in progress (does not include the ACK and Stop bits), SSPBUF is full
0 = Data transmit complete (does not include the ACK and Stop bits), SSPBUF is empty
Note 1: This bit is cleared on Reset and when SSPEN is cleared.
2: This bit holds the R/W bit information following the last address match. This bit is only
valid from the address match to the next Start bit, Stop bit or not ACK bit.
3: ORing this bit with SEN, RSEN, PEN, RCEN or ACKEN will indicate if the MSSP is
in Idle mode.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 179
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 16-4:
SSPCON1: MSSP CONTROL REGISTER 1 (I2C MODE)
R/W-0
WCOL
R/W-0
SSPOV
R/W-0
SSPEN
(1)
R/W-0
CKP
R/W-0
SSPM3
(2)
R/W-0
SSPM2
(2)
R/W-0
SSPM1
(2)
R/W-0
SSPM0(2)
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
WCOL: Write Collision Detect bit
In Master Transmit mode:
1 = A write to the SSPBUF register was attempted while the I2C conditions were not valid for
a transmission to be started (must be cleared in software)
0 = No collision
In Slave Transmit mode:
1 = The SSPBUF register is written while it is still transmitting the previous word (must be
cleared in software)
0 = No collision
In Receive mode (Master or Slave modes):
This is a “don’t care” bit.
bit 6
SSPOV: Receive Overflow Indicator bit
In Receive mode:
1 = A byte is received while the SSPBUF register is still holding the previous byte (must be
cleared in software)
0 = No overflow
In Transmit mode:
This is a “don’t care” bit in Transmit mode.
bit 5
SSPEN: Synchronous Serial Port Enable bit(1)
1 = Enables the serial port and configures the SDA and SCL pins as the serial port pins
0 = Disables serial port and configures these pins as I/O port pins
bit 4
CKP: SCK Release Control bit
In Slave mode:
1 = Releases clock
0 = Holds clock low (clock stretch), used to ensure data setup time
In Master mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 3-0
SSPM3:SSPM0: Synchronous Serial Port Mode Select bits(2)
1111 = I2C Slave mode, 10-bit address with Start and Stop bit interrupts enabled
1110 = I2C Slave mode, 7-bit address with Start and Stop bit interrupts enabled
1011 = I2C Firmware Controlled Master mode (Slave Idle)
1000 = I2C Master mode, clock = FOSC/(4 * (SSPADD + 1))
0111 = I2C Slave mode, 10-bit address
0110 = I2C Slave mode, 7-bit address
Note 1: When enabled, the SDA and SCL pins must be properly configured as input or
output.
2: Bit combinations not specifically listed here are either reserved or implemented in
SPI mode only.
Legend:
DS39635A-page 180
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 16-5:
SSPCON2: MSSP CONTROL REGISTER 2 (I2C MODE)
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
GCEN
ACKSTAT
ACKDT(1)
ACKEN(2)
RCEN(2)
PEN(2)
RSEN(2)
SEN(2)
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
GCEN: General Call Enable bit (Slave mode only)
1 = Enable interrupt when a general call address (0000h) is received in the SSPSR
0 = General call address disabled
bit 6
ACKSTAT: Acknowledge Status bit (Master Transmit mode only)
1 = Acknowledge was not received from slave
0 = Acknowledge was received from slave
bit 5
ACKDT: Acknowledge Data bit (Master Receive mode only)(1)
1 = Not Acknowledge
0 = Acknowledge
bit 4
ACKEN: Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit (Master Receive mode only)(2)
1 = Initiate Acknowledge sequence on SDA and SCL pins and transmit ACKDT data bit.
Automatically cleared by hardware.
0 = Acknowledge sequence Idle
bit 3
RCEN: Receive Enable bit (Master mode only)(2)
1 = Enables Receive mode for I2C
0 = Receive Idle
bit 2
PEN: Stop Condition Enable bit (Master mode only)(2)
1 = Initiate Stop condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware.
0 = Stop condition Idle
bit 1
RSEN: Repeated Start Condition Enable bit (Master mode only)(2)
1 = Initiate Repeated Start condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware.
0 = Repeated Start condition Idle
bit 0
SEN: Start Condition Enable/Stretch Enable bit(2)
In Master mode:
1 = Initiate Start condition on SDA and SCL pins. Automatically cleared by hardware.
0 = Start condition Idle
In Slave mode:
1 = Clock stretching is enabled for both slave transmit and slave receive (stretch enabled)
0 = Clock stretching is disabled
Note 1: Value that will be transmitted when the user initiates an Acknowledge sequence at
the end of a receive.
2: If the I2C module is not in the Idle mode, this bit may not be set (no spooling) and
the SSPBUF may not be written (or writes to the SSPBUF are disabled).
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 181
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.2
OPERATION
16.4.3.1
The MSSP module functions are enabled by setting
MSSP Enable bit, SSPEN (SSPCON<5>).
The SSPCON1 register allows control of the I 2C
operation. Four mode selection bits (SSPCON<3:0>)
allow one of the following I 2C modes to be selected:
I2C Master mode, clock = (FOSC/4) x (SSPADD + 1)
I 2C Slave mode (7-bit address)
I 2C Slave mode (10-bit address)
I 2C Slave mode (7-bit address) with Start and
Stop bit interrupts enabled
• I 2C Slave mode (10-bit address) with Start and
Stop bit interrupts enabled
• I 2C Firmware Controlled Master mode, slave is
Idle
•
•
•
•
Selection of any I 2C mode with the SSPEN bit set,
forces the SCL and SDA pins to be open-drain,
provided these pins are programmed to inputs by
setting the appropriate TRISC bits. To ensure proper
operation of the module, pull-up resistors must be
provided externally to the SCL and SDA pins.
16.4.3
SLAVE MODE
In Slave mode, the SCL and SDA pins must be configured as inputs (TRISC<4:3> set). The MSSP module
will override the input state with the output data when
required (slave-transmitter).
The I 2C Slave mode hardware will always generate an
interrupt on an address match. Through the mode
select bits, the user can also choose to interrupt on
Start and Stop bits
When an address is matched, or the data transfer after
an address match is received, the hardware automatically will generate the Acknowledge (ACK) pulse and
load the SSPBUF register with the received value
currently in the SSPSR register.
Any combination of the following conditions will cause
the MSSP module not to give this ACK pulse:
• The Buffer Full bit, BF (SSPSTAT<0>), was set
before the transfer was received.
• The overflow bit, SSPOV (SSPCON<6>), was set
before the transfer was received.
In this case, the SSPSR register value is not loaded
into the SSPBUF, but bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) is set. The
BF bit is cleared by reading the SSPBUF register, while
bit SSPOV is cleared through software.
Addressing
Once the MSSP module has been enabled, it waits for
a Start condition to occur. Following the Start condition,
the 8 bits are shifted into the SSPSR register. All incoming bits are sampled with the rising edge of the clock
(SCL) line. The value of register SSPSR<7:1> is
compared to the value of the SSPADD register. The
address is compared on the falling edge of the eighth
clock (SCL) pulse. If the addresses match and the BF
and SSPOV bits are clear, the following events occur:
1.
2.
3.
4.
The SSPSR register value is loaded into the
SSPBUF register.
The Buffer Full bit, BF, is set.
An ACK pulse is generated.
MSSP Interrupt Flag bit, SSPIF (PIR1<3>), is
set (interrupt is generated, if enabled) on the
falling edge of the ninth SCL pulse.
In 10-bit Address mode, two address bytes need to be
received by the slave. The five Most Significant bits
(MSbs) of the first address byte specify if this is a 10-bit
address. Bit R/W (SSPSTAT<2>) must specify a write so
the slave device will receive the second address byte.
For a 10-bit address, the first byte would equal ‘11110
A9 A8 0’, where ‘A9’ and ‘A8’ are the two MSbs of the
address. The sequence of events for 10-bit address is as
follows, with steps 7 through 9 for the slave-transmitter:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Receive first (high) byte of address (bits SSPIF,
BF and UA (SSPSTAT<1>) are set).
Update the SSPADD register with second (low)
byte of address (clears bit UA and releases the
SCL line).
Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and
clear flag bit SSPIF.
Receive second (low) byte of address (bits
SSPIF, BF and UA are set).
Update the SSPADD register with the first (high)
byte of address. If match releases SCL line, this
will clear bit UA.
Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and
clear flag bit SSPIF.
Receive Repeated Start condition.
Receive first (high) byte of address (bits SSPIF
and BF are set).
Read the SSPBUF register (clears bit BF) and
clear flag bit SSPIF.
The SCL clock input must have a minimum high and
low for proper operation. The high and low times of the
I2C specification, as well as the requirement of the
MSSP module, are shown in timing parameter #100
and parameter #101.
DS39635A-page 182
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.3.2
Reception
16.4.3.3
When the R/W bit of the address byte is clear and an
address match occurs, the R/W bit of the SSPSTAT
register is cleared. The received address is loaded into
the SSPBUF register and the SDA line is held low
(ACK).
When the address byte overflow condition exists, then
the no Acknowledge (ACK) pulse is given. An overflow
condition is defined as either bit BF (SSPSTAT<0>) is
set, or bit SSPOV (SSPCON1<6>) is set.
An MSSP interrupt is generated for each data transfer
byte. Flag bit SSPIF (PIR1<3>) must be cleared in
software. The SSPSTAT register is used to determine
the status of the byte.
If SEN is enabled (SSPCON2<0> = 1), RC3/SCK/SCL
will be held low (clock stretch) following each data
transfer. The clock must be released by setting bit
CKP (SSPCON<4>). See Section 16.4.4 “Clock
Stretching” for more detail.
Transmission
When the R/W bit of the incoming address byte is set
and an address match occurs, the R/W bit of the
SSPSTAT register is set. The received address is
loaded into the SSPBUF register. The ACK pulse will
be sent on the ninth bit and pin RC3/SCK/SCL is held
low regardless of SEN (see Section 16.4.4 “Clock
Stretching” for more detail). By stretching the clock,
the master will be unable to assert another clock pulse
until the slave is done preparing the transmit data. The
transmit data must be loaded into the SSPBUF register
which also loads the SSPSR register. Then, pin RC3/
SCK/SCL should be enabled by setting bit CKP
(SSPCON1<4>). The 8 data bits are shifted out on the
falling edge of the SCL input. This ensures that the
SDA signal is valid during the SCL high time
(Figure 16-9).
The ACK pulse from the master-receiver is latched on
the rising edge of the ninth SCL input pulse. If the SDA
line is high (not ACK), then the data transfer is
complete. In this case, when the ACK is latched by the
slave, the slave logic is reset (resets SSPSTAT register) and the slave monitors for another occurrence of
the Start bit. If the SDA line was low (ACK), the next
transmit data must be loaded into the SSPBUF register.
Again, pin RC3/SCK/SCL must be enabled by setting
bit CKP.
An MSSP interrupt is generated for each data transfer
byte. The SSPIF bit must be cleared in software and
the SSPSTAT register is used to determine the status
of the byte. The SSPIF bit is set on the falling edge of
the ninth clock pulse.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 183
DS39635A-page 184
Preliminary
CKP
2
A6
3
4
A4
5
A3
Receiving Address
A5
6
A2
(CKP does not reset to ‘0’ when SEN = 0)
SSPOV (SSPCON1<6>)
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
(PIR1<3>)
SSPIF
1
SCL
S
A7
7
A1
8
9
ACK
R/W = 0
1
D7
3
4
D4
5
D3
Receiving Data
D5
Cleared in software
SSPBUF is read
2
D6
6
D2
7
D1
8
D0
9
ACK
1
D7
2
D6
3
4
D4
5
D3
Receiving Data
D5
6
D2
7
D1
8
D0
Bus master
terminates
transfer
P
SSPOV is set
because SSPBUF is
still full. ACK is not sent.
9
ACK
FIGURE 16-8:
SDA
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I2C™ SLAVE MODE TIMING WITH SEN = 0 (RECEPTION, 7-BIT ADDRESS)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
1
Preliminary
CKP
2
A6
Data in
sampled
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
SSPIF (PIR1<3>)
S
A7
3
A5
4
A4
5
A3
6
A2
Receiving Address
7
A1
8
R/W = 1
9
ACK
SCL held low
while CPU
responds to SSPIF
1
D7
4
D4
5
D3
Cleared in software
3
D5
6
D2
CKP is set in software
SSPBUF is written in software
2
D6
Transmitting Data
7
8
D0
9
ACK
From SSPIF ISR
D1
1
D7
4
D4
5
D3
6
D2
CKP is set in software
7
8
D0
9
ACK
From SSPIF ISR
D1
Transmitting Data
Cleared in software
3
D5
SSPBUF is written in software
2
D6
P
FIGURE 16-9:
SCL
SDA
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I2C™ SLAVE MODE TIMING (TRANSMISSION, 7-BIT ADDRESS)
DS39635A-page 185
DS39635A-page 186
2
1
Preliminary
4
1
5
0
7
A8
UA is set indicating that
the SSPADD needs to be
updated
SSPBUF is written with
contents of SSPSR
6
A9
8
9
(CKP does not reset to ‘0’ when SEN = 0)
UA (SSPSTAT<1>)
SSPOV (SSPCON1<6>)
CKP
3
1
Cleared in software
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
(PIR1<3>)
SSPIF
1
SCL
S
1
ACK
R/W = 0
A7
2
4
A4
5
A3
6
8
9
A0 ACK
UA is set indicating that
SSPADD needs to be
updated
Cleared by hardware
when SSPADD is updated
with low byte of address
7
A2 A1
Cleared in software
3
A5
Dummy read of SSPBUF
to clear BF flag
1
A6
Receive Second Byte of Address
1
D7
4
5
6
Cleared in software
3
7
8
9
1
2
4
5
6
Cleared in software
3
D3 D2
Receive Data Byte
D1 D0 ACK D7 D6 D5 D4
Cleared by hardware when
SSPADD is updated with high
byte of address
2
D3 D2
Receive Data Byte
D6 D5 D4
Clock is held low until
update of SSPADD has
taken place
7
8
D1 D0
9
P
Bus master
terminates
transfer
SSPOV is set
because SSPBUF is
still full. ACK is not sent.
ACK
FIGURE 16-10:
SDA
Receive First Byte of Address
Clock is held low until
update of SSPADD has
taken place
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I2C™ SLAVE MODE TIMING WITH SEN = 0 (RECEPTION, 10-BIT ADDRESS)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
2
Preliminary
CKP (SSPCON1<4>)
UA (SSPSTAT<1>)
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
(PIR1<3>)
SSPIF
1
S
SCL
1
4
1
5
0
6
7
A9 A8
8
UA is set indicating that
the SSPADD needs to be
updated
SSPBUF is written with
contents of SSPSR
3
1
Receive First Byte of Address
1
9
ACK
1
3
4
5
Cleared in software
2
7
UA is set indicating that
SSPADD needs to be
updated
Cleared by hardware when
SSPADD is updated with low
byte of address
6
8
A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0
Receive Second Byte of Address
Dummy read of SSPBUF
to clear BF flag
A7
9
ACK
2
3
1
4
1
Cleared in software
1
1
5
0
6
8
9
ACK
R/W = 1
1
2
4
5
6
Cleared in software
3
CKP is set in software
9
P
Completion of
data transmission
clears BF flag
8
ACK
Bus master
terminates
transfer
CKP is automatically cleared in hardware, holding SCL low
7
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0
Transmitting Data Byte
Clock is held low until
CKP is set to ‘1’
Write of SSPBUF
BF flag is clear
initiates transmit
at the end of the
third address sequence
7
A9 A8
Cleared by hardware when
SSPADD is updated with high
byte of address.
Dummy read of SSPBUF
to clear BF flag
Sr
1
Receive First Byte of Address
Clock is held low until
update of SSPADD has
taken place
FIGURE 16-11:
SDA
R/W = 0
Clock is held low until
update of SSPADD has
taken place
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I2C™ SLAVE MODE TIMING (TRANSMISSION, 10-BIT ADDRESS)
DS39635A-page 187
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.4
CLOCK STRETCHING
16.4.4.3
Both 7 and 10-bit Slave modes implement automatic
clock stretching during a transmit sequence.
The SEN bit (SSPCON2<0>) allows clock stretching to
be enabled during receives. Setting SEN will cause
the SCL pin to be held low at the end of each data
receive sequence.
16.4.4.1
Clock Stretching for 7-bit Slave
Receive Mode (SEN = 1)
In 7-bit Slave Receive mode, on the falling edge of the
ninth clock at the end of the ACK sequence, if the BF
bit is set, the CKP bit in the SSPCON1 register is
automatically cleared, forcing the SCL output to be
held low. The CKP being cleared to ‘0’ will assert the
SCL line low. The CKP bit must be set in the user’s
ISR before reception is allowed to continue. By holding
the SCL line low, the user has time to service the ISR
and read the contents of the SSPBUF before the
master device can initiate another receive sequence.
This will prevent buffer overruns from occurring (see
Figure 16-13).
Note 1: If the user reads the contents of the
SSPBUF before the falling edge of the
ninth clock, thus clearing the BF bit, the
CKP bit will not be cleared and clock
stretching will not occur.
2: The CKP bit can be set in software
regardless of the state of the BF bit. The
user should be careful to clear the BF bit
in the ISR before the next receive
sequence in order to prevent an overflow
condition.
16.4.4.2
Clock Stretching for 7-bit Slave
Transmit Mode
7-bit Slave Transmit mode implements clock stretching
by clearing the CKP bit after the falling edge of the ninth
clock, if the BF bit is clear. This occurs regardless of the
state of the SEN bit.
The user’s ISR must set the CKP bit before transmission is allowed to continue. By holding the SCL line
low, the user has time to service the ISR and load the
contents of the SSPBUF before the master device can
initiate another transmit sequence (see Figure 16-9).
Note 1: If the user loads the contents of SSPBUF,
setting the BF bit before the falling edge of
the ninth clock, the CKP bit will not be
cleared and clock stretching will not occur.
2: The CKP bit can be set in software
regardless of the state of the BF bit.
16.4.4.4
Clock Stretching for 10-bit Slave
Transmit Mode
In 10-bit Slave Transmit mode, clock stretching is
controlled during the first two address sequences by
the state of the UA bit, just as it is in 10-bit Slave
Receive mode. The first two addresses are followed
by a third address sequence which contains the highorder bits of the 10-bit address and the R/W bit set to
‘1’. After the third address sequence is performed, the
UA bit is not set, the module is now configured in
Transmit mode and clock stretching is controlled by
the BF flag as in 7-bit Slave Transmit mode (see
Figure 16-11).
Clock Stretching for 10-bit Slave
Receive Mode (SEN = 1)
In 10-bit Slave Receive mode during the address
sequence, clock stretching automatically takes place
but CKP is not cleared. During this time, if the UA bit is
set after the ninth clock, clock stretching is initiated.
The UA bit is set after receiving the upper byte of the
10-bit address and following the receive of the second
byte of the 10-bit address with the R/W bit cleared to
‘0’. The release of the clock line occurs upon updating
SSPADD. Clock stretching will occur on each data
receive sequence as described in 7-bit mode.
Note:
If the user polls the UA bit and clears it by
updating the SSPADD register before the
falling edge of the ninth clock occurs and if
the user hasn’t cleared the BF bit by reading the SSPBUF register before that time,
then the CKP bit will still NOT be asserted
low. Clock stretching on the basis of the
state of the BF bit only occurs during a
data sequence, not an address sequence.
DS39635A-page 188
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.4.5
Clock Synchronization and
the CKP bit
When the CKP bit is cleared, the SCL output is forced
to ‘0’. However, setting the CKP bit will not assert the
SCL output low until the SCL output is already sampled low. Therefore, the CKP bit will not assert the
SCL line until an external I2C master device has
FIGURE 16-12:
already asserted the SCL line. The SCL output will
remain low until the CKP bit is set and all other
devices on the I2C bus have deasserted SCL. This
ensures that a write to the CKP bit will not violate the
minimum high time requirement for SCL (see
Figure 16-12).
CLOCK SYNCHRONIZATION TIMING
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
SDA
DX
DX – 1
SCL
CKP
Master device
asserts clock
Master device
deasserts clock
WR
SSPCON
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 189
DS39635A-page 190
Preliminary
CKP
SSPOV (SSPCON1<6>)
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
(PIR1<3>)
SSPIF
1
SCL
S
A7
2
A6
3
4
A4
5
A3
6
A2
Receiving Address
A5
7
A1
8
9
ACK
R/W = 0
3
4
D4
5
D3
Receiving Data
D5
Cleared in software
2
D6
If BF is cleared
prior to the falling
edge of the 9th clock,
CKP will not be reset
to ‘0’ and no clock
stretching will occur
SSPBUF is read
1
D7
6
D2
7
D1
9
ACK
1
D7
BF is set after falling
edge of the 9th clock,
CKP is reset to ‘0’ and
clock stretching occurs
8
D0
CKP
written
to ‘1’ in
software
2
D6
Clock is held low until
CKP is set to ‘1’
3
4
D4
5
D3
Receiving Data
D5
6
D2
7
D1
8
D0
Bus master
terminates
transfer
P
SSPOV is set
because SSPBUF is
still full. ACK is not sent.
9
ACK
Clock is not held low
because ACK = 1
FIGURE 16-13:
SDA
Clock is not held low
because buffer full bit is
clear prior to falling edge
of 9th clock
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I2C™ SLAVE MODE TIMING WITH SEN = 1 (RECEPTION, 7-BIT ADDRESS)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
2
1
Preliminary
UA (SSPSTAT<1>)
SSPOV (SSPCON1<6>)
CKP
3
1
4
1
5
0
6
7
A9 A8
8
UA is set indicating that
the SSPADD needs to be
updated
SSPBUF is written with
contents of SSPSR
Cleared in software
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
(PIR1<3>)
SSPIF
1
SCL
S
1
9
ACK
R/W = 0
A7
2
4
A4
5
A3
6
A2
Cleared in software
3
A5
7
A1
8
A0
Note: An update of the SSPADD
register before the falling
edge of the ninth clock will
have no effect on UA and
UA will remain set.
UA is set indicating that
SSPADD needs to be
updated
Cleared by hardware when
SSPADD is updated with low
byte of address after falling edge
of ninth clock
Dummy read of SSPBUF
to clear BF flag
1
A6
Receive Second Byte of Address
9
ACK
2
4
5
6
D3 D2
Cleared in software
3
D5 D4
7
D1
8
Note: An update of the SSPADD register before
the falling edge of the ninth clock will have
no effect on UA and UA will remain set.
9
ACK
1
4
5
6
Cleared in software
3
CKP written to ‘1’
in software
2
D3 D2
Receive Data Byte
D7 D6 D5 D4
Clock is held low until
CKP is set to ‘1’
D0
Cleared by hardware when
SSPADD is updated with high
byte of address after falling edge
of ninth clock
Dummy read of SSPBUF
to clear BF flag
1
D7 D6
Receive Data Byte
Clock is held low until
update of SSPADD has
taken place
7
8
9
Bus master
terminates
transfer
P
SSPOV is set
because SSPBUF is
still full. ACK is not sent.
D1 D0
ACK
Clock is not held low
because ACK = 1
FIGURE 16-14:
SDA
Receive First Byte of Address
Clock is held low until
update of SSPADD has
taken place
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I2C™ SLAVE MODE TIMING SEN = 1 (RECEPTION, 10-BIT ADDRESS)
DS39635A-page 191
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.5
GENERAL CALL ADDRESS
SUPPORT
If the general call address matches, the SSPSR is
transferred to the SSPBUF, the BF flag bit is set (eighth
bit) and on the falling edge of the ninth bit (ACK bit), the
SSPIF interrupt flag bit is set.
The addressing procedure for the I2C bus is such that
the first byte after the Start condition usually determines which device will be the slave addressed by the
master. The exception is the general call address which
can address all devices. When this address is used, all
devices should, in theory, respond with an
Acknowledge.
When the interrupt is serviced, the source for the interrupt can be checked by reading the contents of the
SSPBUF. The value can be used to determine if the
address was device specific or a general call address.
In 10-bit mode, the SSPADD is required to be updated
for the second half of the address to match and the UA
bit is set (SSPSTAT<1>). If the general call address is
sampled when the GCEN bit is set, while the slave is
configured in 10-bit Address mode, then the second
half of the address is not necessary, the UA bit will not
be set and the slave will begin receiving data after the
Acknowledge (Figure 16-15).
The general call address is one of eight addresses
reserved for specific purposes by the I2C protocol. It
consists of all ‘0’s with R/W = 0.
The general call address is recognized when the General Call Enable bit (GCEN) is enabled (SSPCON2<7>
set). Following a Start bit detect, 8 bits are shifted into
the SSPSR and the address is compared against the
SSPADD. It is also compared to the general call
address and fixed in hardware.
FIGURE 16-15:
SLAVE MODE GENERAL CALL ADDRESS SEQUENCE
(7 OR 10-BIT ADDRESS MODE)
Address is compared to General Call Address
after ACK, set interrupt
R/W = 0
ACK D7
General Call Address
SDA
Receiving Data
ACK
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SCL
S
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
9
SSPIF
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
Cleared in software
SSPBUF is read
SSPOV (SSPCON1<6>)
‘0’
GCEN (SSPCON2<7>)
‘1’
DS39635A-page 192
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
MASTER MODE
Note:
Master mode is enabled by setting and clearing the
appropriate SSPM bits in SSPCON1 and by setting the
SSPEN bit. In Master mode, the SCL and SDA lines
are manipulated by the MSSP hardware.
Master mode of operation is supported by interrupt
generation on the detection of the Start and Stop conditions. The Stop (P) and Start (S) bits are cleared from
a Reset or when the MSSP module is disabled. Control
of the I 2C bus may be taken when the P bit is set or the
bus is Idle, with both the S and P bits clear.
In Firmware Controlled Master mode, user code
conducts all I 2C bus operations based on Start and
Stop bit conditions.
Once Master mode is enabled, the user has six
options.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Assert a Start condition on SDA and SCL.
Assert a Repeated Start condition on SDA and
SCL.
Write to the SSPBUF register initiating
transmission of data/address.
Configure the I2C port to receive data.
Generate an Acknowledge condition at the end
of a received byte of data.
Generate a Stop condition on SDA and SCL.
FIGURE 16-16:
The MSSP module, when configured in
I2C Master mode, does not allow queueing
of events. For instance, the user is not
allowed to initiate a Start condition and
immediately write the SSPBUF register to
initiate transmission before the Start condition is complete. In this case, the SSPBUF
will not be written to and the WCOL bit will
be set, indicating that a write to the
SSPBUF did not occur.
The following events will cause SSP Interrupt Flag bit,
SSPIF, to be set (SSP interrupt, if enabled):
•
•
•
•
•
Start condition
Stop condition
Data transfer byte transmitted/received
Acknowledge transmit
Repeated Start
MSSP BLOCK DIAGRAM (I2C™ MASTER MODE)
Internal
Data Bus
Read
SSPM3:SSPM0
SSPADD<6:0>
Write
SSPBUF
Baud
Rate
Generator
Shift
Clock
SDA
SDA In
SCL In
Bus Collision
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
LSb
Start bit, Stop bit,
Acknowledge
Generate
Start bit Detect
Stop bit Detect
Write Collision Detect
Clock Arbitration
State Counter for
end of XMIT/RCV
Preliminary
Clock Cntl
SCL
Receive Enable
SSPSR
MSb
Clock Arbitrate/WCOL Detect
(hold off clock source)
16.4.6
Set/Reset, S, P, WCOL (SSPSTAT)
Set SSPIF, BCLIF
Reset ACKSTAT, PEN (SSPCON2)
DS39635A-page 193
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.6.1
I2C Master Mode Operation
A typical transmit sequence would go as follows:
The master device generates all of the serial clock
pulses and the Start and Stop conditions. A transfer is
ended with a Stop condition or with a Repeated Start
condition. Since the Repeated Start condition is also
the beginning of the next serial transfer, the I2C bus will
not be released.
In Master Transmitter mode, serial data is output
through SDA, while SCL outputs the serial clock. The
first byte transmitted contains the slave address of the
receiving device (7 bits) and the Read/Write (R/W) bit.
In this case, the R/W bit will be logic ‘0’. Serial data is
transmitted 8 bits at a time. After each byte is transmitted, an Acknowledge bit is received. Start and Stop
conditions are output to indicate the beginning and the
end of a serial transfer.
In Master Receive mode, the first byte transmitted
contains the slave address of the transmitting device
(7 bits) and the R/W bit. In this case, the R/W bit will be
logic ‘1’. Thus, the first byte transmitted is a 7-bit slave
address, followed by a ‘1’ to indicate the receive bit.
Serial data is received via SDA, while SCL outputs the
serial clock. Serial data is received 8 bits at a time. After
each byte is received, an Acknowledge bit is transmitted. Start and Stop conditions indicate the beginning
and end of transmission.
The Baud Rate Generator used for the SPI mode operation is used to set the SCL clock frequency for either
100 kHz, 400 kHz or 1 MHz I2C operation. See
Section 16.4.7 “Baud Rate” for more detail.
DS39635A-page 194
1.
The user generates a Start condition by setting
the Start Enable bit, SEN (SSPCON2<0>).
2. SSPIF is set. The MSSP module will wait the
required start time before any other operation
takes place.
3. The user loads the SSPBUF with the slave
address to transmit.
4. Address is shifted out the SDA pin until all 8 bits
are transmitted.
5. The MSSP module shifts in the ACK bit from the
slave device and writes its value into the
SSPCON2 register (SSPCON2<6>).
6. The MSSP module generates an interrupt at the
end of the ninth clock cycle by setting the SSPIF
bit.
7. The user loads the SSPBUF with 8 bits of data.
8. Data is shifted out the SDA pin until all 8 bits are
transmitted.
9. The MSSP module shifts in the ACK bit from the
slave device and writes its value into the
SSPCON2 register (SSPCON2<6>).
10. The MSSP module generates an interrupt at the
end of the ninth clock cycle by setting the SSPIF
bit.
11. The user generates a Stop condition by setting
the Stop Enable bit, PEN (SSPCON2<2>).
12. Interrupt is generated once the Stop condition is
complete.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.7
BAUD RATE
2
In I C Master mode, the Baud Rate Generator (BRG)
reload value is placed in the lower 7 bits of the
SSPADD register (Figure 16-17). When a write occurs
to SSPBUF, the Baud Rate Generator will automatically
begin counting. The BRG counts down to ‘0’ and stops
until another reload has taken place. The BRG count is
decremented twice per instruction cycle (TCY) on the
Q2 and Q4 clocks. In I2C Master mode, the BRG is
reloaded automatically.
FIGURE 16-17:
Once the given operation is complete (i.e., transmission of the last data bit is followed by ACK), the internal
clock will automatically stop counting and the SCL pin
will remain in its last state.
Table 16-3 demonstrates clock rates based on
instruction cycles and the BRG value loaded into
SSPADD.
BAUD RATE GENERATOR BLOCK DIAGRAM
SSPM3:SSPM0
SSPM3:SSPM0
Reload
SCL
Control
CLKO
TABLE 16-3:
Note 1:
SSPADD<6:0>
Reload
BRG Down Counter
FOSC/4
I2C™ CLOCK RATE W/BRG
FCY
FCY*2
BRG Value
FSCL
(2 Rollovers of BRG)
10 MHz
20 MHz
19h
400 kHz(1)
10 MHz
20 MHz
20h
312.5 kHz
10 MHz
20 MHz
3Fh
100 kHz
4 MHz
8 MHz
0Ah
400 kHz(1)
4 MHz
8 MHz
0Dh
308 kHz
4 MHz
8 MHz
28h
100 kHz
1 MHz
2 MHz
03h
333 kHz(1)
1 MHz
2 MHz
0Ah
100 kHz
1 MHz
2 MHz
00h
1 MHz(1)
The I2C interface does not conform to the 400 kHz I2C specification (which applies to rates greater than
100 kHz) in all details, but may be used with care where higher rates are required by the application.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 195
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.7.1
Clock Arbitration
Clock arbitration occurs when the master, during any
receive, transmit or Repeated Start/Stop condition,
deasserts the SCL pin (SCL allowed to float high).
When the SCL pin is allowed to float high, the Baud
Rate Generator (BRG) is suspended from counting
until the SCL pin is actually sampled high. When the
FIGURE 16-18:
SCL pin is sampled high, the Baud Rate Generator is
reloaded with the contents of SSPADD<6:0> and
begins counting. This ensures that the SCL high time
will always be at least one BRG rollover count in the
event that the clock is held low by an external device
(Figure 16-18).
BAUD RATE GENERATOR TIMING WITH CLOCK ARBITRATION
SDA
DX
DX – 1
SCL deasserted but slave holds
SCL low (clock arbitration)
SCL allowed to transition high
SCL
BRG decrements on
Q2 and Q4 cycles
BRG
Value
03h
02h
01h
00h (hold off)
03h
02h
SCL is sampled high, reload takes
place and BRG starts its count
BRG
Reload
DS39635A-page 196
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.8
I2C MASTER MODE START
CONDITION TIMING
Note:
To initiate a Start condition, the user sets the Start
Enable bit, SEN (SSPCON2<0>). If the SDA and SCL
pins are sampled high, the Baud Rate Generator is
reloaded with the contents of SSPADD<6:0> and starts
its count. If SCL and SDA are both sampled high when
the Baud Rate Generator times out (TBRG), the SDA
pin is driven low. The action of the SDA being driven
low while SCL is high is the Start condition and causes
the S bit (SSPSTAT<3>) to be set. Following this, the
Baud Rate Generator is reloaded with the contents of
SSPADD<6:0> and resumes its count. When the Baud
Rate Generator times out (TBRG), the SEN bit
(SSPCON2<0>) will be automatically cleared by hardware, the Baud Rate Generator is suspended, leaving
the SDA line held low and the Start condition is
complete.
FIGURE 16-19:
16.4.8.1
If, at the beginning of the Start condition,
the SDA and SCL pins are already sampled low, or if during the Start condition, the
SCL line is sampled low before the SDA
line is driven low, a bus collision occurs,
the Bus Collision Interrupt Flag, BCLIF, is
set, the Start condition is aborted and the
I2C module is reset into its Idle state.
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a Start sequence
is in progress, the WCOL is set and the contents of the
buffer are unchanged (the write doesn’t occur).
Note:
Because queueing of events is not
allowed, writing to the lower 5 bits of
SSPCON2 is disabled until the Start
condition is complete.
FIRST START BIT TIMING
Set S bit (SSPSTAT<3>)
Write to SEN bit occurs here
SDA = 1,
SCL = 1
TBRG
At completion of Start bit,
hardware clears SEN bit
and sets SSPIF bit
TBRG
Write to SSPBUF occurs here
1st bit
SDA
2nd bit
TBRG
SCL
TBRG
S
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 197
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.9
I2C MASTER MODE REPEATED
START CONDITION TIMING
Note 1: If RSEN is programmed while any other
event is in progress, it will not take effect.
A Repeated Start condition occurs when the RSEN bit
(SSPCON2<1>) is programmed high and the I2C logic
module is in the Idle state. When the RSEN bit is set,
the SCL pin is asserted low. When the SCL pin is sampled low, the Baud Rate Generator is loaded with the
contents of SSPADD<5:0> and begins counting. The
SDA pin is released (brought high) for one Baud Rate
Generator count (TBRG). When the Baud Rate Generator times out, if SDA is sampled high, the SCL pin will
be deasserted (brought high). When SCL is sampled
high, the Baud Rate Generator is reloaded with the
contents of SSPADD<6:0> and begins counting. SDA
and SCL must be sampled high for one TBRG. This
action is then followed by assertion of the SDA pin
(SDA = 0) for one TBRG while SCL is high. Following
this, the RSEN bit (SSPCON2<1>) will be automatically
cleared and the Baud Rate Generator will not be
reloaded, leaving the SDA pin held low. As soon as a
Start condition is detected on the SDA and SCL pins,
the S bit (SSPSTAT<3>) will be set. The SSPIF bit will
not be set until the Baud Rate Generator has timed out.
2: A bus collision during the Repeated Start
condition occurs if:
• SDA is sampled low when SCL goes
from low-to-high.
• SCL goes low before SDA is
asserted low. This may indicate that
another master is attempting to
transmit a data ‘1’.
Immediately following the SSPIF bit getting set, the user
may write the SSPBUF with the 7-bit address in 7-bit
mode, or the default first address in 10-bit mode. After
the first 8 bits are transmitted and an ACK is received,
the user may then transmit an additional eight bits of
address (10-bit mode) or 8 bits of data (7-bit mode).
16.4.9.1
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a Repeated Start
sequence is in progress, the WCOL is set and the contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesn’t
occur).
Note:
FIGURE 16-20:
WCOL Status Flag
Because queueing of events is not
allowed, writing of the lower 5 bits of
SSPCON2 is disabled until the Repeated
Start condition is complete.
REPEAT START CONDITION WAVEFORM
Set S (SSPSTAT<3>)
Write to SSPCON2
occurs here.
SDA = 1,
SCL (no change).
SDA = 1,
SCL = 1
TBRG
At completion of Start bit,
hardware clears RSEN bit
and sets SSPIF
TBRG
TBRG
1st bit
SDA
Write to SSPBUF occurs here
Falling edge of ninth clock,
end of Xmit
TBRG
SCL
TBRG
Sr = Repeated Start
DS39635A-page 198
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.10
I2C MASTER MODE
TRANSMISSION
16.4.10.3
Transmission of a data byte, a 7-bit address, or the
other half of a 10-bit address is accomplished by simply
writing a value to the SSPBUF register. This action will
set the Buffer Full flag bit, BF and allow the Baud Rate
Generator to begin counting and start the next transmission. Each bit of address/data will be shifted out
onto the SDA pin after the falling edge of SCL is
asserted (see data hold time specification parameter
#106). SCL is held low for one Baud Rate Generator
rollover count (TBRG). Data should be valid before SCL
is released high (see data setup time specification
parameter #107). When the SCL pin is released high, it
is held that way for TBRG. The data on the SDA pin
must remain stable for that duration and some hold
time after the next falling edge of SCL. After the eighth
bit is shifted out (the falling edge of the eighth clock),
the BF flag is cleared and the master releases SDA.
This allows the slave device being addressed to
respond with an ACK bit during the ninth bit time if an
address match occurred, or if data was received
properly. The status of ACK is written into the ACKDT
bit on the falling edge of the ninth clock. If the master
receives an Acknowledge, the Acknowledge Status bit,
ACKSTAT, is cleared. If not, the bit is set. After the ninth
clock, the SSPIF bit is set and the master clock (Baud
Rate Generator) is suspended until the next data byte
is loaded into the SSPBUF, leaving SCL low and SDA
unchanged (Figure 16-21).
After the write to the SSPBUF, each bit of address will
be shifted out on the falling edge of SCL until all
7 address bits and the R/W bit are completed. On the
falling edge of the eighth clock, the master will deassert
the SDA pin, allowing the slave to respond with an
Acknowledge. On the falling edge of the ninth clock, the
master will sample the SDA pin to see if the address
was recognized by a slave. The status of the ACK bit is
loaded into the ACKSTAT status bit (SSPCON2<6>).
Following the falling edge of the ninth clock transmission of the address, the SSPIF is set, the BF flag is
cleared and the Baud Rate Generator is turned off until
another write to the SSPBUF takes place, holding SCL
low and allowing SDA to float.
16.4.10.1
BF Status Flag
ACKSTAT Status Flag
In Transmit mode, the ACKSTAT bit (SSPCON2<6>) is
cleared when the slave has sent an Acknowledge
(ACK = 0) and is set when the slave does not Acknowledge (ACK = 1). A slave sends an Acknowledge when
it has recognized its address (including a general call),
or when the slave has properly received its data.
16.4.11
I2C MASTER MODE RECEPTION
Master mode reception is enabled by programming the
Receive Enable bit, RCEN (SSPCON2<3>).
Note:
The MSSP module must be in an Idle state
before the RCEN bit is set or the RCEN bit
will be disregarded.
The Baud Rate Generator begins counting and on each
rollover, the state of the SCL pin changes (high-to-low/
low-to-high) and data is shifted into the SSPSR. After
the falling edge of the eighth clock, the receive enable
flag is automatically cleared, the contents of the
SSPSR are loaded into the SSPBUF, the BF flag bit is
set, the SSPIF flag bit is set and the Baud Rate
Generator is suspended from counting, holding SCL
low. The MSSP is now in Idle state awaiting the next
command. When the buffer is read by the CPU, the BF
flag bit is automatically cleared. The user can then
send an Acknowledge bit at the end of reception by setting the Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit, ACKEN
(SSPCON2<4>).
16.4.11.1
BF Status Flag
In receive operation, the BF bit is set when an address
or data byte is loaded into SSPBUF from SSPSR. It is
cleared when the SSPBUF register is read.
16.4.11.2
SSPOV Status Flag
In receive operation, the SSPOV bit is set when 8 bits
are received into the SSPSR and the BF flag bit is
already set from a previous reception.
16.4.11.3
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a receive is
already in progress (i.e., SSPSR is still shifting in a data
byte), the WCOL bit is set and the contents of the buffer
are unchanged (the write doesn’t occur).
In Transmit mode, the BF bit (SSPSTAT<0>) is set
when the CPU writes to SSPBUF and is cleared when
all 8 bits are shifted out.
16.4.10.2
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a transmit is
already in progress (i.e., SSPSR is still shifting out a
data byte), the WCOL is set and the contents of the
buffer are unchanged (the write doesn’t occur).
WCOL must be cleared in software.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 199
DS39635A-page 200
S
Preliminary
R/W
PEN
SEN
BF (SSPSTAT<0>)
SSPIF
SCL
SDA
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
3
4
5
Cleared in software
2
6
7
8
9
After Start condition, SEN cleared by hardware
SSPBUF written
1
D7
1
SCL held low
while CPU
responds to SSPIF
ACK = 0
R/W = 0
SSPBUF written with 7-bit address and R/W
start transmit
A7
Transmit Address to Slave
3
D5
4
D4
5
D3
6
D2
7
D1
8
D0
SSPBUF is written in software
Cleared in software service routine
from SSP interrupt
2
D6
Transmitting Data or Second Half
of 10-bit Address
From slave, clear ACKSTAT bit SSPCON2<6>
P
Cleared in software
9
ACK
ACKSTAT in
SSPCON2 = 1
FIGURE 16-21:
SEN = 0
Write SSPCON2<0> SEN = 1
Start condition begins
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I 2C™ MASTER MODE WAVEFORM (TRANSMISSION, 7 OR 10-BIT ADDRESS)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
ACKEN
SSPOV
BF
(SSPSTAT<0>)
SDA = 0, SCL = 1
while CPU
responds to SSPIF
SSPIF
4
5
Cleared in software
3
6
2
1
SCL
S
A6 A5 A4 A3 A2
Transmit Address to Slave
A7
SDA
7
A1
8
9
R/W = 1
ACK
ACK from Slave
2
3
5
6
7
8
D0
9
ACK
2
3
4
5
6
7
Cleared in software
Set SSPIF interrupt
at end of Acknowledge
sequence
Data shifted in on falling edge of CLK
1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1
Cleared in
software
Set SSPIF at end
of receive
9
ACK is not sent
ACK
P
Set SSPIF interrupt
at end of Acknowledge sequence
Bus master
terminates
transfer
Set P bit
(SSPSTAT<4>)
and SSPIF
PEN bit = 1
written here
SSPOV is set because
SSPBUF is still full
8
D0
RCEN cleared
automatically
Set ACKEN, start Acknowledge sequence
SDA = ACKDT = 1
Receiving Data from Slave
RCEN = 1, start
next receive
ACK from Master
SDA = ACKDT = 0
Last bit is shifted into SSPSR and
contents are unloaded into SSPBUF
Cleared in software
Set SSPIF interrupt
at end of receive
4
Cleared in software
1
D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1
Receiving Data from Slave
RCEN cleared
automatically
Master configured as a receiver
by programming SSPCON2<3> (RCEN = 1)
FIGURE 16-22:
SEN = 0
Write to SSPBUF occurs here
Start XMIT
Write to SSPCON2<0> (SEN = 1)
Begin Start Condition
Write to SSPCON2<4>
to start Acknowledge sequence
SDA = ACKDT (SSPCON2<5>) = 0
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
I 2C™ MASTER MODE WAVEFORM (RECEPTION, 7-BIT ADDRESS)
DS39635A-page 201
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.12
ACKNOWLEDGE SEQUENCE
TIMING
16.4.13
A Stop bit is asserted on the SDA pin at the end of a
receive/transmit by setting the Stop Sequence Enable
bit, PEN (SSPCON2<2>). At the end of a receive/
transmit, the SCL line is held low after the falling edge
of the ninth clock. When the PEN bit is set, the master
will assert the SDA line low. When the SDA line is sampled low, the Baud Rate Generator is reloaded and
counts down to ‘0’. When the Baud Rate Generator
times out, the SCL pin will be brought high and one
TBRG (Baud Rate Generator rollover count) later, the
SDA pin will be deasserted. When the SDA pin is sampled high while SCL is high, the P bit (SSPSTAT<4>) is
set. A TBRG later, the PEN bit is cleared and the SSPIF
bit is set (Figure 16-24).
An Acknowledge sequence is enabled by setting the
Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit, ACKEN
(SSPCON2<4>). When this bit is set, the SCL pin is
pulled low and the contents of the Acknowledge data bit
are presented on the SDA pin. If the user wishes to generate an Acknowledge, then the ACKDT bit should be
cleared. If not, the user should set the ACKDT bit before
starting an Acknowledge sequence. The Baud Rate
Generator then counts for one rollover period (TBRG)
and the SCL pin is deasserted (pulled high). When the
SCL pin is sampled high (clock arbitration), the Baud
Rate Generator counts for TBRG. The SCL pin is then
pulled low. Following this, the ACKEN bit is automatically
cleared, the Baud Rate Generator is turned off and the
MSSP module then goes into Idle mode (Figure 16-23).
16.4.12.1
16.4.13.1
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when a Stop sequence
is in progress, then the WCOL bit is set and the
contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesn’t
occur).
WCOL Status Flag
If the user writes the SSPBUF when an Acknowledge
sequence is in progress, then WCOL is set and the
contents of the buffer are unchanged (the write doesn’t
occur).
FIGURE 16-23:
STOP CONDITION TIMING
ACKNOWLEDGE SEQUENCE WAVEFORM
Acknowledge sequence starts here,
write to SSPCON2
ACKEN = 1, ACKDT = 0
ACKEN automatically cleared
TBRG
SDA
ACK
D0
SCL
TBRG
8
9
SSPIF
Set SSPIF at the end
of receive
Cleared in
software
Set SSPIF at the end
of Acknowledge sequence
Cleared in
software
Note: TBRG = one Baud Rate Generator period.
FIGURE 16-24:
STOP CONDITION RECEIVE OR TRANSMIT MODE
SCL = 1 for TBRG, followed by SDA = 1 for TBRG
after SDA sampled high. P bit (SSPSTAT<4>) is set.
Write to SSPCON2,
set PEN
PEN bit (SSPCON2<2>) is cleared by
hardware and the SSPIF bit is set
Falling edge of
9th clock
TBRG
SCL
SDA
ACK
P
TBRG
TBRG
TBRG
SCL brought high after TBRG
SDA asserted low before rising edge of clock
to setup Stop condition
Note: TBRG = one Baud Rate Generator period.
DS39635A-page 202
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.14
SLEEP OPERATION
16.4.17
2
While in Sleep mode, the I C module can receive
addresses or data and when an address match or
complete byte transfer occurs, wake the processor
from Sleep (if the MSSP interrupt is enabled).
16.4.15
EFFECT OF A RESET
A Reset disables the MSSP module and terminates the
current transfer.
16.4.16
MULTI-MASTER MODE
In Multi-Master mode, the interrupt generation on the
detection of the Start and Stop conditions allows the
determination of when the bus is free. The Stop (P) and
Start (S) bits are cleared from a Reset or when the
MSSP module is disabled. Control of the I 2C bus may
be taken when the P bit (SSPSTAT<4>) is set, or the
bus is Idle, with both the S and P bits clear. When the
bus is busy, enabling the SSP interrupt will generate
the interrupt when the Stop condition occurs.
In multi-master operation, the SDA line must be
monitored for arbitration to see if the signal level is the
expected output level. This check is performed in
hardware with the result placed in the BCLIF bit.
The states where arbitration can be lost are:
•
•
•
•
•
Address Transfer
Data Transfer
A Start Condition
A Repeated Start Condition
An Acknowledge Condition
MULTI -MASTER COMMUNICATION,
BUS COLLISION AND BUS
ARBITRATION
Multi-Master mode support is achieved by bus arbitration. When the master outputs address/data bits onto
the SDA pin, arbitration takes place when the master
outputs a ‘1’ on SDA, by letting SDA float high and
another master asserts a ‘0’. When the SCL pin floats
high, data should be stable. If the expected data on
SDA is a ‘1’ and the data sampled on the SDA pin = 0,
then a bus collision has taken place. The master will set
the Bus Collision Interrupt Flag, BCLIF and reset the
I2C port to its Idle state (Figure 16-25).
If a transmit was in progress when the bus collision
occurred, the transmission is halted, the BF flag is
cleared, the SDA and SCL lines are deasserted and the
SSPBUF can be written to. When the user services the
bus collision Interrupt Service Routine and if the I2C
bus is free, the user can resume communication by
asserting a Start condition.
If a Start, Repeated Start, Stop or Acknowledge condition was in progress when the bus collision occurred, the
condition is aborted, the SDA and SCL lines are deasserted and the respective control bits in the SSPCON2
register are cleared. When the user services the bus
collision Interrupt Service Routine and if the I2C bus is
free, the user can resume communication by asserting a
Start condition.
The master will continue to monitor the SDA and SCL
pins. If a Stop condition occurs, the SSPIF bit will be set.
A write to the SSPBUF will start the transmission of
data at the first data bit regardless of where the
transmitter left off when the bus collision occurred.
In Multi-Master mode, the interrupt generation on the
detection of Start and Stop conditions allows the determination of when the bus is free. Control of the I2C bus
can be taken when the P bit is set in the SSPSTAT
register, or the bus is Idle and the S and P bits are
cleared.
FIGURE 16-25:
BUS COLLISION TIMING FOR TRANSMIT AND ACKNOWLEDGE
Data changes
while SCL = 0
SDA line pulled low
by another source
SDA released
by master
Sample SDA. While SCL is high,
data doesn’t match what is driven
by the master.
Bus collision has occurred.
SDA
SCL
Set bus collision
interrupt (BCLIF)
BCLIF
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 203
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.17.1
Bus Collision During a Start
Condition
During a Start condition, a bus collision occurs if:
a)
b)
SDA or SCL are sampled low at the beginning of
the Start condition (Figure 16-26).
SCL is sampled low before SDA is asserted low
(Figure 16-27).
During a Start condition, both the SDA and the SCL
pins are monitored.
If the SDA pin is sampled low during this count, the
BRG is reset and the SDA line is asserted early
(Figure 16-28). If, however, a ‘1’ is sampled on the SDA
pin, the SDA pin is asserted low at the end of the BRG
count. The Baud Rate Generator is then reloaded and
counts down to ‘0’ and during this time, if the SCL pins
are sampled as ‘0’, a bus collision does not occur. At
the end of the BRG count, the SCL pin is asserted low.
Note:
If the SDA pin is already low, or the SCL pin is already
low, then all of the following occur:
• the Start condition is aborted,
• the BCLIF flag is set and
• the MSSP module is reset to its Idle state
(Figure 16-26).
The Start condition begins with the SDA and SCL pins
deasserted. When the SDA pin is sampled high, the
Baud Rate Generator is loaded from SSPADD<6:0>
and counts down to ‘0’. If the SCL pin is sampled low
while SDA is high, a bus collision occurs because it is
assumed that another master is attempting to drive a
data ‘1’ during the Start condition.
FIGURE 16-26:
The reason that bus collision is not a factor
during a Start condition is that no two bus
masters can assert a Start condition at the
exact same time. Therefore, one master
will always assert SDA before the other.
This condition does not cause a bus
collision because the two masters must be
allowed to arbitrate the first address following the Start condition. If the address is the
same, arbitration must be allowed to
continue into the data portion, Repeated
Start or Stop conditions.
BUS COLLISION DURING START CONDITION (SDA ONLY)
SDA goes low before the SEN bit is set.
Set BCLIF,
S bit and SSPIF set because
SDA = 0, SCL = 1.
SDA
SCL
Set SEN, enable Start
condition if SDA = 1, SCL = 1
SEN cleared automatically because of bus collision.
SSP module reset into Idle state.
SEN
BCLIF
SDA sampled low before
Start condition. Set BCLIF.
S bit and SSPIF set because
SDA = 0, SCL = 1.
SSPIF and BCLIF are
cleared in software
S
SSPIF
SSPIF and BCLIF are
cleared in software
DS39635A-page 204
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 16-27:
BUS COLLISION DURING A START CONDITION (SCL = 0)
SDA = 0, SCL = 1
TBRG
TBRG
SDA
Set SEN, enable Start
sequence if SDA = 1, SCL = 1
SCL
SCL = 0 before SDA = 0,
bus collision occurs. Set BCLIF.
SEN
SCL = 0 before BRG time-out,
bus collision occurs. Set BCLIF.
BCLIF
Interrupt cleared
in software
S
‘0’
‘0’
SSPIF
‘0’
‘0’
FIGURE 16-28:
BRG RESET DUE TO SDA ARBITRATION DURING START CONDITION
SDA = 0, SCL = 1
Set S
Less than TBRG
SDA
Set SSPIF
TBRG
SDA pulled low by other master.
Reset BRG and assert SDA.
SCL
S
SCL pulled low after BRG
time-out
SEN
BCLIF
Set SEN, enable START
sequence if SDA = 1, SCL = 1
‘0’
S
SSPIF
SDA = 0, SCL = 1,
set SSPIF
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
Interrupts cleared
in software
DS39635A-page 205
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.17.2
Bus Collision During a Repeated
Start Condition
If SDA is low, a bus collision has occurred (i.e., another
master is attempting to transmit a data ‘0’, Figure 16-29).
If SDA is sampled high, the BRG is reloaded and begins
counting. If SDA goes from high-to-low before the BRG
times out, no bus collision occurs because no two
masters can assert SDA at exactly the same time.
During a Repeated Start condition, a bus collision
occurs if:
a)
b)
A low level is sampled on SDA when SCL goes
from low level to high level.
SCL goes low before SDA is asserted low,
indicating that another master is attempting to
transmit a data ‘1’.
If SCL goes from high-to-low before the BRG times out
and SDA has not already been asserted, a bus collision
occurs. In this case, another master is attempting to
transmit a data ‘1’ during the Repeated Start condition
(see Figure 16-30).
When the user deasserts SDA and the pin is allowed to
float high, the BRG is loaded with SSPADD<6:0> and
counts down to ‘0’. The SCL pin is then deasserted and
when sampled high, the SDA pin is sampled.
FIGURE 16-29:
If, at the end of the BRG time-out, both SCL and SDA
are still high, the SDA pin is driven low and the BRG is
reloaded and begins counting. At the end of the count,
regardless of the status of the SCL pin, the SCL pin is
driven low and the Repeated Start condition is
complete.
BUS COLLISION DURING A REPEATED START CONDITION (CASE 1)
SDA
SCL
Sample SDA when SCL goes high.
If SDA = 0, set BCLIF and release SDA and SCL.
RSEN
BCLIF
Cleared in software
‘0’
S
‘0’
SSPIF
FIGURE 16-30:
BUS COLLISION DURING A REPEATED START CONDITION (CASE 2)
TBRG
TBRG
SDA
SCL
BCLIF
SCL goes low before SDA,
set BCLIF. Release SDA and SCL.
Interrupt cleared
in software
RSEN
‘0’
S
SSPIF
DS39635A-page 206
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
16.4.17.3
Bus Collision During a Stop
Condition
The Stop condition begins with SDA asserted low.
When SDA is sampled low, the SCL pin is allowed to
float. When the pin is sampled high (clock arbitration),
the Baud Rate Generator is loaded with SSPADD<6:0>
and counts down to ‘0’. After the BRG times out, SDA
is sampled. If SDA is sampled low, a bus collision has
occurred. This is due to another master attempting to
drive a data ‘0’ (Figure 16-31). If the SCL pin is
sampled low before SDA is allowed to float high, a bus
collision occurs. This is another case of another master
attempting to drive a data ‘0’ (Figure 16-32).
Bus collision occurs during a Stop condition if:
a)
b)
After the SDA pin has been deasserted and
allowed to float high, SDA is sampled low after
the BRG has timed out.
After the SCL pin is deasserted, SCL is sampled
low before SDA goes high.
FIGURE 16-31:
BUS COLLISION DURING A STOP CONDITION (CASE 1)
TBRG
TBRG
TBRG
SDA sampled
low after TBRG,
set BCLIF
SDA
SDA asserted low
SCL
PEN
BCLIF
P
‘0’
SSPIF
‘0’
FIGURE 16-32:
BUS COLLISION DURING A STOP CONDITION (CASE 2)
TBRG
TBRG
TBRG
SDA
SCL goes low before SDA goes high,
set BCLIF
Assert SDA
SCL
PEN
BCLIF
P
‘0’
SSPIF
‘0’
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 207
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 16-4:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH I2C™ OPERATION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
IPR1
TRISC
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
PORTC Data Direction Register
60
SSPBUF
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
58
SSPADD
Synchronous Serial Port Receive Buffer/Transmit Register
58
SSPCON1
WCOL
SSPOV
SSPEN
CKP
SSPM3
SSPM2
SSPM1
SSPM0
58
SSPCON2
GCEN
ACKSTAT
ACKDT
ACKEN
RCEN
PEN
RSEN
SEN
58
SSPSTAT
SMP
CKE
D/A
P
S
R/W
UA
BF
58
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the MSSP in SPI™ mode.
DS39635A-page 208
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.0
ENHANCED UNIVERSAL
SYNCHRONOUS
ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER
TRANSMITTER (EUSART)
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices have three
serial I/O modules: the MSSP module, discussed in the
previous chapter and two Universal Synchronous
Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (USART) modules. (Generically, the USART is also known as a Serial
Communications Interface or SCI.) The USART can be
configured as a full-duplex asynchronous system that
can communicate with peripheral devices, such as
CRT terminals and personal computers. It can also be
configured as a half-duplex synchronous system that
can communicate with peripheral devices, such as A/D
or D/A integrated circuits, serial EEPROMs, etc.
There are two distinct implementations of the USART
module in these devices: the Enhanced USART
(EUSART), discussed here and the Addressable
USART, discussed in the next chapter. For this device
family, USART1 always refers to the EUSART, while
USART2 is always the AUSART.
The EUSART and AUSART modules implement the
same core features for serial communications; their
basic operation is essentially the same. The EUSART
module provides additional features, including automatic baud rate detection and calibration, automatic
wake-up on Sync Break reception and 12-bit Break
character transmit. These features make it ideally
suited for use in Local Interconnect Network bus (LIN
bus) systems.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
The EUSART can be configured in the following
modes:
• Asynchronous (full-duplex) with:
- Auto-wake-up on character reception
- Auto-baud calibration
- 12-bit Break character transmission
• Synchronous – Master (half-duplex) with
selectable clock polarity
• Synchronous – Slave (half-duplex) with selectable
clock polarity
The pins of the Enhanced USART are multiplexed with
PORTC. In order to configure RC6/TX1/CK1 and
RC7/RX1/DT1 as a USART:
• bit SPEN (RCSTA1<7>) must be set (= 1)
• bit TRISC<7> must be set (= 1)
• bit TRISC<6> must be set (= 1)
Note:
The USART control will automatically
reconfigure the pin from input to output as
needed.
The operation of the Enhanced USART module is
controlled through three registers:
• Transmit Status and Control Register 1 (TXSTA1)
• Receive Status and Control Register 1 (RCSTA1)
• Baud Rate Control Register 1 (BAUDCON1)
The registers are described
Register 17-2 and Register 17-3.
Preliminary
in
Register 17-1,
DS39635A-page 209
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 17-1:
TXSTA1: EUSART TRANSMIT STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-1
R/W-0
CSRC
TX9
TXEN(1)
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
CSRC: Clock Source Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
Don’t care.
Synchronous mode:
1 = Master mode (clock generated internally from BRG)
0 = Slave mode (clock from external source)
bit 6
TX9: 9-bit Transmit Enable bit
1 = Selects 9-bit transmission
0 = Selects 8-bit transmission
bit 5
TXEN: Transmit Enable bit(1)
1 = Transmit enabled
0 = Transmit disabled
Note 1: SREN/CREN overrides TXEN in Sync mode.
bit 4
SYNC: AUSART Mode Select bit
1 = Synchronous mode
0 = Asynchronous mode
bit 3
SENDB: Send Break Character bit
Asynchronous mode:
1 = Send Sync Break on next transmission (cleared by hardware upon completion)
0 = Sync Break transmission completed
Synchronous mode:
Don’t care.
bit 2
BRGH: High Baud Rate Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
1 = High speed
0 = Low speed
Synchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 1
TRMT: Transmit Shift Register Status bit
1 = TSR empty
0 = TSR full
bit 0
TX9D: 9th bit of Transmit Data
Can be address/data bit or a parity bit.
Legend:
DS39635A-page 210
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 17-2:
RCSTA1: EUSART RECEIVE STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
bit 7
R-x
RX9D
bit 0
bit 7
SPEN: Serial Port Enable bit
1 = Serial port enabled (configures RX/DT and TX/CK pins as serial port pins)
0 = Serial port disabled (held in Reset)
bit 6
RX9: 9-bit Receive Enable bit
1 = Selects 9-bit reception
0 = Selects 8-bit reception
bit 5
SREN: Single Receive Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
Don’t care.
Synchronous mode – Master:
1 = Enables single receive
0 = Disables single receive
This bit is cleared after reception is complete.
Synchronous mode – Slave:
Don’t care.
bit 4
CREN: Continuous Receive Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
1 = Enables receiver
0 = Disables receiver
Synchronous mode:
1 = Enables continuous receive until enable bit CREN is cleared (CREN overrides SREN)
0 = Disables continuous receive
bit 3
ADDEN: Address Detect Enable bit
Asynchronous mode 9-bit (RX9 = 1):
1 = Enables address detection, enables interrupt and loads the receive buffer when RSR<8>
is set
0 = Disables address detection, all bytes are received and ninth bit can be used as parity bit
Asynchronous mode 9-bit (RX9 = 0):
Don’t care.
bit 2
FERR: Framing Error bit
1 = Framing error (can be updated by reading RCREG register and receiving next valid byte)
0 = No framing error
bit 1
OERR: Overrun Error bit
1 = Overrun error (can be cleared by clearing bit CREN)
0 = No overrun error
bit 0
RX9D: 9th bit of Received Data
This can be address/data bit or a parity bit and must be calculated by user firmware.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 211
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 17-3:
BAUDCON1: BAUD RATE CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R-1
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ABDOVF
RCIDL
—
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
ABDOVF: Auto-Baud Acquisition Rollover Status bit
1 = A BRG rollover has occurred during Auto-Baud Rate Detect mode
(must be cleared in software)
0 = No BRG rollover has occurred
bit 6
RCIDL: Receive Operation Idle Status bit
1 = Receive operation is Idle
0 = Receive operation is active
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4
SCKP: Synchronous Clock Polarity Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
Synchronous mode:
1 = Idle state for clock (CK) is a high level
0 = Idle state for clock (CK) is a low level
bit 3
BRG16: 16-bit Baud Rate Register Enable bit
1 = 16-bit Baud Rate Generator – SPBRGH1 and SPBRG1
0 = 8-bit Baud Rate Generator – SPBRG1 only (Compatible mode), SPBRGH1 value ignored
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1
WUE: Wake-up Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
1 = EUSART will continue to sample the RX pin – interrupt generated on falling edge; bit
cleared in hardware on following rising edge
0 = RX pin not monitored or rising edge detected
Synchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 0
ABDEN: Auto-Baud Detect Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
1 = Enable baud rate measurement on the next character. Requires reception of a Sync field
(55h); cleared in hardware upon completion.
0 = Baud rate measurement disabled or completed
Synchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
Legend:
DS39635A-page 212
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.1
EUSART Baud Rate Generator
(BRG)
be advantageous to use the high baud rate (BRGH = 1)
or the 16-bit BRG to reduce the baud rate error, or
achieve a slow baud rate for a fast oscillator frequency.
The BRG is a dedicated, 8-bit or 16-bit generator that
supports both the Asynchronous and Synchronous
modes of the EUSART. By default, the BRG operates
in 8-bit mode; setting the BRG16 bit (BAUDCON1<3>)
selects 16-bit mode.
The SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 register pair controls the
period of a free running timer. In Asynchronous mode,
bits BRGH (TXSTA1<2>) and BRG16 (BAUDCON1<3>)
also control the baud rate. In Synchronous mode, BRGH
is ignored. Table 17-1 shows the formula for computation of the baud rate for different EUSART modes that
only apply in Master mode (internally generated clock).
Given the desired baud rate and FOSC, the nearest
integer value for the SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 registers can
be calculated using the formulas in Table 17-1. From
this, the error in baud rate can be determined. An
example calculation is shown in Example 17-1. Typical
baud rates and error values for the various
Asynchronous modes are shown in Table 17-2. It may
TABLE 17-1:
Writing a new value to the SPBRGH1:SPBRG1
registers causes the BRG timer to be reset (or cleared).
This ensures the BRG does not wait for a timer
overflow before outputting the new baud rate.
17.1.1
OPERATION IN POWER MANAGED
MODES
The device clock is used to generate the desired baud
rate. When one of the power managed modes is
entered, the new clock source may be operating at a
different frequency. This may require an adjustment to
the value in the SPBRG1 register pair.
17.1.2
SAMPLING
The data on the RX1 pin is sampled three times by a
majority detect circuit to determine if a high or a low
level is present at the RX1 pin.
BAUD RATE FORMULAS
Configuration Bits
BRG/EUSART Mode
Baud Rate Formula
0
8-bit/Asynchronous
FOSC/[64 (n + 1)]
1
8-bit/Asynchronous
1
0
16-bit/Asynchronous
0
1
1
16-bit/Asynchronous
1
0
x
8-bit/Synchronous
1
1
x
16-bit/Synchronous
SYNC
BRG16
BRGH
0
0
0
0
0
FOSC/[16 (n + 1)]
FOSC/[4 (n + 1)]
Legend: x = Don’t care, n = Value of SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 register pair
EXAMPLE 17-1:
CALCULATING BAUD RATE ERROR
For a device with FOSC of 16 MHz, desired baud rate of 9600, Asynchronous mode, 8-bit BRG:
Desired Baud Rate
= FOSC/(64 ([SPBRGH1:SPBRG1] + 1))
Solving for SPBRGH1:SPBRG1:
X = ((FOSC/Desired Baud Rate)/64) – 1
= ((16000000/9600)/64) – 1
= [25.042] = 25
Calculated Baud Rate = 16000000/(64 (25 + 1))
= 9615
Error
= (Calculated Baud Rate – Desired Baud Rate)/Desired Baud Rate
= (9615 – 9600)/9600 = 0.16%
TABLE 17-2:
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE BAUD RATE GENERATOR
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset Values
on Page
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
59
RCSTA1
BAUDCON1
SPEN
ABDOVF
RX9
RCIDL
SREN
—
CREN
SCKP
ADDEN
BRG16
FERR
—
OERR
WUE
RX9D
ABDEN
59
60
SPBRGH1
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator Register, High Byte
Baud Rate Generator Register, Low Byte
Name
TXSTA1
60
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the BRG.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 213
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 17-3:
BAUD RATES FOR ASYNCHRONOUS MODES
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
—
1.221
2.441
1.73
255
9.615
0.16
64
19.2
19.531
1.73
31
57.6
56.818
-1.36
115.2
125.000
8.51
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
—
—
1.2
—
2.4
9.6
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
1.73
255
1.202
2.404
0.16
129
9.766
1.73
31
19.531
1.73
10
62.500
4
104.167
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
0.16
129
1201
-0.16
103
2.404
0.16
64
2403
-0.16
51
9.766
1.73
15
9615
-0.16
12
15
19.531
1.73
7
—
—
—
8.51
4
52.083
-9.58
2
—
—
—
-9.58
2
78.125
-32.18
1
—
—
—
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
0.300
0.16
1.2
1.202
0.16
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
207
300
-0.16
51
1201
-0.16
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
103
300
-0.16
51
25
1201
-0.16
12
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
2.4
2.404
0.16
25
2403
-0.16
12
—
—
—
9.6
8.929
-6.99
6
—
—
—
—
—
—
19.2
20.833
8.51
2
—
—
—
—
—
—
57.6
62.500
8.51
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
115.2
62.500
-45.75
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
9.766
1.73
255
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
—
1.2
—
2.4
9.6
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
9.615
0.16
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2.441
1.73
255
2403
-0.16
207
129
9.615
0.16
64
9615
-0.16
51
25
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
—
19.2
19.231
0.16
129
19.231
0.16
64
19.531
1.73
31
19230
-0.16
57.6
58.140
0.94
42
56.818
-1.36
21
56.818
-1.36
10
55555
3.55
8
115.2
113.636
-1.36
21
113.636
-1.36
10
125.000
8.51
4
—
—
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
0.3
—
—
—
—
—
—
300
-0.16
207
1.2
1.202
0.16
207
1201
-0.16
103
1201
-0.16
51
2.4
2.404
0.16
103
2403
-0.16
51
2403
-0.16
25
9.6
9.615
0.16
25
9615
-0.16
12
—
—
—
19.2
19.231
0.16
12
—
—
—
—
—
—
57.6
62.500
8.51
3
—
—
—
—
—
—
115.2
125.000
8.51
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
DS39635A-page 214
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 17-3:
BAUD RATES FOR ASYNCHRONOUS MODES (CONTINUED)
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
0.3
0.300
0.00
8332
0.300
0.02
4165
0.300
0.02
2082
300
-0.04
1.2
1.200
0.02
2082
1.200
-0.03
1041
1.200
-0.03
520
1201
-0.16
1665
415
2.4
2.402
0.06
1040
2.399
-0.03
520
2.404
0.16
259
2403
-0.16
207
9.6
9.615
0.16
259
9.615
0.16
129
9.615
0.16
64
9615
-0.16
51
25
19.2
19.231
0.16
129
19.231
0.16
64
19.531
1.73
31
19230
-0.16
57.6
58.140
0.94
42
56.818
-1.36
21
56.818
-1.36
10
55555
3.55
8
115.2
113.636
-1.36
21
113.636
-1.36
10
125.000
8.51
4
—
—
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
0.300
0.04
832
300
-0.16
415
300
-0.16
1.2
1.202
0.16
207
1201
-0.16
103
1201
-0.16
51
2.4
2.404
0.16
103
2403
-0.16
51
2403
-0.16
25
9.6
9.615
0.16
25
9615
-0.16
12
—
—
—
19.2
19.231
0.16
12
—
—
—
—
—
—
57.6
62.500
8.51
3
—
—
—
—
—
—
115.2
125.000
8.51
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
207
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 1 or SYNC = 1, BRG16 = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.00
33332
0.300
0.00
8332
1.200
0.02
4165
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
0.300
1.2
1.200
2.4
2.400
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.00
16665
0.300
0.00
0.02
4165
1.200
0.02
2.400
0.02
2082
2.402
0.06
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
8332
300
-0.01
6665
2082
1200
-0.04
1665
1040
2400
-0.04
832
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
9.6
9.606
0.06
1040
9.596
-0.03
520
9.615
0.16
259
9615
-0.16
207
19.2
19.193
-0.03
520
19.231
0.16
259
19.231
0.16
129
19230
-0.16
103
57.6
57.803
0.35
172
57.471
-0.22
86
58.140
0.94
42
57142
0.79
34
115.2
114.943
-0.22
86
116.279
0.94
42
113.636
-1.36
21
117647
-2.12
16
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 1 or SYNC = 1, BRG16 = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
0.3
1.2
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.300
1.200
0.01
0.04
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
3332
832
300
1201
-0.04
-0.16
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
1665
415
300
1201
-0.04
-0.16
832
207
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
2.4
2.404
0.16
415
2403
-0.16
207
2403
-0.16
103
9.6
9.615
0.16
103
9615
-0.16
51
9615
-0.16
25
19.2
19.231
0.16
51
19230
-0.16
25
19230
-0.16
12
57.6
58.824
2.12
16
55555
3.55
8
—
—
—
115.2
111.111
-3.55
8
—
—
—
—
—
—
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 215
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.1.3
AUTO-BAUD RATE DETECT
The Enhanced USART module supports the automatic
detection and calibration of baud rate. This feature is
active only in Asynchronous mode and while the WUE
bit is clear.
The automatic baud rate measurement sequence
(Figure 17-1) begins whenever a Start bit is received
and the ABDEN bit is set. The calculation is
self-averaging.
While the ABD sequence takes place, the EUSART
state machine is held in Idle. The RC1IF interrupt is set
once the fifth rising edge on RX1 is detected. The value
in the RCREG1 needs to be read to clear the RC1IF
interrupt. The contents of RCREG1 should be
discarded.
Note 1: If the WUE bit is set with the ABDEN bit,
Auto-Baud Rate Detection will occur on
the byte following the Break character.
2: It is up to the user to determine that the
incoming character baud rate is within the
range of the selected BRG clock source.
Some combinations of oscillator frequency
and EUSART baud rates are not possible
due to bit error rates. Overall system timing
and communication baud rates must be
taken into consideration when using the
Auto-Baud Rate Detection feature.
In the Auto-Baud Rate Detect (ABD) mode, the clock to
the BRG is reversed. Rather than the BRG clocking the
incoming RX1 signal, the RX1 signal is timing the BRG.
In ABD mode, the internal Baud Rate Generator is
used as a counter to time the bit period of the incoming
serial byte stream.
Once the ABDEN bit is set, the state machine will clear
the BRG and look for a Start bit. The Auto-Baud Rate
Detect must receive a byte with the value, 55h (ASCII
“U”, which is also the LIN bus Sync character), in order
to calculate the proper bit rate. The measurement is
taken over both a low and a high bit time in order to
minimize any effects caused by asymmetry of the
incoming signal. After a Start bit, the SPBRG1 begins
counting up, using the preselected clock source on the
first rising edge of RX1. After eight bits on the RX1 pin
or the fifth rising edge, an accumulated value totalling
the
proper
BRG
period
is
left
in
the
SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 register pair. Once the 5th edge is
seen (this should correspond to the Stop bit), the
ABDEN bit is automatically cleared.
If a rollover of the BRG occurs (an overflow from FFFFh
to 0000h), the event is trapped by the ABDOVF status bit
(BAUDCON1<7>). It is set in hardware by BRG rollovers
and can be set or cleared by the user in software. ABD
mode remains active after rollover events and the
ABDEN bit remains set (Figure 17-2).
While calibrating the baud rate period, the BRG
registers are clocked at 1/8th the preconfigured clock
rate. Note that the BRG clock will be configured by the
BRG16 and BRGH bits. Independent of the BRG16 bit
setting, both the SPBRG1 and SPBRGH1 will be used
as a 16-bit counter. This allows the user to verify that
no carry occurred for 8-bit modes by checking for 00h
in the SPBRGH1 register. Refer to Table 17-4 for
counter clock rates to the BRG.
DS39635A-page 216
TABLE 17-4:
BRG COUNTER CLOCK
RATES
BRG16
BRGH
BRG Counter Clock
0
0
FOSC/512
0
1
FOSC/128
1
0
FOSC/128
1
FOSC/32
1
Note:
17.1.3.1
During the ABD sequence, SPBRG1 and
SPBRGH1 are both used as a 16-bit
counter, independent of the BRG16 setting.
ABD and EUSART Transmission
Since the BRG clock is reversed during ABD acquisition, the EUSART transmitter cannot be used during
ABD. This means that whenever the ABDEN bit is set,
TXREG1 cannot be written to. Users should also
ensure that ABDEN does not become set during a
transmit sequence. Failing to do this may result in
unpredictable EUSART operation.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 17-1:
BRG Value
AUTOMATIC BAUD RATE CALCULATION
XXXXh
0000h
001Ch
Start
RX1 pin
Edge #1
Bit 1
Bit 0
Edge #2
Bit 3
Bit 2
Edge #3
Bit 5
Bit 4
Edge #4
Bit 7
Bit 6
Edge #5
Stop Bit
BRG Clock
Auto-Cleared
Set by User
ABDEN bit
RC1IF bit
(Interrupt)
Read
RCREG1
SPBRG1
XXXXh
1Ch
SPBRGH1
XXXXh
00h
Note: The ABD sequence requires the EUSART module to be configured in Asynchronous mode and WUE = 0.
FIGURE 17-2:
BRG OVERFLOW SEQUENCE
BRG Clock
ABDEN bit
RX1 pin
Start
Bit 0
ABDOVF bit
FFFFh
BRG Value
XXXXh
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
0000h
0000h
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 217
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.2
EUSART Asynchronous Mode
Once the TXREG1 register transfers the data to the
TSR register (occurs in one TCY), the TXREG1 register
is empty and the TX1IF flag bit (PIR1<4>) is set. This
interrupt can be enabled or disabled by setting or clearing the interrupt enable bit, TX1IE (PIE1<4>). TX1IF
will be set regardless of the state of TX1IE; it cannot be
cleared in software. TX1IF is also not cleared immediately upon loading TXREG1, but becomes valid in the
second instruction cycle following the load instruction.
Polling TX1IF immediately following a load of TXREG1
will return invalid results.
The Asynchronous mode of operation is selected by
clearing the SYNC bit (TXSTA1<4>). In this mode, the
EUSART uses standard Non-Return-to-Zero (NRZ) format (one Start bit, eight or nine data bits and one Stop bit).
The most common data format is 8 bits. An on-chip dedicated 8-bit/16-bit Baud Rate Generator can be used to
derive standard baud rate frequencies from the oscillator.
The EUSART transmits and receives the LSb first. The
EUSART’s transmitter and receiver are functionally
independent, but use the same data format and baud
rate. The Baud Rate Generator produces a clock, either
x16 or x64 of the bit shift rate depending on the BRGH
and BRG16 bits (TXSTA1<2> and BAUDCON1<3>).
Parity is not supported by the hardware but can be
implemented in software and stored as the 9th data bit.
While TX1IF indicates the status of the TXREG1 register, another bit, TRMT (TXSTA1<1>), shows the status
of the TSR register. TRMT is a read-only bit which is set
when the TSR register is empty. No interrupt logic is
tied to this bit so the user has to poll this bit in order to
determine if the TSR register is empty.
When operating in Asynchronous mode, the EUSART
module consists of the following important elements:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Note 1: The TSR register is not mapped in data
memory so it is not available to the user.
Baud Rate Generator
Sampling Circuit
Asynchronous Transmitter
Asynchronous Receiver
Auto-Wake-up on Sync Break Character
12-bit Break Character Transmit
Auto-Baud Rate Detection
17.2.1
2: Flag bit TX1IF is set when enable bit
TXEN is set.
To set up an Asynchronous Transmission:
1.
2.
EUSART ASYNCHRONOUS
TRANSMITTER
3.
4.
The EUSART transmitter block diagram is shown in
Figure 17-3. The heart of the transmitter is the Transmit
(Serial) Shift register (TSR). The Shift register obtains
its data from the Read/Write Transmit Buffer register,
TXREG1. The TXREG1 register is loaded with data in
software. The TSR register is not loaded until the Stop
bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As
soon as the Stop bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded
with new data from the TXREG1 register (if available).
5.
6.
7.
8.
FIGURE 17-3:
Initialize the SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 registers for
the appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the
BRGH and BRG16 bits, as required, to achieve
the desired baud rate.
Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TX1IE.
If 9-bit transmission is desired, set transmit bit
TX9; can be used as address/data bit.
Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN,
which will also set bit TX1IF.
If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
Load data to the TXREG1 register (starts
transmission).
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
EUSART TRANSMIT BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus
TX1IF
TXREG1 Register
TX1IE
8
MSb
(8)
LSb
• • •
Pin Buffer
and Control
0
TSR Register
TX1 pin
Interrupt
TXEN
Baud Rate CLK
TRMT
BRG16
SPBRGH1
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator
DS39635A-page 218
SPEN
TX9
TX9D
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 17-4:
ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Write to TXREG1
Word 1
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
TX1 (pin)
Start bit
bit 0
bit 1
bit 7/8
Stop bit
Word 1
TX1IF bit
(Transmit Buffer
Reg. Empty Flag)
1 TCY
Word 1
Transmit Shift Reg
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
FIGURE 17-5:
ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (BACK TO BACK)
Write to TXREG1
Word 2
Word 1
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
TX1 (pin)
TX1IF bit
(Interrupt Reg. Flag)
Start bit
bit 0
bit 1
1 TCY
bit 7/8
Stop bit
Start bit
bit 0
Word 2
Word 1
1 TCY
Word 1
Transmit Shift Reg.
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
Note:
Word 2
Transmit Shift Reg.
This timing diagram shows two consecutive transmissions.
TABLE 17-5:
Name
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
INTCON
RCSTA1
TXREG1
TXSTA1
BAUDCON1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
EUSART Transmit Register
59
59
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
59
ABDOVF
RCIDL
—
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
60
SPBRGH1
Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
60
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
59
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for asynchronous transmission.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 219
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.2.2
EUSART ASYNCHRONOUS
RECEIVER
17.2.3
The receiver block diagram is shown in Figure 17-6.
The data is received on the RX1 pin and drives the data
recovery block. The data recovery block is actually a
high-speed shifter operating at x16 times the baud rate,
whereas the main receive serial shifter operates at the
bit rate or at FOSC. This mode would typically be used
in RS-232 systems.
This mode would typically be used in RS-485 systems.
To set up an Asynchronous Reception with Address
Detect Enable:
1.
Initialize the SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 registers for
the appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the
BRGH and BRG16 bits, as required, to achieve
the desired baud rate.
2. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
the SYNC bit and setting the SPEN bit.
3. If interrupts are required, set the RCEN bit and
select the desired priority level with the RC1IP
bit.
4. Set the RX9 bit to enable 9-bit reception.
5. Set the ADDEN bit to enable address detect.
6. Enable reception by setting the CREN bit.
7. The RC1IF bit will be set when reception is
complete. The interrupt will be Acknowledged if
the RC1IE and GIE bits are set.
8. Read the RCSTA1 register to determine if any
error occurred during reception, as well as read
bit 9 of data (if applicable).
9. Read RCREG1 to determine if the device is
being addressed.
10. If any error occurred, clear the CREN bit.
11. If the device has been addressed, clear the
ADDEN bit to allow all received data into the
receive buffer and interrupt the CPU.
To set up an Asynchronous Reception:
1.
Initialize the SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 registers for
the appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the
BRGH and BRG16 bits, as required, to achieve
the desired baud rate.
2. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN.
3. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RC1IE.
4. If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
5. Enable the reception by setting bit CREN.
6. Flag bit RC1IF will be set when reception is
complete and an interrupt will be generated if
enable bit RC1IE was set.
7. Read the RCSTA1 register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
8. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG1 register.
9. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
enable bit CREN.
10. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
FIGURE 17-6:
SETTING UP 9-BIT MODE WITH
ADDRESS DETECT
EUSART RECEIVE BLOCK DIAGRAM
CREN
OERR
FERR
x64 Baud Rate CLK
BRG16
SPBRGH1
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator
÷ 64
or
÷ 16
or
÷4
RSR Register
MSb
Stop
(8)
7
• • •
LSb
1
0
Start
RX9
Pin Buffer
and Control
Data
Recovery
RX1
RX9D
RCREG1 Register
FIFO
SPEN
8
Interrupt
RC1IF
Data Bus
RC1IE
DS39635A-page 220
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 17-7:
ASYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION
Start
bit
RX1 (pin)
bit 0
bit 1
Start
bit
bit 7/8 Stop
bit
bit 0
Rcv Shift Reg
Rcv Buffer Reg
Stop
bit
Start
bit
bit 7/8
Stop
bit
Word 2
RCREG1
Word 1
RCREG1
RCREG1
Read Rcv
Buffer Reg
bit 7/8
RC1IF
(Interrupt Flag)
OERR bit
CREN bit
Note:
This timing diagram shows three words appearing on the RX1 input. The RCREG1 (Receive Buffer) is read after the third word causing
the OERR (Overrun) bit to be set.
TABLE 17-6:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH ASYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
RCSTA1
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
59
RCREG1
TXSTA1
EUSART Receive Register
59
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
59
RCIDL
—
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
60
BAUDCON1
ABDOVF
SPBRGH1
Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
60
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
59
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for asynchronous reception.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 221
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.2.4
AUTO-WAKE-UP ON SYNC BREAK
CHARACTER
During Sleep mode, all clocks to the EUSART are
suspended. Because of this, the Baud Rate Generator
is inactive and a proper byte reception cannot be performed. The auto-wake-up feature allows the controller
to wake-up, due to activity on the RX1/DT1 line while
the EUSART is operating in Asynchronous mode.
The auto-wake-up feature is enabled by setting the
WUE bit (BAUDCON<1>). Once set, the typical receive
sequence on RX1/DT1 is disabled and the EUSART
remains in an Idle state, monitoring for a wake-up event
independent of the CPU mode. A wake-up event
consists of a high-to-low transition on the RX1/DT1
line. (This coincides with the start of a Sync Break or a
Wake-up Signal character for the LIN protocol.)
Following a wake-up event, the module generates an
RC1IF interrupt. The interrupt is generated synchronously to the Q clocks in normal operating modes
(Figure 17-8) and asynchronously, if the device is in
Sleep mode (Figure 17-9). The interrupt condition is
cleared by reading the RCREG1 register.
17.2.4.2
Special Considerations Using
the WUE Bit
The timing of WUE and RC1IF events may cause some
confusion when it comes to determining the validity of
received data. As noted, setting the WUE bit places the
EUSART in an Idle mode. The wake-up event causes
a receive interrupt by setting the RC1IF bit. The WUE
bit is cleared after this when a rising edge is seen on
RX1/DT1. The interrupt condition is then cleared by
reading the RCREG1 register. Ordinarily, the data in
RCREG1 will be dummy data and should be discarded.
The fact that the WUE bit has been cleared (or is still
set) and the RC1IF flag is set should not be used as an
indicator of the integrity of the data in RCREG1. Users
should consider implementing a parallel method in
firmware to verify received data integrity.
To assure that no actual data is lost, check the RCIDL
bit to verify that a receive operation is not in process. If
a receive operation is not occurring, the WUE bit may
then be set just prior to entering the Sleep mode.
The WUE bit is automatically cleared once a
low-to-high transition is observed on the RX1 line following the wake-up event. At this point, the EUSART
module is in Idle mode and returns to normal operation.
This signals to the user that the Sync Break event is
over.
17.2.4.1
Special Considerations Using
Auto-Wake-up
Since auto-wake-up functions by sensing rising edge
transitions on RX1/DT1, information with any state
changes before the Stop bit may signal a false
end-of-character and cause data or framing errors.
Therefore, to work properly, the initial character in the
transmission must be all ‘0’s. This can be 00h (8 bytes)
for standard RS-232 devices, or 000h (12 bits) for LIN
bus.
Oscillator start-up time must also be considered,
especially in applications using oscillators with longer
start-up intervals (i.e., XT or HS mode). The Sync
Break (or Wake-up Signal) character must be of sufficient length and be followed by a sufficient interval to
allow enough time for the selected oscillator to start
and provide proper initialization of the EUSART.
DS39635A-page 222
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 17-8:
AUTO-WAKE-UP BIT (WUE) TIMINGS DURING NORMAL OPERATION
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
OSC1
Bit set by user
Auto-Cleared
WUE bit
RX1/DT1 Line
RC1IF
Note:
Cleared due to user read of RCREG1
The EUSART remains in Idle while the WUE bit is set.
FIGURE 17-9:
AUTO-WAKE-UP BIT (WUE) TIMINGS DURING SLEEP
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Q1
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
OSC1
Bit set by user
Auto-Cleared
WUE bit
RX1/DT1 Line
Note 1
RC1IF
SLEEP Command Executed
Note 1:
2:
Sleep Ends
Cleared due to user read of RCREG1
If the wake-up event requires long oscillator warm-up time, the auto-clear of the WUE bit can occur while the stposc signal is still active.
This sequence should not depend on the presence of Q clocks.
The EUSART remains in Idle while the WUE bit is set.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 223
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.2.5
BREAK CHARACTER SEQUENCE
The Enhanced USART module has the capability of
sending the special Break character sequences that are
required by the LIN bus standard. The Break character
transmit consists of a Start bit, followed by twelve ‘0’ bits
and a Stop bit. The Frame Break character is sent
whenever the SENDB and TXEN bits (TXSTA<3> and
TXSTA<5>) are set while the Transmit Shift register is
loaded with data. Note that the value of data written to
TXREG1 will be ignored and all ‘0’s will be transmitted.
The SENDB bit is automatically reset by hardware after
the corresponding Stop bit is sent. This allows the user
to preload the transmit FIFO with the next transmit byte
following the Break character (typically, the Sync
character in the LIN specification).
Note that the data value written to the TXREG1 for the
Break character is ignored. The write simply serves the
purpose of initiating the proper sequence.
The TRMT bit indicates when the transmit operation is
active or Idle, just as it does during normal transmission. See Figure 17-10 for the timing of the Break
character sequence.
17.2.5.1
Break and Sync Transmit Sequence
The following sequence will send a message frame
header made up of a Break, followed by an Auto-Baud
Sync byte. This sequence is typical of a LIN bus master.
1.
2.
Configure the EUSART for the desired mode.
Set the TXEN and SENDB bits to set up the
Break character.
FIGURE 17-10:
Write to TXREG1
3.
4.
5.
Load the TXREG1 with a dummy character to
initiate transmission (the value is ignored).
Write ‘55h’ to TXREG1 to load the Sync
character into the transmit FIFO buffer.
After the Break has been sent, the SENDB bit is
reset by hardware. The Sync character now
transmits in the preconfigured mode.
When the TXREG1 becomes empty, as indicated by the
TX1IF, the next data byte can be written to TXREG1.
17.2.6
RECEIVING A BREAK CHARACTER
The Enhanced USART module can receive a Break
character in two ways.
The first method forces configuration of the baud rate
at a frequency of 9/13 the typical speed. This allows for
the Stop bit transition to be at the correct sampling
location (13 bits for Break versus Start bit and 8 data
bits for typical data).
The second method uses the auto-wake-up feature
described in Section 17.2.4 “Auto-Wake-up on Sync
Break Character”. By enabling this feature, the
EUSART will sample the next two transitions on
RX1/DT1, cause an RC1IF interrupt and receive the
next data byte followed by another interrupt.
Note that following a Break character, the user will
typically want to enable the Auto-Baud Rate Detect
feature. For both methods, the user can set the ABD bit
once the TX1IF interrupt is observed.
SEND BREAK CHARACTER SEQUENCE
Dummy Write
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
TX1 (pin)
Start bit
bit 0
bit 1
bit 11
Stop bit
Break
TX1IF bit
(Transmit Buffer
Reg. Empty Flag)
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
SENDB sampled here
Auto-Cleared
SENDB
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
DS39635A-page 224
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.3
EUSART Synchronous
Master Mode
Once the TXREG1 register transfers the data to the
TSR register (occurs in one TCYCLE), the TXREG1 is
empty and the TX1IF flag bit (PIR1<4>) is set. The
interrupt can be enabled or disabled by setting or clearing the interrupt enable bit, TX1IE (PIE1<4>). TX1IF is
set regardless of the state of enable bit TX1IE; it cannot
be cleared in software. It will reset only when new data
is loaded into the TXREG1 register.
The Synchronous Master mode is entered by setting
the CSRC bit (TXSTA<7>). In this mode, the data is
transmitted in a half-duplex manner (i.e., transmission
and reception do not occur at the same time). When
transmitting data, the reception is inhibited and vice
versa. Synchronous mode is entered by setting bit
SYNC (TXSTA<4>). In addition, enable bit, SPEN
(RCSTA1<7>), is set in order to configure the TX1 and
RX1 pins to CK1 (clock) and DT1 (data) lines,
respectively.
While flag bit TX1IF indicates the status of the TXREG1
register, another bit, TRMT (TXSTA<1>), shows the
status of the TSR register. TRMT is a read-only bit which
is set when the TSR is empty. No interrupt logic is tied to
this bit so the user has to poll this bit in order to determine if the TSR register is empty. The TSR is not
mapped in data memory so it is not available to the user.
The Master mode indicates that the processor transmits the master clock on the CK1 line. Clock polarity is
selected with the SCKP bit (BAUDCON<4>); setting
SCKP sets the Idle state on CK1 as high, while clearing
the bit sets the Idle state as low. This option is provided
to support Microwire devices with this module.
17.3.1
To set up a Synchronous Master Transmission:
1.
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS MASTER
TRANSMISSION
2.
The EUSART transmitter block diagram is shown in
Figure 17-3. The heart of the transmitter is the Transmit
(Serial) Shift register (TSR). The Shift register obtains
its data from the Read/Write Transmit Buffer register,
TXREG1. The TXREG1 register is loaded with data in
software. The TSR register is not loaded until the last
bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As
soon as the last bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded
with new data from the TXREG1 (if available).
FIGURE 17-11:
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
Initialize the SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 registers for
the appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the
BRG16 bit, as required, to achieve the desired
baud rate.
Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC, SPEN and CSRC.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TX1IE.
If 9-bit transmission is desired, set bit TX9.
Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN.
If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
Start transmission by loading data to the
TXREG1 register.
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Q1 Q2 Q3Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
RC7/RX1/DT1
pin
bit 0
bit 1
bit 2
Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
bit 7
bit 0
bit 1
bit 7
Word 2
Word 1
RC6/TX1/CK1 pin
(SCKP = 0)
RC6/TX1/CK1 pin
(SCKP = 1)
Write to
TXREG1 Reg
Write Word 1
Write Word 2
TX1IF bit
(Interrupt Flag)
TRMT bit
TXEN bit
Note:
‘1’
‘1’
Sync Master mode, SPBRG1 = 0, continuous transmission of two 8-bit words.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 225
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 17-12:
SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (THROUGH TXEN)
RC7/RX1/DT1 pin
bit 0
bit 1
bit 2
bit 6
bit 7
RC6/TX1/CK1 pin
Write to
TXREG1 Reg
TX1IF bit
TRMT bit
TXEN bit
TABLE 17-7:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS MASTER TRANSMISSION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
RCSTA1
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
59
TXREG1
TXSTA1
EUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
BAUDCON1 ABDOVF
59
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
59
RCIDL
—
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
60
SPBRGH1
Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
60
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous master transmission.
DS39635A-page 226
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.3.2
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS
MASTER RECEPTION
Once Synchronous mode is selected, reception is
enabled by setting either the Single Receive Enable bit,
SREN (RCSTA1<5>), or the Continuous Receive
Enable bit, CREN (RCSTA1<4>). Data is sampled on
the RX1 pin on the falling edge of the clock.
If enable bit SREN is set, only a single word is received.
If enable bit CREN is set, the reception is continuous
until CREN is cleared. If both bits are set, then CREN
takes precedence.
To set up a Synchronous Master Reception:
1.
2.
Initialize the SPBRGH1:SPBRG1 registers for the
appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the BRG16 bit,
as required, to achieve the desired baud rate.
Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC, SPEN and CSRC.
FIGURE 17-13:
3.
4.
5.
6.
Ensure bits CREN and SREN are clear.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RC1IE.
If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
If a single reception is required, set bit SREN.
For continuous reception, set bit CREN.
7. Interrupt flag bit RC1IF will be set when reception
is complete and an interrupt will be generated if
the enable bit RC1IE was set.
8. Read the RCSTA1 register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
9. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG1 register.
10. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
bit CREN.
11. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
SYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION (MASTER MODE, SREN)
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
RC7/RX1/DT1
pin
bit 0
bit 1
bit 2
bit 3
bit 4
bit 5
bit 6
bit 7
RC6/TX1/CK1 pin
(SCKP = 0)
RC6/TX1/CK1 pin
(SCKP = 1)
Write to
SREN bit
SREN bit
CREN bit ‘0’
‘0’
RC1IF bit
(Interrupt)
Read
RCREG1
Note:
Timing diagram demonstrates Sync Master mode with bit SREN = 1 and bit BRGH = 0.
TABLE 17-8:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS MASTER RECEPTION
Bit 7
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
RCSTA1
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
59
RCREG1
TXSTA1
EUSART Receive Register
CSRC
BAUDCON1 ABDOVF
59
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
59
RCIDL
—
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
60
SPBRGH1
Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
60
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous master reception.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 227
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.4
EUSART Synchronous Slave Mode
Synchronous Slave mode is entered by clearing bit
CSRC (TXSTA<7>). This mode differs from the
Synchronous Master mode in that the shift clock is
supplied externally at the CK1 pin (instead of being
supplied internally in Master mode). This allows the
device to transfer or receive data while in any
low-power mode.
17.4.1
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE
TRANSMIT
To set up a Synchronous Slave Transmission:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
The operation of the Synchronous Master and Slave
modes are identical except in the case of the Sleep
mode.
7.
8.
If two words are written to the TXREG1 and then the
SLEEP instruction is executed, the following will occur:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
Enable the synchronous slave serial port by
setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit
CSRC.
Clear bits CREN and SREN.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TX1IE.
If 9-bit transmission is desired, set bit TX9.
Enable the transmission by setting enable bit
TXEN.
If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
Start transmission by loading data to the
TXREG1x register.
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
The first word will immediately transfer to the
TSR register and transmit.
The second word will remain in TXREG1
register.
Flag bit TX1IF will not be set.
When the first word has been shifted out of TSR,
the TXREG1 register will transfer the second
word to the TSR and flag bit TX1IF will now be set.
If enable bit TX1IE is set, the interrupt will wake
the chip from Sleep. If the global interrupt is
enabled, the program will branch to the interrupt
vector.
TABLE 17-9:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE TRANSMISSION
Bit 7
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
RCSTA1
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
59
TXREG1
TXSTA1
EUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
BAUDCON1 ABDOVF
59
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
59
RCIDL
—
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
60
SPBRGH1
Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
60
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous slave transmission.
DS39635A-page 228
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
17.4.2
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE
RECEPTION
To set up a Synchronous Slave Reception:
1.
The operation of the Synchronous Master and Slave
modes is identical except in the case of Sleep or any
Idle mode and bit SREN, which is a “don’t care” in
Slave mode.
If receive is enabled by setting the CREN bit prior to
entering Sleep or any Idle mode, then a word may be
received while in this low-power mode. Once the word
is received, the RSR register will transfer the data to the
RCREG1 register; if the RC1IE enable bit is set, the
interrupt generated will wake the chip from the
low-power mode. If the global interrupt is enabled, the
program will branch to the interrupt vector.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit
CSRC.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RC1IE.
If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
To enable reception, set enable bit CREN.
Flag bit RC1IF will be set when reception is
complete. An interrupt will be generated if
enable bit RC1IE was set.
Read the RCSTA1 register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG1 register.
If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
bit CREN.
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
TABLE 17-10: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE RECEPTION
Name
INTCON
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
59
RCSTA1
RCREG1
TXSTA1
EUSART Receive Register
CSRC
BAUDCON1 ABDOVF
59
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
SENDB
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
59
RCIDL
—
SCKP
BRG16
—
WUE
ABDEN
60
SPBRGH1
Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
60
SPBRG1
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous slave reception.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 229
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 230
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.0
ADDRESSABLE UNIVERSAL
SYNCHRONOUS
ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER
TRANSMITTER (AUSART)
The Addressable Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (AUSART) module is very
similar in function to the Enhanced USART module,
discussed in the previous chapter. It is provided as an
additional channel for serial communication with
external devices, for those situations that do not require
auto-baud detection or LIN bus support.
The AUSART can be configured in the following
modes:
• Asynchronous (full-duplex)
• Synchronous – Master (half-duplex)
• Synchronous – Slave (half-duplex)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
The pins of the AUSART module are multiplexed with
the functions of PORTG (RG1/TX2/CK2 and
RG2/RX2/DT2, respectively). In order to configure
these pins as an AUSART:
• bit SPEN (RCSTA2<7>) must be set (= 1)
• bit TRISG<2> must be set (= 1)
• bit TRISG<1> must be cleared (= 0) for Asynchronous and Synchronous Master modes
• bit TRISG<1> must be set (= 1) for Synchronous
Slave mode
Note:
The USART control will automatically
reconfigure the pin from input to output as
needed.
The operation of the Addressable USART module is
controlled through two registers, TXSTA2 and
RXSTA2. These are detailed in Register 18-1 and
Register 18-2 respectively.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 231
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 18-1:
TXSTA2: AUSART TRANSMIT STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R-1
R/W-0
CSRC
TX9
TXEN(1)
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
CSRC: Clock Source Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
Don’t care.
Synchronous mode:
1 = Master mode (clock generated internally from BRG)
0 = Slave mode (clock from external source)
bit 6
TX9: 9-bit Transmit Enable bit
1 = Selects 9-bit transmission
0 = Selects 8-bit transmission
bit 5
TXEN: Transmit Enable bit(1)
1 = Transmit enabled
0 = Transmit disabled
Note 1: SREN/CREN overrides TXEN in Sync mode.
bit 4
SYNC: AUSART Mode Select bit
1 = Synchronous mode
0 = Asynchronous mode
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
BRGH: High Baud Rate Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
1 = High speed
0 = Low speed
Synchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 1
TRMT: Transmit Shift Register Status bit
1 = TSR empty
0 = TSR full
bit 0
TX9D: 9th bit of Transmit Data
Can be address/data bit or a parity bit.
Legend:
DS39635A-page 232
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 18-2:
RCSTA2: AUSART RECEIVE STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R-x
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
SPEN: Serial Port Enable bit
1 = Serial port enabled (configures RX/DT and TX/CK pins as serial port pins)
0 = Serial port disabled (held in Reset)
bit 6
RX9: 9-bit Receive Enable bit
1 = Selects 9-bit reception
0 = Selects 8-bit reception
bit 5
SREN: Single Receive Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
Don’t care.
Synchronous mode – Master:
1 = Enables single receive
0 = Disables single receive
This bit is cleared after reception is complete.
Synchronous mode – Slave:
Don’t care.
bit 4
CREN: Continuous Receive Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
1 = Enables receiver
0 = Disables receiver
Synchronous mode:
1 = Enables continuous receive until enable bit CREN is cleared (CREN overrides SREN)
0 = Disables continuous receive
bit 3
ADDEN: Address Detect Enable bit
Asynchronous mode 9-bit (RX9 = 1):
1 = Enables address detection, enables interrupt and loads the receive buffer when RSR<8>
is set
0 = Disables address detection, all bytes are received and ninth bit can be used as parity bit
Asynchronous mode 9-bit (RX9 = 0):
Don’t care.
bit 2
FERR: Framing Error bit
1 = Framing error (can be updated by reading RCREG register and receiving next valid byte)
0 = No framing error
bit 1
OERR: Overrun Error bit
1 = Overrun error (can be cleared by clearing bit CREN)
0 = No overrun error
bit 0
RX9D: 9th bit of Received Data
This can be address/data bit or a parity bit and must be calculated by user firmware.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 233
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.1
AUSART Baud Rate Generator
(BRG)
The BRG is a dedicated 8-bit generator that supports
both the Asynchronous and Synchronous modes of the
AUSART.
The SPBRG2 register controls the period of a free
running timer. In Asynchronous mode, bit BRGH
(TXSTA<2>) also controls the baud rate. In Synchronous mode, BRGH is ignored. Table 18-1 shows the
formula for computation of the baud rate for different
AUSART modes, which only apply in Master mode
(internally generated clock).
Given the desired baud rate and FOSC, the nearest
integer value for the SPBRG2 register can be calculated using the formulas in Table 18-1. From this, the
error in baud rate can be determined. An example
calculation is shown in Example 18-1. Typical baud
rates and error values for the various Asynchronous
modes are shown in Table 18-2. It may be advantageous to use the high baud rate (BRGH = 1) to reduce
the baud rate error, or achieve a slow baud rate for a
fast oscillator frequency.
TABLE 18-1:
Writing a new value to the SPBRG2 register causes the
BRG timer to be reset (or cleared). This ensures the
BRG does not wait for a timer overflow before outputting
the new baud rate.
18.1.1
OPERATION IN POWER MANAGED
MODES
The device clock is used to generate the desired baud
rate. When one of the power managed modes is
entered, the new clock source may be operating at a
different frequency. This may require an adjustment to
the value in the SPBRG2 register.
18.1.2
SAMPLING
The data on the RX2 pin is sampled three times by a
majority detect circuit to determine if a high or a low
level is present at the RX2 pin.
BAUD RATE FORMULAS
Configuration Bits
BRG/AUSART Mode
Baud Rate Formula
0
Asynchronous
FOSC/[64 (n + 1)]
1
Asynchronous
FOSC/[16 (n + 1)]
x
Synchronous
FOSC/[4 (n + 1)]
SYNC
BRGH
0
0
1
Legend: x = Don’t care, n = Value of SPBRG2 register
EXAMPLE 18-1:
CALCULATING BAUD RATE ERROR
For a device with FOSC of 16 MHz, desired baud rate of 9600, Asynchronous mode, BRGH = 0:
Desired Baud Rate
= FOSC/(64 ([SPBRG2] + 1))
Solving for SPBRG2:
X = ((FOSC/Desired Baud Rate)/64) – 1
= ((16000000/9600)/64) – 1
= [25.042] = 25
Calculated Baud Rate = 16000000/(64 (25 + 1))
= 9615
Error
= (Calculated Baud Rate – Desired Baud Rate)/Desired Baud Rate
= (9615 – 9600)/9600 = 0.16%
TABLE 18-2:
Name
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE BAUD RATE GENERATOR
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values on
Page
TXSTA2
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
60
RCSTA2
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
60
SPBRG2
Baud Rate Generator Register
60
Legend: Shaded cells are not used by the BRG.
DS39635A-page 234
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 18-3:
BAUD RATES FOR ASYNCHRONOUS MODES
BRGH = 0
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
1.221
—
1.73
2.404
9.766
19.531
10
4
BAUD
RATE
(K)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
1.2
—
—
—
—
2.4
2.441
1.73
255
9.6
9.615
0.16
64
19.2
19.531
1.73
31
57.6
56.818
-1.36
115.2
125.000
8.51
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
255
—
1.202
—
0.16
0.16
129
2.404
1.73
31
9.766
1.73
15
62.500
8.51
104.167
-9.58
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
129
—
1201
—
-0.16
—
103
0.16
64
2403
-0.16
51
1.73
15
9615
-0.16
12
19.531
1.73
7
—
—
—
4
52.083
-9.58
2
—
—
—
2
78.125
-32.18
1
—
—
—
SPBRG
value
%
Error
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
BRGH = 0
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
207
300
-0.16
103
300
-0.16
51
0.16
51
1201
-0.16
25
1201
-0.16
12
BAUD
RATE
(K)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
0.300
0.16
1.2
1.202
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
2.4
2.404
0.16
25
2403
-0.16
12
—
—
—
9.6
8.929
-6.99
6
—
—
—
—
—
—
19.2
20.833
8.51
2
—
—
—
—
—
—
57.6
62.500
8.51
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
115.2
62.500
-45.75
0
—
—
—
—
—
—
BRGH = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
0.3
—
1.2
—
2.4
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SPBRG
value
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2.441
1.73
255
2403
-0.16
207
SPBRG
value
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
—
9.6
9.766
1.73
255
9.615
0.16
129
9.615
0.16
64
9615
-0.16
51
19.2
19.231
0.16
129
19.231
0.16
64
19.531
1.73
31
19230
-0.16
25
57.6
58.140
0.94
42
56.818
-1.36
21
56.818
-1.36
10
55555
3.55
8
115.2
113.636
-1.36
21
113.636
-1.36
10
125.000
8.51
4
—
—
—
BRGH = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
%
Error
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
0.3
—
—
—
—
—
—
300
-0.16
207
1.2
1.202
0.16
207
1201
-0.16
103
1201
-0.16
51
2.4
2.404
0.16
103
2403
-0.16
51
2403
-0.16
25
9.6
9.615
0.16
25
9615
-0.16
12
—
—
—
19.2
19.231
0.16
12
—
—
—
—
—
—
57.6
62.500
8.51
3
—
—
—
—
—
—
115.2
125.000
8.51
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 235
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.2
interrupt can be enabled or disabled by setting or
clearing the interrupt enable bit, TX2IE (PIE3<4>).
TX2IF will be set regardless of the state of TX2IE; it
cannot be cleared in software. TX2IF is also not
cleared immediately upon loading TXREG2, but
becomes valid in the second instruction cycle following
the load instruction. Polling TX2IF immediately
following a load of TXREG2 will return invalid results.
AUSART Asynchronous Mode
The Asynchronous mode of operation is selected by
clearing the SYNC bit (TXSTA2<4>). In this mode, the
AUSART uses standard Non-Return-to-Zero (NRZ) format (one Start bit, eight or nine data bits and one Stop
bit). The most common data format is 8 bits. An on-chip
dedicated 8-bit Baud Rate Generator can be used to
derive standard baud rate frequencies from the
oscillator.
While TX2IF indicates the status of the TXREG2 register, another bit, TRMT (TXSTA2<1>), shows the status
of the TSR register. TRMT is a read-only bit which is set
when the TSR register is empty. No interrupt logic is
tied to this bit so the user has to poll this bit in order to
determine if the TSR register is empty.
The AUSART transmits and receives the LSb first. The
AUSART’s transmitter and receiver are functionally
independent but use the same data format and baud
rate. The Baud Rate Generator produces a clock,
either x16 or x64 of the bit shift rate, depending on the
BRGH bit (TXSTA2<2>). Parity is not supported by the
hardware but can be implemented in software and
stored as the 9th data bit.
Note 1: The TSR register is not mapped in data
memory so it is not available to the user.
2: Flag bit TX2IF is set when enable bit
TXEN is set.
When operating in Asynchronous mode, the AUSART
module consists of the following important elements:
•
•
•
•
To set up an Asynchronous Transmission:
Baud Rate Generator
Sampling Circuit
Asynchronous Transmitter
Asynchronous Receiver
18.2.1
1.
2.
AUSART ASYNCHRONOUS
TRANSMITTER
3.
4.
The AUSART transmitter block diagram is shown in
Figure 18-1. The heart of the transmitter is the Transmit
(Serial) Shift register (TSR). The Shift register obtains
its data from the Read/Write Transmit Buffer register,
TXREG2. The TXREG2 register is loaded with data in
software. The TSR register is not loaded until the Stop
bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As
soon as the Stop bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded
with new data from the TXREG2 register (if available).
5.
6.
7.
8.
Once the TXREG2 register transfers the data to the
TSR register (occurs in one TCY), the TXREG2 register
is empty and the TX2IF flag bit (PIR3<4>) is set. This
FIGURE 18-1:
Initialize the SPBRG2 register for the appropriate
baud rate. Set or clear the BRGH bit, as required,
to achieve the desired baud rate.
Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TX2IE.
If 9-bit transmission is desired, set transmit bit
TX9. Can be used as address/data bit.
Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN,
which will also set bit TX2IF.
If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
Load data to the TXREG2 register (starts
transmission).
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
AUSART TRANSMIT BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus
TX2IF
TXREG2 Register
TX2IE
8
MSb
(8)
LSb
• • •
Pin Buffer
and Control
0
TSR Register
TX2 pin
Interrupt
TXEN
Baud Rate CLK
TRMT
SPBRG2
SPEN
TX9
Baud Rate Generator
TX9D
DS39635A-page 236
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 18-2:
ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Write to TXREG2
Word 1
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
TX2 (pin)
Start bit
bit 0
bit 1
bit 7/8
Stop bit
Word 1
TX2IF bit
(Transmit Buffer
Reg. Empty Flag)
1 TCY
Word 1
Transmit Shift Reg
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
FIGURE 18-3:
ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (BACK TO BACK)
Write to TXREG2
Word 1
Word 2
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
TX2 (pin)
Start bit
bit 0
bit 1
1 TCY
TX2IF bit
(Interrupt Reg. Flag)
bit 7/8
Stop bit
Start bit
bit 0
Word 2
Word 1
1 TCY
Word 1
Transmit Shift Reg.
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
Note:
Word 2
Transmit Shift Reg.
This timing diagram shows two consecutive transmissions.
TABLE 18-4:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Bit 7
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
59
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
59
IPR3
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
RCSTA2
TXREG2
TXSTA2
SPBRG2
AUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
60
60
SYNC
—
Baud Rate Generator Register
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
60
60
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for asynchronous transmission.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 237
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.2.2
AUSART ASYNCHRONOUS
RECEIVER
18.2.3
The receiver block diagram is shown in Figure 18-4.
The data is received on the RX2 pin and drives the data
recovery block. The data recovery block is actually a
high-speed shifter operating at x16 times the baud rate,
whereas the main receive serial shifter operates at the
bit rate or at FOSC. This mode would typically be used
in RS-232 systems.
This mode would typically be used in RS-485 systems.
To set up an Asynchronous Reception with Address
Detect Enable:
1.
Initialize the SPBRG2 register for the appropriate
baud rate. Set or clear the BRGH and BRG16
bits, as required, to achieve the desired baud
rate.
2. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
the SYNC bit and setting the SPEN bit.
3. If interrupts are required, set the RCEN bit and
select the desired priority level with the RC2IP
bit.
4. Set the RX9 bit to enable 9-bit reception.
5. Set the ADDEN bit to enable address detect.
6. Enable reception by setting the CREN bit.
7. The RC2IF bit will be set when reception is
complete. The interrupt will be Acknowledged if
the RC2IE and GIE bits are set.
8. Read the RCSTA2 register to determine if any
error occurred during reception, as well as read
bit 9 of data (if applicable).
9. Read RCREG2 to determine if the device is
being addressed.
10. If any error occurred, clear the CREN bit.
11. If the device has been addressed, clear the
ADDEN bit to allow all received data into the
receive buffer and interrupt the CPU.
To set up an Asynchronous Reception:
1.
Initialize the SPBRG2 register for the appropriate
baud rate. Set or clear the BRGH bit, as required,
to achieve the desired baud rate.
2. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN.
3. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RC2IE.
4. If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
5. Enable the reception by setting bit CREN.
6. Flag bit RC2IF will be set when reception is
complete and an interrupt will be generated if
enable bit RC2IE was set.
7. Read the RCSTA2 register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
8. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG2 register.
9. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
enable bit CREN.
10. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
FIGURE 18-4:
SETTING UP 9-BIT MODE WITH
ADDRESS DETECT
AUSART RECEIVE BLOCK DIAGRAM
CREN
OERR
FERR
x64 Baud Rate CLK
SPBRG2
Baud Rate Generator
÷ 64
or
÷ 16
or
÷4
MSb
Stop
RSR Register
(8)
7
• • •
1
LSb
0
Start
RX9
Pin Buffer
and Control
Data
Recovery
RX2
RX9D
RCREG2 Register
FIFO
SPEN
8
Interrupt
RC2IF
Data Bus
RC2IE
DS39635A-page 238
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 18-5:
ASYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION
Start
bit
bit 0
RX2 (pin)
bit 1
bit 7/8 Stop
bit
Start
bit
bit 7/8
bit 0
Rcv Shift Reg
Rcv Buffer Reg
Start
bit
bit 7/8
Stop
bit
Word 2
RCREG2
Word 1
RCREG2
Read Rcv
Buffer Reg
RCREG2
Stop
bit
RC2IF
(Interrupt Flag)
OERR bit
CREN
Note:
This timing diagram shows three words appearing on the RX2 input.
causing the OERR (Overrun) bit to be set.
TABLE 18-5:
Name
INTCON
The RCREG2 (Receive Buffer) is read after the third word
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH ASYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
59
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
59
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
60
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
60
IPR3
RCSTA2
RCREG2
TXSTA2
SPBRG2
AUSART Receive Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
60
Baud Rate Generator Register
60
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for asynchronous reception.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 239
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.3
AUSART Synchronous
Master Mode
Once the TXREG2 register transfers the data to the
TSR register (occurs in one TCYCLE), the TXREG2 is
empty and the TX2IF flag bit (PIR3<4>) is set. The
interrupt can be enabled or disabled by setting or clearing the interrupt enable bit TX2IE (PIE3<4>). TX2IF is
set regardless of the state of enable bit TX2IE; it cannot
be cleared in software. It will reset only when new data
is loaded into the TXREG2 register.
The Synchronous Master mode is entered by setting
the CSRC bit (TXSTA2<7>). In this mode, the data is
transmitted in a half-duplex manner (i.e., transmission
and reception do not occur at the same time). When
transmitting data, the reception is inhibited and vice
versa. Synchronous mode is entered by setting bit
SYNC (TXSTA2<4>). In addition, enable bit SPEN
(RCSTA2<7>) is set in order to configure the TX2 and
RX2 pins to CK2 (clock) and DT2 (data) lines,
respectively.
While flag bit TX2IF indicates the status of the TXREG2
register, another bit, TRMT (TXSTA2<1>), shows the
status of the TSR register. TRMT is a read-only bit which
is set when the TSR is empty. No interrupt logic is tied to
this bit so the user has to poll this bit in order to determine if the TSR register is empty. The TSR is not
mapped in data memory so it is not available to the user.
The Master mode indicates that the processor transmits
the master clock on the CK2 line.
18.3.1
To set up a Synchronous Master Transmission:
AUSART SYNCHRONOUS MASTER
TRANSMISSION
1.
The AUSART transmitter block diagram is shown in
Figure 18-1. The heart of the transmitter is the Transmit
(Serial) Shift register (TSR). The Shift register obtains
its data from the Read/Write Transmit Buffer register,
TXREG2. The TXREG2 register is loaded with data in
software. The TSR register is not loaded until the last
bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As
soon as the last bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded
with new data from the TXREG2 (if available).
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
FIGURE 18-6:
Initialize the SPBRG2 register for the appropriate
baud rate.
Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC, SPEN and CSRC.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TX2IE.
If 9-bit transmission is desired, set bit TX9.
Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN.
If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
Start transmission by loading data to the
TXREG2 register.
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Q1 Q2 Q3Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
RX2/DT2 pin
bit 0
bit 1
bit 2
bit 7
bit 0
bit 1
bit 7
Word 2
Word 1
TX2/CK2 pin
Write to
TXREG2 Reg
Write Word 1
Write Word 2
TX2IF bit
(Interrupt Flag)
TRMT bit
TXEN bit
Note:
‘1’
‘1’
Sync Master mode, SPBRG2 = 0, continuous transmission of two 8-bit words.
DS39635A-page 240
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 18-7:
SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (THROUGH TXEN)
RX2/DT2 pin
bit 0
bit 1
bit 2
bit 6
bit 7
TX2/CK2 pin
Write to
TXREG2 Reg
TX2IF bit
TRMT bit
TXEN bit
TABLE 18-6:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS MASTER TRANSMISSION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
59
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
59
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
60
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
IPR3
RCSTA2
TXREG2
TXSTA2
SPBRG2
AUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
60
Baud Rate Generator Register
60
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous master transmission.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 241
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.3.2
AUSART SYNCHRONOUS
MASTER RECEPTION
4.
5.
6.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RC2IE.
If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
If a single reception is required, set bit SREN.
For continuous reception, set bit CREN.
7. Interrupt flag bit, RC2IF, will be set when
reception is complete and an interrupt will be
generated if the enable bit RC2IE was set.
8. Read the RCSTA2 register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
9. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG2 register.
10. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
bit CREN.
11. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
Once Synchronous mode is selected, reception is
enabled by setting either the Single Receive Enable bit,
SREN (RCSTA2<5>), or the Continuous Receive
Enable bit, CREN (RCSTA2<4>). Data is sampled on
the RX2 pin on the falling edge of the clock.
If enable bit SREN is set, only a single word is received.
If enable bit CREN is set, the reception is continuous
until CREN is cleared. If both bits are set, then CREN
takes precedence.
To set up a Synchronous Master Reception:
1.
2.
3.
Initialize the SPBRG2 register for the appropriate
baud rate.
Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC, SPEN and CSRC.
Ensure bits CREN and SREN are clear.
FIGURE 18-8:
SYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION (MASTER MODE, SREN)
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
RX2/DT2 pin
bit 0
bit 1
bit 2
bit 3
bit 4
bit 5
bit 6
bit 7
TX2/CK2 pin
Write to
bit SREN
SREN bit
CREN bit ‘0’
‘0’
RC2IF bit
(Interrupt)
Read
RCREG2
Note:
Timing diagram demonstrates Sync Master mode with bit SREN = 1 and bit BRGH = 0.
TABLE 18-7:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS MASTER RECEPTION
Bit 7
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
59
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
59
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
60
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
IPR3
RCSTA2
RCREG2
TXSTA2
SPBRG2
AUSART Receive Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
60
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
60
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous master reception.
DS39635A-page 242
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.4
AUSART Synchronous Slave Mode
Synchronous Slave mode is entered by clearing bit
CSRC (TXSTA2<7>). This mode differs from the
Synchronous Master mode in that the shift clock is
supplied externally at the CK2 pin (instead of being
supplied internally in Master mode). This allows the
device to transfer or receive data while in any
low-power mode.
18.4.1
AUSART SYNCHRONOUS
SLAVE TRANSMIT
To set up a Synchronous Slave Transmission:
1.
Enable the synchronous slave serial port by
setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit
CSRC.
Clear bits CREN and SREN.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TX2IE.
If 9-bit transmission is desired, set bit TX9.
Enable the transmission by setting enable bit
TXEN.
If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
Start transmission by loading data to the
TXREG2 register.
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
The operation of the Synchronous Master and Slave
modes are identical except in the case of the Sleep
mode.
7.
8.
If two words are written to the TXREG2 and then the
SLEEP instruction is executed, the following will occur:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
The first word will immediately transfer to the
TSR register and transmit.
The second word will remain in TXREG2
register.
Flag bit TX2IF will not be set.
When the first word has been shifted out of TSR,
the TXREG2 register will transfer the second
word to the TSR and flag bit TX2IF will now be
set.
If enable bit TX2IE is set, the interrupt will wake
the chip from Sleep. If the global interrupt is
enabled, the program will branch to the interrupt
vector.
TABLE 18-8:
Name
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE TRANSMISSION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
59
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
59
IPR3
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
60
INTCON
RCSTA2
TXREG2
TXSTA2
SPBRG2
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
AUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
60
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
60
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous slave transmission.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 243
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
18.4.2
AUSART SYNCHRONOUS
SLAVE RECEPTION
To set up a Synchronous Slave Reception:
1.
The operation of the Synchronous Master and Slave
modes is identical except in the case of Sleep, or any
Idle mode and bit SREN, which is a “don’t care” in
Slave mode.
If receive is enabled by setting the CREN bit prior to
entering Sleep, or any Idle mode, then a word may be
received while in this low-power mode. Once the word
is received, the RSR register will transfer the data to the
RCREG2 register; if the RC2IE enable bit is set, the
interrupt generated will wake the chip from low-power
mode. If the global interrupt is enabled, the program will
branch to the interrupt vector.
Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit
CSRC.
If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RC2IE.
If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
To enable reception, set enable bit CREN.
Flag bit RC2IF will be set when reception is
complete. An interrupt will be generated if
enable bit RC2IE was set.
Read the RCSTA2 register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG2 register.
If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
bit CREN.
If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
TABLE 18-9:
Name
INTCON
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE RECEPTION
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR3
—
—
RC2IF
TX2IF
—
—
—
CCP3IF
59
PIE3
—
—
RC2IE
TX2IE
—
—
—
CCP3IE
59
IPR3
—
—
RC2IP
TX2IP
—
—
—
CCP3IP
59
SPEN
RX9
SREN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
60
RCSTA2
RCREG2
TXSTA2
SPBRG2
AUSART Receive Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
60
SYNC
—
BRGH
TRMT
TX9D
Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
60
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous slave reception.
DS39635A-page 244
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
19.0
10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER (A/D) MODULE
The module has five registers:
•
•
•
•
•
The Analog-to-Digital (A/D) converter module has
12 inputs for the PIC18FX310/X410 devices. This
module allows conversion of an analog input signal to
a corresponding 10-bit digital number.
A/D Result High Register (ADRESH)
A/D Result Low Register (ADRESL)
A/D Control Register 0 (ADCON0)
A/D Control Register 1 (ADCON1)
A/D Control Register 2 (ADCON2)
The ADCON0 register, shown in Register 19-1,
controls the operation of the A/D module. The
ADCON1 register, shown in Register 19-2, configures
the functions of the port pins. The ADCON2 register,
shown in Register 19-3, configures the A/D clock
source, programmed acquisition time and justification.
REGISTER 19-1:
ADCON0 REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
—
—
CHS3
CHS2
CHS1
CHS0
GO/DONE
ADON
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-2
CHS3:CHS0: Analog Channel Select bits
0000 = Channel 0 (AN0)
0001 = Channel 1 (AN1)
0010 = Channel 2 (AN2)
0011 = Channel 3 (AN3)
0100 = Channel 4 (AN4)
0101 = Channel 5 (AN5)
0110 = Channel 6 (AN6)
0111 = Channel 7 (AN7)
1000 = Channel 8 (AN8)
1001 = Channel 9 (AN9)
1010 = Channel 10 (AN10)
1011 = Channel 11 (AN11)
1100 = Unimplemented(1)
1101 = Unimplemented(1)
1110 = Unimplemented(1)
1111 = Unimplemented(1)
Note 1: Performing a conversion on unimplemented channels will return a floating input
measurement.
bit 1
GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit
When ADON = 1:
1 = A/D conversion in progress
0 = A/D Idle
bit 0
ADON: A/D On bit
1 = A/D converter module is enabled
0 = A/D converter module is disabled
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 245
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 19-2:
ADCON1 REGISTER
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-q
R/W-q
R/W-q
R/W-q
—
—
VCFG1
VCFG0
PCFG3
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
bit 7
bit 0
PCFG3:
PCFG0
AN6
AN5
AN4
AN3
AN2
AN1
AN0
PCFG3:PCFG0: A/D Port Configuration Control bits:
AN7
bit 3-0
AN8
VCFG0: Voltage Reference Configuration bit (VREF+ source):
1 = VREF+ (AN3)
0 = AVDD
AN9
bit 4
AN10
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
VCFG1: Voltage Reference Configuration bit (VREF- source):
1 = VREF- (AN2)
0 = AVSS
AN11
bit 7-6
bit 5
0000
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
0001
0010
0011
0100
0101
0110
0111
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
A = Analog input
D = Digital I/O
Legend:
DS39635A-page 246
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 19-3:
ADCON2 REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ADFM
—
ACQT2
ACQT1
ACQT0
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
ADFM: A/D Result Format Select bit
1 = Right justified
0 = Left justified
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-3
ACQT2:ACQT0: A/D Acquisition Time Select bits
111 = 20 TAD
110 = 16 TAD
101 = 12 TAD
100 = 8 TAD
011 = 6 TAD
010 = 4 TAD
001 = 2 TAD
000 = 0 TAD(1)
bit 2-0
ADCS2:ADCS0: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits
111 = FRC (clock derived from A/D RC oscillator)(1)
110 = FOSC/64
101 = FOSC/16
100 = FOSC/4
011 = FRC (clock derived from A/D RC oscillator)(1)
010 = FOSC/32
001 = FOSC/8
000 = FOSC/2
Note 1: If the A/D FRC clock source is selected, a delay of one TCY (instruction cycle) is
added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed
before starting a conversion.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 247
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
The analog reference voltage is software selectable to
either the device’s positive and negative supply voltage
(AVDD and AVSS), or the voltage level on the
RA3/AN3/VREF+ and RA2/AN2/VREF- pins.
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the A/D module to be turned off and any
conversion in progress is aborted.
Each port pin associated with the A/D converter can be
configured as an analog input or as a digital I/O. The
ADRESH and ADRESL registers contain the result of
the A/D conversion. When the A/D conversion is complete, the result is loaded into the ADRESH/ADRESL
registers, the GO/DONE bit (ADCON0 register) is
cleared and the A/D Interrupt Flag bit, ADIF, is set. The
block diagram of the A/D module is shown in
Figure 19-1.
The A/D converter has a unique feature of being able
to operate while the device is in Sleep mode. To operate in Sleep, the A/D conversion clock must be derived
from the A/D’s internal RC oscillator.
The output of the sample and hold is the input into the
converter, which generates the result via successive
approximation.
FIGURE 19-1:
A/D BLOCK DIAGRAM
CHS3:CHS0
1011
1010
1001
1000
0111
0110
0101
0100
VAIN
0011
(Input Voltage)
10-bit
Converter
A/D
0010
0001
VCFG1:VCFG0
0000
AVDD
Reference
Voltage
VREF+
X0
X1
1X
VREF-
0X
AN11
AN10
AN9
AN8
AN7
AN6
AN5
AN4
AN3
AN2
AN1
AN0
AVSS
Note 1:
I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS.
DS39635A-page 248
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Wait for A/D conversion to complete, by either:
• Polling for the GO/DONE bit to be cleared
OR
• Waiting for the A/D interrupt
Read A/D Result registers (ADRESH:ADRESL);
clear bit ADIF, if required.
For next conversion, go to step 1 or step 2, as
required. The A/D conversion time per bit is
defined as TAD. A minimum wait of 3 TAD is
required before the next acquisition starts.
6.
7.
FIGURE 19-2:
The following steps should be followed to perform an
A/D conversion:
3FFh
1.
3FEh
FIGURE 19-3:
Digital Code Output
002h
001h
1023 LSB
1023.5 LSB
1022 LSB
1022.5 LSB
3 LSB
Analog Input Voltage
ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
Sampling
Switch
VT = 0.6V
Rs
VAIN
2 LSB
000h
2.5 LSB
3.
4.
003h
0.5 LSB
2.
Configure the A/D module:
• Configure analog pins, voltage reference and
digital I/O (ADCON1)
• Select A/D input channel (ADCON0)
• Select A/D acquisition time (ADCON2)
• Select A/D conversion clock (ADCON2)
• Turn on A/D module (ADCON0)
Configure A/D interrupt (if desired):
• Clear ADIF bit
• Set ADIE bit
• Set GIE bit
Wait the required acquisition time (if required).
Start conversion:
• Set GO/DONE bit (ADCON0 register)
A/D TRANSFER FUNCTION
1 LSB
After the A/D module has been configured as desired,
the selected channel must be acquired before the
conversion is started. The analog input channels must
have their corresponding TRIS bits selected as an
input. To determine acquisition time, see Section 19.1
“A/D Acquisition Requirements”. After this acquisition time has elapsed, the A/D conversion can be
started. An acquisition time can be programmed to
occur between setting the GO/DONE bit and the actual
start of the conversion.
5.
1.5 LSB
The value in the ADRESH:ADRESL registers is not
modified for a Power-on Reset. The ADRESH:ADRESL
registers will contain unknown data after a Power-on
Reset.
RIC ≤ 1k
ANx
CPIN
5 pF
VT = 0.6V
SS
RSS
ILEAKAGE
± 100 nA
CHOLD = 25 pF
VSS
Legend: CPIN
VT
ILEAKAGE
RIC
SS
CHOLD
RSS
= input capacitance
= threshold voltage
= leakage current at the pin due to
various junctions
= interconnect resistance
= sampling switch
= sample/hold capacitance (from DAC)
= sampling switch resistance
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
VDD
6V
5V
4V
3V
2V
1
2
3
4
Sampling Switch (kΩ)
DS39635A-page 249
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
19.1
A/D Acquisition Requirements
For the A/D converter to meet its specified accuracy,
the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed
to fully charge to the input channel voltage level. The
analog input model is shown in Figure 19-3. The
source impedance (RS) and the internal sampling
switch (RSS) impedance directly affect the time
required to charge the capacitor CHOLD. The sampling
switch (RSS) impedance varies over the device voltage
(VDD). The source impedance affects the offset voltage
at the analog input (due to pin leakage current). The
maximum recommended impedance for analog
sources is 2.5 kΩ. After the analog input channel is
selected (changed), the channel must be sampled for
at least the minimum acquisition time before starting a
conversion.
Note:
CHOLD
Rs
Conversion Error
VDD
Temperature
=
=
≤
=
=
25 pF
2.5 kΩ
1/2 LSb
5V → Rss = 2 kΩ
85°C (system max.)
ACQUISITION TIME
=
Amplifier Settling Time + Holding Capacitor Charging Time + Temperature Coefficient
=
TAMP + TC + TCOFF
EQUATION 19-2:
VHOLD
or
TC
Example 19-3 shows the calculation of the minimum
required acquisition time TACQ. This calculation is
based on the following application system
assumptions:
When the conversion is started, the
holding capacitor is disconnected from the
input pin.
EQUATION 19-1:
TACQ
To calculate the minimum acquisition time,
Equation 19-1 may be used. This equation assumes
that 1/2 LSb error is used (1024 steps for the A/D). The
1/2 LSb error is the maximum error allowed for the A/D
to meet its specified resolution.
A/D MINIMUM CHARGING TIME
=
(VREF – (VREF/2048)) • (1 – e(-TC/CHOLD(RIC + RSS + RS)))
=
-(CHOLD)(RIC + RSS + RS) ln(1/2048)
EQUATION 19-3:
CALCULATING THE MINIMUM REQUIRED ACQUISITION TIME
TACQ
=
TAMP + TC + TCOFF
TAMP
=
0.2 µs
TCOFF
=
(Temp – 25°C)(0.02 µs/°C)
(50°C – 25°C)(0.02 µs/°C)
1.2 µs
Temperature coefficient is only required for temperatures > 25°C. Below 25°C, TCOFF = 0 ms.
TC
=
-(CHOLD)(RIC + RSS + RS) ln(1/2047) µs
-(25 pF) (1 kΩ + 2 kΩ + 2.5 kΩ) ln(0.0004883) µs
5.03 µs
TACQ
=
0.2 µs + 5 µs + 1.2 µs
6.4 µs
DS39635A-page 250
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
19.2
Selecting and Configuring
Automatic Acquisition Time
19.3
The ADCON2 register allows the user to select an
acquisition time that occurs each time the GO/DONE
bit is set.
When the GO/DONE bit is set, sampling is stopped and
a conversion begins. The user is responsible for ensuring the required acquisition time has passed between
selecting the desired input channel and setting the
GO/DONE bit. This occurs when the ACQT2:ACQT0
bits (ADCON2<5:3>) remain in their Reset state (‘000’)
and is compatible with devices that do not offer
programmable acquisition times.
If desired, the ACQT bits can be set to select a
programmable acquisition time for the A/D module.
When the GO/DONE bit is set, the A/D module continues to sample the input for the selected acquisition
time, then automatically begins a conversion. Since the
acquisition time is programmed, there may be no need
to wait for an acquisition time between selecting a
channel and setting the GO/DONE bit.
Selecting the A/D Conversion
Clock
The A/D conversion time per bit is defined as TAD. The
A/D conversion requires 11 TAD per 10-bit conversion.
The source of the A/D conversion clock is software
selectable. There are seven possible options for TAD:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
2 TOSC
4 TOSC
8 TOSC
16 TOSC
32 TOSC
64 TOSC
Internal RC Oscillator
For correct A/D conversions, the A/D conversion clock
(TAD) must be as short as possible, but greater than the
minimum TAD (approximately 2 µs, see parameter 130
for more information).
Table 19-1 shows the resultant TAD times derived from
the device operating frequencies and the A/D clock
source selected.
In either case, when the conversion is completed, the
GO/DONE bit is cleared, the ADIF flag is set and the
A/D begins sampling the currently selected channel
again. If an acquisition time is programmed, there is
nothing to indicate if the acquisition time has ended, or
if the conversion has begun.
TABLE 19-1:
TAD vs. DEVICE OPERATING FREQUENCIES
AD Clock Source (TAD)
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Maximum Device Frequency
Operation
ADCS2:ADCS0
PIC18F6X10/8X10
PIC18LF6X10/8X10(4)
2 TOSC
000
1.25 MHz
666 kHz
4 TOSC
100
2.50 MHz
1.33 MHz
8 TOSC
001
5.00 MHz
2.66 MHz
16 TOSC
101
10.0 MHz
5.33 MHz
32 TOSC
010
20.0 MHz
10.65 MHz
64 TOSC
110
40.0 MHz
21.33 MHz
RC(3)
x11
1.00 MHz(1)
1.00 MHz(2)
The RC source has a typical TAD time of 4 µs.
The RC source has a typical TAD time of 6 µs.
For device frequencies above 1 MHz, the device must be in Sleep for the entire conversion or the A/D
accuracy may be out of specification.
Low-power (PIC18LFXXXX) devices only.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 251
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
19.4
Operation in Power Managed
Modes
19.5
The selection of the automatic acquisition time and A/D
conversion clock is determined in part by the clock
source and frequency while in a power managed mode.
If the A/D is expected to operate while the device is in
a power managed mode, the ACQT2:ACQT0 and
ADCS2:ADCS0 bits in ADCON2 should be updated in
accordance with the power managed mode clock that
will be used. After the power managed mode is
entered, an A/D acquisition or conversion may be
started. Once an acquisition or conversion is started,
the device should continue to be clocked by the same
power managed mode clock source until the conversion has been completed. If desired, the device may be
placed into the corresponding Power Managed Idle
mode during the conversion.
Configuring Analog Port Pins
The ADCON1, TRISA and TRISF registers all
configure the A/D port pins. The port pins needed as
analog inputs must have their corresponding TRIS bits
set (input). If the TRIS bit is cleared (output), the digital
output level (VOH or VOL) will be converted.
The A/D operation is independent of the state of the
CHS3:CHS0 bits and the TRIS bits.
Note 1: When reading the Port register, all pins
configured as analog input channels will
read as cleared (a low level). Pins configured as digital inputs will convert an
analog input. Analog levels on a digitally
configured input will be accurately
converted.
If the power managed mode clock frequency is less
than 1 MHz, the A/D RC clock source should be
selected.
2: Analog levels on any pin defined as a
digital input may cause the digital input
buffer to consume current out of the
device’s specification limits.
Operation in the Sleep mode requires the A/D FRC
clock to be selected. If bits ACQT2:ACQT0 are set to
‘000’ and a conversion is started, the conversion will be
delayed one instruction cycle to allow execution of the
SLEEP instruction and entry to Sleep mode. The IDLEN
and SCS bits in the OSCCON register must have
already been cleared prior to starting the conversion.
DS39635A-page 252
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
19.6
A/D Conversions
After the A/D conversion is completed or aborted, a
2 TAD wait is required before the next acquisition can be
started. After this wait, acquisition on the selected
channel is automatically started.
Figure 19-4 shows the operation of the A/D converter
after the GO bit has been set and the ACQT2:ACQT0
bits are cleared. A conversion is started after the following instruction to allow entry into Sleep mode before the
conversion begins.
Note:
Figure 19-5 shows the operation of the A/D converter
after the GO bit has been set and the ACQT2:ACQT0
bits are set to ‘010’ and selecting a 4 TAD acquisition
time before the conversion starts.
19.7
Discharge
The discharge phase is used to initialize the value of
the capacitor array. The array is discharged before
every sample. This feature helps to optimize the
unity-gain amplifier as the circuit always needs to
charge
the
capacitor
array,
rather
than
charge/discharge based on previous measure values.
Clearing the GO/DONE bit during a conversion will
abort the current conversion. The A/D Result register
pair will NOT be updated with the partially completed
A/D
conversion
sample.
This
means
the
ADRESH:ADRESL registers will continue to contain
the value of the last completed conversion (or the last
value written to the ADRESH:ADRESL registers).
FIGURE 19-4:
The GO/DONE bit should NOT be set in
the same instruction that turns on the A/D.
A/D CONVERSION TAD CYCLES (ACQT<2:0> = 000, TACQ = 0)
TCY - TAD TAD1 TAD2 TAD3 TAD4 TAD5 TAD6 TAD7 TAD8 TAD9 TAD10 TAD11 TAD1
b4
b1
b0
b6
b7
b2
b9
b8
b3
b5
Conversion starts
Discharge
Holding capacitor is disconnected from analog input (typically 100 ns)
Set GO bit
On the following cycle:
ADRESH:ADRESL is loaded, GO bit is cleared,
ADIF bit is set, holding capacitor is connected to analog input.
FIGURE 19-5:
A/D CONVERSION TAD CYCLES (ACQT<2:0> = 010, TACQ = 4 TAD)
TAD Cycles
TACQT Cycles
1
2
3
Automatic
Acquisition
Time
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
b9
b8
b7
b6
b5
b4
b3
b2
b1
b0
Conversion starts
(Holding capacitor is disconnected)
Set GO bit
(Holding capacitor continues
acquiring input)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
TAD1
Discharge
On the following cycle:
ADRESH:ADRESL is loaded, GO bit is cleared,
ADIF bit is set, holding capacitor is connected to analog input.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 253
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
19.8
Use of the CCP2 Trigger
An A/D conversion can be started by the “special event
trigger” of the CCP2 module. This requires that the
CCP2M3:CCP2M0 bits (CCP2CON<3:0>) be programmed as ‘1011’ and that the A/D module is enabled
(ADON bit is set). When the trigger occurs, the
GO/DONE bit will be set, starting the A/D acquisition
and conversion and the Timer1 (or Timer3) counter will
be reset to zero. Timer1 (or Timer3) is reset to automatically repeat the A/D acquisition period with minimal
TABLE 19-2:
Name
INTCON
software overhead (moving ADRESH/ADRESL to the
desired location). The appropriate analog input
channel must be selected and the minimum acquisition
period is either timed by the user, or an appropriate
TACQ time selected before the “special event trigger”
sets the GO/DONE bit (starts a conversion).
If the A/D module is not enabled (ADON is cleared), the
“special event trigger” will be ignored by the A/D
module, but will still reset the Timer1 (or Timer3)
counter.
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH A/D OPERATION
Bit 7
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
Bit 6
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
PIR1
PSPIF
ADIF
RC1IF
TX1IF
SSPIF
CCP1IF
TMR2IF
TMR1IF
59
PIE1
PSPIE
ADIE
RC1IE
TX1IE
SSPIE
CCP1IE
TMR2IE
TMR1IE
59
IPR1
PSPIP
ADIP
RC1IP
TX1IP
SSPIP
CCP1IP
TMR2IP
TMR1IP
59
PIR2
OSCFIF
CMIF
—
—
BCLIF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
CCP2IF
59
PIE2
OSCFIE
CMIE
—
—
BCLIE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
CCP2IE
59
IPR2
OSCFIP
CMIP
—
—
BCLIP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
CCP2IP
59
ADRESH
A/D Result Register High Byte
58
ADRESL
A/D Result Register Low Byte
58
ADCON0
—
—
CHS3
CHS2
CHS1
CHS0
GO/DONE
ADON
58
ADCON1
—
—
VCFG1
VCFG0
PCFG3
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
58
ADCON2
ADFM
—
ACQT2
ACQT1
ACQT0
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
58
PORTA
RA7(1)
RA6(1)
RA5
RA4
RA3
RA2
RA1
RA0
60
TRISA
TRISA7(1) TRISA6(1) PORTA Data Direction Register
60
PORTF
Read PORTF pins, Write LATF Latch
60
TRISF
PORTF Data Direction Register
60
LATF
PORTF Output Data Latch
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for A/D conversion.
Note 1: These pins may be configured as port pins depending on the oscillator mode selected.
DS39635A-page 254
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
20.0
COMPARATOR MODULE
The analog comparator module contains two
comparators that can be configured in a variety of
ways. The inputs can be selected from the analog
inputs multiplexed with pins RF3 through RF6, as well
as the on-chip voltage reference (see Section 21.0
“Comparator Voltage Reference Module”). The digital outputs (normal or inverted) are available at the pin
level and can also be read through the control register.
REGISTER 20-1:
The CMCON register (Register 20-1) selects the
comparator input and output configuration. Block
diagrams of the various comparator configurations are
shown in Figure 20-1.
CMCON REGISTER
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
C2OUT
C1OUT
C2INV
C1INV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
C2OUT: Comparator 2 Output bit
When C2INV = 0:
1 = C2 VIN+ > C2 VIN0 = C2 VIN+ < C2 VINWhen C2INV = 1:
1 = C2 VIN+ < C2 VIN0 = C2 VIN+ > C2 VIN-
bit 6
C1OUT: Comparator 1 Output bit
When C1INV = 0:
1 = C1 VIN+ > C1 VIN0 = C1 VIN+ < C1 VINWhen C1INV = 1:
1 = C1 VIN+ < C1 VIN0 = C1 VIN+ > C1 VIN-
bit 5
C2INV: Comparator 2 Output Inversion bit
1 = C2 output inverted
0 = C2 output not inverted
bit 4
C1INV: Comparator 1 Output Inversion bit
1 = C1 output inverted
0 = C1 output not inverted
bit 3
CIS: Comparator Input Switch bit
When CM2:CM0 = 110:
1 = C1 VIN- connects to RF5/AN10
C2 VIN- connects to RF3/AN8
0 = C1 VIN- connects to RF6/AN11
C2 VIN- connects to RF4/AN9
bit 2-0
CM2:CM0: Comparator Mode bits
Figure 20-1 shows the Comparator modes and the CM2:CM0 bit settings.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 255
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
20.1
Comparator Configuration
There are eight modes of operation for the comparators, shown in Figure 20-1. Bits CM2:CM0 of the
CMCON register are used to select these modes. The
TRISF register controls the data direction of the
comparator pins for each mode. If the Comparator
FIGURE 20-1:
A
VIN-
RF5/AN10/ A
CVREF
VIN+
A
VIN-
RF4/AN9
RF3/AN8
A
Comparator interrupts should be disabled
during a Comparator mode change;
otherwise, a false interrupt may occur.
VIN+
Comparators Off
CM2:CM0 = 111
C1
Off (Read as ‘0’)
C2
Off (Read as ‘0’)
Two Independent Comparators
CM2:CM0 = 010
A
VIN-
RF5/AN10/ A
CVREF
VIN+
RF4/AN9
A
VIN-
RF3/AN8
A
VIN+
RF6/AN11
Note:
COMPARATOR I/O OPERATING MODES
Comparators Reset (POR Default Value)
CM2:CM0 = 000
RF6/AN11
mode is changed, the comparator output level may not
be valid for the specified mode change delay shown in
Section 26.0 “Electrical Characteristics”.
RF6/AN11
D
VIN-
RF5/AN10/
CVREF
D
VIN+
RF4/AN9
D
VIN-
RF3/AN8
D
VIN+
Off (Read as ‘0’)
C2
Off (Read as ‘0’)
Two Independent Comparators with Outputs
CM2:CM0 = 011
A
C1
C1
RF6/AN11
RF5/AN10/ A
CVREF
C1OUT
VINVIN+
C1
C1OUT
C2
C2OUT
RF2/AN7/C1OUT*
C2
C2OUT
RF4/AN9
A
VIN-
RF3/AN8
A
VIN+
RF1/AN6/C2OUT*
Two Common Reference Comparators
CM2:CM0 = 100
A
VIN-
RF5/AN10/ A
CVREF
VIN+
RF4/AN9
A
VIN-
RF3/AN8
D
VIN+
RF6/AN11
C1
Two Common Reference Comparators with Outputs
CM2:CM0 = 101
RF6/AN11
RF5/AN10/
CVREF
C1OUT
A
VIN-
A
VIN+
C1
C1OUT
C2
C2OUT
RF2/AN7/C1OUT*
C2
C2OUT
RF4/AN9
A
VIN-
RF3/AN8
D
VIN+
RF1/AN6/C2OUT*
Four Inputs Multiplexed to Two Comparators
CM2:CM0 = 110
One Independent Comparator with Output
CM2:CM0 = 001
RF6/AN11 A
VIN-
RF5/AN10/ A
CVREF
VIN+
C1
C1OUT
RF2/AN7/C1OUT*
RF4/AN9
RF3/AN8
D
VIN-
D
VIN+
C2
RF6/AN11
A
RF5/AN10/
CVREF
A
RF4/AN9
A
RF3/AN8
A
CIS = 0
CIS = 1
VINVIN+
CIS = 0
CIS = 1
C1
C1OUT
C2
C2OUT
VINVIN+
Off (Read as ‘0’)
CVREF
From VREF Module
A = Analog Input, port reads zeros always
D = Digital Input
CIS (CMCON<3>) is the Comparator Input Switch
* Setting the TRISF<2:1> bits will disable the comparator outputs by configuring the pins as inputs.
DS39635A-page 256
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
20.2
20.3.2
Comparator Operation
INTERNAL REFERENCE SIGNAL
A single comparator is shown in Figure 20-2, along with
the relationship between the analog input levels and
the digital output. When the analog input at VIN+ is less
than the analog input VIN-, the output of the comparator
is a digital low level. When the analog input at VIN+ is
greater than the analog input VIN-, the output of the
comparator is a digital high level. The shaded areas of
the output of the comparator in Figure 20-2 represent
the uncertainty, due to input offsets and response time.
The comparator module also allows the selection of an
internally generated voltage reference from the comparator voltage reference module. This module is
described in more detail in Section 21.0 “Comparator
Voltage Reference Module”.
20.3
20.4
Comparator Reference
Depending on the comparator operating mode, either
an external or internal voltage reference may be used.
The analog signal present at VIN- is compared to the
signal at VIN+ and the digital output of the comparator
is adjusted accordingly (Figure 20-2).
FIGURE 20-2:
VIN+
VIN-
SINGLE COMPARATOR
Output
Comparator Response Time
Response time is the minimum time, after selecting a
new reference voltage or input source, before the
comparator output has a valid level. If the internal reference is changed, the maximum delay of the internal
voltage reference must be considered when using the
comparator outputs. Otherwise, the maximum delay of
the comparators should be used (see Section 26.0
“Electrical Characteristics”).
20.5
+
–
The internal reference is only available in the mode
where four inputs are multiplexed to two comparators
(CM2:CM0 = 110). In this mode, the internal voltage
reference is applied to the VIN+ pin of both comparators.
Comparator Outputs
The comparator outputs are read through the CMCON
register. These bits are read-only. The comparator
outputs may also be directly output to the RF2 and RF1
I/O pins. When enabled, multiplexors in the output path
of the RF2 and RF1 pins will switch and the output of
each pin will be the unsynchronized output of the
comparator. The uncertainty of each of the
comparators is related to the input offset voltage and
the response time given in the specifications.
Figure 20-3 shows the comparator output block
diagram.
VINVIN+
The TRISF bits will still function as an output enable/
disable for the RF2 and RF1 pins while in this mode.
Output
The polarity of the comparator outputs can be changed
using the C2INV and C1INV bits (CMCON<5:4>).
20.3.1
EXTERNAL REFERENCE SIGNAL
When external voltage references are used, the
comparator module can be configured to have the comparators operate from the same, or different reference
sources. However, threshold detector applications may
require the same reference. The reference signal must
be between VSS and VDD and can be applied to either
pin of the comparator(s).
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Note 1: When reading the Port register, all pins
configured as analog inputs will read as a
‘0’. Pins configured as digital inputs will
convert an analog input according to the
Schmitt Trigger input specification.
Preliminary
2: Analog levels on any pin defined as a digital input may cause the input buffer to
consume more current than is specified.
DS39635A-page 257
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
+
To RF2 or
RF1 pin
-
Port pins
COMPARATOR OUTPUT BLOCK DIAGRAM
MULTIPLEX
FIGURE 20-3:
D
Q
Bus
Data
CxINV
EN
Read CMCON
D
Q
EN
CL
From
other
Comparator
Reset
20.6
Comparator Interrupts
20.7
The comparator interrupt flag is set whenever there is
a change in the output value of either comparator.
Software will need to maintain information about the
status of the output bits, as read from CMCON<7:6>, to
determine the actual change that occurred. The CMIF
bit (PIR2<6>) is the Comparator Interrupt Flag. The
CMIF bit must be reset by clearing it. Since it is also
possible to write a ‘1’ to this register, a simulated
interrupt may be initiated.
Both the CMIE bit (PIE2<6>) and the PEIE bit
(INTCON<6>) must be set to enable the interrupt. In
addition, the GIE bit (INTCON<7>) must also be set. If
any of these bits are clear, the interrupt is not enabled,
though the CMIF bit will still be set if an interrupt
condition occurs.
Note:
If a change in the CMCON register
(C1OUT or C2OUT) should occur when a
read operation is being executed (start of
the Q2 cycle), then the CMIF (PIR
registers) interrupt flag may not get set.
The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, can clear the
interrupt in the following manner:
a)
b)
Set
CMIF
bit
Comparator Operation During
Sleep
When a comparator is active and the device is placed
in Sleep mode, the comparator remains active and the
interrupt is functional, if enabled. This interrupt will
wake-up the device from Sleep mode, when enabled.
While the comparator is powered up, higher Sleep
currents than shown in the power-down current
specification will occur. Each operational comparator
will consume additional current, as shown in the
comparator specifications. To minimize power
consumption while in Sleep mode, turn off the
comparators (CM2:CM0 = 111) before entering Sleep.
If the device wakes up from Sleep, the contents of the
CMCON register are not affected.
20.8
Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces the CMCON register to its Reset
state, causing the comparator module to be in the
Comparator Reset mode (CM2:CM0 = 000). This
ensures that all potential inputs are analog inputs.
Device current is minimized when analog inputs are
present at Reset time. The comparators are powered
down during the Reset interval.
Any read or write of CMCON will end the
mismatch condition.
Clear flag bit CMIF.
A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit CMIF.
Reading CMCON will end the mismatch condition and
allow flag bit CMIF to be cleared.
DS39635A-page 258
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
20.9
Analog Input Connection
Considerations
range by more than 0.6V in either direction, one of the
diodes is forward biased and a latch-up condition may
occur. A maximum source impedance of 10 kΩ is
recommended for the analog sources. Any external
component connected to an analog input pin, such as
a capacitor or a Zener diode, should have very little
leakage current.
A simplified circuit for an analog input is shown in
Figure 20-4. Since the analog pins are connected to a
digital output, they have reverse biased diodes to VDD
and VSS. The analog input, therefore, must be between
VSS and VDD. If the input voltage deviates from this
FIGURE 20-4:
COMPARATOR ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
VT = 0.6V
RS < 10k
RIC
Comparator
Input
AIN
CPIN
5 pF
VA
VT = 0.6V
ILEAKAGE
±500 nA
VSS
Legend: CPIN
VT
ILEAKAGE
RIC
RS
VA
TABLE 20-1:
=
=
=
=
=
=
Input Capacitance
Threshold Voltage
Leakage Current at the pin due to various junctions
Interconnect Resistance
Source Impedance
Analog Voltage
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH COMPARATOR MODULE
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
CMCON
C2OUT
C1OUT
C2INV
C1INV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
59
CVRCON
CVREN
CVROE
CVRR
CVRSS
CVR3
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
59
Name
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR2
INTCON
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
OSCFIF
CMIF
—
—
BCLIF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
CCP2IF
59
PIE2
OCSFIE
CMIE
—
—
BCLIE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
CCP2IE
59
IPR2
OSCFIP
CMIP
—
—
BCLIP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
CCP2IP
59
PORTF
Read PORTF pins, Write LATF Latch
60
LATF
LATF Data Output Register
60
TRISF
PORTF Data Direction Register
60
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are unused by the comparator module.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 259
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 260
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
21.0
COMPARATOR VOLTAGE
REFERENCE MODULE
The comparator voltage reference is a 16-tap resistor
ladder network that provides a selectable reference
voltage. Although its primary purpose is to provide a
reference for the analog comparators, it may also be
used independently of them.
A block diagram is of the module shown in Figure 21-1.
The resistor ladder is segmented to provide two ranges
of CVREF values and has a power-down function to
conserve power when the reference is not being used.
The module’s supply reference can be provided from
either device VDD/VSS, or an external voltage
reference.
21.1
Configuring the Comparator
Voltage Reference
The voltage reference module is controlled through the
CVRCON register (Register 21-1). The Comparator
Voltage Reference provides two ranges of output voltage, each with 16 distinct levels. The range to be used
REGISTER 21-1:
is selected by the CVRR bit (CVRCON<5>). The
primary difference between the ranges is the size of the
steps selected by the CVREF selection bits
(CVR3:CVR0), with one range offering finer resolution.
The equations used to calculate the output of the
Comparator Voltage Reference are as follows:
If CVRR = 1:
CVREF = ((CVR3:CVR0)/24) x CVRSRC
If CVRR = 0:
CVREF = (CVDD x 1/4) + (((CVR3:CVR0)/32) x
CVRSRC)
The comparator reference supply voltage can come
from either VDD and VSS, or the external VREF+ and
VREF- that are multiplexed with RA2 and RA3. The
voltage source is selected by the CVRSS bit
(CVRCON<4>).
The settling time of the comparator voltage reference
must be considered when changing the CVREF
output (see Table 26-3 in Section 26.0 “Electrical
Characteristics”).
CVRCON REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
CVREN
CVROE(1)
CVRR
CVRSS
CVR3
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
CVREN: Comparator Voltage Reference Enable bit
1 = CVREF circuit powered on
0 = CVREF circuit powered down
bit 6
CVROE: Comparator VREF Output Enable bit(1)
1 = CVREF voltage level is also output on the RF5/AN10/CVREF pin
0 = CVREF voltage is disconnected from the RF5/AN10/CVREF pin
Note 1: CVROE overrides the TRISF<5> bit setting if enabled for output; RF5 must also be
configured as an input by setting TRISF<5> to ‘1’.
bit 5
CVRR: Comparator VREF Range Selection bit
1 = 0.00 CVRSRC to 0.75 CVRSRC, with CVRSRC/24 step size
0 = 0.25 CVRSRC to 0.75 CVRSRC, with CVRSRC/32 step size
bit 4
CVRSS: Comparator VREF Source Selection bit
1 = Comparator reference source, CVRSRC = (VREF+) – (VREF-)
0 = Comparator reference source, CVRSRC = VDD – VSS
bit 3-0
CVR3:CVR0: Comparator VREF Value Selection bits (0 ≤ (CVR3:CVR0) ≤ 15)
When CVRR = 1:
CVREF = ((CVR3:CVR0)/24) • (CVRSRC)
When CVRR = 0:
CVREF = (CVRSRC/4) + ((CVR3:CVR0)/32) • (CVRSRC)
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 261
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 21-1:
VOLTAGE REFERENCE BLOCK DIAGRAM
VREF+
VDD
CVRSS = 1
8R
CVRSS = 0
CVR3:CVR0
R
CVREN
R
R
16 to 1 MUX
R
16 Steps
CVREF
R
R
R
CVRR
VREF-
8R
CVRSS = 1
CVRSS = 0
21.2
Voltage Reference Accuracy/Error
The full range of voltage reference cannot be realized
due to the construction of the module. The transistors
on the top and bottom of the resistor ladder network
(Figure 21-1) keep CVREF from approaching the reference source rails. The voltage reference is derived
from the reference source; therefore, the CVREF output
changes with fluctuations in that source. The tested
absolute accuracy of the voltage reference can be
found in Section 26.0 “Electrical Characteristics”.
21.3
Operation During Sleep
When the device wakes up from Sleep through an
interrupt or a Watchdog Timer time-out, the contents of
the CVRCON register are not affected. To minimize
current consumption in Sleep mode, the voltage
reference should be disabled.
21.4
Effects of a Reset
A device Reset disables the voltage reference by
clearing bit CVREN (CVRCON<7>). This Reset also
disconnects the reference from the RA2 pin by clearing
bit CVROE (CVRCON<6>) and selects the high-voltage
range by clearing bit CVRR (CVRCON<5>). The CVR
value select bits are also cleared.
21.5
Connection Considerations
The voltage reference module operates independently
of the comparator module. The output of the reference
generator may be connected to the RF5 pin if the
TRISF<5> bit and the CVROE bit are both set.
Enabling the voltage reference output onto the RF5 pin,
with an input signal present, will increase current consumption. Connecting RF5 as a digital output with
CVRSS enabled will also increase current
consumption.
The RF5 pin can be used as a simple D/A output with
limited drive capability. Due to the limited current drive
capability, a buffer must be used on the voltage reference output for external connections to VREF.
Figure 21-2 shows an example buffering technique.
DS39635A-page 262
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 21-2:
VOLTAGE REFERENCE OUTPUT BUFFER EXAMPLE
PIC18FXXXX
CVREF
Module
R(1)
Voltage
Reference
Output
Impedance
Note 1:
TABLE 21-1:
Name
CVREF Output
R is dependent upon the voltage reference configuration bits, CVRCON<3:0> and CVRCON<5>.
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE
Bit 7
Bit 6
CVRCON
CVREN
CMCON
C2OUT
TRISF
+
–
RF5
Reset
Values
on Page
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
CVROE
CVRR
CVRSS
CVR3
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
59
C1OUT
C2INV
C1INV
CIS
CM2
CM1
CM0
59
PORTF Data Direction Register
60
Legend: Shaded cells are not used with the comparator voltage reference.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 263
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 264
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
22.0
HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE
DETECT (HLVD)
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
devices
have
a
High/Low-Voltage Detect module (HLVD). This is a
programmable circuit that allows the user to specify
both a device voltage trip point and the direction of
change from that point. If the device experiences an
excursion past the trip point in that direction, an interrupt flag is set. If the interrupt is enabled, the program
execution will branch to the interrupt vector address
and the software can then respond to the interrupt.
REGISTER 22-1:
The High/Low-Voltage Detect Control register
(Register 22-1) completely controls the operation of the
HLVD module. This allows the circuitry to be “turned
off” by the user under software control, which
minimizes the current consumption for the device.
The block diagram for the HLVD module is shown in
Figure 22-1.
HLVDCON: HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-1
R/W-0
R/W-1
VDIRMAG
—
IRVST
HLVDEN
HLVDL3
HLVDL2
HLVDL1
HLVDL0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
VDIRMAG: Voltage Direction Magnitude Select bit
1 = Event occurs when voltage equals or exceeds trip point (HLVDL3:HLDVL0)
0 = Event occurs when voltage equals or falls below trip point (HLVDL3:HLVDL0)
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
IRVST: Internal Reference Voltage Stable Flag bit
1 = Indicates that the voltage detect logic will generate the interrupt flag at the specified voltage
range
0 = Indicates that the voltage detect logic will not generate the interrupt flag at the specified
voltage range and the HLVD interrupt should not be enabled
bit 4
HLVDEN: High/Low-Voltage Detect Power Enable bit
1 = HLVD enabled
0 = HLVD disabled
bit 3-0
HLVDL3:HLVDL0: Voltage Detection Limit bits
1111 = External analog input is used (input comes from the HLVDIN pin)
1110 = 4.41V-4.87V
1101 = 4.11V-4.55V
1100 = 3.92V-4.34V
1011 = 3.72V-4.12V
1010 = 3.53V-3.91V
1001 = 3.43V-3.79V
1000 = 3.24V-3.58V
0111 = 2.95V-3.26V
0110 = 2.75V-3.03V
0101 = 2.64V-2.92V
0100 = 2.43V-2.69V
0011 = 2.35V-2.59V
0010 = 2.16V-2.38V
0001 = 1.96V-2.16V
0000 = Reserved
Note:
HLVDL3:HLVDL0 modes that result in a trip point below the valid operating voltage
of the device are not tested.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
x = Bit is unknown
DS39635A-page 265
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
The module is enabled by setting the HLVDEN bit.
Each time that the HLVD module is enabled, the
circuitry requires some time to stabilize. The IRVST bit
is a read-only bit and is used to indicate when the circuit
is stable. The module can only generate an interrupt
after the circuit is stable and IRVST is set.
event, depending on the configuration of the module.
When the supply voltage is equal to the trip point, the
voltage tapped off of the resistor array is equal to the
internal reference voltage generated by the voltage
reference module. The comparator then generates an
interrupt signal by setting the HLVDIF bit.
The VDIRMAG bit determines the overall operation of
the module. When VDIRMAG is cleared, the module
monitors for drops in VDD below a predetermined set
point. When the bit is set, the module monitors for rises
in VDD above the set point.
The trip point voltage is software programmable to any
one of 16 values. The trip point is selected by
programming
the
HLVDL3:HLVDL0
bits
(HLVDCON<3:0>).
22.1
The HLVD module has an additional feature that allows
the user to supply the trip voltage to the module from
an external source. This mode is enabled when bits
HLVDL3:HLVDL0 are set to ‘1111’. In this state, the
comparator input is multiplexed from the external input
pin, HLVDIN. This gives users flexibility because it
allows them to configure the High/Low-Voltage Detect
interrupt to occur at any voltage in the valid operating
range.
Operation
When the HLVD module is enabled, a comparator uses
an internally generated reference voltage as the set
point. The set point is compared with the trip point
where each node in the resistor divider represents a
trip point voltage. The “trip point” voltage is the voltage
level at which the device detects a high or low-voltage
FIGURE 22-1:
HLVD MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM (WITH EXTERNAL INPUT)
Externally Generated
Trip Point
VDD
VDD
HLVDCON
Register
HLVDEN
HLVDIN
16 to 1 MUX
HLVDIN
HLVDL3:HLVDL0
VDIRMAG
Set
HLVDIF
HLVDEN
Internal Voltage
Reference
BOREN
DS39635A-page 266
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
22.2
HLVD Setup
Depending on the application, the HLVD module does
not need to be operating constantly. To decrease the
current requirements, the HLVD circuitry may only
need to be enabled for short periods where the voltage
is checked. After doing the check, the HLVD module
may be disabled.
The following steps are needed to set up the HLVD
module:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Disable the module by clearing the HLVDEN bit
(HLVDCON<4>).
Write the value to the HLVDL3:HLVDL0 bits that
selects the desired HLVD trip point.
Set the VDIRMAG bit to detect high voltage
(VDIRMAG = 1) or low voltage (VDIRMAG = 0).
Enable the HLVD module by setting the
HLVDEN bit.
Clear the HLVD interrupt flag (PIR2<2>), which
may have been set from a previous interrupt.
Enable the HLVD interrupt, if interrupts are
desired, by setting the HLVDIE and GIE bits
(PIE<2> and INTCON<7>). An interrupt will not
be generated until the IRVST bit is set.
22.3
22.4
The internal reference voltage of the HLVD module,
specified in electrical specification parameter #D423,
may be used by other internal circuitry, such as the
Programmable Brown-out Reset. If the HLVD or other
circuits using the voltage reference are disabled to
lower the device’s current consumption, the reference
voltage circuit will require time to become stable before
a low or high-voltage condition can be reliably
detected. This start-up time, TIRVST, is an interval that
is independent of device clock speed. It is specified in
electrical specification parameter 36 (Table 26-12).
Current Consumption
The HLVD interrupt flag is not enabled until TIRVST has
expired and a stable reference voltage is reached. For
this reason, brief excursions beyond the set point may
not be detected during this interval. Refer to
Figure 22-2 or Figure 22-3.
When the module is enabled, the HLVD comparator
and voltage divider are enabled and will consume static
current. The total current consumption, when enabled,
is specified in electrical specification parameter
#D022B.
FIGURE 22-2:
HLVD Start-up Time
HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT OPERATION (VDIRMAG = 0)
CASE 1:
HLVDIF may not be set
VDD
VLVD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIVRST
IRVST
Internal Reference is stable
HLVDIF cleared in software
CASE 2:
VDD
VLVD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIVRST
IRVST
Internal Reference is stable
HLVDIF cleared in software
HLVDIF cleared in software,
HLVDIF remains set since HLVD condition still exists
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 267
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 22-3:
HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT OPERATION (VDIRMAG = 1)
CASE 1:
HLVDIF may not be set
VLVD
VDD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIVRST
IRVST
HLVDIF cleared in software
Internal Reference is stable
CASE 2:
VLVD
VDD
HLVDIF
Enable HLVD
TIVRST
IRVST
Internal Reference is stable
HLVDIF cleared in software
HLVDIF cleared in software,
HLVDIF remains set since HLVD condition still exists
FIGURE 22-4:
Applications
In many applications, the ability to detect a drop below
or rise above a particular threshold is desirable. For
example, the HLVD module could be periodically
enabled to detect USB attach or detach. This assumes
the device is powered by a lower voltage source than
the Universal Serial Bus when detached. An attach
would indicate a high-voltage detect from, for example,
3.3V to 5V (the voltage on USB) and vice versa for a
detach. This feature could save a design a few extra
components and an attach signal (input pin).
VA
VB
For general battery applications, Figure 22-4 shows a
possible voltage curve. Over time, the device voltage
decreases. When the device voltage reaches voltage
VA, the HLVD logic generates an interrupt at time TA.
The interrupt could cause the execution of an ISR,
which would allow the application to perform “housekeeping tasks” and perform a controlled shutdown
before the device voltage exits the valid operating
range at TB. The HLVD thus would give the application
a time window, represented by the difference between
TA and TB, to safely exit.
DS39635A-page 268
TYPICAL LOW-VOLTAGE
DETECT APPLICATION
Voltage
22.5
Preliminary
Time
TA
TB
Legend: VA = HLVD trip point
VB = Minimum valid device
operating voltage
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
22.6
Operation During Sleep
22.7
When enabled, the HLVD circuitry continues to operate
during Sleep. If the device voltage crosses the trip
point, the HLVDIF bit will be set and the device will
wake-up from Sleep. Device execution will continue
from the interrupt vector address if interrupts have
been globally enabled.
TABLE 22-1:
Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the HLVD module to be turned off.
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT MODULE
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
HLVDCON
VDIRMAG
—
IRVST
HLVDEN
HLVDL3
HLVDL2
HLVDL1
HLVDL0
58
INTCON
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
57
PIR2
OSCFIF
CMIF
—
—
BCLIF
HLVDIF
TMR3IF
CCP2IF
59
PIE2
OCSFIE
CMIE
—
—
BCLIE
HLVDIE
TMR3IE
CCP2IE
59
IPR2
OSCFIP
CMIP
—
—
BCLIP
HLVDIP
TMR3IP
CCP2IP
59
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are unused by the HLVD module.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 269
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 270
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
23.0
SPECIAL FEATURES OF THE
CPU
A complete discussion of device Resets and interrupts
is available in previous sections of this data sheet.
In addition to their Power-up and Oscillator Start-up Timers provided for Resets, PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
devices have a Watchdog Timer, which is either
permanently enabled via the configuration bits, or
software controlled (if configured as disabled).
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices include several
features intended to maximize reliability and minimize
cost through elimination of external components.
These are:
• Oscillator Selection
• Resets:
- Power-on Reset (POR)
- Power-up Timer (PWRT)
- Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
- Brown-out Reset (BOR)
• Interrupts
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
• Two-Speed Start-up
• Code Protection
• ID Locations
• In-Circuit Serial Programming
The inclusion of an internal RC oscillator also provides
the additional benefits of a Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
(FSCM) and Two-Speed Start-up. FSCM provides for
background monitoring of the peripheral clock and
automatic switchover in the event of its failure.
Two-Speed Start-up enables code to be executed
almost immediately on start-up, while the primary clock
source completes its start-up delays.
All of these features are enabled and configured by
setting the appropriate configuration register bits.
23.1
The configuration bits can be programmed (read as
‘0’), or left unprogrammed (read as ‘1’), to select
various device configurations. These bits are mapped
starting at program memory location 300000h.
The oscillator can be configured for the application
depending on frequency, power, accuracy and cost. All
of the options are discussed in detail in Section 2.0
“Oscillator Configurations”.
TABLE 23-1:
Configuration Bits
The user will note that address 300000h is beyond the
user program memory space. In fact, it belongs to the
configuration memory space (300000h-3FFFFFh),
which can only be accessed using table reads.
CONFIGURATION BITS AND DEVICE IDs
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Default/
Unprogrammed
Value
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
00-- 0111
300001h
CONFIG1H
IESO
FCMEN
—
—
FOSC3
300002h
CONFIG2L
—
—
—
BORV1
BORV0
300003h
CONFIG2H
—
—
—
WDTEN
---1 1111
300004h
CONFIG3L
WAIT
BW
—
—
—
—
PM1
PM0
11-- --11
300005h
CONFIG3H
MCLRE
—
—
—
—
LPT1OSC
—
CCP2MX
1--- -0-1
300006h
CONFIG4L
DEBUG
XINST
—
—
—
—
—
STVREN
10-- ---1
300008h
CONFIG5L
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CP
---- ---1
30000Ch
CONFIG7L(1)
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
EBTR
---- ---1
3FFFFEh
DEVID1
DEV2
DEV1
DEV0
REV4
REV3
REV2
REV1
REV0
11qx xxxx(2)
3FFFFFh
DEVID2
DEV10
DEV9
DEV8
DEV7
DEV6
DEV5
DEV4
DEV3
0000 qq1q(2)
Legend:
x = unknown, u = unchanged, - = unimplemented, q = value depends on individual device.
Shaded cells are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
Unimplemented in PIC18F6310/6410 devices; maintain this bit set.
See Register 23-9 for DEVID1 values. DEVID registers are read-only and cannot be programmed by the user.
Note 1:
2:
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
BOREN1 BOREN0 PWRTEN
WDTPS3 WDTPS2 WDTPS1 WDTPS0
Preliminary
---1 1111
DS39635A-page 271
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-1:
CONFIG1H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 1 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 300001h)
R/P-0
R/P-0
U-0
U-0
R/P-0
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
IESO
FCMEN
—
—
FOSC3
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
IESO: Internal/External Oscillator Switchover bit
1 = Oscillator Switchover mode enabled
0 = Oscillator Switchover mode disabled
bit 6
FCMEN: Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Enable bit
1 = Fail-Safe Clock Monitor enabled
0 = Fail-Safe Clock Monitor disabled
bit 5-4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 3-0
FOSC3:FOSC0: Oscillator Selection bits
11xx = External RC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
101x = External RC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
1001 = Internal oscillator block, CLKO function on RA6, port function on RA7
1000 = Internal oscillator block, port function on RA6 and RA7
0111 = External RC oscillator, port function on RA6
0110 = HS oscillator, PLL enabled (clock frequency = 4 x FOSC1)
0101 = EC oscillator, port function on RA6
0100 = EC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
0011 = External RC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
0010 = HS oscillator
0001 = XT oscillator
0000 = LP oscillator
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
DS39635A-page 272
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-2:
CONFIG2L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 2 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300002h)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
R/P-1
—
BORV1
R/P-1
BORV0
R/P-1
BOREN1
R/P-1
(1)
BOREN0
R/P-1
(1)
PWRTEN(1)
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-3
BORV1:BORV0: Brown-out Reset Voltage bits
11 = VBOR set to 2.1V
10 = VBOR set to 2.8V
01 = VBOR set to 4.3V
00 = VBOR set to 4.6V
bit 2-1
BOREN1:BOREN0 Brown-out Reset Enable bits(1)
11 = Brown-out Reset enabled in hardware only (SBOREN is disabled)
10 = Brown-out Reset enabled in hardware only and disabled in Sleep mode
(SBOREN is disabled)
10 = Brown-out Reset enabled and controlled by software (SBOREN is enabled)
10 = Brown-out Reset disabled in hardware and software
bit 0
PWRTEN: Power-up Timer Enable bit(1)
1 = PWRT disabled
0 = PWRT enabled
Note 1: The Power-up Timer is decoupled from Brown-out Reset, allowing these features to
be independently controlled.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
DS39635A-page 273
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-3:
CONFIG2H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 2 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 300003h)
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
—
—
—
WDTPS3
WDTPS2
WDTPS1
WDTPS0
WDTEN
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-1
WDTPS3:WDTPS0: Watchdog Timer Postscale Select bits
1111 = 1:32,768
1110 = 1:16,384
1101 = 1:8,192
1100 = 1:4,096
1011 = 1:2,048
1010 = 1:1,024
1001 = 1:512
1000 = 1:256
0111 = 1:128
0110 = 1:64
0101 = 1:32
0100 = 1:16
0011 = 1:8
0010 = 1:4
0001 = 1:2
0000 = 1:1
bit 0
WDTEN: Watchdog Timer Enable bit
1 = WDT enabled
0 = WDT disabled (control is placed on the SWDTEN bit)
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
DS39635A-page 274
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-4:
CONFIG3L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 3 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300004h)
R/P-1
R/P-1
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/P-1
R/P-1
WAIT
BW
—
—
—
—
PM1
PM0
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
WAIT: External Bus Data Wait Enable bit
1 = Wait selections unavailable, device will not wait
0 = Wait programmed by WAIT1 and WAIT0 bits of MEMCOM register (MEMCOM<5:4>)
bit 6
BW: External Bus Data Width Select bit
1 = 16-bit External Bus Data Width
0 = 8-bit External Bus Data Width
bit 5-2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 1-0
PM1:PM0: Processor Data Memory Mode Select bits
11 = Microcontroller mode
10 = Microprocessor mode(1)
01 = Microcontroller with Boot Block mode(1)
00 = Extended Microcontroller mode(1)
Note 1: This mode is available only on PIC18F8310/8410 devices.
Legend:
REGISTER 23-5:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value after erase
‘1’ = Bit is set
‘0’ = Bit is cleared
x = Bit is unknown
CONFIG3H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 3 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 300005h)
R/P-1
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/P-0
U-0
R/P-1
MCLRE
—
—
—
—
LPT1OSC
—
CCP2MX
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
MCLRE: MCLR Pin Enable bit
1 = MCLR pin enabled; RG5 input pin disabled
0 = RG5 input pin enabled; MCLR disabled
bit 6-3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2
LPT1OSC: Low-Power Timer 1 Oscillator Enable bit
1 = Timer1 configured for low-power operation
0 = Timer1 configured for higher power operation
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
CCP2MX: CCP2 Mux bit
In Microcontroller Mode only (all devices):
1 = CCP2 input/output is multiplexed with RC1
0 = CCP2 input/output is multiplexed with RE7
In Microprocessor, Extended Microcontroller and Microcontroller with Boot Block Modes
(PIC18F8310/8410 devices only):
1 = CCP2 input/output is multiplexed with RC1
0 = CCP2 input/output is multiplexed with RB3
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
DS39635A-page 275
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-6:
CONFIG4L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 4 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300006h)
R/P-1
R/P-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/P-1
DEBUG
XINST
—
—
—
—
—
STVREN
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7
DEBUG: Background Debugger Enable bit
1 = Background debugger disabled, RB6 and RB7 configured as general purpose I/O pins
0 = Background debugger enabled, RB6 and RB7 are dedicated to In-Circuit Debug
bit 6
XINST: Extended Instruction Set Enable bit
1 = Instruction set extension and Indexed Addressing mode enabled
0 = Instruction set extension and Indexed Addressing mode disabled (Legacy mode)
bit 5-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
STVREN: Stack Full/Underflow Reset Enable bit
1 = Stack full/underflow will cause Reset
0 = Stack full/underflow will not cause Reset
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
REGISTER 23-7:
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
CONFIG5L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 5 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300008h)
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/C-1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CP
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
CP: Code Protection bit
1 = Program memory block not code-protected
0 = Program memory block code-protected
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
DS39635A-page 276
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-8:
CONFIG7L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 7 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 30000Ch)(1)
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/C-1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
EBTR(2)
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
EBTR: Table Read Protection bit(2)
1= Internal program memory block not protected from table reads executed from external
memory block
0= Internal program memory block protected from table reads executed from external memory
block
Note 1: Unimplemented on PIC18F6310/6410 devices; maintain the bit set.
2: Valid for the entire internal program memory block in Extended Microcontroller mode
and for only the boot block (0000h to 07FFh) in Microcontroller with Boot Block
mode. This bit has no effect in Microcontroller and Microprocessor modes.
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
DS39635A-page 277
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-9:
DEVICE ID REGISTER 1 FOR PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 DEVICES
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
DEV2
DEV1
DEV0
REV4
REV3
REV2
REV1
REV0
bit 7
bit 7-5
bit 0
DEV2:DEV0: Device ID bits
110 = PIC18F8310, PIC18F8410
111 = PIC18F6310, PIC18F6410
Note:
bit 4-0
These values for DEV2:DEV0 may be shared with other devices. The specific
device is always identified by using the entire DEV10:DEV0 bit sequence.
REV4:REV0: Revision ID bits
These bits are used to indicate the device revision.
Legend:
R = Read-only bit
P = Programmable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
REGISTER 23-10: DEVICE ID REGISTER 2 FOR PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 DEVICES
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
DEV10
DEV9
DEV8
DEV7
DEV6
DEV5
DEV4
DEV3
bit 7
bit 7-0
bit 0
DEV10:DEV3: Device ID bits
These bits are used with the DEV2:DEV0 bits in the Device ID Register 1 to identify the
part number.
0000 0110 = PIC18F6410/8410 devices
0000 1011 = PIC18F6310/8310 devices
Note:
These values for DEV10:DEV3 may be shared with other devices. The specific
device is always identified by using the entire DEV10:DEV0 bit sequence.
Legend:
R = Read-only bit
P = Programmable bit
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
DS39635A-page 278
Preliminary
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
u = Unchanged from programmed state
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
23.2
Watchdog Timer (WDT)
For PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices, the WDT is
driven by the INTRC source. When the WDT is
enabled, the clock source is also enabled. The nominal
WDT period is 4 ms and has the same stability as the
INTRC oscillator.
The 4 ms period of the WDT is multiplied by a 16-bit
postscaler. Any output of the WDT postscaler is
selected by a multiplexer, controlled by bits in Configuration Register 2H. Available periods range from 4 ms
to 131.072 seconds (2.18 minutes). The WDT and
postscaler are cleared when any of the following events
occur: a SLEEP or CLRWDT instruction is executed, the
IRCF bits (OSCCON<6:4>) are changed or a clock
failure has occurred.
FIGURE 23-1:
SWDTEN
WDTEN
Note 1: The CLRWDT and SLEEP instructions
clear the WDT and postscaler counts
when executed.
2: Changing the setting of the IRCF bits
(OSCCON<6:4>) clears the WDT and
postscaler counts.
3: When a CLRWDT instruction is executed
the postscaler count will be cleared.
23.2.1
CONTROL REGISTER
Register 23-11 shows the WDTCON register. This is a
readable and writable register, which contains a control
bit that allows software to override the WDT enable
configuration bit, but only if the configuration bit has
disabled the WDT.
WDT BLOCK DIAGRAM
Enable WDT
INTRC Control
WDT Counter
INTRC Source
÷128
Wake-up
from Power
Managed Modes
Change on IRCF bits
Programmable Postscaler
1:1 to 1:32,768
CLRWDT
All Device Resets
WDTPS<3:0>
Reset
WDT
Reset
WDT
4
Sleep
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 279
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
REGISTER 23-11: WDTCON: WATCHDOG TIMER CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
U-0
R/W-0
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SWDTEN
bit 7
bit 0
bit 7-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 0
SWDTEN: Software Controlled Watchdog Timer Enable bit
1 = Watchdog Timer is on
0 = Watchdog Timer is off
Note:
This bit has no effect if the configuration bit WDTEN is enabled.
Legend:
TABLE 23-2:
Name
RCON
WDTCON
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value at POR
SUMMARY OF WATCHDOG TIMER REGISTERS
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Reset
Values
on Page
IPEN
SBOREN
—
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
58
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
SWDTEN
58
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer.
DS39635A-page 280
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
23.3
Two-Speed Start-up
Reset. For wake-ups from Sleep, the INTOSC or
postscaler clock sources can be selected by setting the
IFRC2:IFRC0 bits prior to entering Sleep mode.
The Two-Speed Start-up feature helps to minimize the
latency period from oscillator start-up to code execution
by allowing the microcontroller to use the INTRC
oscillator as a clock source until the primary clock
source is available. It is enabled by setting the IESO
configuration bit.
In all other power managed modes, Two-Speed Start-up
is not used. The device will be clocked by the currently
selected clock source until the primary clock source
becomes available. The setting of the IESO bit is
ignored.
Two-Speed Start-up should be enabled only if the
primary oscillator mode is LP, XT, HS or HSPLL
(Crystal-based modes). Other sources do not require a
OST start-up delay; for these, Two-Speed Start-up
should be disabled.
23.3.1
While using the INTRC oscillator in Two-Speed
Start-up, the device still obeys the normal command
sequences for entering power managed modes,
including serial SLEEP instructions (refer to
Section 3.1.2 “Entering Power Managed Modes”).
In practice, this means that user code can change
the SCS1:SCS0 bit settings or issue SLEEP
instructions before the OST times out. This would
allow an application to briefly wake-up, perform
routine “housekeeping” tasks and return to Sleep
before the device starts to operate from the primary
oscillator.
When enabled, Resets and wake-ups from Sleep mode
cause the device to configure itself to run from the internal oscillator block as the clock source, following the
time-out of the Power-up Timer after a Power-on Reset
is enabled. This allows almost immediate code
execution while the primary oscillator starts and the
OST is running. Once the OST times out, the device
automatically switches to PRI_RUN mode.
Because the OSCCON register is cleared on Reset
events, the INTOSC (or postscaler) clock source is not
initially available after a Reset event; the INTRC clock
is used directly at its base frequency. To use a higher
clock speed on wake-up, the INTOSC or postscaler
clock sources can be selected to provide a higher clock
speed by setting bits, IFRC2:IFRC0, immediately after
FIGURE 23-2:
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS FOR
USING TWO-SPEED START-UP
User code can also check if the primary clock source is
currently providing the device clocking by checking the
status of the OSTS bit (OSCCON<3>). If the bit is set,
the primary oscillator is providing the clock. Otherwise,
the internal oscillator block is providing the clock during
wake-up from Reset or Sleep mode.
TIMING TRANSITION FOR TWO-SPEED START-UP (INTOSC TO HSPLL)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3
Q1
INTOSC
Multiplexer
OSC1
TOST(1)
TPLL(1)
1
PLL Clock
Output
2
n-1 n
Clock
Transition
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
Wake from Interrupt Event
PC + 2
PC + 4
PC + 6
OSTS bit Set
Note 1: TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 281
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
23.4
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the
microcontroller to continue operation in the event of an
external oscillator failure by automatically switching the
device clock to the internal oscillator block. The FSCM
function is enabled by setting the FCMEN configuration
bit.
When FSCM is enabled, the INTRC oscillator runs at
all times to monitor clocks to peripherals and provide a
backup clock in the event of a clock failure. Clock
monitoring (shown in Figure 23-3) is accomplished by
creating a sample clock signal, which is the INTRC
output divided by 64. This allows ample time between
FSCM sample clocks for a peripheral clock edge to
occur. The peripheral device clock and the sample
clock are presented as inputs to the Clock Monitor latch
(CM). The CM is set on the falling edge of the device
clock source, but cleared on the rising edge of the
sample clock.
FIGURE 23-3:
FSCM BLOCK DIAGRAM
Clock Monitor
Latch (CM)
(edge-triggered)
Peripheral
Clock
INTRC
Source
(32 µs)
÷ 64
S
Q
C
Q
The FSCM will detect failures of the primary or secondary clock sources only. If the internal oscillator block
fails, no failure would be detected, nor would any action
be possible.
23.4.1
Clock
Failure
Detected
Clock failure is tested for on the falling edge of the sample clock. If a sample clock falling edge occurs while
CM is still set, a clock failure has been detected
(Figure 23-4). This causes the following:
• the FSCM generates an oscillator fail interrupt by
setting bit, OSCFIF (PIR2<7>);
• the device clock source is switched to the internal
oscillator block (OSCCON is not updated to show
the current clock source – this is the Fail-Safe
condition); and
• the WDT is reset.
During switchover, the postscaler frequency from the
internal oscillator block may not be sufficiently stable for
timing sensitive applications. In these cases, it may be
desirable to select another clock configuration and enter
an alternate power managed mode. This can be done to
attempt a partial recovery or execute a controlled shutdown. See Section 3.1.2 “Entering Power Managed
Modes” and Section 23.3.1 “Special Considerations
for Using Two-Speed Start-up” for more details.
FSCM AND THE WATCHDOG TIMER
Both the FSCM and the WDT are clocked by the
INTRC oscillator. Since the WDT operates with a
separate divider and counter, disabling the WDT has
no effect on the operation of the INTRC oscillator when
the FSCM is enabled.
As already noted, the clock source is switched to the
INTOSC clock when a clock failure is detected.
Depending on the frequency selected by the
IRCF2:IRCF0 bits, this may mean a substantial change
in the speed of code execution. If the WDT is enabled
with a small prescale value, a decrease in clock speed
allows a WDT time-out to occur and a subsequent
device Reset. For this reason, Fail-Safe Clock events
also reset the WDT and postscaler, allowing it to start
timing from when execution speed was changed and
decreasing the likelihood of an erroneous time-out.
23.4.2
488 Hz
(2.048 ms)
DS39635A-page 282
To use a higher clock speed on wake-up, the INTOSC
or postscaler clock sources can be selected to provide
a higher clock speed by setting bits IFRC2:IFRC0
immediately after Reset. For wake-ups from Sleep, the
INTOSC or postscaler clock sources can be selected
by setting the IFRC2:IFRC0 bits prior to entering Sleep
mode.
EXITING FAIL-SAFE OPERATION
The Fail-Safe condition is terminated by either a device
Reset or by entering a power managed mode. On
Reset, the controller starts the primary clock source
specified in Configuration Register 1H (with any
required start-up delays that are required for the oscillator mode, such as the OST or PLL timer). The
INTOSC multiplexer provides the device clock until the
primary clock source becomes ready (similar to a
Two-Speed Start-up). The clock source is then
switched to the primary clock (indicated by the OSTS
bit in the OSCCON register becoming set). The
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor then resumes monitoring the
peripheral clock.
The primary clock source may never become ready
during start-up. In this case, operation is clocked by the
INTOSC multiplexer. The OSCCON register will remain
in its Reset state until a power managed mode is
entered.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 23-4:
FSCM TIMING DIAGRAM
Sample Clock
Oscillator
Failure
Device
Clock
Output
CM Output
(Q)
Failure
Detected
OSCFIF
CM Test
Note:
23.4.3
CM Test
CM Test
The device clock is normally at a much higher frequency than the sample clock. The relative frequencies in this
example have been chosen for clarity.
FSCM INTERRUPTS IN POWER
MANAGED MODES
23.4.4
By entering a power managed mode, the clock
multiplexer selects the clock source selected by the
OSCCON register. Fail-safe monitoring of the power
managed clock source resumes in the power managed
mode.
If an oscillator failure occurs during power managed
operation, the subsequent events depend on whether
or not the oscillator failure interrupt is enabled. If
enabled (OSCFIF = 1), code execution will be clocked
by the INTOSC multiplexer. An automatic transition
back to the failed clock source will not occur.
If the interrupt is disabled, the device will not exit the
power managed mode on oscillator failure. Instead, the
device will continue to operate as before, but clocked
by the INTOSC multiplexer. While in Idle mode, subsequent interrupts will cause the CPU to begin executing
instructions while being clocked by the INTOSC
multiplexer.
POR OR WAKE FROM SLEEP
The FSCM is designed to detect oscillator failure at any
point after the device has exited Power-on Reset
(POR) or low-power Sleep mode. When the primary
device clock is EC, RC or INTRC modes, monitoring
can begin immediately following these events.
For oscillator modes involving a crystal or resonator
(HS, HSPLL, LP or XT), the situation is somewhat
different. Since the oscillator may require a start-up
time considerably longer than the FCSM sample clock
time, a false clock failure may be detected. To prevent
this, the internal oscillator block is automatically configured as the device clock and functions until the primary
clock is stable (the OST and PLL timers have timed
out). This is identical to Two-Speed Start-up mode.
Once the primary clock is stable, the INTRC returns to
its role as the FSCM source.
Note:
The same logic that prevents false
oscillator failure interrupts on POR or
wake from Sleep, will also prevent the
detection of the oscillator’s failure to start
at all following these events. This can be
avoided by monitoring the OSTS bit and
using a timing routine to determine if the
oscillator is taking too long to start. Even
so, no oscillator failure interrupt will be
flagged.
As noted in Section 23.3.1 “Special Considerations
for Using Two-Speed Start-up”, it is also possible to
select another clock configuration and enter an
alternate power managed mode while waiting for the
primary clock to become stable. When the new
powered managed mode is selected, the primary clock
is disabled.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 283
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
23.5
Program Verification and
Code Protection
The overall structure of the code protection on the
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 Flash devices differs
from previous PIC18 devices.
For all devices in the PIC18FX310/X410 family, the
user program memory is made of a single block.
Figure 23-5 shows the program memory organization
for individual devices. Code protection for this block is
controlled by a single bit, CP (CONFIG5L<0>). The CP
bit inhibits external reads and writes. It has no direct
effect in normal execution mode.
23.5.1
CODE PROTECTION FROM
EXTERNAL TABLE READS
EBTR is implemented only on devices with the external
memory interface. Its operation also depends on the
particular mode of operation selected. In Extended
Microcontroller mode, programming EBTR enables
protection from external table reads for the entire
program memory. In Microcontroller with Boot Block
mode, only the first 2 Kbytes of on-chip memory (000h
to 7FFh) are protected; this is because only this range
of internal program memory is accessible by the
microcontroller in this operating mode.
When the device is in Micrcontroller or Microprocessor
modes, EBTR has no effect on code protection.
The program memory may be read to any location
using the Table Read instructions. The device ID and
the configuration registers may be read with the table
read instructions.
For devices with the external memory interface, it is
possible to execute a Table Read from an external
program memory space and read the contents of the
on-chip memory. An additional code protection bit,
FIGURE 23-5:
EBTR (CONFIG7L<0>), is used to protect the on-chip
program memory space from this possibility. Setting
EBTR prevents Table Read commands from executing
on any address in the on-chip program memory space.
23.5.2
CONFIGURATION REGISTER
PROTECTION
The configuration registers can only be written via
ICSP using an external programmer. No separate
protection bit is associated with them.
CODE-PROTECTED PROGRAM MEMORY FOR PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
MEMORY SIZE/DEVICE
8 Kbytes
Address
(PIC18F6310/8310) Range
Program memory
Block
000000h
001FFFh
Program memory
Block
002000h
Unimplemented
Read ‘0’s
000000h
003FFFh
CP, EBTR
004000h
Unimplemented
Read ‘0’s
1FFFFFh
TABLE 23-3:
Block Code Protection
Controlled By:
16 Kbytes
Address
(PIC18F6410/8410) Range
(Unimplemented Memory Space)
1FFFFFh
SUMMARY OF CODE PROTECTION REGISTERS
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
300008h
CONFIG5L
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CP
30000Ch
CONFIG7L*
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
EBTR
Legend: Shaded cells are unimplemented.
* Unimplemented in PIC18F6310/8310 devices; maintain this bit set.
DS39635A-page 284
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
23.6
ID Locations
23.8
In-Circuit Debugger
Eight memory locations (200000h-200007h) are
designated as ID locations, where the user can store
checksum or other code identification numbers. These
locations are readable during normal execution through
the TBLRD instruction; during program/verify, these
locations are readable and writable. The ID locations
can be read when the device is code-protected.
When the DEBUG configuration bit is programmed to a
‘0’, the In-Circuit Debugger functionality is enabled.
This function allows simple debugging functions when
used with MPLAB® IDE. When the microcontroller has
this feature enabled, some resources are not available
for general use. Table 23-4 shows which resources are
required by the background debugger.
23.7
TABLE 23-4:
In-Circuit Serial Programming
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 microcontrollers can be
serially programmed while in the end application circuit.
This is simply done with two lines for clock and data
and three other lines for power, ground and the
programming voltage. This allows customers to manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices and then
program the microcontroller just before shipping the
product. This also allows the most recent firmware or a
custom firmware to be programmed.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
DEBUGGER RESOURCES
I/O pins:
RB6, RB7
Stack:
2 levels
Program Memory:
512 bytes
Data Memory:
10 bytes
To use the in-circuit debugger function of the microcontroller, the design must implement In-Circuit Serial
Programming connections to MCLR/VPP, VDD, VSS,
RB7 and RB6. This will interface to the In-Circuit
Debugger module available from Microchip or one of
the third party development tool companies.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 285
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 286
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
24.0
INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 devices incorporate the
standard set of 75 PIC18 core instructions, as well as
an extended set of 8 new instructions for the optimization of code that is recursive or that utilizes a software
stack. The extended set is discussed later in this
section.
24.1
Standard Instruction Set
The standard PIC18 instruction set adds many
enhancements to the previous PICmicro® instruction
sets, while maintaining an easy migration from these
PICmicro instruction sets. Most instructions are a
single program memory word (16 bits), but there are
four instructions that require two program memory
locations.
Each single-word instruction is a 16-bit word divided
into an opcode, which specifies the instruction type and
one or more operands, which further specify the
operation of the instruction.
The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped
into four basic categories:
•
•
•
•
Byte-oriented operations
Bit-oriented operations
Literal operations
Control operations
The PIC18 instruction set summary in Table 24-2 lists
byte-oriented, bit-oriented, literal and control
operations. Table 24-1 shows the opcode field
descriptions.
Most byte-oriented instructions have three operands:
1.
2.
3.
The file register (specified by ‘f’)
The destination of the result (specified by ‘d’)
The accessed memory (specified by ‘a’)
The file register designator ‘f’ specifies which file
register is to be used by the instruction. The destination
designator ‘d’ specifies where the result of the
operation is to be placed. If ‘d’ is zero, the result is
placed in the WREG register. If ‘d’ is one, the result is
placed in the file register specified in the instruction.
All bit-oriented instructions have three operands:
1.
2.
3.
The file register (specified by ‘f’)
The bit in the file register (specified by ‘b’)
The accessed memory (specified by ‘a’)
The literal instructions may use some of the following
operands:
• A literal value to be loaded into a file register
(specified by ‘k’)
• The desired FSR register to load the literal value
into (specified by ‘f’)
• No operand required
(specified by ‘—’)
The control instructions may use some of the following
operands:
• A program memory address (specified by ‘n’)
• The mode of the call or return instructions
(specified by ‘s’)
• The mode of the table read and table write
instructions (specified by ‘m’)
• No operand required
(specified by ‘—’)
All instructions are a single word, except for four
double-word instructions. These instructions were
made double-word to contain the required information
in 32 bits. In the second word, the 4 MSbs are ‘1’s. If
this second word is executed as an instruction (by
itself), it will execute as a NOP.
All single-word instructions are executed in a single
instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true or the
program counter is changed as a result of the instruction. In these cases, the execution takes two instruction
cycles with the additional instruction cycle(s) executed
as a NOP.
The double word instructions execute in two instruction
cycles.
One instruction cycle consists of four oscillator periods.
Thus, for an oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, the normal
instruction execution time is 1 µs. If a conditional test is
true, or the program counter is changed as a result of
an instruction, the instruction execution time is 2 µs.
Two-word branch instructions (if true) would take 3 µs.
Figure 24-1 shows the general formats that the instructions can have. All examples use the convention ‘nnh’
to represent a hexadecimal number.
The Instruction Set Summary, shown in Table 24-2,
lists the standard instructions recognized by the
Microchip Assembler (MPASM™).
Section 24.1.1 “Standard Instruction Set” provides
a description of each instruction.
The bit field designator ‘b’ selects the number of the bit
affected by the operation, while the file register designator ‘f’ represents the number of the file in which the
bit is located.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 287
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 24-1:
OPCODE FIELD DESCRIPTIONS
Field
Description
a
RAM access bit
a = 0: RAM location in Access RAM (BSR register is ignored)
a = 1: RAM bank is specified by BSR register
bbb
Bit address within an 8-bit file register (0 to 7).
BSR
Bank Select Register. Used to select the current RAM bank.
C, DC, Z, OV, N
ALU status bits: Carry, Digit Carry, Zero, Overflow, Negative.
d
Destination select bit
d = 0: store result in WREG
d = 1: store result in file register f.
dest
Destination: either the WREG register or the specified register file location.
f
8-bit register file address (00h to FFh), or 2-bit FSR designator (0h to 3h).
fs
12-bit register file address (000h to FFFh). This is the source address.
fd
12-bit register file address (000h to FFFh). This is the destination address.
GIE
Global interrupt enable bit.
k
Literal field, constant data or label (may be either an 8-bit, 12-bit or a 20-bit value).
label
Label name.
mm
The mode of the TBLPTR register for the table read and table write instructions.
Only used with table read and table write instructions:
*
No change to register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes).
*+
Post-Increment register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes).
*-
Post-Decrement register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes).
Pre-Increment register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes).
+*
n
The relative address (2’s complement number) for relative branch instructions, or the direct address for
call/branch and return instructions.
PC
Program Counter.
PCL
Program Counter Low Byte.
PCH
Program Counter High Byte.
PCLATH
Program Counter High Byte Latch.
PCLATU
Program Counter Upper Byte Latch.
PD
Power-Down bit.
PRODH
Product of Multiply high byte.
PRODL
Product of Multiply low byte.
s
Fast Call/Return mode select bit
s = 0: do not update into/from shadow registers
s = 1: certain registers loaded into/from shadow registers (Fast mode)
TBLPTR
21-bit Table Pointer (points to a program memory location).
TABLAT
8-bit Table Latch.
TO
Time-out bit.
TOS
Top-of-Stack.
u
Unused or Unchanged.
WDT
Watchdog Timer.
WREG
Working register (accumulator).
x
Don’t care (‘0’ or ‘1’). The assembler will generate code with x = 0. It is the recommended form of use for
compatibility with all Microchip software tools.
zs
7-bit offset value for indirect addressing of register files (source).
7-bit offset value for indirect addressing of register files (destination).
zd
{
}
Optional argument.
[text]
Indicates an indexed address.
(text)
The contents of text.
[expr]<n>
Specifies bit n of the register indicated by the pointer expr.
→
Assigned to.
< >
Register bit field.
∈
In the set of.
italics
User-defined term (font is Courier).
DS39635A-page 288
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 24-1:
GENERAL FORMAT FOR INSTRUCTIONS
Byte-oriented file register operations
15
10
9 8 7
OPCODE d
a
Example Instruction
0
f (FILE #)
ADDWF MYREG, W, B
d = 0 for result destination to be WREG register
d = 1 for result destination to be file register (f)
a = 0 to force Access Bank
a = 1 for BSR to select bank
f = 8-bit file register address
Byte to Byte move operations (2-word)
15
12 11
OPCODE
15
0
f (Source FILE #)
12 11
MOVFF MYREG1, MYREG2
0
f (Destination FILE #)
1111
f = 12-bit file register address
Bit-oriented file register operations
15
12 11
9 8 7
OPCODE b (BIT #) a
0
f (FILE #)
BSF MYREG, bit, B
b = 3-bit position of bit in file register (f)
a = 0 to force Access Bank
a = 1 for BSR to select bank
f = 8-bit file register address
Literal operations
15
8
7
OPCODE
0
k (literal)
MOVLW
7Fh
k = 8-bit immediate value
Control operations
CALL, GOTO and Branch operations
15
8 7
OPCODE
15
0
n<7:0> (literal)
12 11
GOTO Label
0
n<19:8> (literal)
1111
n = 20-bit immediate value
15
8 7
OPCODE
15
S
0
CALL MYFUNC
n<7:0> (literal)
12 11
0
n<19:8> (literal)
1111
S = Fast bit
15
OPCODE
15
OPCODE
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
11 10
0
BRA MYFUNC
n<10:0> (literal)
8 7
0
n<7:0> (literal)
Preliminary
BC MYFUNC
DS39635A-page 289
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 24-2:
PIC18FXXX INSTRUCTION SET
Mnemonic,
Operands
16-Bit Instruction Word
Description
Cycles
MSb
LSb
Status
Affected
Notes
BYTE-ORIENTED OPERATIONS
ADDWF
ADDWFC
ANDWF
CLRF
COMF
CPFSEQ
CPFSGT
CPFSLT
DECF
DECFSZ
DCFSNZ
INCF
INCFSZ
INFSNZ
IORWF
MOVF
MOVFF
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, a
f, d, a
f, a
f, a
f, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
fs, fd
MOVWF
MULWF
NEGF
RLCF
RLNCF
RRCF
RRNCF
SETF
SUBFWB
f, a
f, a
f, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, d, a
f, a
f, d, a
SUBWF
SUBWFB
f, d, a
f, d, a
SWAPF
TSTFSZ
XORWF
f, d, a
f, a
f, d, a
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
Add WREG and f
Add WREG and Carry bit to f
AND WREG with f
Clear f
Complement f
Compare f with WREG, skip =
Compare f with WREG, skip >
Compare f with WREG, skip <
Decrement f
Decrement f, Skip if 0
Decrement f, Skip if Not 0
Increment f
Increment f, Skip if 0
Increment f, Skip if Not 0
Inclusive OR WREG with f
Move f
Move fs (source) to 1st word
fd (destination)2nd word
Move WREG to f
Multiply WREG with f
Negate f
Rotate Left f through Carry
Rotate Left f (No Carry)
Rotate Right f through Carry
Rotate Right f (No Carry)
Set f
Subtract f from WREG with
borrow
Subtract WREG from f
Subtract WREG from f with
borrow
Swap nibbles in f
Test f, skip if 0
Exclusive OR WREG with f
1
1
1
1
1
1 (2 or 3)
1 (2 or 3)
1 (2 or 3)
1
1 (2 or 3)
1 (2 or 3)
1
1 (2 or 3)
1 (2 or 3)
1
1
2
C, DC, Z, OV, N
C, DC, Z, OV, N
Z, N
Z
Z, N
None
None
None
C, DC, Z, OV, N
None
None
C, DC, Z, OV, N
None
None
Z, N
Z, N
None
1, 2
1, 2
1,2
2
1, 2
4
4
1, 2
1, 2, 3, 4
1, 2, 3, 4
1, 2
1, 2, 3, 4
4
1, 2
1, 2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0010
0010
0001
0110
0001
0110
0110
0110
0000
0010
0100
0010
0011
0100
0001
0101
1100
1111
0110
0000
0110
0011
0100
0011
0100
0110
0101
01da
00da
01da
101a
11da
001a
010a
000a
01da
11da
11da
10da
11da
10da
00da
00da
ffff
ffff
111a
001a
110a
01da
01da
00da
00da
100a
01da
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
1
1
0101
0101
11da
10da
ffff
ffff
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N 1, 2
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
1
0011
1 (2 or 3) 0110
1
0001
10da
011a
10da
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff None
ffff None
ffff Z, N
None
1, 2
None
C, DC, Z, OV, N
1, 2
C, Z, N
Z, N
C, Z, N
Z, N
1, 2
None
C, DC, Z, OV, N
4
1, 2
When a Port register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1, 0), the value used will be that
value present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is
driven low by an external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and, where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if
assigned.
If Program Counter (PC) is modified or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second
cycle is executed as a NOP.
Some instructions are two-word instructions. The second word of these instructions will be executed as a NOP,
unless the first word of the instruction retrieves the information embedded in these 16-bits. This ensures that all
program memory locations have a valid instruction.
Table write instructions are unavailable in 64-pin devices in normal operating modes. See Section 6.4 “Writing to
Program Memory Space (PIC18F8310/8410 only)” and Section 6.6 “Writing and Erasing On-Chip Program
Memory (ICSP Mode)” for more information.
DS39635A-page 290
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 24-2:
PIC18FXXX INSTRUCTION SET (CONTINUED)
16-Bit Instruction Word
Mnemonic,
Operands
Description
Cycles
MSb
LSb
Status
Affected
Notes
BIT-ORIENTED OPERATIONS
BCF
BSF
BTFSC
BTFSS
BTG
f, b, a
f, b, a
f, b, a
f, b, a
f, d, a
Bit Clear f
Bit Set f
Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
Bit Test f, Skip if Set
Bit Toggle f
1
1
1 (2 or 3)
1 (2 or 3)
1
1001
1000
1011
1010
0111
bbba
bbba
bbba
bbba
bbba
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
None
None
None
None
None
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
2
1 (2)
2
0010
0110
0011
0111
0101
0001
0100
0nnn
0000
110s
kkkk
0000
0000
1111
kkkk
0000
xxxx
0000
0000
1nnn
0000
0000
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
kkkk
kkkk
0000
0000
kkkk
kkkk
0000
xxxx
0000
0000
nnnn
1111
0001
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
kkkk
kkkk
0100
0111
kkkk
kkkk
0000
xxxx
0110
0101
nnnn
1111
000s
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
1110
1110
1110
1110
1110
1110
1110
1101
1110
1110
1111
0000
0000
1110
1111
0000
1111
0000
0000
1101
0000
0000
2
2
1
0000
0000
0000
1100
0000
0000
kkkk
0001
0000
1, 2
1, 2
3, 4
3, 4
1, 2
CONTROL OPERATIONS
BC
BN
BNC
BNN
BNOV
BNZ
BOV
BRA
BZ
CALL
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
n, s
CLRWDT
DAW
GOTO
—
—
n
NOP
NOP
POP
PUSH
RCALL
RESET
RETFIE
—
—
—
—
n
s
Branch if Carry
Branch if Negative
Branch if Not Carry
Branch if Not Negative
Branch if Not Overflow
Branch if Not Zero
Branch if Overflow
Branch Unconditionally
Branch if Zero
Call subroutine 1st word
2nd word
Clear Watchdog Timer
Decimal Adjust WREG
Go to address 1st word
2nd word
No Operation
No Operation
Pop top of return stack (TOS)
Push top of return stack (TOS)
Relative Call
Software device Reset
Return from interrupt enable
RETLW
RETURN
SLEEP
k
s
—
Return with literal in WREG
Return from Subroutine
Go into Standby mode
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
1
1
2
TO, PD
C
None
None
None
None
None
None
All
GIE/GIEH,
PEIE/GIEL
kkkk None
001s None
0011 TO, PD
4
When a Port register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1, 0), the value used will be that
value present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is
driven low by an external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and, where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if
assigned.
If Program Counter (PC) is modified or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second
cycle is executed as a NOP.
Some instructions are two-word instructions. The second word of these instructions will be executed as a NOP,
unless the first word of the instruction retrieves the information embedded in these 16-bits. This ensures that all
program memory locations have a valid instruction.
Table write instructions are unavailable in 64-pin devices in normal operating modes. See Section 6.4 “Writing to
Program Memory Space (PIC18F8310/8410 only)” and Section 6.6 “Writing and Erasing On-Chip Program
Memory (ICSP Mode)” for more information.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 291
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 24-2:
PIC18FXXX INSTRUCTION SET (CONTINUED)
16-Bit Instruction Word
Mnemonic,
Operands
Description
Cycles
MSb
LSb
Status
Affected
Notes
LITERAL OPERATIONS
ADDLW
ANDLW
IORLW
LFSR
k
k
k
f, k
MOVLB
MOVLW
MULLW
RETLW
SUBLW
XORLW
k
k
k
k
k
k
Add literal and WREG
AND literal with WREG
Inclusive OR literal with WREG
Move literal (12-bit) 2nd word
to FSR(f)
1st word
Move literal to BSR<3:0>
Move literal to WREG
Multiply literal with WREG
Return with literal in WREG
Subtract WREG from literal
Exclusive OR literal with WREG
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
0000
0000
0000
1110
1111
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
1111
1011
1001
1110
0000
0001
1110
1101
1100
1000
1010
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
00ff
kkkk
0000
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
C, DC, Z, OV, N
Z, N
Z, N
None
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
0000
1000
1001
1010
1011
1100
1101
1110
1111
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
C, DC, Z, OV, N
Z, N
DATA MEMORY ↔ PROGRAM MEMORY OPERATIONS
TBLRD*
TBLRD*+
TBLRD*TBLRD+*
TBLWT*
TBLWT*+
TBLWT*TBLWT+*
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
Note:
Table Read
2
Table Read with post-increment
Table Read with post-decrement
Table Read with pre-increment
Table Write
2
Table Write with post-increment
Table Write with post-decrement
Table Write with pre-increment
5
5
5
5
When a Port register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1, 0), the value used will be that
value present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is
driven low by an external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and, where applicable, d = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if
assigned.
If Program Counter (PC) is modified or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second
cycle is executed as a NOP.
Some instructions are two-word instructions. The second word of these instructions will be executed as a NOP,
unless the first word of the instruction retrieves the information embedded in these 16-bits. This ensures that all
program memory locations have a valid instruction.
Table write instructions are unavailable in 64-pin devices in normal operating modes. See Section 6.4 “Writing to
Program Memory Space (PIC18F8310/8410 only)” and Section 6.6 “Writing and Erasing On-Chip Program
Memory (ICSP Mode)” for more information.
All PIC18 instructions may take an optional label argument, preceding the instruction mnemonic, for use in
symbolic addressing. If a label is used, the instruction format then becomes:
{label} instruction argument(s)
DS39635A-page 292
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
24.1.1
STANDARD INSTRUCTION SET
ADDLW
ADD literal to W
ADDWF
ADD W to f
Syntax:
ADDLW
Syntax:
ADDWF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) + (f) → dest
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
k
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
(W) + k → W
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Encoding:
0000
1111
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of W are added to the
8-bit literal ‘k’ and the result is placed in
W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
0010
f {,d {,a}}
01da
ffff
ffff
Description:
Add W to register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’
(default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Before Instruction
Words:
1
W
= 10h
After Instruction
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
ADDLW
W
=
15h
25h
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
ADDWF
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
W
=
REG
=
After Instruction
W
REG
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
=
=
17h
0C2h
0D9h
0C2h
DS39635A-page 293
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
ADDWFC
ADD W and Carry bit to f
ANDLW
AND literal with W
Syntax:
ADDWFC
Syntax:
ANDLW
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
f {,d {,a}}
(W) + (f) + (C) → dest
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
0010
Description:
00da
ffff
ffff
Add W, the Carry flag and data memory
location ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed in data memory location ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
(W) .AND. k → W
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
N,OV, C, DC, Z
k
0000
1011
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of W are ANDed with the
8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
ANDLW
05Fh
Before Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
W
=
A3h
03h
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
ADDWFC
Before Instruction
Carry bit =
REG
=
W
=
After Instruction
Carry bit =
REG
=
W
=
DS39635A-page 294
REG, 0, 1
1
02h
4Dh
0
02h
50h
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
ANDWF
AND W with f
BC
Branch if Carry
Syntax:
ANDWF
Syntax:
BC
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operation:
if carry bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
None
f {,d {,a}}
Operation:
(W) .AND. (f) → dest
Status Affected:
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
Encoding:
0001
Description:
01da
ffff
ffff
The contents of W are AND’ed with
register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1110
Description:
0010
nnnn
nnnn
If the Carry bit is ‘1’, then the program
will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
1
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
n
ANDWF
If No Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
W
=
REG
=
After Instruction
W
REG
=
=
17h
C2h
Example:
02h
C2h
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Carry
PC
If Carry
PC
Preliminary
BC
5
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
1;
address (HERE + 12)
0;
address (HERE + 2)
DS39635A-page 295
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
BCF
Bit Clear f
BN
Branch if Negative
Syntax:
BCF
Syntax:
BN
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0≤b≤7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operation:
if Negative bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
None
f, b {,a}
Operation:
0 → f<b>
Status Affected:
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
Encoding:
1001
Description:
bbba
ffff
ffff
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is cleared.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
1110
Description:
nnnn
nnnn
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
BCF
FLAG_REG,
7, 0
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If No Jump:
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG = C7h
After Instruction
FLAG_REG = 47h
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Example:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Negative
PC
If Negative
PC
DS39635A-page 296
0110
If the Negative bit is ‘1’, then the
program will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
n
Preliminary
BN
Jump
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
1;
address (Jump)
0;
address (HERE + 2)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
BNC
Branch if Not Carry
BNN
Branch if Not Negative
Syntax:
BNC
Syntax:
BNN
n
n
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operation:
if Carry bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Operation:
if Negative bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
0011
nnnn
nnnn
Encoding:
1110
0111
nnnn
nnnn
Description:
If the Carry bit is ‘0’, then the program
will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Description:
If the Negative bit is ‘0’, then the
program will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
If No Jump:
Example:
If No Jump:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Carry
PC
If Carry
PC
BNC
Jump
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
0;
address (Jump)
1;
address (HERE + 2)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Example:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Negative
PC
If Negative
PC
Preliminary
BNN
Jump
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
0;
address (Jump)
1;
address (HERE + 2)
DS39635A-page 297
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
BNOV
Branch if Not Overflow
BNZ
Branch if Not Zero
Syntax:
BNOV
Syntax:
BNZ
n
n
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operation:
if Overflow bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Operation:
if Zero bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
0101
nnnn
nnnn
Encoding:
1110
0001
nnnn
nnnn
Description:
If the Overflow bit is ‘0’, then the
program will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Description:
If the Zero bit is ‘0’, then the program
will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to PC
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
If No Jump:
If No Jump:
Example:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Overflow
PC
If Overflow
PC
DS39635A-page 298
BNOV Jump
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
0;
address (Jump)
1;
address (HERE + 2)
Example:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Zero
PC
If Zero
PC
Preliminary
BNZ
Jump
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
0;
address (Jump)
1;
address (HERE + 2)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
BRA
Unconditional Branch
BSF
Bit Set f
Syntax:
BRA
Syntax:
BSF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0≤b≤7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
1 → f<b>
Status Affected:
None
n
Operands:
-1024 ≤ n ≤ 1023
Operation:
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1101
Description:
0nnn
nnnn
nnnn
Add the 2’s complement number ‘2n’ to
the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Encoding:
1000
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
PC
BRA
address (HERE)
=
address (Jump)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
ffff
ffff
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is set.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Jump
=
bbba
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f, b {,a}
Example:
BSF
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG
After Instruction
FLAG_REG
Preliminary
FLAG_REG, 7, 1
=
0Ah
=
8Ah
DS39635A-page 299
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
BTFSC
Bit Test File, Skip if Clear
BTFSS
Bit Test File, Skip if Set
Syntax:
BTFSC f, b {,a}
Syntax:
BTFSS f, b {,a}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0≤b≤7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0≤b<7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 0
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 1
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1011
Description:
bbba
ffff
ffff
Encoding:
1010
bbba
ffff
ffff
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, then the next
instruction is skipped. If bit ‘b’ is ‘0’, then
the next instruction fetched during the
current instruction execution is discarded
and a NOP is executed instead, making
this a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected. If
‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction set
is enabled, this instruction operates in
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Description:
Words:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘1’, then the next
instruction is skipped. If bit ‘b’ is ‘1’, then
the next instruction fetched during the
current instruction execution is discarded
and a NOP is executed instead, making
this a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected. If
‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates in
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip:
If skip:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
FALSE
TRUE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If FLAG<1>
PC
If FLAG<1>
PC
DS39635A-page 300
BTFSC
:
:
FLAG, 1, 0
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
0;
address (TRUE)
1;
address (FALSE)
Example:
HERE
FALSE
TRUE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If FLAG<1>
PC
If FLAG<1>
PC
Preliminary
BTFSS
:
:
FLAG, 1, 0
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
0;
address (FALSE)
1;
address (TRUE)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
BTG
Bit Toggle f
BOV
Branch if Overflow
Syntax:
BTG f, b {,a}
Syntax:
BOV
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0≤b<7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operation:
if Overflow bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Status Affected:
None
Operation:
(f<b>) → f<b>
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0111
Description:
Encoding:
bbba
ffff
ffff
Bit ‘b’ in data memory location ‘f’ is
inverted.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
n
1110
0100
nnnn
nnnn
Description:
If the Overflow bit is ‘1’, then the
program will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If No Jump:
Example:
BTG
PORTC,
4, 0
Before Instruction:
PORTC =
0111 0101 [75h]
After Instruction:
PORTC =
0110 0101 [65h]
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Example:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Overflow
PC
If Overflow
PC
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
BOV
Jump
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
1;
address (Jump)
0;
address (HERE + 2)
DS39635A-page 301
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
BZ
Branch if Zero
CALL
Subroutine Call
Syntax:
BZ
Syntax:
CALL k {,s}
n
Operands:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operands:
Operation:
if Zero bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
0 ≤ k ≤ 1048575
s ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
Status Affected:
None
(PC) + 4 → TOS,
k → PC<20:1>,
if s = 1
(W) → WS,
(Status) → STATUSS,
(BSR) → BSRS
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
Description:
0000
nnnn
nnnn
If the Zero bit is ‘1’, then the program
will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Encoding:
1st word (k<7:0>)
2nd word(k<19:8>)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If No Jump:
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If Zero
PC
If Zero
PC
DS39635A-page 302
BZ
Subroutine call of entire 2-Mbyte
memory range. First, return address
(PC + 4) is pushed onto the return
stack. If ‘s’ = 1, the W, Status and BSR
registers are also pushed into their
respective shadow registers, WS,
STATUSS and BSRS. If ‘s’ = 0, no
update occurs (default). Then, the
20-bit value ‘k’ is loaded into PC<20:1>.
CALL is a two-cycle instruction.
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘k’<7:0>,
Push PC to
stack
Read literal
’k’<19:8>,
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Jump
=
address (HERE)
=
=
=
=
1;
address (Jump)
0;
address (HERE + 2)
kkkk0
kkkk8
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Example:
k7kkk
kkkk
110s
k19kkk
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Decode
1110
1111
Example:
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
=
After Instruction
PC
=
TOS
=
WS
=
BSRS
=
STATUSS=
Preliminary
CALL
THERE,1
address (HERE)
address (THERE)
address (HERE + 4)
W
BSR
Status
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
CLRF
Clear f
Syntax:
CLRF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
f {,a}
Operation:
000h → f
1→Z
Status Affected:
Z
Encoding:
0110
Description:
101a
ffff
ffff
Clears the contents of the specified
register.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
CLRWDT
Clear Watchdog Timer
Syntax:
CLRWDT
Operands:
None
Operation:
000h → WDT,
000h → WDT postscaler,
1 → TO,
1 → PD
Status Affected:
TO, PD
Encoding:
0000
Description:
0000
0000
0100
CLRWDT instruction resets the
Watchdog Timer. It also resets the
postscaler of the WDT. Status bits, TO
and PD, are set.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
Process
Data
No
operation
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
CLRF
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG
After Instruction
FLAG_REG
FLAG_REG,1
=
5Ah
=
00h
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
CLRWDT
Before Instruction
WDT Counter
After Instruction
WDT Counter
WDT Postscaler
TO
PD
Preliminary
=
?
=
=
=
=
00h
0
1
1
DS39635A-page 303
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
COMF
Complement f
CPFSEQ
Compare f with W, skip if f = W
Syntax:
COMF
Syntax:
CPFSEQ
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W),
skip if (f) = (W)
(unsigned comparison)
Status Affected:
None
f {,d {,a}}
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
( f ) → dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
0001
11da
ffff
ffff
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
complemented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Encoding:
0110
f {,a}
001a
ffff
ffff
Description:
Compares the contents of data memory
location ‘f’ to the contents of W by
performing an unsigned subtraction.
If ‘f’ = W, then the fetched instruction is
discarded and a NOP is executed
instead, making this a two-cycle
instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
COMF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
REG, 0, 0
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
13h
If skip:
13h
ECh
Q1
Q2
Q3
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
Example:
DS39635A-page 304
Preliminary
HERE
NEQUAL
EQUAL
Q4
No
operation
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
CPFSEQ REG, 0
:
:
Before Instruction
PC Address
W
REG
After Instruction
=
=
=
HERE
?
?
If REG
PC
If REG
PC
=
=
≠
=
W;
Address (EQUAL)
W;
Address (NEQUAL)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
CPFSGT
Compare f with W, skip if f > W
CPFSLT
Compare f with W, skip if f < W
Syntax:
CPFSGT
Syntax:
CPFSLT
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
(f) − (W),
skip if (f) > (W)
(unsigned comparison)
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W),
skip if (f) < (W)
(unsigned comparison)
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0110
Description:
f {,a}
010a
ffff
ffff
Compares the contents of data memory
location ‘f’ to the contents of the W by
performing an unsigned subtraction.
If the contents of ‘f’ are greater than the
contents of WREG, then the fetched
instruction is discarded and a NOP is
executed instead, making this a
two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q2
Read
register ‘f’
Q3
Process
Data
Q4
No
operation
Q1
Q2
Q3
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
Q4
No
operation
HERE
NGREATER
GREATER
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
=
=
Address (HERE)
?
If REG
PC
If REG
PC
>
=
≤
=
W;
Address (GREATER)
W;
Address (NGREATER)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
ffff
ffff
Compares the contents of data memory
location ‘f’ to the contents of W by
performing an unsigned subtraction.
If the contents of ‘f’ are less than the
contents of W, then the fetched
instruction is discarded and a NOP is
executed instead, making this a
two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
CPFSGT REG, 0
:
:
Before Instruction
PC
W
After Instruction
000a
Description:
If skip:
Example:
0110
Q Cycle Activity:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Encoding:
f {,a}
Preliminary
HERE
NLESS
LESS
CPFSLT REG, 1
:
:
Before Instruction
PC
W
After Instruction
=
=
Address (HERE)
?
If REG
PC
If REG
PC
<
=
≥
=
W;
Address (LESS)
W;
Address (NLESS)
DS39635A-page 305
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
DAW
Decimal Adjust W Register
DECF
Decrement f
Syntax:
DAW
Syntax:
DECF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
None
Operands:
Operation:
If [W<3:0> >9] or [DC = 1] then
(W<3:0>) + 6 → W<3:0>;
else
(W<3:0>) → W<3:0>;
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – 1 → dest
Status Affected:
C, DC, N, OV, Z
Encoding:
If [W<7:4> > 9] or [C = 1] then
(W<7:4>) + 6 → W<7:4>
C = 1;
else
(W<7:4>) → W<7:4>;
Status Affected:
0000
0000
0000
0000
ffff
ffff
Description:
Decrement register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’
(default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
C
Encoding:
01da
0111
Description:
DAW adjusts the eight-bit value in W,
resulting from the earlier addition of two
variables (each in packed BCD format)
and produces a correct packed BCD
result.
Words:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register W
Process
Data
Write
W
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example 1:
DAW
Example:
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
DC
=
After Instruction
W
C
DC
Example 2:
=
=
=
DECF
Before Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
A5h
0
0
05h
1
0
CNT,
1, 0
01h
0
00h
1
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
DC
=
After Instruction
W
C
DC
=
=
=
DS39635A-page 306
CEh
0
0
34h
1
0
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
DECFSZ
Decrement f, skip if 0
DCFSNZ
Decrement f, skip if not 0
Syntax:
DECFSZ f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
DCFSNZ
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – 1 → dest,
skip if result = 0
Operation:
(f) – 1 → dest,
skip if result ≠ 0
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0010
11da
ffff
ffff
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If the result is ‘0’, the next instruction,
which is already fetched, is discarded
and a NOP is executed instead, making
it a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Encoding:
0100
Description:
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
1
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
DECFSZ
GOTO
CNT, 1, 1
LOOP
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
CONTINUE
HERE
ZERO
NZERO
Before Instruction
TEMP
After Instruction
TEMP
If TEMP
PC
If TEMP
PC
Address (HERE)
CNT – 1
0;
Address (CONTINUE)
0;
Address (HERE + 2)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
ffff
Cycles:
If skip:
Before Instruction
PC
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
If CNT
=
PC =
If CNT
≠
PC =
ffff
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
HERE
11da
The contents of register ‘f’ are
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If the result is not ‘0’, the next
instruction, which is already fetched, is
discarded and a NOP is executed
instead, making it a two-cycle
instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is 1, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
f {,d {,a}}
Preliminary
DCFSNZ
:
:
TEMP, 1, 0
=
?
=
=
=
≠
=
TEMP – 1,
0;
Address (ZERO)
0;
Address (NZERO)
DS39635A-page 307
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
GOTO
Unconditional Branch
INCF
Increment f
Syntax:
GOTO k
Syntax:
INCF
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 1048575
Operands:
Operation:
k → PC<20:1>
Status Affected:
None
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) + 1 → dest
Status Affected:
C, DC, N, OV, Z
Encoding:
1st word (k<7:0>)
2nd word(k<19:8>)
1110
1111
Description:
1111
k19kkk
k7kkk
kkkk
kkkk0
kkkk8
GOTO allows an unconditional branch
Encoding:
0010
2
Cycles:
2
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read literal
‘k’<7:0>,
No
operation
Read literal
’k’<19:8>,
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
No
operation
No
operation
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
INCF
Before Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
C
=
DC
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
Z
=
C
=
DC
=
DS39635A-page 308
ffff
Words:
GOTO THERE
After Instruction
PC =
Address (THERE)
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
10da
Description:
anywhere within entire
2-Mbyte memory range. The 20-bit
value ‘k’ is loaded into PC<20:1>.
GOTO is always a two-cycle
instruction.
Words:
f {,d {,a}}
Preliminary
CNT, 1, 0
FFh
0
?
?
00h
1
1
1
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
INCFSZ
Increment f, skip if 0
INFSNZ
Syntax:
INCFSZ
Syntax:
INFSNZ
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
f {,d {,a}}
Increment f, skip if not 0
f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
(f) + 1 → dest,
skip if result = 0
Operation:
(f) + 1 → dest,
skip if result ≠ 0
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0011
11da
ffff
ffff
Encoding:
0100
Description:
10da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If the result is not ‘0’, the next
instruction, which is already fetched, is
discarded and a NOP is executed
instead, making it a two-cycle
instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’. (default)
If the result is ‘0’, the next instruction,
which is already fetched, is discarded
and a NOP is executed instead, making
it a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip:
If skip:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
NZERO
ZERO
Before Instruction
PC
=
After Instruction
CNT
=
If CNT
=
PC
=
If CNT
≠
PC
=
INCFSZ
:
:
CNT, 1, 0
Example:
Before Instruction
PC
=
After Instruction
REG
=
≠
If REG
PC
=
If REG
=
PC
=
Address (HERE)
CNT + 1
0;
Address (ZERO)
0;
Address (NZERO)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
HERE
ZERO
NZERO
Preliminary
INFSNZ
REG, 1, 0
Address (HERE)
REG + 1
0;
Address (NZERO)
0;
Address (ZERO)
DS39635A-page 309
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
IORLW
Inclusive OR literal with W
IORWF
Inclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
IORLW k
Syntax:
IORWF
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
Operation:
(W) .OR. k → W
Status Affected:
N, Z
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) .OR. (f) → dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
0000
1001
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of W are ORed with the
eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in
W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
0001
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
IORLW
W
=
9Ah
BFh
ffff
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
35h
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
IORWF
Before Instruction
RESULT =
W
=
After Instruction
RESULT =
W
=
DS39635A-page 310
ffff
Inclusive OR W with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’,
the result is placed back in register ‘f’
(default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Before Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
00da
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,d {,a}}
Preliminary
RESULT, 0, 1
13h
91h
13h
93h
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
LFSR
Load FSR
MOVF
Move f
Syntax:
LFSR f, k
Syntax:
MOVF
Operands:
0≤f≤2
0 ≤ k ≤ 4095
Operands:
Operation:
k → FSRf
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Status Affected:
None
Operation:
f → dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
1110
1111
1110
0000
00ff
k7kkk
k11kkk
kkkk
Description:
The 12-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into the
file select register pointed to by ‘f’.
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
Encoding:
0101
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read literal
‘k’ MSB
Process
Data
Write
literal ‘k’
MSB to
FSRfH
Decode
Read literal
‘k’ LSB
Process
Data
Write literal
‘k’ to FSRfL
Example:
After Instruction
FSR2H
FSR2L
LFSR 2, 3ABh
=
=
03h
ABh
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are moved to
a destination dependent upon the
status of ‘d’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
Location ‘f’ can be anywhere in the
256-byte bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write W
Example:
MOVF
Before Instruction
REG
W
After Instruction
REG
W
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
00da
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,d {,a}}
Preliminary
REG, 0, 0
=
=
22h
FFh
=
=
22h
22h
DS39635A-page 311
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
MOVFF
Move f to f
MOVLB
Move literal to low nibble in BSR
Syntax:
MOVFF fs,fd
Syntax:
MOVLW k
Operands:
0 ≤ fs ≤ 4095
0 ≤ fd ≤ 4095
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
k → BSR
None
Operation:
(fs) → fd
Status Affected:
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (destin.)
1100
1111
Description:
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffffs
ffffd
The contents of source register ‘fs’ are
moved to destination register ‘fd’.
Location of source ‘fs’ can be anywhere
in the 4096-byte data space (000h to
FFFh) and location of destination ‘fd’
can also be anywhere from 000h to
FFFh.
Either source or destination can be W
(a useful special situation).
MOVFF is particularly useful for
transferring a data memory location to a
peripheral register (such as the transmit
buffer or an I/O port).
The MOVFF instruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register
Words:
2
Cycles:
2 (3)
0000
0001
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The eight-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into the
Bank Select Register (BSR). The value
of BSR<7:4> always remains ‘0’,
regardless of the value of k7:k4.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write literal
‘k’ to BSR
MOVLB
5
Example:
Before Instruction
BSR Register =
After Instruction
BSR Register =
02h
05h
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
(src)
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
Write
register ‘f’
(dest)
No dummy
read
Example:
MOVFF
Before Instruction
REG1
REG2
After Instruction
REG1
REG2
DS39635A-page 312
REG1, REG2
=
=
33h
11h
=
=
33h
33h
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
MOVLW
Move literal to W
MOVWF
Move W to f
Syntax:
MOVLW k
Syntax:
MOVWF
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
Operation:
k→W
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
Description:
1110
kkkk
kkkk
The eight-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Operation:
(W) → f
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0110
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
MOVLW
=
5Ah
ffff
ffff
Move data from W to register ‘f’.
Location ‘f’ can be anywhere in the
256-byte bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
5Ah
After Instruction
W
111a
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,a}
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
MOVWF
REG, 0
Before Instruction
W
=
REG
=
After Instruction
W
REG
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
=
=
4Fh
FFh
4Fh
4Fh
DS39635A-page 313
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
MULLW
Multiply literal with W
MULWF
Multiply W with f
Syntax:
MULLW
Syntax:
MULWF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) x (f) → PRODH:PRODL
Status Affected:
None
k
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
(W) x k → PRODH:PRODL
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
Description:
1101
kkkk
kkkk
An unsigned multiplication is carried
out between the contents of W and the
8-bit literal ‘k’. The 16-bit result is
placed in PRODH:PRODL register
pair. PRODH contains the high byte.
W is unchanged.
None of the Status flags are affected.
Note that neither Overflow nor Carry is
possible in this operation. A Zero result
is possible but not detected.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
0000
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write
registers
PRODH:
PRODL
Example:
MULLW
0C4h
Before Instruction
W
PRODH
PRODL
After Instruction
W
PRODH
PRODL
=
=
=
E2h
?
?
=
=
=
E2h
ADh
08h
001a
ffff
ffff
Description:
An unsigned multiplication is carried
out between the contents of W and the
register file location ‘f’. The 16-bit
result is stored in the PRODH:PRODL
register pair. PRODH contains the
high byte. Both W and ‘f’ are
unchanged.
None of the Status flags are affected.
Note that neither Overflow nor Carry is
possible in this operation. A Zero
result is possible but not detected.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is
selected. If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used
to select the GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction
operates in Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode whenever f ≤ 95
(5Fh). See Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,a}
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
registers
PRODH:
PRODL
Example:
MULWF
REG, 1
Before Instruction
W
REG
PRODH
PRODL
After Instruction
W
REG
PRODH
PRODL
DS39635A-page 314
Preliminary
=
=
=
=
C4h
B5h
?
?
=
=
=
=
C4h
B5h
8Ah
94h
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NEGF
Negate f
NOP
No Operation
Syntax:
NEGF
Syntax:
NOP
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
f {,a}
Operands:
None
Operation:
No operation
None
Operation:
(f)+1→f
Status Affected:
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Encoding:
Encoding:
0110
Description:
110a
ffff
Location ‘f’ is negated using two’s
complement. The result is placed in the
data memory location ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
0000
1111
ffff
0000
xxxx
Description:
No operation.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
0000
xxxx
0000
xxxx
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
None.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
NEGF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
REG, 1
0011 1010 [3Ah]
1100 0110 [C6h]
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 315
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
POP
Pop Top of Return Stack
PUSH
Push Top of Return Stack
Syntax:
POP
Syntax:
PUSH
Operands:
None
Operands:
None
Operation:
(TOS) → bit bucket
Operation:
(PC + 2) → TOS
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
0000
0000
0110
Description:
The TOS value is pulled off the return
stack and is discarded. The TOS value
then becomes the previous value that
was pushed onto the return stack.
This instruction is provided to enable
the user to properly manage the return
stack to incorporate a software stack.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Encoding:
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
POP TOS
value
No
operation
POP
GOTO
NEW
Before Instruction
TOS
Stack (1 level down)
DS39635A-page 316
0000
0101
The PC + 2 is pushed onto the top of
the return stack. The previous TOS
value is pushed down on the stack.
This instruction allows implementing a
software stack by modifying TOS and
then pushing it onto the return stack.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
After Instruction
TOS
PC
0000
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
0000
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
PUSH
PC + 2 onto
return stack
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
=
=
=
=
0031A2h
014332h
014332h
NEW
Preliminary
PUSH
Before Instruction
TOS
PC
=
=
345Ah
0124h
After Instruction
PC
TOS
Stack (1 level down)
=
=
=
0126h
0126h
345Ah
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
RCALL
Relative Call
RESET
Reset
Syntax:
RCALL
Syntax:
RESET
n
Operands:
-1024 ≤ n ≤ 1023
Operands:
None
Operation:
(PC) + 2 → TOS,
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Operation:
Reset all registers and flags that are
affected by a MCLR Reset.
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
All
Encoding:
1101
Description:
1nnn
nnnn
nnnn
Subroutine call with a jump up to 1K
from the current location. First, return
address (PC + 2) is pushed onto the
stack. Then, add the 2’s complement
number ‘2n’ to the PC. Since the PC will
have incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Encoding:
0000
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to PC
No
operation
No
operation
1111
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Start
Reset
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
Q2
1111
This instruction provides a way to
execute a MCLR Reset in software.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
0000
Description:
After Instruction
Registers =
Flags*
=
RESET
Reset Value
Reset Value
Push PC to
stack
No
operation
Example:
No
operation
HERE
RCALL Jump
Before Instruction
PC =
Address (HERE)
After Instruction
PC =
Address (Jump)
TOS =
Address (HERE + 2)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 317
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
RETFIE
Return from Interrupt
RETLW
Return literal to W
Syntax:
RETFIE {s}
Syntax:
RETLW k
Operands:
s ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
(TOS) → PC,
1 → GIE/GIEH or PEIE/GIEL,
if s = 1
(WS) → W,
(STATUSS) → Status,
(BSRS) → BSR,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged.
Operation:
k → W,
(TOS) → PC,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
0000
Description:
0000
0001
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
kkkk
kkkk
W is loaded with the eight-bit literal ‘k’.
The program counter is loaded from the
top of the stack (the return address).
The high address latch (PCLATH)
remains unchanged.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
000s
Return from interrupt. Stack is popped
and Top-of-Stack (TOS) is loaded into
the PC. Interrupts are enabled by
setting either the high or low priority
global interrupt enable bit. If ‘s’ = 1, the
contents of the shadow registers, WS,
STATUSS and BSRS, are loaded into
their corresponding registers, W,
Status and BSR. If ‘s’ = 0, no update of
these registers occurs (default).
1100
Description:
GIE/GIEH, PEIE/GIEL.
Encoding:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Pop PC from
stack, Write
to W
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
Pop PC from
stack
Set GIEH or
GIEL
No
operation
0000
No
operation
Example:
RETFIE
After Interrupt
PC
W
BSR
Status
GIE/GIEH, PEIE/GIEL
No
operation
No
operation
1
=
=
=
=
=
TOS
WS
BSRS
STATUSS
1
CALL TABLE ;
;
;
;
:
TABLE
ADDWF PCL ;
RETLW k0
;
RETLW k1
;
:
:
RETLW kn
;
W = offset
Begin table
End of table
Before Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
W
DS39635A-page 318
W contains table
offset value
W now has
table value
Preliminary
=
07h
value of kn
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
RLCF
Rotate Left f through Carry
Syntax:
RETURN {s}
Syntax:
RLCF
Operands:
s ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
(TOS) → PC,
if s = 1
(WS) → W,
(STATUSS) → Status,
(BSRS) → BSR,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f<n>) → dest<n + 1>,
(f<7>) → C,
(C) → dest<0>
Status Affected:
C, N, Z
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
Encoding:
0000
0001
001s
Description:
Return from subroutine. The stack is
popped and the top of the stack (TOS)
is loaded into the program counter. If
‘s’= 1, the contents of the shadow
registers, WS, STATUSS and BSRS,
are loaded into their corresponding
registers, W, Status and BSR. If ‘s’ = 0,
no update of these registers occurs
(default).
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
0011
Description:
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
Process
Data
Pop PC from
stack
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
Before Instruction
REG
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
ffff
Q Cycle Activity:
RETURN
After Instruction:
PC = TOS
ffff
register f
C
Q1
Example:
01da
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the left through the Carry
flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in
W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is
selected. If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to
select the GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction
operates in Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode whenever f ≤ 95
(5Fh). See Section 24.2.3 for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
No
operation
f {,d {,a}}
Preliminary
RLCF
REG, 0, 0
1110 0110
0
1110 0110
1100 1100
1
DS39635A-page 319
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
RLNCF
Rotate Left f (no carry)
RRCF
Rotate Right f through Carry
Syntax:
RLNCF
Syntax:
RRCF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f<n>) → dest<n + 1>,
(f<7>) → dest<0>
Operation:
Status Affected:
N, Z
(f<n>) → dest<n-1>,
(f<0>) → C,
(C) → dest<7>
Status Affected:
C, N, Z
Encoding:
0100
Description:
f {,d {,a}}
01da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the left. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Encoding:
0011
Description:
register f
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
DS39635A-page 320
00da
RLNCF
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
ffff
register f
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
REG, 1, 0
1010 1011
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the right through the Carry
flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in W.
If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
C
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
f {,d {,a}}
Example:
RRCF
Before Instruction
REG
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
0101 0111
Preliminary
REG, 0, 0
1110 0110
0
1110 0110
0111 0011
0
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
RRNCF
Rotate Right f (no carry)
SETF
Syntax:
RRNCF
Syntax:
SETF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f<n>) → dest<n – 1>,
(f<0>) → dest<7>
FFh → f
Operation:
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
f {,d {,a}}
Encoding:
N, Z
Encoding:
0100
Description:
00da
ffff
ffff
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the right. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank will be
selected, overriding the BSR value. If ‘a’
is ‘1’, then the bank will be selected as
per the BSR value (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
1
Cycles:
1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example 1:
RRNCF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
Example 2:
100a
ffff
ffff
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
Q1
0110
The contents of the specified register
are set to FFh.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,a}
Description:
register f
Words:
Set f
SETF
Before Instruction
REG
After Instruction
REG
REG,1
=
5Ah
=
FFh
REG, 1, 0
1101 0111
1110 1011
RRNCF
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
W
=
REG
=
After Instruction
W
REG
=
=
?
1101 0111
1110 1011
1101 0111
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 321
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
SLEEP
Enter Sleep mode
SUBFWB
Subtract f from W with borrow
Syntax:
SLEEP
Syntax:
SUBFWB
Operands:
None
Operands:
Operation:
00h → WDT,
0 → WDT postscaler,
1 → TO,
0 → PD
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) – (f) – (C) → dest
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
TO, PD
Encoding:
0000
Encoding:
0000
0000
0011
Description:
The Power-Down status bit (PD) is
cleared. The Time-out status bit (TO)
is set. Watchdog Timer and its
postscaler are cleared.
The processor is put into Sleep mode
with the oscillator stopped.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
0101
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
Process
Data
Go to
sleep
Example:
SLEEP
† If WDT causes wake-up, this bit is cleared.
DS39635A-page 322
ffff
ffff
Subtract register ‘f’ and Carry flag
(borrow) from W (2’s complement
method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored in
register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is
selected. If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used
to select the GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction
operates in Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode whenever f ≤ 95
(5Fh). See Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Before Instruction
TO =
?
?
PD =
After Instruction
1†
TO =
0
PD =
01da
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
f {,d {,a}}
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
SUBFWB
REG, 1, 0
Example 1:
Before Instruction
REG
=
3
W
=
2
C
=
1
After Instruction
REG
=
FF
W
=
2
C
=
0
Z
=
0
N
=
1 ; result is negative
SUBFWB
REG, 0, 0
Example 2:
Before Instruction
REG
=
2
W
=
5
C
=
1
After Instruction
REG
=
2
W
=
3
C
=
1
Z
=
0
N
=
0 ; result is positive
SUBFWB
REG, 1, 0
Example 3:
Before Instruction
REG
=
1
W
=
2
C
=
0
After Instruction
REG
=
0
W
=
2
C
=
1
Z
=
1 ; result is zero
N
=
0
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
SUBLW
Subtract W from literal
SUBWF
Subtract W from f
Syntax:
SUBLW k
Syntax:
SUBWF
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
Operation:
k – (W) → W
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W) → dest
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Encoding:
0000
1000
kkkk
kkkk
f {,d {,a}}
Description:
W is subtracted from the eight-bit
literal ‘k’. The result is placed in W.
Encoding:
Words:
1
Description:
Cycles:
1
Subtract W from register ‘f’ (2’s
complement method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is V, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’
(default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is
selected. If ‘a’ is V, the BSR is used to
select the GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction
operates in Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode whenever f ≤ 95
(5Fh). See Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
0101
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example 1:
SUBLW
02h
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
W
C
Z
N
=
=
=
=
Example 2:
01h
?
01h
1
; result is positive
0
0
SUBLW
02h
W
C
Z
N
=
=
=
=
Example 3:
02h
?
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
SUBWF
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
02h
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
W
C
Z
N
=
=
=
=
03h
?
Example 2:
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
FFh ; (2’s complement)
0
; result is negative
0
1
Example 3:
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
ffff
Decode
Example 1:
00h
1
; result is zero
1
0
SUBLW
ffff
Q Cycle Activity:
Before Instruction
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
11da
Preliminary
3
2
?
1
2
1
0
0
; result is positive
SUBWF
REG, 0, 0
2
2
?
2
0
1
1
0
SUBWF
; result is zero
REG, 1, 0
1
2
?
FFh ;(2’s complement)
2
0
; result is negative
0
1
DS39635A-page 323
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
SUBWFB
Subtract W from f with Borrow
SWAPF
Swap f
Syntax:
SUBWFB
Syntax:
SWAPF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W) – (C) → dest
Operation:
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
(f<3:0>) → dest<7:4>,
(f<7:4>) → dest<3:0>
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0101
Description:
f {,d {,a}}
10da
ffff
ffff
Subtract W and the Carry flag (borrow)
from register ‘f’ (2’s complement
method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Q2
Read
register ‘f’
Example 1:
SUBWFB
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 2:
Q4
Write to
destination
(0001 1001)
(0000 1101)
0Ch
0Dh
1
0
0
(0000 1011)
(0000 1101)
10da
ffff
ffff
The upper and lower nibbles of register
‘f’ are exchanged. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
REG, 1, 0
19h
0Dh
1
0011
Description:
Example:
SWAPF
Before Instruction
REG
=
After Instruction
REG
=
REG, 1, 0
53h
35h
; result is positive
SUBWFB REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
Z
=
N
=
Example 3:
1Bh
1Ah
0
(0001 1011)
(0001 1010)
1Bh
00h
1
1
0
(0001 1011)
SUBWFB
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
C
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
C
Z
N
Q3
Process
Data
Encoding:
=
=
=
=
DS39635A-page 324
; result is zero
REG, 1, 0
03h
0Eh
1
(0000 0011)
(0000 1101)
F5h
(1111 0100)
; [2’s comp]
(0000 1101)
0Eh
0
0
1
; result is negative
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TBLRD
Table Read
TBLRD
Table Read (Continued)
Syntax:
TBLRD ( *; *+; *-; +*)
Example 1:
TBLRD
Operands:
None
Operation:
if TBLRD *,
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT;
TBLPTR – No Change;
if TBLRD *+,
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT;
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLRD *-,
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT;
(TBLPTR) – 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLRD +*,
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT;
Before Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
MEMORY(00A356h)
After Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
Example 2:
Status Affected: None
Encoding:
0000
0000
0000
TBLRD
Before Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
MEMORY(01A357h)
MEMORY(01A358h)
After Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
*+ ;
=
=
=
55h
00A356h
34h
=
=
34h
00A357h
+* ;
=
=
=
=
AAh
01A357h
12h
34h
=
=
34h
01A358h
10nn
nn=0 *
=1 *+
=2 *=3 +*
Description:
This instruction is used to read the contents
of Program Memory (P.M.). To address the
program memory, a pointer called Table
Pointer (TBLPTR) is used.
The TBLPTR (a 21-bit pointer) points to
each byte in the program memory. TBLPTR
has a 2-Mbyte address range.
TBLPTR[0] = 0: Least Significant Byte
of Program Memory
Word
TBLPTR[0] = 1: Most Significant Byte
of Program Memory
Word
The TBLRD instruction can modify the value
of TBLPTR as follows:
• no change
• post-increment
• post-decrement
• pre-increment
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No operation
(Read Program
Memory)
No
operation
No operation
(Write
TABLAT)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 325
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TBLWT
Table Write
TBLWT
Table Write (Continued)
Syntax:
TBLWT ( *; *+; *-; +*)
Example 1:
TBLWT
Operands:
None
Operation:
if TBLWT*,
(TABLAT) → Holding Register;
TBLPTR – No Change;
if TBLWT*+,
(TABLAT) → Holding Register;
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLWT*-,
(TABLAT) → Holding Register;
(TBLPTR) – 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLWT+*,
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
(TABLAT) → Holding Register;
Status Affected:
Description:
Example 2:
0000
0000
0000
11nn
nn=0 *
=1 *+
=2 *=3 +*
This instruction uses the 3 LSBs of
TBLPTR to determine which of the 8
holding registers the TABLAT is written to.
The holding registers are used to program
the contents of Program Memory (P.M.).
(Refer to Section 6.0 “Program Memory”
for additional details on programming Flash
memory.)
The TBLPTR (a 21-bit pointer) points to
each byte in the program memory.
TBLPTR has a 2-Mbyte address range.
The LSb of the TBLPTR selects which
byte of the program memory location to
access.
TBLPTR[0] = 0: Least Significant
Byte of Program
Memory Word
TBLPTR[0] = 1: Most Significant
Byte of Program
Memory Word
The TBLWT instruction can modify the
value of TBLPTR as follows:
• no change
• post-increment
• post-decrement
• pre-increment
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
TBLWT
+*;
Before Instruction
TABLAT
=
34h
TBLPTR
=
01389Ah
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Ah)
=
FFh
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Bh)
=
FFh
After Instruction (table write completion)
TABLAT
=
34h
TBLPTR
=
01389Bh
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Ah)
=
FFh
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Bh)
=
34h
None
Encoding:
*+;
Before Instruction
TABLAT
=
55h
TBLPTR
=
00A356h
HOLDING REGISTER
(00A356h)
=
FFh
After Instructions (table write completion)
TABLAT
=
55h
TBLPTR
=
00A357h
HOLDING REGISTER
(00A356h)
=
55h
Note:
The TBLWT instruction is not available in
PIC18F6310/6410 devices (i.e., 64-pin
devices) in normal operating modes.
TBLWT
can
only
be
used
by
PIC18F8310/8410 devices with the
external memory interface and only when
writing to an external memory device.
For more information, refer to Section 6.4
“Writing to Program Memory Space
(PIC18F8310/8410
only)”
and
Section 6.6 “Writing and Erasing
On-Chip Program Memory (ICSP
Mode)”.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
operation operation operation
No
No
No
No
operation operation operation operation
(Write to
(Read
Holding
TABLAT)
Register )
DS39635A-page 326
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TSTFSZ
Test f, skip if 0
XORLW
Syntax:
TSTFSZ f {,a}
Syntax:
XORLW k
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
(W) .XOR. k → W
Operation:
skip if f = 0
Status Affected:
N, Z
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
Encoding:
0110
Description:
Exclusive OR literal with W
011a
ffff
ffff
If ‘f’ = 0, the next instruction, fetched
during the current instruction execution,
is discarded and a NOP is executed,
making this a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
0000
1010
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of W are XORed with
the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed
in W.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
XORLW
0AFh
Before Instruction
W
=
After Instruction
W
=
B5h
1Ah
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
NZERO
ZERO
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
If CNT
PC
If CNT
PC
TSTFSZ
:
:
CNT, 1
=
Address (HERE)
=
=
≠
=
00h,
Address (ZERO)
00h,
Address (NZERO)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 327
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
XORWF
Exclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
XORWF
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) .XOR. (f) → dest
Status Affected:
N, Z
Encoding:
0001
f {,d {,a}}
10da
ffff
ffff
Description:
Exclusive OR the contents of W with
register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in the register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 24.2.3 for details.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
XORWF
Before Instruction
REG
=
W
=
After Instruction
REG
=
W
=
DS39635A-page 328
REG, 1, 0
AFh
B5h
1Ah
B5h
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
24.2
Extended Instruction Set
In addition to the standard 75 instructions of the PIC18
instruction set, PIC18FX310/X410 devices also
provide an optional extension to the core CPU functionality. The added features include eight additional
instructions that augment indirect and indexed
addressing operations and the implementation of
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing for many of the
standard PIC18 instructions.
A summary of the instructions in the extended instruction set is provided in Table 24-3. Detailed descriptions
are provided in Section 24.2.2 “Extended Instruction
Set”. The opcode field descriptions in Table 24-1 (page
288) apply to both the standard and extended PIC18
instruction sets.
Note:
The additional features of the extended instruction set
are disabled by default. To enable them, users must set
the XINST configuration bit.
The instructions in the extended set can all be classified as literal operations which either manipulate the
File Select Registers, or use them for indexed addressing. Two of the instructions, ADDFSR and SUBFSR,
each have an additional special instantiation for using
FSR2. These versions (ADDULNK and SUBULNK) allow
for automatic return after execution.
The extended instructions are specifically implemented
to optimize re-entrant program code (that is, code that
is recursive or that uses a software stack) written in
high-level languages, particularly C. Among other
things, they allow users working in high-level
languages to perform certain operations on data
structures more efficiently. These include:
• dynamic allocation and de-allocation of software
stack space when entering and leaving
subroutines
• function pointer invocation
• software stack pointer manipulation
• manipulation of variables located in a software
stack
TABLE 24-3:
EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SYNTAX
Most of the extended instructions use indexed arguments, using one of the File Select Registers and some
offset to specify a source or destination register. When
an argument for an instruction serves as part of
indexed addressing, it is enclosed in square brackets
(“[ ]”). This is done to indicate that the argument is used
as an index or offset. The MPASM Assembler will flag
an error if it determines that an index or offset value is
not bracketed.
When the extended instruction set is enabled, brackets
are also used to indicate index arguments in
byte-oriented and bit-oriented instructions. This is in
addition to other changes in their syntax. For more
details, see Section 24.2.3.1 “Extended Instruction
Syntax with Standard PIC18 Commands”.
Note:
In the past, square brackets have been
used to denote optional arguments in the
PIC18 and earlier instruction sets. In this
text and going forward, optional
arguments are denoted by braces (“{ }”).
EXTENSIONS TO THE PIC18 INSTRUCTION SET
16-Bit Instruction Word
Mnemonic,
Operands
ADDFSR
ADDULNK
CALLW
MOVSF
f, k
k
MOVSS
zs, zd
PUSHL
SUBFSR
SUBULNK
k
f, k
k
Note:
24.2.1
The instruction set extension and the
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
were designed for optimizing applications
written in C; the user may likely never use
these instructions directly in assembler.
The syntax for these commands is provided as a reference for users who may be
reviewing code that has been generated
by a compiler.
zs, fd
Description
Cycles
MSb
Add literal to FSR
Add literal to FSR2 and return
Call subroutine using WREG
Move zs (source) to 1st word
fd (destination) 2nd word
Move zs (source) to 1st word
zd (destination) 2nd word
Store literal at FSR2, decrement FSR2
Subtract literal from FSR
Subtract literal from FSR2 and return
1
2
2
2
2
1
1
2
1110
1110
0000
1110
1111
1110
1111
1110
1110
1110
LSb
1000
1000
0000
1011
ffff
1011
xxxx
1010
1001
1001
ffkk
11kk
0001
0zzz
ffff
1zzz
xzzz
kkkk
ffkk
11kk
kkkk
kkkk
0100
zzzz
ffff
zzzz
zzzz
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
Status
Affected
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
All PIC18 instructions may take an optional label argument, preceding the instruction mnemonic, for use
in symbolic addressing. If a label is used, the instruction syntax then becomes:
{label} instruction argument(s)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 329
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
24.2.2
EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SET
ADDFSR
Add Literal to FSR
ADDULNK
Syntax:
ADDFSR f, k
Syntax:
ADDULNK k
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
f ∈ [0, 1, 2]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
Operation:
FSR(f) + k → FSR(f)
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
FSR2 + k → FSR2,
Operation:
(TOS) → PC
Status Affected:
1000
ffkk
kkkk
Description:
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is added to the
contents of the FSR specified by ‘f’.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
FSR
ADDFSR
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
After Instruction
FSR2
=
2, 23h
None
Encoding:
1110
11kk
kkkk
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is added to the
contents of FSR2. A RETURN is then
executed by loading the PC with the
TOS.
The instruction takes two cycles to
execute; a NOP is performed during the
second cycle.
This may be though of as a special case
of the ADDFSR instruction, where f = 3
(binary ‘11’); it operates only on FSR2.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
03FFh
0422h
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
FSR
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
Example:
DS39635A-page 330
1000
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Example:
Add Literal to FSR2 and Return
Preliminary
ADDULNK 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
03FFh
0100h
After Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
0422h
(TOS)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
CALLW
Subroutine Call Using WREG
MOVSF
Syntax:
CALLW
Syntax:
MOVSF [zs], fd
Operands:
None
Operands:
Operation:
(PC + 2) → TOS,
(W) → PCL,
(PCLATH) → PCH,
(PCLATU) → PCU
0 ≤ zs ≤ 127
0 ≤ fd ≤ 4095
Operation:
((FSR2) + zs) → fd
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0000
0000
0001
0100
Description
First, the return address (PC + 2) is
pushed onto the return stack. Next, the
contents of W are written to PCL; the
existing value is discarded. Then, the
contents of PCLATH and PCLATU are
latched into PCH and PCU,
respectively. The second cycle is
executed as a NOP instruction while the
new next instruction is fetched.
Unlike CALL, there is no option to
update W, Status or BSR.
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Move Indexed to f
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (destin.)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
WREG
Push PC to
stack
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
HERE
Before Instruction
PC
=
PCLATH =
PCLATU =
W
=
After Instruction
PC
=
TOS
=
PCLATH =
PCLATU =
W
=
2
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
address (HERE)
10h
00h
06h
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
zzzzs
ffffd
Words:
CALLW
001006h
address (HERE + 2)
10h
00h
06h
0zzz
ffff
The contents of the source register are
moved to destination register ‘fd’. The
actual address of the source register is
determined by adding the 7-bit literal
offset ‘zs’ in the first word to the value of
FSR2. The address of the destination
register is specified by the 12-bit literal
‘fd’ in the second word. Both addresses
can be anywhere in the 4096-byte data
space (000h to FFFh).
The MOVSF instruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register.
If the resultant source address points to
an indirect addressing register, the
value returned will be 00h.
Decode
Example:
1011
ffff
Description:
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
1110
1111
Q2
Q3
Determine
Determine
source addr source addr
No
operation
No
operation
No dummy
read
Example:
MOVSF
Before Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
REG2
After Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
REG2
Preliminary
Q4
Read
source reg
Write
register ‘f’
(dest)
[05h], REG2
=
80h
=
=
33h
11h
=
80h
=
=
33h
33h
DS39635A-page 331
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
MOVSS
Move Indexed to Indexed
Syntax:
Operands:
MOVSS [zs], [zd]
0 ≤ zs ≤ 127
0 ≤ zd ≤ 127
Operation:
((FSR2) + zs) → ((FSR2) + zd)
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (dest.)
1110
1111
Description
1011
xxxx
1zzz
xzzz
zzzzs
zzzzd
The contents of the source register are
moved to the destination register. The
addresses of the source and destination
registers are determined by adding the
7-bit literal offsets ‘zs’ or ‘zd’,
respectively, to the value of FSR2. Both
registers can be located anywhere in
the 4096-byte data memory space
(000h to FFFh).
The MOVSS instruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register.
If the resultant source address points to
an indirect addressing register, the
value returned will be 00h. If the
resultant destination address points to
an indirect addressing register, the
instruction will execute as a NOP.
Words:
2
Cycles:
2
PUSHL
Store Literal at FSR2,
Decrement FSR2
Syntax:
PUSHL k
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operation:
k → (FSR2),
FSR2 - 1→ FSR2
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
Decode
Decode
Q2
Q3
Determine
Determine
source addr source addr
Determine
dest addr
Example:
MOVSS
Before Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
Contents
of 86h
After Instruction
FSR2
Contents
of 85h
Contents
of 86h
DS39635A-page 332
Determine
dest addr
1010
kkkk
kkkk
The 8-bit literal ‘k’ is written to the data
memory address specified by FSR2.
FSR2 is decremented by ‘1’ after the
operation.
This instruction allows users to push
values onto a software stack.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
data
Write to
destination
Example:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
1111
Description:
Q4
PUSHL
08h
Before Instruction
FSR2H:FSR2L
Memory (01ECh)
=
=
01ECh
00h
After Instruction
FSR2H:FSR2L
Memory (01ECh)
=
=
01EBh
08h
Read
source reg
Write
to dest reg
[05h], [06h]
=
80h
=
33h
=
11h
=
80h
=
33h
=
33h
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
SUBFSR
Subtract Literal from FSR
Syntax:
SUBFSR f, k
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
Syntax:
SUBULNK k
f ∈ [ 0, 1, 2 ]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
Operation:
FSRf – k → FSRf
Operation:
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
Description:
1
Cycles:
1
FSR2 – k → FSR2
(TOS) → PC
1001
ffkk
kkkk
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is subtracted from
the contents of the FSR specified by
‘f’.
Words:
Subtract Literal from FSR2
and Return
SUBULNK
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1110
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
SUBFSR 2, 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
03FFh
After Instruction
FSR2
=
03DCh
kkkk
Words:
1
Cycles:
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
Example:
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
11kk
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is subtracted from
the contents of the FSR2. A RETURN
is then executed by loading the PC
with the TOS.
The instruction takes two cycles to
execute; a NOP is performed during
the second cycle.
This may be though of as a special
case of the SUBFSR instruction,
where f = 3 (binary ‘11’); it operates
only on FSR2.
Q Cycle Activity:
Decode
1001
Description:
Preliminary
SUBULNK 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
03FFh
0100h
After Instruction
FSR2
=
PC
=
03DCh
(TOS)
DS39635A-page 333
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
24.2.3
Note:
BYTE-ORIENTED AND
BIT-ORIENTED INSTRUCTIONS IN
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
Enabling the PIC18 instruction set extension may cause legacy applications to
behave erratically or fail entirely.
In addition to eight new commands in the extended set,
enabling the extended instruction set also enables
Indexed Literal Offset addressing (Section 5.6.1
“Indexed Addressing with Literal Offset”). This has
a significant impact on the way that many commands of
the standard PIC18 instruction set are interpreted.
When the extended set is disabled, addresses
embedded in opcodes are treated as literal memory
locations: either as a location in the Access Bank
(a = 0) or in a GPR bank designated by the BSR
(a = 1). When the extended instruction set is enabled
and a = 0, however, a file register argument of 5Fh or
less is interpreted as an offset from the pointer value in
FSR2 and not as a literal address. For practical
purposes, this means that all instructions that use the
Access RAM bit as an argument – that is, all
byte-oriented and bit-oriented instructions, or almost
half of the core PIC18 instructions – may behave
differently when the extended instruction set is
enabled.
When the content of FSR2 is 00h, the boundaries of the
Access RAM are essentially remapped to their original
values. This may be useful in creating backward
compatible code. If this technique is used, it may be
necessary to save the value of FSR2 and restore it
when moving back and forth between C and assembly
routines in order to preserve the Stack Pointer. Users
must also keep in mind the syntax requirements of the
extended instruction set (see Section 24.2.3.1
“Extended Instruction Syntax with Standard PIC18
Commands”).
Although the Indexed Literal Offset mode can be very
useful for dynamic stack and pointer manipulation, it
can also be very annoying if a simple arithmetic
operation is carried out on the wrong register. Users
who are accustomed to the PIC18 programming must
keep in mind that, when the extended instruction set is
enabled, register addresses of 5Fh or less are used for
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing.
Representative examples of typical byte-oriented and
bit-oriented instructions in the Indexed Literal Offset
mode are provided on the following page to show how
execution is affected. The operand conditions shown in
the examples are applicable to all instructions of these
types.
DS39635A-page 334
24.2.3.1
Extended Instruction Syntax with
Standard PIC18 Commands
When the extended instruction set is enabled, the file
register argument ‘f’ in the standard byte-oriented and
bit-oriented commands is replaced with the literal offset
value ‘k’. As already noted, this occurs only when f is
less than or equal to 5Fh. When an offset value is used,
it must be indicated by square brackets (“[ ]”). As with
the extended instructions, the use of brackets indicates
to the compiler that the value is to be interpreted as an
index or an offset. Omitting the brackets, or using a
value greater than 5Fh within brackets, will generate an
error in the MPASM Assembler.
If the index argument is properly bracketed for Indexed
Literal Offset addressing, the Access RAM argument is
never specified; it will automatically be assumed to be
‘0’. This is in contrast to standard operation (extended
instruction set disabled), when ‘a’ is set on the basis of
the target address. Declaring the Access RAM bit in
this mode will also generate an error in the MPASM
assembler.
The destination argument ‘d’ functions as before.
In the latest versions of the MPASM assembler,
language support for the extended instruction set must
be explicitly invoked. This is done with either the
command line option /y, or the PE directive in the
source listing.
24.2.4
CONSIDERATIONS WHEN
ENABLING THE EXTENDED
INSTRUCTION SET
It is important to note that the extensions to the instruction set may not be beneficial to all users. In particular,
users who are not writing code that uses a software
stack may not benefit from using the extensions to the
instruction set.
Additionally, the Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode may create issues with legacy applications written to PIC18 assembler. This is because instructions in
the legacy code may attempt to address registers in the
Access Bank below 5Fh. Since these addresses are
interpreted as literal offsets to FSR2 when the
instruction set extension is enabled, the application
may read or write to the wrong data addresses.
When porting an application to the PIC18FX310/X410,
it is very important to consider the type of code. A large,
re-entrant application that is written in C and would
benefit from efficient compilation will do well when
using the instruction set extensions. Legacy applications that heavily use the Access Bank will most likely
not benefit from using the extended instruction set.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
ADDWF
ADD W to Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
BSF
Bit Set Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
Syntax:
ADDWF
Syntax:
BSF [k], b
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 95
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 95
0≤b≤7
Operation:
(W) + ((FSR2) + k) → dest
Operation:
1 → ((FSR2) + k)<b>
Status Affected:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
[k] {,d}
0010
Description:
01d0
kkkk
kkkk
The contents of W are added to the
contents of the register indicated by
FSR2, offset by the value ‘k’.
If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in W. If ‘d’
is ‘1’, the result is stored back in
register ‘f’ (default).
Encoding:
1000
bbb0
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
Bit ‘b’ of the register indicated by FSR2,
offset by the value ‘k’, is set.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Words:
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Cycles:
1
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
ADDWF
Example:
Before Instruction
FLAG_OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A0Ah
After Instruction
Contents
of 0A0Ah
[OFST] ,0
Before Instruction
W
OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A2Ch
After Instruction
W
Contents
of 0A2Ch
=
=
=
17h
2Ch
0A00h
=
20h
=
37h
=
20h
BSF
[FLAG_OFST], 7
=
=
0Ah
0A00h
=
55h
=
D5h
Set Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
SETF
Syntax:
SETF [k]
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 95
Operation:
FFh → ((FSR2) + k)
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
0110
1000
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of the register indicated
by FSR2, offset by ‘k’, are set to FFh.
Words:
1
Cycles:
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
Data
Write
register
Example:
SETF
Before Instruction
OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A2Ch
After Instruction
Contents
of 0A2Ch
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
[OFST]
=
=
2Ch
0A00h
=
00h
=
FFh
DS39635A-page 335
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
24.2.5
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS WITH
MICROCHIP MPLAB IDE TOOLS
The latest versions of Microchip’s software tools have
been designed to fully support the extended instruction
set of the PIC18FX310/X410 family of devices. This
includes the MPLAB C18 compiler, MPASM assembly
language and MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment (IDE).
When selecting a target device for software development, MPLAB IDE will automatically set default configuration bits for that device. The default setting for the
XINST configuration is ‘0’, disabling the extended
instruction set and Indexed Literal Offset Addressing.
For proper execution of applications developed to take
advantage of the extended instruction set, XINST must
be set during programming.
DS39635A-page 336
To develop software for the extended instruction set,
the user must enable support for the instructions and
the indexed addressing mode in their language tool(s).
Depending on the environment being used, this may be
done in several ways:
• A menu option or dialog box within the
environment that allows the user to configure the
language tool and its settings for the project
• A command line option
• A directive in the source code
These options vary between different compilers,
assemblers and development environments. Users are
encouraged to review the documentation accompanying
their development systems for the appropriate
information.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18FX310/X410
25.0
DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
25.1
The PICmicro® microcontrollers are supported with a
full range of hardware and software development tools:
• Integrated Development Environment
- MPLAB® IDE Software
• Assemblers/Compilers/Linkers
- MPASMTM Assembler
- MPLAB C17 and MPLAB C18 C Compilers
- MPLINKTM Object Linker/
MPLIBTM Object Librarian
- MPLAB C30 C Compiler
- MPLAB ASM30 Assembler/Linker/Library
• Simulators
- MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
- MPLAB dsPIC30 Software Simulator
• Emulators
- MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator
- MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator
• In-Circuit Debugger
- MPLAB ICD 2
• Device Programmers
- PRO MATE® II Universal Device Programmer
- PICSTART® Plus Development Programmer
- MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
• Low-Cost Demonstration Boards
- PICDEMTM 1 Demonstration Board
- PICDEM.netTM Demonstration Board
- PICDEM 2 Plus Demonstration Board
- PICDEM 3 Demonstration Board
- PICDEM 4 Demonstration Board
- PICDEM 17 Demonstration Board
- PICDEM 18R Demonstration Board
- PICDEM LIN Demonstration Board
- PICDEM USB Demonstration Board
• Evaluation Kits
- KEELOQ® Evaluation and Programming Tools
- PICDEM MSC
- microID® Developer Kits
- CAN
- PowerSmart® Developer Kits
- Analog
MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software
The MPLAB IDE software brings an ease of software
development previously unseen in the 8/16-bit microcontroller market. The MPLAB IDE is a Windows®
based application that contains:
• An interface to debugging tools
- simulator
- programmer (sold separately)
- emulator (sold separately)
- in-circuit debugger (sold separately)
• A full-featured editor with color coded context
• A multiple project manager
• Customizable data windows with direct edit of
contents
• High-level source code debugging
• Mouse over variable inspection
• Extensive on-line help
The MPLAB IDE allows you to:
• Edit your source files (either assembly or C)
• One touch assemble (or compile) and download
to PICmicro emulator and simulator tools
(automatically updates all project information)
• Debug using:
- source files (assembly or C)
- mixed assembly and C
- machine code
MPLAB IDE supports multiple debugging tools in a
single development paradigm, from the cost effective
simulators, through low-cost in-circuit debuggers, to
full-featured emulators. This eliminates the learning
curve when upgrading to tools with increasing flexibility
and power.
25.2
MPASM Assembler
The MPASM assembler is a full-featured, universal
macro assembler for all PICmicro MCUs.
The MPASM assembler generates relocatable object
files for the MPLINK object linker, Intel® standard HEX
files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines and
generated machine code and COFF files for
debugging.
The MPASM assembler features include:
• Integration into MPLAB IDE projects
• User defined macros to streamline assembly code
• Conditional assembly for multi-purpose source
files
• Directives that allow complete control over the
assembly process
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 337
PIC18FX310/X410
25.3
MPLAB C17 and MPLAB C18
C Compilers
25.6
The MPLAB C17 and MPLAB C18 Code Development
Systems are complete ANSI C compilers for
Microchip’s PIC17CXXX and PIC18CXXX family of
microcontrollers. These compilers provide powerful
integration capabilities, superior code optimization and
ease of use not found with other compilers.
For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide
symbol information that is optimized to the MPLAB IDE
debugger.
25.4
MPLINK Object Linker/
MPLIB Object Librarian
The MPLINK object linker combines relocatable
objects created by the MPASM assembler and the
MPLAB C17 and MPLAB C18 C compilers. It can link
relocatable objects from precompiled libraries, using
directives from a linker script.
The MPLIB object librarian manages the creation and
modification of library files of precompiled code. When
a routine from a library is called from a source file, only
the modules that contain that routine will be linked in
with the application. This allows large libraries to be
used efficiently in many different applications.
The object linker/library features include:
• Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many
smaller files
• Enhanced code maintainability by grouping
related modules together
• Flexible creation of libraries with easy module
listing, replacement, deletion and extraction
25.5
MPLAB C30 C Compiler
MPLAB C30 is distributed with a complete ANSI C
standard library. All library functions have been validated and conform to the ANSI C library standard. The
library includes functions for string manipulation,
dynamic memory allocation, data conversion, timekeeping and math functions (trigonometric, exponential
and hyperbolic). The compiler provides symbolic
information for high-level source debugging with the
MPLAB IDE.
DS39635A-page 338
MPLAB ASM30 assembler produces relocatable
machine code from symbolic assembly language for
dsPIC30F devices. MPLAB C30 compiler uses the
assembler to produce it’s object file. The assembler
generates relocatable object files that can then be
archived or linked with other relocatable object files and
archives to create an executable file. Notable features
of the assembler include:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Support for the entire dsPIC30F instruction set
Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
Command line interface
Rich directive set
Flexible macro language
MPLAB IDE compatibility
25.7
MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
The MPLAB SIM software simulator allows code development in a PC hosted environment by simulating the
PICmicro series microcontrollers on an instruction
level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be
examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from
a file, or user defined key press, to any pin. The execution can be performed in Single-Step, Execute Until
Break or Trace mode.
The MPLAB SIM simulator fully supports symbolic
debugging using the MPLAB C17 and MPLAB C18
C Compilers, as well as the MPASM assembler. The
software simulator offers the flexibility to develop and
debug code outside of the laboratory environment,
making it an excellent, economical software
development tool.
25.8
The MPLAB C30 C compiler is a full-featured, ANSI
compliant, optimizing compiler that translates standard
ANSI C programs into dsPIC30F assembly language
source. The compiler also supports many command
line options and language extensions to take full
advantage of the dsPIC30F device hardware capabilities and afford fine control of the compiler code
generator.
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker
and Librarian
MPLAB SIM30 Software Simulator
The MPLAB SIM30 software simulator allows code
development in a PC hosted environment by simulating
the dsPIC30F series microcontrollers on an instruction
level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be
examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from
a file, or user defined key press, to any of the pins.
The MPLAB SIM30 simulator fully supports symbolic
debugging using the MPLAB C30 C Compiler and
MPLAB ASM30 assembler. The simulator runs in either
a Command Line mode for automated tasks, or from
MPLAB IDE. This high-speed simulator is designed to
debug, analyze and optimize time intensive DSP
routines.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18FX310/X410
25.9
MPLAB ICE 2000
High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator
25.11 MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger
The MPLAB ICE 2000 universal in-circuit emulator is
intended to provide the product development engineer
with a complete microcontroller design tool set for
PICmicro microcontrollers. Software control of the
MPLAB ICE 2000 in-circuit emulator is advanced by
the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment,
which allows editing, building, downloading and source
debugging from a single environment.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 is a full-featured emulator system with enhanced trace, trigger and data monitoring
features. Interchangeable processor modules allow the
system to be easily reconfigured for emulation of different processors. The universal architecture of the
MPLAB ICE in-circuit emulator allows expansion to
support new PICmicro microcontrollers.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 in-circuit emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft® Windows 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
25.10 MPLAB ICE 4000
High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 4000 universal in-circuit emulator is
intended to provide the product development engineer
with a complete microcontroller design tool set for highend PICmicro microcontrollers. Software control of the
MPLAB ICE in-circuit emulator is provided by the
MPLAB Integrated Development Environment, which
allows editing, building, downloading and source
debugging from a single environment.
The MPLAB ICD 4000 is a premium emulator system,
providing the features of MPLAB ICE 2000, but with
increased emulation memory and high-speed performance for dsPIC30F and PIC18XXXX devices. Its
advanced emulator features include complex triggering
and timing, up to 2 Mb of emulation memory and the
ability to view variables in real-time.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 in-circuit emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft Windows 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Microchip’s In-Circuit Debugger, MPLAB ICD 2, is a
powerful, low-cost, run-time development tool,
connecting to the host PC via an RS-232 or high-speed
USB interface. This tool is based on the Flash
PICmicro MCUs and can be used to develop for these
and other PICmicro microcontrollers. The MPLAB
ICD 2 utilizes the in-circuit debugging capability built
into the Flash devices. This feature, along with
Microchip’s In-Circuit Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM)
protocol, offers cost effective in-circuit Flash debugging
from the graphical user interface of the MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment. This enables a
designer to develop and debug source code by setting
breakpoints, single-stepping and watching variables,
CPU status and peripheral registers. Running at full
speed enables testing hardware and applications in
real-time. MPLAB ICD 2 also serves as a development
programmer for selected PICmicro devices.
25.12 PRO MATE II Universal Device
Programmer
The PRO MATE II is a universal, CE compliant device
programmer with programmable voltage verification at
VDDMIN and VDDMAX for maximum reliability. It features
an LCD display for instructions and error messages
and a modular detachable socket assembly to support
various package types. In Stand-Alone mode, the
PRO MATE II device programmer can read, verify and
program PICmicro devices without a PC connection. It
can also set code protection in this mode.
25.13 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
The MPLAB PM3 is a universal, CE compliant device
programmer with programmable voltage verification at
VDDMIN and VDDMAX for maximum reliability. It features
a large LCD display (128 x 64) for menus and error
messages and a modular detachable socket assembly
to support various package types. The ICSP™ cable
assembly is included as a standard item. In StandAlone mode, the MPLAB PM3 device programmer can
read, verify and program PICmicro devices without a
PC connection. It can also set code protection in this
mode. MPLAB PM3 connects to the host PC via an RS232 or USB cable. MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and optimized algorithms for quick programming of large memory devices and incorporates
an SD/MMC card for file storage and secure data applications.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 339
PIC18FX310/X410
25.14 PICSTART Plus Development
Programmer
25.17 PICDEM 2 Plus
Demonstration Board
The PICSTART Plus development programmer is an
easy-to-use, low-cost, prototype programmer. It connects to the PC via a COM (RS-232) port. MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment software makes
using the programmer simple and efficient. The
PICSTART Plus development programmer supports
most PICmicro devices up to 40 pins. Larger pin count
devices, such as the PIC16C92X and PIC17C76X,
may be supported with an adapter socket. The
PICSTART Plus development programmer is CE
compliant.
The PICDEM 2 Plus demonstration board supports
many 18, 28 and 40-pin microcontrollers, including
PIC16F87X and PIC18FXX2 devices. All the necessary hardware and software is included to run the demonstration programs. The sample microcontrollers
provided with the PICDEM 2 demonstration board can
be programmed with a PRO MATE II device programmer, PICSTART Plus development programmer, or
MPLAB ICD 2 with a Universal Programmer Adapter.
The MPLAB ICD 2 and MPLAB ICE in-circuit emulators
may also be used with the PICDEM 2 demonstration
board to test firmware. A prototype area extends the
circuitry for additional application components. Some
of the features include an RS-232 interface, a 2 x 16
LCD display, a piezo speaker, an on-board temperature
sensor, four LEDs and sample PIC18F452 and
PIC16F877 Flash microcontrollers.
25.15 PICDEM 1 PICmicro
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM 1 demonstration board demonstrates the
capabilities of the PIC16C5X (PIC16C54 to
PIC16C58A), PIC16C61, PIC16C62X, PIC16C71,
PIC16C8X, PIC17C42, PIC17C43 and PIC17C44. All
necessary hardware and software is included to run
basic demo programs. The sample microcontrollers
provided with the PICDEM 1 demonstration board can
be programmed with a PRO MATE II device programmer or a PICSTART Plus development programmer.
The PICDEM 1 demonstration board can be connected
to the MPLAB ICE in-circuit emulator for testing. A
prototype area extends the circuitry for additional application components. Features include an RS-232
interface, a potentiometer for simulated analog input,
push button switches and eight LEDs.
25.16 PICDEM.net Internet/Ethernet
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM.net demonstration board is an Internet/
Ethernet demonstration board using the PIC18F452
microcontroller and TCP/IP firmware. The board
supports any 40-pin DIP device that conforms to the
standard pinout used by the PIC16F877 or
PIC18C452. This kit features a user friendly TCP/IP
stack, web server with HTML, a 24L256 Serial
EEPROM for Xmodem download to web pages into
Serial EEPROM, ICSP/MPLAB ICD 2 interface connector, an Ethernet interface, RS-232 interface and a
16 x 2 LCD display. Also included is the book and
CD-ROM “TCP/IP Lean, Web Servers for Embedded
Systems,” by Jeremy Bentham
DS39635A-page 340
25.18 PICDEM 3 PIC16C92X
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM 3 demonstration board supports the
PIC16C923 and PIC16C924 in the PLCC package. All
the necessary hardware and software is included to run
the demonstration programs.
25.19 PICDEM 4 8/14/18-Pin
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM 4 can be used to demonstrate the capabilities of the 8, 14 and 18-pin PIC16XXXX and
PIC18XXXX MCUs, including the PIC16F818/819,
PIC16F87/88, PIC16F62XA and the PIC18F1320
family of microcontrollers. PICDEM 4 is intended to
showcase the many features of these low pin count
parts, including LIN and Motor Control using ECCP.
Special provisions are made for low-power operation
with the supercapacitor circuit and jumpers allow onboard hardware to be disabled to eliminate current
draw in this mode. Included on the demo board are provisions for Crystal, RC or Canned Oscillator modes, a
five volt regulator for use with a nine volt wall adapter
or battery, DB-9 RS-232 interface, ICD connector for
programming via ICSP and development with MPLAB
ICD 2, 2 x 16 liquid crystal display, PCB footprints for
H-Bridge motor driver, LIN transceiver and EEPROM.
Also included are: header for expansion, eight LEDs,
four potentiometers, three push buttons and a prototyping area. Included with the kit is a PIC16F627A and
a PIC18F1320. Tutorial firmware is included along
with the User’s Guide.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18FX310/X410
25.20 PICDEM 17 Demonstration Board
The PICDEM 17 demonstration board is an evaluation
board that demonstrates the capabilities of several
Microchip microcontrollers, including PIC17C752,
PIC17C756A, PIC17C762 and PIC17C766. A programmed sample is included. The PRO MATE II device
programmer, or the PICSTART Plus development programmer, can be used to reprogram the device for user
tailored application development. The PICDEM 17
demonstration board supports program download and
execution from external on-board Flash memory. A
generous prototype area is available for user hardware
expansion.
25.21 PICDEM 18R PIC18C601/801
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM 18R demonstration board serves to assist
development of the PIC18C601/801 family of Microchip
microcontrollers. It provides hardware implementation
of both 8-bit Multiplexed/Demultiplexed and 16-bit
Memory modes. The board includes 2 Mb external
Flash memory and 128 Kb SRAM memory, as well as
serial EEPROM, allowing access to the wide range of
memory types supported by the PIC18C601/801.
25.22 PICDEM LIN PIC16C43X
Demonstration Board
The powerful LIN hardware and software kit includes a
series of boards and three PICmicro microcontrollers.
The small footprint PIC16C432 and PIC16C433 are
used as slaves in the LIN communication and feature
on-board LIN transceivers. A PIC16F874 Flash
microcontroller serves as the master. All three microcontrollers are programmed with firmware to provide
LIN bus communication.
25.24 PICDEM USB PIC16C7X5
Demonstration Board
The PICDEM USB Demonstration Board shows off the
capabilities of the PIC16C745 and PIC16C765 USB
microcontrollers. This board provides the basis for
future USB products.
25.25 Evaluation and
Programming Tools
In addition to the PICDEM series of circuits, Microchip
has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software
for these products.
• KEELOQ evaluation and programming tools for
Microchip’s HCS Secure Data Products
• CAN developers kit for automotive network
applications
• Analog design boards and filter design software
• PowerSmart battery charging evaluation/
calibration kits
• IrDA® development kit
• microID development and rfLabTM development
software
• SEEVAL® designer kit for memory evaluation and
endurance calculations
• PICDEM MSC demo boards for Switching mode
power supply, high-power IR driver, delta sigma
ADC and flow rate sensor
Check the Microchip web page and the latest Product
Selector Guide for the complete list of demonstration
and evaluation kits.
25.23 PICkitTM 1 Flash Starter Kit
A complete “development system in a box”, the PICkit™
Flash Starter Kit includes a convenient multi-section
board for programming, evaluation and development of
8/14-pin Flash PIC® microcontrollers. Powered via USB,
the board operates under a simple Windows GUI. The
PICkit 1 Starter Kit includes the User’s Guide (on CD
ROM), PICkit 1 tutorial software and code for various
applications. Also included are MPLAB® IDE (Integrated
Development Environment) software, software and
hardware “Tips 'n Tricks for 8-pin Flash PIC®
Microcontrollers” Handbook and a USB interface cable.
Supports all current 8/14-pin Flash PIC microcontrollers,
as well as many future planned devices.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 341
PIC18FX310/X410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 342
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.0
ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Absolute Maximum Ratings(†)
Ambient temperature under bias.............................................................................................................-40°C to +125°C
Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS (except VDD, MCLR and RA4) .......................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ......................................................................................................... -0.3V to +7.5V
Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS (Note 2) ......................................................................................... 0V to +13.25V
Voltage on RA4 with respect to Vss ............................................................................................................... 0V to +8.5V
Total power dissipation (Note 1) ...............................................................................................................................1.0W
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin ..............................................................................................................................250 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD)...................................................................................................................... ±20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD) .............................................................................................................. ±20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin..........................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ....................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum current sunk by all ports .......................................................................................................................200 mA
Maximum current sourced by all ports ..................................................................................................................200 mA
Note 1: Power dissipation is calculated as follows:
Pdis = VDD x {IDD – ∑ IOH} + ∑ {(VDD – VOH) x IOH} + ∑(VOL x IOL)
2: Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR/VPP pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may cause latch-up.
Thus, a series resistor of 50-100Ω should be used when applying a “low” level to the MCLR/VPP pin, rather
than pulling this pin directly to VSS.
† NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those
indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 343
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-1:
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH (INDUSTRIAL)
6.0V
5.5V
5.0V
PIC18FX310/410
Voltage
4.5V
4.2V
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
2.0V
40 MHz
Frequency
FIGURE 26-2:
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH (INDUSTRIAL)
6.0V
5.5V
Voltage
5.0V
PIC18LFX310/410
4.5V
4.2V
4.0V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
2.0V
40 MHz
4 MHz
Frequency
FMAX = (16.36 MHz/V) (VDDAPPMIN – 2.0V) + 4 MHz
Note: VDDAPPMIN is the minimum voltage of the PICmicro® device in the application.
DS39635A-page 344
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.1
DC Characteristics:
Supply Voltage
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Symbol
VDD
D001
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
PIC18LFX310/X410
2.0
—
5.5
V
PIC18FX310/X410
Supply Voltage
4.2
—
5.5
V
D002
VDR
RAM Data Retention
Voltage(1)
1.5
—
—
V
D003
VPOR
VDD Start Voltage
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
—
—
0.7
V
D004
SVDD
VDD Rise Rate
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
0.05
—
—
BORV1:BORV0 = 11
1.96
2.06
2.16
BORV1:BORV0 = 10
2.64
2.78
2.92
V
BORV1:BORV0 = 01
4.11
4.33
4.55
V
BORV1:BORV0 = 00
4.41
4.64
4.87
V
VBOR
D005
Legend:
Note 1:
Conditions
HS, XT, RC and LP Oscillator mode
See Section 4.3 “Power-on Reset (POR)” for
details
V/ms See Section 4.3 “Power-on Reset (POR)” for
details
Brown-out Reset Voltage
V
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in Sleep mode, or during a device Reset, without losing RAM data.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 345
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.2
DC Characteristics:
Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
0.18
0.95
µA
-40°C
0.19
1.0
µA
+25°C
0.20
1.1
µA
+85°C
0.27
0.95
µA
-40°C
0.28
1.0
µA
+25°C
0.30
1.1
µA
+85°C
0.42
1.9
µA
-40°C
0.44
2.0
µA
+25°C
0.47
2.1
µA
+85°C
Power-down Current (IPD)(1)
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
VDD = 2.0V,
(Sleep mode)
VDD = 3.0V,
(Sleep mode)
VDD = 5.0V,
(Sleep mode)
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with
the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that add delta
current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 Oscillator, BOR, etc.).
The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading
and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on
the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated
by the formula Ir = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
Standard low-cost 32 kHz crystals have an operating temperature range of -10°C to +70°C. Extended temperature
crystals are available at a much higher cost.
DS39635A-page 346
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.2
DC Characteristics:
Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
15.6
31.5
µA
-40°C
14.8
30
µA
+25°C
14.1
28.5
µA
+85°C
34
63
µA
-40°C
32.4
57
µA
+25°C
30.7
60
µA
+85°C
83.2
168
µA
-40°C
79.2
160
µA
+25°C
75.2
152
µA
+85°C
Supply Current (IDD)(2,3)
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
339
630
µA
-40°C
323
600
µA
+25°C
306
570
µA
+85°C
.55
1.3
mA
-40°C
.52
1.2
mA
+25°C
.50
1.1
mA
+85°C
1.2
2.3
mA
-40°C
1.1
2.2
mA
+25°C
+85°C
1.1
2.1
mA
0.84
2.1
mA
-40°C
0.80
2.0
mA
+25°C
0.76
1.9
mA
+85°C
1.4
2.7
mA
-40°C
1.3
2.6
mA
+25°C
1.3
2.5
mA
+85°C
2.6
5.3
mA
-40°C
2.5
5.0
mA
+25°C
2.4
4.8
mA
+85°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 31 kHz
(RC_RUN mode,
Internal oscillator source)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 1 MHz
(RC_RUN mode,
Internal oscillator source)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 4 MHz
(RC_RUN mode,
Internal oscillator source)
VDD = 5.0V
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with
the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that add delta
current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 Oscillator, BOR, etc.).
The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading
and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on
the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated
by the formula Ir = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
Standard low-cost 32 kHz crystals have an operating temperature range of -10°C to +70°C. Extended temperature
crystals are available at a much higher cost.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 347
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.2
DC Characteristics:
Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
3.3
6.5
µA
-40°C
3.1
6.2
µA
+25°C
3.0
5.9
µA
+85°C
5.0
10.1
µA
-40°C
4.8
9.6
µA
+25°C
+85°C
Supply Current (IDD)(2,3)
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
4.6
9.1
µA
10.3
15.8
µA
-40°C
9.8
15.0
µA
+25°C
9.3
14.3
µA
+85°C
183
368
µA
-40°C
175
350
µA
+25°C
166
333
µA
+85°C
280
473
µA
-40°C
267
450
µA
+25°C
253
428
µA
+85°C
546
893
µA
-40°C
520
850
µA
+25°C
494
808
µA
+85°C
362
525
µA
-40°C
344
500
µA
+25°C
327
475
µA
+85°C
572
840
µA
-40°C
544
800
µA
+25°C
517
760
µA
+85°C
1.2
1.6
mA
-40°C
1.1
1.5
mA
+25°C
1.0
1.4
mA
+85°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 31 kHz
(RC_IDLE mode,
Internal oscillator source)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 1 MHz
(RC_IDLE mode,
Internal oscillator source)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 4 MHz
(RC_IDLE mode,
Internal oscillator source)
VDD = 5.0V
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with
the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that add delta
current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 Oscillator, BOR, etc.).
The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading
and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on
the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated
by the formula Ir = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
Standard low-cost 32 kHz crystals have an operating temperature range of -10°C to +70°C. Extended temperature
crystals are available at a much higher cost.
DS39635A-page 348
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.2
DC Characteristics:
Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
271
420
µA
-40°C
258
400
µA
+25°C
245
380
µA
+85°C
Supply Current (IDD)(2,3)
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
All devices
All devices
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
502
735
µA
-40°C
478
700
µA
+25°C
454
665
µA
+85°C
1.1
2.6
mA
-40°C
1.1
2.5
mA
+25°C
1.0
2.4
mA
+85°C
0.78
1.6
mA
-40°C
0.74
1.5
mA
+25°C
0.70
1.4
mA
+85°C
1.4
2.6
mA
-40°C
1.3
2.5
mA
+25°C
1.2
2.4
mA
+85°C
2.8
5.3
mA
-40°C
2.6
5.0
mA
+25°C
+85°C
2.5
4.8
mA
16.5
26.3
mA
-40°C
15.7
25.0
mA
+25°C
14.9
23.8
mA
+85°C
21.7
31.5
mA
-40°C
20.6
30.0
mA
+25°C
19.6
28.5
mA
+85°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 1 MHZ
(PRI_RUN,
EC oscillator)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 4 MHz
(PRI_RUN,
EC oscillator)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 4.2V
FOSC = 40 MHZ
(PRI_RUN,
EC oscillator)
VDD = 5.0V
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with
the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that add delta
current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 Oscillator, BOR, etc.).
The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading
and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on
the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated
by the formula Ir = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
Standard low-cost 32 kHz crystals have an operating temperature range of -10°C to +70°C. Extended temperature
crystals are available at a much higher cost.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 349
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.2
DC Characteristics:
Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
68.2
126
µA
65.0
120
µA
+25°C
61.7
114
µA
+85°C
123
263
µA
-40°C
117
250
µA
+25°C
+85°C
Supply Current (IDD)(2,3)
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
All devices
All devices
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
-40°C
111
238
µA
241
473
µA
-40°C
230
450
µA
+25°C
218
428
µA
+85°C
268
473
µA
-40°C
255
450
µA
+25°C
242
428
µA
+85°C
448
1000
µA
-40°C
426
952
µA
+25°C
+85°C
405
904
µA
0.93
1.5
mA
-40°C
0.88
1.4
mA
+25°C
0.84
1.3
mA
+85°C
6.3
9.5
mA
-40°C
6.0
9.0
mA
+25°C
5.7
8.6
mA
+85°C
9.5
12.6
mA
-40°C
9.1
12.0
mA
+25°C
8.6
11.4
mA
+85°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 1 MHz
(PRI_IDLE mode,
EC oscillator)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 4 MHz
(PRI_IDLE mode,
EC oscillator)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 4.2 V
FOSC = 40 MHz
(PRI_IDLE mode,
EC oscillator)
VDD = 5.0V
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with
the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that add delta
current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 Oscillator, BOR, etc.).
The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading
and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on
the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated
by the formula Ir = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
Standard low-cost 32 kHz crystals have an operating temperature range of -10°C to +70°C. Extended temperature
crystals are available at a much higher cost.
DS39635A-page 350
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.2
DC Characteristics:
Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
15.8
31.5
µA
-10°C
15.0
30.0
µA
+25°C
14.3
28.5
µA
+70°C
Supply Current (IDD)(2,3)
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
PIC18LFX310/X410
PIC18LFX310/X410
All devices
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
33.4
73.5
µA
-10°C
31.8
70.0
µA
+25°C
30.2
66.5
µA
+70°C
83.2
126
µA
-10°C
79.2
120
µA
+25°C
75.2
114
µA
+70°C
3.9
9.5
µA
-10°C
3.7
9.0
µA
+25°C
3.5
8.6
µA
+70°C
5.4
10.5
µA
-10°C
5.1
10.0
µA
+25°C
4.8
9.5
µA
+70°C
9.4
16.8
µA
-10°C
9.0
16.0
µA
+25°C
8.5
15.2
µA
+70°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 32 kHz(4)
(SEC_RUN mode,
Timer1 as clock)
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
FOSC = 32 kHz(4)
(SEC_IDLE mode,
Timer1 as clock)
VDD = 5.0V
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with
the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that add delta
current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 Oscillator, BOR, etc.).
The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading
and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on
the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated
by the formula Ir = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
Standard low-cost 32 kHz crystals have an operating temperature range of -10°C to +70°C. Extended temperature
crystals are available at a much higher cost.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 351
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.2
DC Characteristics:
Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial, Extended)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
Module Differential Currents (∆IWDT, ∆IBOR, ∆ILVD, ∆IOSCB, ∆IAD)
D022
(∆IWDT)
Watchdog Timer
D022A
(∆IBOR)
Brown-out Reset
D022B
(∆ILVD)
Low-Voltage Detect
D025
(∆IOSCB)
Timer1 Oscillator
D026
(∆IAD)
A/D Converter
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
1.3
3.8
µA
-40°C
1.4
4.0
µA
+25°C
1.4
4.2
µA
+85°C
1.9
4.8
µA
-40°C
2.0
5.0
µA
+25°C
2.1
5.3
µA
+85°C
5.2
9.5
µA
-40°C
5.5
10.0
µA
+25°C
5.7
10.5
µA
+85°C
32.2
52.3
µA
-40°C to +85°C
35.6
63.0
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 5.0V
19
31.5
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
21.7
31.5
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 3.0V
24.3
36.8
µA
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 5.0V
1.2
5.7
µA
-10°C
1.3
6.0
µA
+25°C
1.3
6.3
µA
+70°C
1.6
7.6
µA
-10°C
1.7
8.0
µA
+25°C
1.8
8.4
µA
+70°C
2.6
9.5
µA
-10°C
2.8
10.0
µA
+25°C
2.9
10.5
µA
+70°C
1.0
3.0
µA
—
VDD = 2.0V
1.0
4.0
µA
—
VDD = 3.0V
1.0
10.0
µA
—
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 3.0V
VDD = 2.0V
32 kHz on Timer1(4)
VDD = 3.0V
32 kHz on Timer1(4)
VDD = 5.0V
32 kHz on Timer1(4)
A/D on, not converting,
1.6 µs ≤ TAD ≤ 6.4 µs
Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured with
the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that add delta
current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 Oscillator, BOR, etc.).
The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin loading
and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have an impact on
the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
For RC oscillator configurations, current through REXT is not included. The current through the resistor can be estimated
by the formula Ir = VDD/2REXT (mA) with REXT in kΩ.
Standard low-cost 32 kHz crystals have an operating temperature range of -10°C to +70°C. Extended temperature
crystals are available at a much higher cost.
DS39635A-page 352
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.3
DC Characteristics: PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
VIL
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
with TTL buffer
VSS
0.15 VDD
V
VDD < 4.5V
—
0.8
V
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
RC3 and RC4
VSS
VSS
0.2 VDD
0.3 VDD
V
V
Input Low Voltage
I/O ports:
D030
D030A
D031
D032
MCLR
VSS
0.2 VDD
V
D032A
OSC1 and T1OSI
VSS
0.3 VDD
V
LP, XT, HS, HSPLL
modes(1)
D033
OSC1
VSS
0.2 VDD
V
EC mode(1)
0.25 VDD + 0.8V
VDD
V
VDD < 4.5V
2.0
VDD
V
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
0.8 VDD
0.7 VDD
VDD
VDD
V
V
VIH
Input High Voltage
I/O ports:
D040
with TTL buffer
D040A
D041
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
RC3 and RC4
D042
MCLR
0.8 VDD
VDD
V
D042A
OSC1 and T1OSI
0.7 VDD
VDD
V
LP, XT, HS, HSPLL
modes(1)
D043
OSC1
0.8 VDD
VDD
V
EC mode(1)
IIL
Input Leakage Current(2,3)
D060
I/O ports
—
±1
µA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at hi-impedance
D061
MCLR
—
±5
µA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
OSC1
—
±5
µA
VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
50
400
µA
VDD = 5V, VPIN = VSS
D063
D070
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
IPU
Weak Pull-up Current
IPURB
PORTB weak pull-up current
In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKI pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the
PICmicro® device be driven with an external clock while in RC mode.
The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified
levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input
voltages.
Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
Parameter is characterized but not tested.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 353
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.3
DC Characteristics: PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (Industrial) (Continued)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
VOL
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
Output Low Voltage
D080
I/O ports
—
0.6
V
IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
-40°C to +85°C
D083
OSC2/CLKO
(RC, RCIO, EC, ECIO modes)
—
0.6
V
IOL = 1.6 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
-40°C to +85°C
VOH
Output High Voltage(3)
D090
I/O ports
VDD – 0.7
—
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
-40°C to +85°C
D092
OSC2/CLKO
(RC, RCIO, EC, ECIO modes)
VDD – 0.7
—
V
IOH = -1.3 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
-40°C to +85°C
—
8.5
V
RA4 pin
D150
VOD
Open-Drain High Voltage
Capacitive Loading Specs
on Output Pins
D100(4) COSC2
OSC2 pin
—
15
pF
In XT, HS and LP modes
when external clock is
used to drive OSC1
D101
CIO
All I/O pins and OSC2
(in RC mode)
—
50
pF
To meet the AC Timing
Specifications
D102
CB
SCL, SDA
—
400
pF
I2C Specification
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKI pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the
PICmicro® device be driven with an external clock while in RC mode.
The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified
levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input
voltages.
Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
Parameter is characterized but not tested.
DS39635A-page 354
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 26-1:
MEMORY PROGRAMMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
DC Characteristics
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
Program Flash Memory
D110
VPP
Voltage on MCLR/VPP pin
10.0
—
12.0
V
D113
IDDP
Supply Current during
Programming
—
—
1
mA
D130
EP
Cell Endurance
—
1K
—
E/W -40°C to +85°C
D131
VPR
VDD for Read
VMIN
—
5.5
V
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D132
VIE
VDD for Block Erase
4.5
—
5.5
V
Using ICSP port
D132A VIW
VDD for Externally Timed Erase
or Write
4.5
—
5.5
V
Using ICSP port
D132B VPEW
VDD for Self-timed Write
VMIN
—
5.5
V
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D133
TIE
ICSP™ Block Erase Cycle Time
—
4
—
ms
VDD > 4.5V
D133A TIW
ICSP Erase or Write Cycle Time
(externally timed)
2
—
—
ms
VDD > 4.5V
D133A TIW
Self-timed Write Cycle Time
D134
TRETD Characteristic Retention
—
2
—
40
100
—
ms
Year Provided no other
specifications are violated
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 355
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 26-2:
COMPARATOR SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: 3.0V < VDD < 5.5V, -40°C < TA < +85°C, unless otherwise stated.
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristics
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Comments
D300
VIOFF
Input Offset Voltage
—
± 5.0
± 10
mV
D301
VICM
Input Common Mode Voltage*
0
—
VDD – 1.5
V
D302
CMRR
Common Mode Rejection Ratio*
55
—
—
dB
300
TRESP
Response Time(1)*
—
150
400
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
150
600
ns
PIC18LFXXXX,
VDD = 2.0V
—
—
10
µs
300A
301
*
Note 1:
TMC2OV
Comparator Mode Change to
Output Valid*
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Response time measured with one comparator input at (VDD – 1.5)/2, while the other input transitions
from VSS to VDD.
TABLE 26-3:
VOLTAGE REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: 3.0V < VDD < 5.5V, -40°C < TA < +85°C, unless otherwise stated.
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristics
Min
Typ
Max
Units
D310
VRES
Resolution
VDD/24
—
VDD/32
LSb
D311
VRAA
Absolute Accuracy
—
—
—
—
1/4
1/2
LSb
LSb
D312
VRUR
Unit Resistor Value (R)*
—
2k
—
Ω
TSET
Time(1)*
—
—
10
µs
310
*
Note 1:
Settling
Comments
Low Range (CVRR = 1)
High Range (CVRR = 0)
These parameters are characterized but not tested.
Settling time measured while CVRR = 1 and CVR3:CVR0 transitions from ‘0000’ to ‘1111’.
DS39635A-page 356
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-3:
HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CHARACTERISTICS
For VDIRMAG = 1:
VDD
VHLVD
(HLVDIF set by hardware)
(HLVDIF can be
cleared in software)
VHLVD
VDD
For VDIRMAG = 0:
HLVDIF
TABLE 26-4:
HIGH/LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CHARACTERISTICS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
Symbol
No.
D420
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
HLVD Voltage on VDD LVV = 0000
Transition
LVV = 0001
1.80
1.86
1.91
V
1.96
2.06
2.06
V
LVV = 0010
2.16
2.27
2.38
V
LVV = 0011
2.35
2.47
2.59
V
LVV = 0100
2.43
2.56
2.69
V
LVV = 0101
2.64
2.78
2.92
V
LVV = 0110
2.75
2.89
3.03
V
LVV = 0111
2.95
3.10
3.26
V
LVV = 1000
3.24
3.41
3.58
V
LVV = 1001
3.43
3.61
3.79
V
LVV = 1010
3.53
3.72
3.91
V
LVV = 1011
3.72
3.92
4.12
V
LVV = 1100
3.92
4.13
4.34
V
LVV = 1101
4.11
4.33
4.55
V
LVV = 1110
4.41
4.64
4.87
V
Conditions
† Production tested at TAMB = 25°C. Specifications over temperature limits ensured by characterization.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 357
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.4
26.4.1
AC (Timing) Characteristics
TIMING PARAMETER SYMBOLOGY
The timing parameter symbols have been created
following one of the following formats:
1. TppS2ppS
2. TppS
T
F
Frequency
Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings:
pp
cc
CCP1
ck
CLKO
cs
CS
di
SDI
do
SDO
dt
Data in
io
I/O port
mc
MCLR
Uppercase letters and their meanings:
S
F
Fall
H
High
I
Invalid (High-impedance)
L
Low
I2C only
AA
output access
BUF
Bus free
TCC:ST (I2C specifications only)
CC
HD
Hold
ST
DAT
DATA input hold
STA
Start condition
DS39635A-page 358
3. TCC:ST
4. Ts
(I2C specifications only)
(I2C specifications only)
T
Time
osc
rd
rw
sc
ss
t0
t1
wr
OSC1
RD
RD or WR
SCK
SS
T0CKI
T13CKI
WR
P
R
V
Z
Period
Rise
Valid
High-impedance
High
Low
High
Low
SU
Setup
STO
Stop condition
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.4.2
TIMING CONDITIONS
Note:
The temperature and voltages specified in Table 26-5
apply to all timing specifications unless otherwise
noted. Figure 26-4 specifies the load conditions for the
timing specifications.
TABLE 26-5:
Because of space limitations, the generic
terms “PIC18FXXXX” and “PIC18LFXXXX”
are used throughout this section to refer to
the PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 and
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 families of
devices specifically and only those devices.
TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS – AC
AC CHARACTERISTICS
FIGURE 26-4:
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Operating voltage VDD range as described in DC spec Section 26.1 and
Section 26.3.
LF parts operate for industrial temperatures only.
LOAD CONDITIONS FOR DEVICE TIMING SPECIFICATIONS
Load Condition 1
Load Condition 2
VDD/2
RL
CL
Pin
VSS
CL
Pin
RL = 464Ω
VSS
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
CL = 50 pF
for all pins except OSC2/CLKO
and including D and E outputs as ports
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 359
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
26.4.3
TIMING DIAGRAMS AND SPECIFICATIONS
FIGURE 26-5:
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING (ALL MODES EXCEPT PLL)
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
OSC1
1
3
4
3
4
2
CLKO
TABLE 26-6:
Param.
No.
1A
1
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Symbol
FOSC
TOSC
Characteristic
Min
Max
External CLKI Frequency(1)
DC
40
MHz
EC, ECIO
Oscillator Frequency(1)
DC
4
MHz
RC oscillator
External CLKI Period(1)
(1)
Oscillator Period
Time(1)
2
TCY
Instruction Cycle
3
TOSL,
TOSH
External Clock in (OSC1)
High or Low Time
4
Note 1:
TOSR,
TOSF
External Clock in (OSC1)
Rise or Fall Time
Units
Conditions
0.1
4
MHz
XT oscillator
4
25
MHz
HS oscillator
4
10
MHz
HS + PLL oscillator
5
200
kHz
LP Oscillator mode
25
—
ns
EC, ECIO
250
—
ns
RC oscillator
250
10,000
ns
XT oscillator
25
100
250
250
ns
ns
HS oscillator
HS + PLL oscillator
25
—
µs
LP oscillator
100
—
ns
TCY = 4/FOSC
30
—
ns
XT oscillator
2.5
—
µs
LP oscillator
10
—
ns
HS oscillator
—
20
ns
XT oscillator
—
50
ns
LP oscillator
—
7.5
ns
HS oscillator
Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period for all configurations
except PLL. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under
standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result
in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested
to operate at “min.” values with an external clock applied to the OSC1/CLKI pin. When an external clock
input is used, the “max.” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices.
DS39635A-page 360
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 26-7:
Param
No.
PLL CLOCK TIMING SPECIFICATIONS (VDD = 4.2V TO 5.5V)
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
4
16
—
—
10
40
Units
F10
F11
FOSC Oscillator Frequency Range
FSYS On-Chip VCO System Frequency
F12
trc
PLL Start-up Time (Lock Time)
—
—
2
ms
∆CLK
CLKO Stability (Jitter)
-2
—
+2
%
F13
Conditions
MHz HS mode only
MHz HS mode only
† Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C, unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
TABLE 26-8:
AC CHARACTERISTICS:INTERNAL RC ACCURACY
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (INDUSTRIAL)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (INDUSTRIAL)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Device
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
INTOSC Accuracy @ Freq = 8 MHz, 4 MHz, 2 MHz, 1 MHz, 500 kHz, 250 kHz, 125 kHz(1)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
-2
+/-1
2
%
+25°C
VDD = 2.7-3.3 V
-5
—
5
%
-10°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.7-3.3 V
-10
+/-1
10
%
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.7-3.3 V
-2
+/-1
2
%
+25°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5 V
-5
—
5
%
-10°C to +85°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5 V
-10
+/-1
10
%
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5 V
INTRC Accuracy @ Freq = 31 kHz(2)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 26.562
—
35.938
kHz
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.7-3.3 V
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 26.562
—
35.938
kHz
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 4.5-5.5 V
TBD
1
TBD
%
+25°C
VDD = 2.0V
TBD
1
TBD
%
+25°C
VDD = 3.0V
TBD
1
TBD
%
+25°C
VDD = 5.0V
INTRC Stability(3)
F7
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410
F8
F9
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
All devices
TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Frequency calibrated at 25°C. OSCTUNE register can be used to compensate for temperature drift.
INTRC frequency after calibration.
Change of INTRC frequency as VDD changes.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 361
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-6:
CLKO AND I/O TIMING
Q1
Q4
Q2
Q3
OSC1
11
10
CLKO
13
19
14
12
18
16
I/O pin
(Input)
15
17
I/O pin
(Output)
Note:
20, 21
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-9:
Param
No.
New Value
Old Value
CLKO AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units Conditions
10
TOSH2CKL OSC1 ↑ to CLKO ↓
—
75
200
ns
(Note 1)
11
TOSH2CKH OSC1 ↑ to CLKO ↑
—
75
200
ns
(Note 1)
12
TCKR
CLKO Rise Time
—
35
100
ns
(Note 1)
13
TCKF
CLKO Fall Time
—
35
100
ns
(Note 1)
14
TCKL2IOV CLKO ↓ to Port Out Valid
—
—
0.5 TCY + 20
ns
(Note 1)
15
TIOV2CKH Port In Valid before CLKO ↑
16
TCKH2IOI
17
TOSH2IOV OSC1↑ (Q1 cycle) to Port Out Valid
18
TOSH2IOI
18A
0.25 TCY + 25
—
—
ns
(Note 1)
0
—
—
ns
(Note 1)
Port In Hold after CLKO ↑
OSC1↑ (Q2 cycle) to
Port Input Invalid
(I/O in hold time)
—
50
150
ns
PIC18FXXXX
100
—
—
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
200
—
—
ns
19
TIOV2OSH Port Input Valid to OSC1↑ (I/O in setup time)
0
—
—
ns
20
TIOR
PIC18FXXXX
—
10
25
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
—
60
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
10
25
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
—
60
ns
Port Output Rise Time
20A
21
TIOF
Port Output Fall Time
21A
22†
TINP
INT pin High or Low Time
TCY
—
—
ns
23†
TRBP
RB7:RB4 Change INT High or Low Time
TCY
—
—
ns
24†
TRCP
RC7:RC4 Change INT High or Low Time
20
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
ns
† These parameters are asynchronous events not related to any internal clock edges.
Note 1: Measurements are taken in RC mode, where CLKO output is 4 x TOSC.
DS39635A-page 362
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-7:
PROGRAM MEMORY READ TIMING DIAGRAM
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
OSC1
AD<19:16>
BA0
Address
Address
Address
AD<15:0>
Data from External
150
151
Address
163
160
162
161
155
166
167
168
ALE
164
169
171
CE
171A
OE
165
Operating Conditions: 2.0V < VCC < 5.5V, -40°C < TA < +125°C unless otherwise stated.
TABLE 26-10: CLKO AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Param.
No
Symbol
Characteristics
Min
Typ
Max
Units
0.25 TCY – 10
—
—
ns
150
TadV2alL
Address Out Valid to ALE ↓ (address
setup time)
151
TalL2adl
ALE ↓ to Address Out Invalid (address hold
time)
5
—
—
ns
155
TalL2oeL
ALE ↓ to OE ↓
10
0.125 TCY
—
ns
160
TadZ2oeL
AD high-Z to OE ↓ (bus release to OE)
0
—
—
ns
0.125 TCY – 5
—
—
ns
20
—
—
ns
0
—
—
ns
161
ToeH2adD OE ↑ to AD Driven
162
TadV2oeH LS Data Valid before OE ↑ (data setup time)
163
ToeH2adl
OE ↑ to Data In Invalid (data hold time)
164
TalH2alL
ALE Pulse Width
165
ToeL2oeH OE Pulse Width
—
TCY
—
ns
0.5 TCY – 5
0.5 TCY
—
ns
166
TalH2alH
ALE ↑ to ALE ↑ (cycle time)
—
0.25 TCY
—
ns
167
Tacc
Address Valid to Data Valid
0.75 TCY – 25
—
—
ns
168
Toe
OE ↓ to Data Valid
—
0.5 TCY – 25
ns
169
TalL2oeH
ALE ↓ to OE ↑
0.625 TCY – 10
—
0.625 TCY + 10
ns
171
TalH2csL
Chip Enable Active to ALE ↓
0.25 TCY – 20
—
—
ns
171A
TubL2oeH AD Valid to Chip Enable Active
—
—
10
ns
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 363
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-8:
PROGRAM MEMORY WRITE TIMING DIAGRAM
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
OSC1
AD<19:16>
BA0
Address
Address
166
AD<15:0>
Data
Address
Address
153
150
156
151
ALE
171
CE
171A
154
WRH or
WRL
157A
157
UB or
LB
Operating Conditions: 2.0V < VCC < 5.5V, -40°C < TA < +125°C unless otherwise stated.
TABLE 26-11: PROGRAM MEMORY WRITE TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Param.
No
Symbol
Characteristics
Min
Typ
Max
Units
0.25 TCY – 10
—
—
ns
TadV2alL
Address Out Valid to ALE ↓ (address setup time)
151
TalL2adl
ALE ↓ to Address Out Invalid (address hold time)
5
—
—
ns
153
TwrH2adl
WRn ↑ to Data Out Invalid (data hold time)
5
—
—
ns
154
TwrL
WRn Pulse Width
156
TadV2wrH Data Valid before WRn ↑ (data setup time)
157
TbsV2wrL Byte Select Valid before WRn ↓ (byte select setup
time)
150
157A
TwrH2bsI
WRn ↑ to Byte Select Invalid (byte select hold time)
166
TalH2alH
ALE ↑ to ALE ↑ (cycle time)
171
TalH2csL Chip Enable Active to ALE ↓
171A
TubL2oeH AD Valid to Chip Enable Active
DS39635A-page 364
Preliminary
0.5 TCY – 5
0.5 TCY
—
ns
0.5 TCY – 10
—
—
ns
0.25 TCY
—
—
ns
0.125 TCY – 5
—
—
ns
—
0.25 TCY
—
ns
0.25 TCY – 20
—
—
ns
—
—
10
ns
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-9:
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND
POWER-UP TIMER TIMING
VDD
MCLR
30
Internal
POR
33
PWRT
Time-out
32
OSC
Time-out
Internal
Reset
Watchdog
Timer
Reset
31
34
34
I/O pins
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
FIGURE 26-10:
BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING
BVDD
VDD
35
VBGAP = 1.2V
VIRVST
Enable Internal
Reference Voltage
Internal Reference
Voltage Stable
36
TABLE 26-12: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER
AND BROWN-OUT RESET REQUIREMENTS
Param.
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
30
TMCL
MCLR Pulse Width (low)
2
—
—
µs
31
TWDT
Watchdog Timer Time-out Period
(no postscaler)
—
4.00
TBD
ms
32
TOST
Oscillation Start-up Timer Period
1024 TOSC
—
1024 TOSC
—
33
TPWRT
Power-up Timer Period
—
65.5
TBD
ms
34
TIOZ
I/O High-Impedance from MCLR
Low or Watchdog Timer Reset
—
2
—
µs
200
—
—
µs
—
20
50
µs
—
—
µs
—
10
µs
—
ms
35
TBOR
Brown-out Reset Pulse Width
36
TIVRST
Time for Internal Reference
Voltage to become stable
37
TLVD
Low-Voltage Detect Pulse Width
200
38
TCSD
CPU Start-up Time
5
39
TIOBST
Time for INTRC Block to stabilize
—
1
Conditions
TOSC = OSC1 period
VDD ≤ BVDD (see D005)
VDD ≤ VLVD
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 365
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-11:
TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS
T0CKI
41
40
42
T1OSO/T13CKI
46
45
47
48
TMR0 or
TMR1
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-13: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
40
TT0H
T0CKI High Pulse Width
41
TT0L
T0CKI Low Pulse Width
42
TT0P
T0CKI Period
No prescaler
With prescaler
No prescaler
With prescaler
45
TT1H
ns
10
—
ns
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
ns
ns
With prescaler
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
—
ns
T13CKI
Synchronous, no prescaler
High Time Synchronous,
PIC18FXXXX
with prescaler
PIC18LFXXXX
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
10
—
ns
25
—
ns
30
—
ns
PIC18FXXXX
T13CKI
Low Time
Synchronous, no prescaler
Synchronous,
with prescaler
50
—
ns
0.5 TCY + 5
—
ns
PIC18FXXXX
10
—
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
25
—
ns
Conditions
N = prescale
value
(1, 2, 4,..., 256)
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
PIC18FXXXX
30
—
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
50
—
ns
VDD = 2.0V
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
—
ns
N = prescale
value
(1, 2, 4, 8)
TT1P
T13CKI
Input
Period
FT 1
T13CKI Oscillator Input Frequency Range
Synchronous
TCKE2TMRI Delay from External T13CKI Clock Edge to
Timer Increment
DS39635A-page 366
—
—
Asynchronous
48
0.5 TCY + 20
—
Asynchronous
47
Units
10
No prescaler
PIC18LFXXXX
TT1L
Max
TCY + 10
Asynchronous
46
Min
Preliminary
60
—
ns
DC
50
kHz
2 TOSC
7 TOSC
—
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-12:
CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM TIMINGS (ALL CCP MODULES)
CCPx
(Capture Mode)
50
51
52
CCPx
(Compare or PWM Mode)
54
53
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-14: CAPTURE/COMPARE/PWM REQUIREMENTS (ALL CCP MODULES)
Param
Symbol
No.
50
51
TCCL
TCCH
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
CCPx Input Low No prescaler
Time
With
PIC18FXXXX
prescaler PIC18LFXXXX
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
10
—
ns
20
—
ns
CCPx Input
High Time
0.5 TCY + 20
—
ns
No prescaler
With
prescaler
52
TCCP
CCPx Input Period
53
TCCR
CCPx Output Fall Time
54
TCCF
CCPx Output Fall Time
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Conditions
VDD = 2.0V
PIC18FXXXX
10
—
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
20
—
ns
VDD = 2.0V
3 TCY + 40
N
—
ns
N = prescale
value (1, 4 or 16)
PIC18FXXXX
—
25
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
45
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
25
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
45
ns
Preliminary
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
DS39635A-page 367
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-13:
EXAMPLE SPI MASTER MODE TIMING (CKE = 0)
SS
70
SCK
(CKP = 0)
71
72
78
79
79
78
SCK
(CKP = 1)
80
bit 6 - - - - - - 1
MSb
SDO
LSb
75, 76
SDI
MSb In
bit 6 - - - - 1
LSb In
74
73
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-15: EXAMPLE SPI MODE REQUIREMENTS (MASTER MODE, CKE = 0)
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
70
TSSL2SCH,
TSSL2SCL
SS ↓ to SCK ↓ or SCK ↑ Input
71
TSCH
SCK Input High Time
(Slave mode)
SCK Input Low Time
(Slave mode)
71A
72
TSCL
72A
—
ns
Continuous
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
Single Byte
40
—
ns
Continuous
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
Single Byte
40
—
ns
100
—
ns
1.5 TCY + 40
—
ns
100
—
ns
—
25
ns
TDIV2SCH,
TDIV2SCL
Setup Time of SDI Data Input to SCK Edge
73A
TB2B
Last Clock Edge of Byte 1 to the 1st Clock Edge
of Byte 2
74
TSCH2DIL,
TSCL2DIL
Hold Time of SDI Data Input to SCK Edge
75
TDOR
SDO Data Output Rise Time
76
TDOF
SDO Data Output Fall Time
78
TSCR
SCK Output Rise Time
(Master mode)
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
79
TSCF
TSCH2DOV, SDO Data Output Valid after
TSCL2DOV SCK Edge
Note 1:
2:
Max Units
TCY
73
80
Min
—
45
ns
—
25
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
25
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
45
ns
SCK Output Fall Time (Master mode)
—
25
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
50
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
100
ns
Conditions
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
Requires the use of Parameter #73A.
Only if Parameter #71A and #72A are used.
DS39635A-page 368
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-14:
EXAMPLE SPI MASTER MODE TIMING (CKE = 1)
SS
81
SCK
(CKP = 0)
71
72
79
73
SCK
(CKP = 1)
80
78
MSb
SDO
bit 6 - - - - - - 1
LSb
bit 6 - - - - 1
LSb In
75, 76
SDI
MSb In
74
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-16: EXAMPLE SPI MODE REQUIREMENTS (MASTER MODE, CKE = 1)
Param.
No.
71
Symbol
TSCH
71A
72
TSCL
72A
Characteristic
Max Units
SCK Input High Time
(Slave mode)
Continuous
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
Single Byte
40
—
ns
SCK Input Low Time
(Slave mode)
Continuous
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
Single Byte
40
—
ns
100
—
ns
1.5 TCY + 40
—
ns
100
—
ns
—
25
ns
73
TDIV2SCH,
TDIV2SCL
Setup Time of SDI Data Input to SCK Edge
73A
TB2B
Last Clock Edge of Byte 1 to the 1st Clock Edge
of Byte 2
74
TSCH2DIL,
TSCL2DIL
Hold Time of SDI Data Input to SCK Edge
75
TDOR
SDO Data Output Rise Time
76
TDOF
SDO Data Output Fall Time
78
TSCR
SCK Output Rise Time
(Master mode)
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
—
45
ns
—
25
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
25
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
45
ns
79
TSCF
80
TSCH2DOV, SDO Data Output Valid after
TSCL2DOV SCK Edge
81
TDOV2SCH, SDO Data Output Setup to SCK Edge
TDOV2SCL
Note 1:
2:
Min
SCK Output Fall Time (Master mode)
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
—
25
ns
—
50
ns
—
100
ns
TCY
—
ns
Conditions
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
Requires the use of Parameter #73A.
Only if Parameter #71A and #72A are used.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 369
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-15:
EXAMPLE SPI SLAVE MODE TIMING (CKE = 0)
SS
70
SCK
(CKP = 0)
83
71
72
78
79
79
78
SCK
(CKP = 1)
80
MSb
SDO
bit 6 - - - - - - 1
LSb
75, 76
MSb In
SDI
77
bit 6 - - - - 1
LSb In
74
73
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-17: EXAMPLE SPI MODE REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE TIMING, CKE = 0)
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
70
TSSL2SCH, SS ↓ to SCK ↓ or SCK ↑ Input
TSSL2SCL
71
TSCH
SCK Input High Time
(Slave mode)
TSCL
SCK Input Low Time
(Slave mode)
71A
72
72A
Min
Continuous
—
ns
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
40
—
ns
Continuous
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
Single Byte
40
—
ns
100
—
ns
—
ns
100
—
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
25
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
45
ns
—
25
ns
10
50
ns
—
25
ns
TDIV2SCH, Setup Time of SDI Data Input to SCK Edge
TDIV2SCL
73A
TB2B
74
TSCH2DIL, Hold Time of SDI Data Input to SCK Edge
TSCL2DIL
75
TDOR
SDO Data Output Rise Time
76
TDOF
SDO Data Output Fall Time
Last Clock Edge of Byte 1 to the First Clock Edge of Byte 2 1.5 TCY + 40
77
TSSH2DOZ SS ↑ to SDO Output High-impedance
78
TSCR
SCK Output Rise Time (Master mode)
79
TSCF
SCK Output Fall Time (Master mode)
80
TSCH2DOV, SDO Data Output Valid after SCK Edge PIC18FXXXX
TSCL2DOV
PIC18LFXXXX
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
Note 1:
2:
TCY
Single Byte
73
83
Max Units Conditions
TSCH2SSH, SS ↑ after SCK Edge
TSCL2SSH
—
45
ns
—
25
ns
—
50
ns
—
100
ns
1.5 TCY + 40
—
ns
(Note 1)
(Note 1)
(Note 2)
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
Requires the use of Parameter #73A.
Only if Parameter #71A and #72A are used.
DS39635A-page 370
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-16:
EXAMPLE SPI SLAVE MODE TIMING (CKE = 1)
82
SS
SCK
(CKP = 0)
70
83
71
72
SCK
(CKP = 1)
80
MSb
SDO
bit 6 - - - - - - 1
LSb
75, 76
SDI
MSb In
Note:
77
bit 6 - - - - 1
LSb In
74
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-18: EXAMPLE SPI SLAVE MODE REQUIREMENTS (CKE = 1)
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
70
TSSL2SCH, SS ↓ to SCK ↓ or SCK ↑ Input
TSSL2SCL
71
TSCH
SCK Input High Time
(Slave mode)
TSCL
SCK Input Low Time
(Slave mode)
73A
TB2B
Last Clock Edge of Byte 1 to the First Clock Edge of Byte 2 1.5 TCY + 40
74
TSCH2DIL, Hold Time of SDI Data Input to SCK Edge
TSCL2DIL
75
TDOR
SDO Data Output Rise Time
76
TDOF
SDO Data Output Fall Time
77
78
71A
72
72A
Max Units Conditions
TCY
—
ns
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
Single Byte
40
—
ns
Continuous
1.25 TCY + 30
—
ns
Single Byte
40
—
ns
(Note 1)
—
ns
(Note 2)
100
—
ns
—
25
ns
Continuous
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
—
45
ns
—
25
ns
TSSH2DOZ SS↑ to SDO Output High-Impedance
10
50
ns
TSCR
SCK Output Rise Time
(Master mode)
—
25
ns
79
TSCF
SCK Output Fall Time (Master mode)
80
TSCH2DOV, SDO Data Output Valid after SCK
TSCL2DOV Edge
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
82
TSSL2DOV SDO Data Output Valid after SS ↓
Edge
83
TSCH2SSH, SS ↑ after SCK Edge
TSCL2SSH
Note 1:
2:
—
45
ns
—
25
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
50
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
100
ns
PIC18FXXXX
—
50
ns
—
100
ns
1.5 TCY + 40
—
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
(Note 1)
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
Requires the use of Parameter #73A.
Only if Parameter #71A and #72A are used.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 371
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-17:
I2C BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING
SCL
91
93
90
92
SDA
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-19: I2C BUS START/STOP BITS REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE)
Param.
Symbol
No.
90
91
92
93
TSU:STA
THD:STA
TSU:STO
Characteristic
Max
Units
Conditions
ns
Only relevant for Repeated
Start condition
ns
After this period, the first
clock pulse is generated
Start Condition
100 kHz mode
4700
—
Setup Time
400 kHz mode
600
—
Start Condition
100 kHz mode
4000
—
Hold Time
400 kHz mode
600
—
Stop Condition
100 kHz mode
4700
—
Setup Time
400 kHz mode
600
—
100 kHz mode
4000
—
400 kHz mode
600
—
THD:STO Stop Condition
Hold Time
FIGURE 26-18:
Min
ns
ns
I2C BUS DATA TIMING
103
102
100
101
SCL
90
106
107
91
92
SDA
In
110
109
109
SDA
Out
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
DS39635A-page 372
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 26-20: I2C BUS DATA REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE)
Param.
No.
100
Symbol
THIGH
Characteristic
Clock High Time
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
100 kHz mode
4.0
—
µs
PIC18FXXXX must operate at
a minimum of 1.5 MHz
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
µs
PIC18FXXXX must operate at
a minimum of 10 MHz
1.5 TCY
—
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
µs
PIC18FXXXX must operate at
a minimum of 1.5 MHz
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
µs
PIC18FXXXX must operate at
a minimum of 10 MHz
SSP Module
101
TLOW
Clock Low Time
1.5 TCY
—
100 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
SSP Module
102
TR
103
TF
TSU:STA
90
THD:STA
91
THD:DAT
106
TSU:DAT
107
TSU:STO
92
109
TAA
110
TBUF
D102
CB
Note 1:
2:
SDA and SCL Rise Time
SDA and SCL Fall Time
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
100 kHz mode
—
300
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
Start Condition Setup Time 100 kHz mode
4.7
—
µs
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
µs
Only relevant for Repeated
Start condition
Start Condition Hold Time
Data Input Hold Time
Data Input Setup Time
100 kHz mode
4.0
—
µs
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
µs
100 kHz mode
0
—
ns
400 kHz mode
0
0.9
µs
100 kHz mode
250
—
ns
400 kHz mode
100
—
ns
Stop Condition Setup Time 100 kHz mode
4.7
—
µs
400 kHz mode
0.6
—
µs
Output Valid from Clock
Bus Free Time
Bus Capacitive Loading
100 kHz mode
—
3500
ns
400 kHz mode
—
—
ns
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
µs
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
µs
—
400
pF
After this period, the first clock
pulse is generated
(Note 2)
(Note 1)
Time the bus must be free
before a new transmission can
start
As a transmitter, the device must provide this internal minimum delay time to bridge the undefined region (min. 300 ns)
of the falling edge of SCL to avoid unintended generation of Start or Stop conditions.
A Fast mode I2C bus device can be used in a Standard mode I2C bus system, but the requirement, TSU:DAT ≥ 250 ns,
must then be met. This will automatically be the case if the device does not stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal. If
such a device does stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal, it must output the next data bit to the SDA line,
TR max. + TSU:DAT = 1000 + 250 = 1250 ns (according to the Standard mode I2C bus specification), before the SCL line
is released.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 373
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-19:
MASTER SSP I2C BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING WAVEFORMS
SCL
93
91
90
92
SDA
Stop
Condition
Start
Condition
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-21: MASTER SSP I2C BUS START/STOP BITS REQUIREMENTS
Param.
Symbol
No.
90
TSU:STA
Characteristic
After this period, the
first clock pulse is
generated
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
1 MHz mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
Stop Condition
100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
Setup Time
400 kHz mode
THD:STO Stop Condition
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
1 MHz mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
2C
Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I
FIGURE 26-20:
ns
Setup Time
Hold Time
Note 1:
Only relevant for
Repeated Start
condition
—
1 MHz
93
ns
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
Hold Time
92
Units
100 kHz mode
THD:STA Start Condition
TSU:STO
Max
Start Condition
1 MHz
91
Min
Conditions
ns
ns
pins.
MASTER SSP I2C BUS DATA TIMING
103
102
100
101
SCL
90
106
91
107
92
SDA
In
109
109
110
SDA
Out
Note:
DS39635A-page 374
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 26-22: MASTER SSP I2C BUS DATA REQUIREMENTS
Param.
Symbol
No.
100
101
THIGH
TLOW
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
1 MHz mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
Clock Low Time 100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
(1)
Clock High Time 100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
100 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(1)
—
300
ns
1 MHz mode
102
103
90
91
106
107
92
109
110
D102
TR
TF
TSU:STA
SDA and SCL
Rise Time
SDA and SCL
Fall Time
Start Condition
Setup Time
THD:STA Start Condition
Hold Time
THD:DAT Data Input
Hold Time
TSU:DAT
Data Input
Setup Time
TSU:STO Stop Condition
Setup Time
TAA
TBUF
CB
Output Valid
from Clock
Bus Free Time
100 kHz mode
—
300
ns
400 kHz mode
20 + 0.1 CB
300
ns
1 MHz mode(1)
—
100
ns
100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
1 MHz mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
1 MHz mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
100 kHz mode
0
—
ns
400 kHz mode
0
0.9
ms
1 MHz mode(1)
TBD
—
ns
100 kHz mode
250
—
ns
400 kHz mode
100
—
ns
1 MHz mode(1)
TBD
—
ns
100 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
400 kHz mode
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
1 MHz mode(1)
2(TOSC)(BRG + 1)
—
ms
100 kHz mode
—
3500
ns
400 kHz mode
—
1000
ns
(1)
1 MHz mode
—
—
ns
100 kHz mode
4.7
—
ms
400 kHz mode
1.3
—
ms
1 MHz mode(1)
TBD
—
ms
—
400
pF
Bus Capacitive Loading
Conditions
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
CB is specified to be from
10 to 400 pF
Only relevant for
Repeated Start
condition
After this period, the first
clock pulse is generated
(Note 2)
Time the bus must be free
before a new transmission
can start
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined
Note 1: Maximum pin capacitance = 10 pF for all I2C pins.
2: A Fast mode I2C bus device can be used in a Standard mode I2C bus system, but parameter #107 ≥ 250 ns
must then be met. This will automatically be the case if the device does not stretch the LOW period of the
SCL signal. If such a device does stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal, it must output the next data bit
to the SDA line, parameter #102 + parameter #107 = 1000 + 250 = 1250 ns (for 100 kHz mode,) before the
SCL line is released.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 375
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-21:
USART SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (MASTER/SLAVE) TIMING
RC6/TX1/CK1
pin
121
121
RC7/RX1/DT1
pin
120
Note:
122
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-23: USART SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
TCKH2DTV SYNC XMIT (MASTER and SLAVE)
Clock High to Data Out Valid
PIC18FXXXX
120
Min
Max
Units
—
40
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
100
ns
121
TCKRF
Clock Out Rise Time and Fall Time
(Master mode)
PIC18FXXXX
—
20
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
50
ns
122
TDTRF
Data Out Rise Time and Fall Time
PIC18FXXXX
—
20
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
—
50
ns
FIGURE 26-22:
RC6/TX1/CK1
pin
Conditions
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
USART SYNCHRONOUS RECEIVE (MASTER/SLAVE) TIMING
125
RC7/RX1/DT1
pin
126
Note:
Refer to Figure 26-4 for load conditions.
TABLE 26-24: USART SYNCHRONOUS RECEIVE REQUIREMENTS
Param.
No.
125
126
Symbol
Characteristic
TDTV2CKL SYNC RCV (MASTER and SLAVE)
Data Hold before CK ↓ (DT hold time)
TCKL2DTL
DS39635A-page 376
Data Hold after CK ↓ (DT hold time)
Preliminary
Min
Max
Units
10
—
ns
15
—
ns
Conditions
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
TABLE 26-25: A/D CONVERTER CHARACTERISTICS: PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 (INDUSTRIAL)
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410 (INDUSTRIAL)
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
—
—
10
bit
Conditions
∆VREF ≥ 3.0V
A01
NR
Resolution
A03
EIL
Integral Linearity Error
—
—
<±1
LSb ∆VREF ≥ 3.0V
A04
EDL
Differential Linearity Error
—
—
<±1
LSb ∆VREF ≥ 3.0V
A06
EOFF
Offset Error
—
—
<±1
LSb ∆VREF ≥ 3.0V
A07
EGN
Gain Error
—
—
<±1
LSb ∆VREF ≥ 3.0V
A10
—
Monotonicity
A20
∆VREF
Reference Voltage Range
(VREFH – VREFL)
A21
VREFH
A22
Guaranteed(1)
—
3
—
AVDD – AVSS
V
For 10-bit resolution
Reference Voltage High
AVSS + 3.0V
—
AVDD + 0.3V
V
For 10-bit resolution
VREFL
Reference Voltage Low
AVSS – 0.3V
—
AVDD – 3.0V
V
For 10-bit resolution
A25
VAIN
Analog Input Voltage
VREFL
—
VREFH
V
A28
AVDD
Analog Supply Voltage
VDD – 0.3
—
VDD + 0.3
V
A29
AVSS
Analog Supply Voltage
VSS – 0.3
—
VSS + 0.3
V
A30
ZAIN
Recommended Impedance of
Analog Voltage Source
—
—
2.5
kΩ
A40
IAD
A/D Conversion PIC18FXXXX
Current (VDD)
—
180
—
µA
Average current
consumption when
A/D is on (Note 2)
—
90
—
µA
VDD = 2.0V;
Average current
consumption when
A/D is on (Note 2)
—
—
—
—
±5
±150
µA
µA
During VAIN acquisition.
During A/D conversion
cycle.
PIC18LFXXXX
A50
IREF
Note 1:
2:
3:
VREF Input Current (Note 3)
The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing codes.
When A/D is off, it will not consume any current other than minor leakage current. The power-down current
spec includes any such leakage from the A/D module.
VREFH current is from RA3/AN3/VREF+ pin or AVDD, whichever is selected as the VREFH source.
VREFL current is from RA2/AN2/VREF- pin or AVSS, whichever is selected as the VREFL source.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 377
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
FIGURE 26-23:
A/D CONVERSION TIMING
BSF ADCON0, GO
(Note 2)
131
Q4
130
132
A/D CLK
9
A/D DATA
8
7
...
...
2
1
0
NEW_DATA
OLD_DATA
ADRES
TCY
ADIF
GO
DONE
SAMPLING STOPPED
SAMPLE
Note
1:
If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts.
This allows the SLEEP instruction to be executed.
2:
This is a minimal RC delay (typically 100 ns), which also disconnects the holding capacitor from the analog input.
TABLE 26-26: A/D CONVERSION REQUIREMENTS
Param
Symbol
No.
130
TAD
Characteristic
A/D Clock Period
Min
Max
0.7
25.0(1)
µs
TOSC based, VREF ≥ 3.0V
PIC18LFXXXX
TBD
TBD
µs
VDD = 2.0V;
TOSC based, VREF full range
PIC18FXXXX
TBD
TBD
µs
A/D RC mode
PIC18LFXXXX
TBD
TBD
µs
VDD = 2.0V;
A/D RC mode
11
12
TAD
1.4
TBD
—
—
µs
µs
PIC18FXXXX
131
TCNV
Conversion Time
(not including acquisition time) (Note 2)
132
TACQ
Acquisition Time (Note 3)
135
TSWC
Switching Time from Convert → Sample
—
(Note 4)
TBD
TDIS
Discharge Time
0.2
—
Legend:
Note 1:
2:
3:
4:
Units
Conditions
-40°C to +85°C
0°C ≤ to ≤ +85°C
µs
TBD = To Be Determined
The time of the A/D clock period is dependent on the device frequency and the TAD clock divider.
ADRES register may be read on the following TCY cycle.
The time for the holding capacitor to acquire the “New” input voltage when the voltage changes full scale
after the conversion (AVDD to AVSS or AVSS to AVDD). The source impedance (RS) on the input channels is
50Ω.
On the following cycle of the device clock.
DS39635A-page 378
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
27.0
DC AND AC
CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS
AND TABLES
Graphs and Tables are not available at this time.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 379
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 380
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
28.0
PACKAGING INFORMATION
28.1
Package Marking Information
64-Lead TQFP
Example
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
PIC18F6410
-I/PT
0410017
Example
80-Lead TQFP
XXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
Legend: XX...X
Y
YY
WW
NNN
Note:
*
PIC18F8410-E
/PT
0410017
Customer specific information*
Year code (last digit of calendar year)
Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year)
Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’)
Alphanumeric traceability code
In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will
be carried over to the next line thus limiting the number of available characters
for customer specific information.
Standard PICmicro device marking consists of Microchip part number, year code, week code and
traceability code. For PICmicro device marking beyond this, certain price adders apply. Please check
with your Microchip Sales Office. For QTP devices, any special marking adders are included in QTP
price.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 381
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
28.2
Package Details
The following sections give the technical details of the
packages.
64-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) 10x10x1 mm Body, 1.0/0.10 mm Lead Form (TQFP)
E
E1
#leads=n1
p
D1
D
2
1
B
n
CH x 45°
α
A
c
φ
L
β
A2
A1
(F)
Units
Dimension Limits
n
p
MIN
INCHES
NOM
64
.020
16
.043
.039
.006
.024
.039
3.5
.472
.472
.394
.394
.007
.009
.035
10
10
MAX
MILLIMETERS*
NOM
64
0.50
16
1.00
1.10
0.95
1.00
0.05
0.15
0.45
0.60
1.00
0
3.5
11.75
12.00
11.75
12.00
9.90
10.00
9.90
10.00
0.13
0.18
0.17
0.22
0.64
0.89
5
10
5
10
MIN
Number of Pins
Pitch
Pins per Side
n1
Overall Height
A
.039
.047
Molded Package Thickness
A2
.037
.041
Standoff
A1
.002
.010
Foot Length
L
.018
.030
(F)
Footprint (Reference)
φ
Foot Angle
0
7
Overall Width
E
.463
.482
Overall Length
D
.463
.482
Molded Package Width
E1
.390
.398
Molded Package Length
D1
.390
.398
c
Lead Thickness
.005
.009
Lead Width
B
.007
.011
Pin 1 Corner Chamfer
CH
.025
.045
α
Mold Draft Angle Top
5
15
β
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
5
15
*Controlling Parameter
Notes:
Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions
shall not exceed .010" (0.254mm) per side.
MAX
1.20
1.05
0.25
0.75
7
12.25
12.25
10.10
10.10
0.23
0.27
1.14
15
15
JEDEC Equivalent: MS-026
Drawing No. C04-085
DS39635A-page 382
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
80-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) 12x12x1 mm Body, 1.0/0.10 mm Lead Form (TQFP)
E
E1
#leads=n1
p
D1
D
2
1
B
n
CH x 45°
A
α
c
φ
β
L
A2
A1
(F)
Units
Dimension Limits
n
p
MIN
INCHES
NOM
80
.020
20
.043
.039
.004
.024
.039
3.5
.551
.551
.472
.472
.006
.009
.035
10
10
MAX
MILLIMETERS*
NOM
80
0.50
20
1.00
1.10
0.95
1.00
0.05
0.10
0.45
0.60
1.00
0
3.5
13.75
14.00
13.75
14.00
11.75
12.00
11.75
12.00
0.09
0.15
0.17
0.22
0.64
0.89
5
10
5
10
MIN
Number of Pins
Pitch
Pins per Side
n1
Overall Height
A
.047
.039
Molded Package Thickness
A2
.037
.041
Standoff
A1
.002
.006
Foot Length
L
.018
.030
(F)
Footprint (Reference)
φ
Foot Angle
0
7
Overall Width
E
.541
.561
Overall Length
D
.541
.561
Molded Package Width
E1
.463
.482
Molded Package Length
D1
.463
.482
c
Lead Thickness
.004
.008
Lead Width
B
.007
.011
Pin 1 Corner Chamfer
CH
.025
.045
α
Mold Draft Angle Top
5
15
β
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
5
15
*Controlling Parameter
Notes:
Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions
shall not exceed .010" (0.254mm) per side.
MAX
1.20
1.05
0.15
0.75
7
14.25
14.25
12.25
12.25
0.20
0.27
1.14
15
15
JEDEC Equivalent: MS-026
Drawing No. C04-092
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 383
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 384
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
APPENDIX A:
REVISION HISTORY
APPENDIX B:
Revision A (June 2004)
Original data sheet for PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
devices.
TABLE B-1:
DEVICE
DIFFERENCES
The differences between the devices listed in this data
sheet are shown in Table B-1.
DEVICE DIFFERENCES
Features
Program Memory (Bytes)
Program Memory (Instructions)
External Memory Interface
I/O Ports
Packages
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310
PIC18F6410
PIC18F8310
PIC18F8410
8K
16K
8K
16K
4096
8192
4096
8192
No
No
Yes
Yes
Ports A, B, C, D, E, Ports A, B, C, D, E, Ports A, B, C, D, E, Ports A, B, C, D, E,
F, G
F, G
F, G, H, J
F, G, H, J
64-pin TQFP
64-pin TQFP
Preliminary
80-pin TQFP
80-pin TQFP
DS39635A-page 385
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
APPENDIX C:
CONVERSION
CONSIDERATIONS
APPENDIX D:
This appendix discusses the considerations for
converting from previous versions of a device to the
ones listed in this data sheet. Typically, these changes
are due to the differences in the process technology
used. An example of this type of conversion is from a
PIC16C74A to a PIC16C74B.
Not Applicable
DS39635A-page 386
MIGRATION FROM
BASELINE TO
ENHANCED DEVICES
This section discusses how to migrate from a Baseline
device (i.e., PIC16C5X) to an Enhanced MCU device
(i.e., PIC18FXXX).
The following are the list of modifications over the
PIC16C5X microcontroller family:
Not Currently Available
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
APPENDIX E:
MIGRATION FROM
MID-RANGE TO
ENHANCED DEVICES
A detailed discussion of the differences between the
mid-range MCU devices (i.e., PIC16CXXX) and the
enhanced devices (i.e., PIC18FXXX) is provided in
AN716, “Migrating Designs from PIC16C74A/74B to
PIC18C442”. The changes discussed, while device
specific, are generally applicable to all mid-range to
enhanced device migrations.
APPENDIX F:
MIGRATION FROM
HIGH-END TO
ENHANCED DEVICES
A detailed discussion of the migration pathway and
differences between the high-end MCU devices (i.e.,
PIC17CXXX) and the enhanced devices (i.e.,
PIC18FXXX) is provided in AN726, “PIC17CXXX to
PIC18CXXX Migration”. This Application Note is
available as Literature Number DS00726.
This Application Note is available as Literature Number
DS00716.
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 387
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
NOTES:
DS39635A-page 388
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
INDEX
A
A/D ................................................................................... 245
A/D Converter Interrupt, Configuring ....................... 249
Acquisition Requirements ........................................ 250
ADCON0 Register .................................................... 245
ADCON1 Register .................................................... 245
ADCON2 Register .................................................... 245
ADRESH Register ............................................ 245, 248
ADRESL Register .................................................... 245
Analog Port Pins ...................................................... 140
Analog Port Pins, Configuring .................................. 252
Associated Registers ............................................... 254
Automatic Acquisition Time ...................................... 251
Calculating the Minimum Required
Acquisition Time .............................................. 250
Configuring the Module ............................................ 249
Conversion Clock (TAD) ........................................... 251
Conversion Status (GO/DONE Bit) .......................... 248
Conversions ............................................................. 253
Converter Characteristics ........................................ 377
Discharge ................................................................. 253
Operation in Power Managed Modes ...................... 252
Special Event Trigger (CCP) .................................... 254
Use of the CCP2 Trigger .......................................... 254
Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................. 343
AC (Timing) Characteristics ............................................. 358
Load Conditions for Device
Timing Specifications ....................................... 359
Parameter Symbology ............................................. 358
Temperature and Voltage Specifications ................. 359
Timing Conditions .................................................... 359
Access Bank ...................................................................... 71
ACKSTAT ........................................................................ 199
ACKSTAT Status Flag ..................................................... 199
ADCON0 Register ............................................................ 245
GO/DONE Bit ........................................................... 248
ADCON1 Register ............................................................ 245
ADCON2 Register ............................................................ 245
ADDFSR .......................................................................... 330
ADDLW ............................................................................ 293
Addressable Universal Synchronous
Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (AUSART).
See AUSART.
ADDULNK ........................................................................ 330
ADDWF ............................................................................ 293
ADDWFC ......................................................................... 294
ADRESH Register ............................................................ 245
ADRESL Register .................................................... 245, 248
Analog-to-Digital Converter. See A/D.
ANDLW ............................................................................ 294
ANDWF ............................................................................ 295
Assembler
MPASM Assembler .................................................. 337
AUSART
Asynchronous Mode ................................................ 236
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 239
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 237
Receiver ........................................................... 238
Setting up 9-bit Mode with Address Detect ...... 238
Transmitter ....................................................... 236
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Baud Rate Generator (BRG) ................................... 234
Associated Registers ....................................... 234
Baud Rate Error, Calculating ........................... 234
Baud Rates, Asynchronous Modes ................. 235
High Baud Rate Select (BRGH Bit) ................. 234
Operation in Power Managed Modes .............. 234
Sampling ......................................................... 234
Synchronous Master Mode ...................................... 240
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 242
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 241
Reception ........................................................ 242
Transmission ................................................... 240
Synchronous Slave Mode ........................................ 243
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 244
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 243
Reception ........................................................ 244
Transmission ................................................... 243
Auto-Wake-up on Sync Break Character ......................... 222
B
Bank Select Register (BSR) .............................................. 69
Baud Rate Generator ...................................................... 195
BC .................................................................................... 295
BCF ................................................................................. 296
BF .................................................................................... 199
BF Status Flag ................................................................. 199
Block Diagrams
16-Bit Byte Select Mode ............................................ 93
16-Bit Byte Write Mode .............................................. 91
16-Bit Word Write Mode ............................................ 92
8-Bit Multiplexed Mode .............................................. 96
A/D ........................................................................... 248
Analog Input Model .................................................. 249
AUSART Receive .................................................... 238
AUSART Transmit ................................................... 236
Baud Rate Generator .............................................. 195
Capture Mode Operation ......................................... 161
Comparator
I/O Operating Modes ....................................... 256
Comparator Analog Input Model .............................. 259
Comparator Output .................................................. 258
Comparator Voltage Reference ............................... 262
Compare Mode Operation ....................................... 163
Device Clock .............................................................. 34
EUSART Receive .................................................... 220
EUSART Transmit ................................................... 218
External Power-on Reset Circuit
(Slow VDD Power-up) ........................................ 51
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ........................................... 282
Generic I/O Port Operation ...................................... 117
High/Low-Voltage Detect with
External Input .................................................. 266
Interrupt Logic .......................................................... 102
MSSP (I2C Master Mode) ........................................ 193
MSSP (I2C Mode) .................................................... 178
MSSP (SPI Mode) ................................................... 169
On-Chip Reset Circuit ................................................ 49
PIC18F6310/6410 ..................................................... 10
PIC18F8310/8410 ..................................................... 11
PLL (HS Mode) .......................................................... 31
PORTD and PORTE (Parallel Slave Port) ............... 140
PWM Operation (Simplified) .................................... 165
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 389
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Reads from Program Memory .................................... 86
Single Comparator ................................................... 257
Table Read and Table Write Operations ................... 85
Timer0 in 16-Bit Mode .............................................. 144
Timer0 in 8-Bit Mode ................................................ 144
Timer1 ...................................................................... 148
Timer1 (16-Bit Read/Write Mode) ............................ 148
Timer2 ...................................................................... 154
Timer3 ...................................................................... 156
Timer3 (16-Bit Read/Write Mode) ............................ 156
Voltage Reference Output Buffer
Example ........................................................... 263
Watchdog Timer ....................................................... 279
BN .................................................................................... 296
BNC .................................................................................. 297
BNN .................................................................................. 297
BNOV ............................................................................... 298
BNZ .................................................................................. 298
BOR. See Brown-out Reset.
BOV .................................................................................. 301
BRA .................................................................................. 299
Break Character (12-Bit) Transmit
and Receive ............................................................. 224
BRG. See Baud Rate Generator.
Brown-out Reset (BOR) ............................................. 52, 271
Detecting .................................................................... 52
Disabling in Sleep Mode ............................................ 52
Software Enabled ....................................................... 52
BSF .................................................................................. 299
BTFSC ............................................................................. 300
BTFSS .............................................................................. 300
BTG .................................................................................. 301
BZ ..................................................................................... 302
C
C Compilers
MPLAB C17 ............................................................. 338
MPLAB C18 ............................................................. 338
MPLAB C30 ............................................................. 338
CALL ................................................................................ 302
Capture (CCP Module) ..................................................... 161
Associated Registers ............................................... 164
CCP Pin Configuration ............................................. 161
CCPR2H:CCPR2L Registers ................................... 161
Software Interrupt .................................................... 162
Timer1/Timer3 Mode Selection ................................ 161
Capture/Compare/PWM (CCP) ........................................ 159
Capture Mode. See Capture.
CCP Mode and Timer Resources ............................ 160
CCPRxH Register .................................................... 160
CCPRxL Register ..................................................... 160
Compare Mode. See Compare.
Interconnect Configurations ..................................... 160
Module Configuration ............................................... 160
Clock Sources .................................................................... 34
Selecting the 31 kHz Source ...................................... 35
Selection Using OSCCON Register ........................... 35
CLRF ................................................................................ 303
CLRWDT .......................................................................... 303
DS39635A-page 390
Code Examples
16 x 16 Signed Multiply Routine .............................. 100
16 x 16 Unsigned Multiply Routine .......................... 100
8 x 8 Signed Multiply Routine .................................... 99
8 x 8 Unsigned Multiply Routine ................................ 99
Changing Between Capture Prescalers ................... 162
Computed GOTO Using an Offset Value ................... 66
Fast Register Stack ................................................... 66
How to Clear RAM (Bank 1) Using
Indirect Addressing ............................................ 78
Implementing a Real-Time Clock Using a
Timer1 Interrupt Service .................................. 151
Initializing PORTA .................................................... 117
Initializing PORTB .................................................... 120
Initializing PORTC ................................................... 123
Initializing PORTD ................................................... 126
Initializing PORTE .................................................... 129
Initializing PORTF .................................................... 132
Initializing PORTG ................................................... 134
Initializing PORTH ................................................... 136
Initializing PORTJ .................................................... 138
Loading the SSPBUF (SSPSR) Register ................. 172
Reading a Flash Program Memory Word .................. 87
Saving Status, WREG and
BSR Registers in RAM .................................... 116
Code Protection ............................................................... 271
COMF .............................................................................. 304
Comparator ...................................................................... 255
Analog Input Connection Considerations ................ 259
Associated Registers ............................................... 259
Configuration ........................................................... 256
Effects of a Reset .................................................... 258
Interrupts ................................................................. 258
Operation ................................................................. 257
Operation During Sleep ........................................... 258
Outputs .................................................................... 257
Reference ................................................................ 257
External Signal ................................................ 257
Internal Signal .................................................. 257
Response Time ........................................................ 257
Comparator Specifications ............................................... 356
Comparator Voltage Reference ....................................... 261
Accuracy and Error .................................................. 262
Associated Registers ............................................... 263
Configuring .............................................................. 261
Connection Considerations ...................................... 262
Effects of a Reset .................................................... 262
Operation During Sleep ........................................... 262
Compare (CCP Module) .................................................. 162
Associated Registers ............................................... 164
CCP Pin Configuration ............................................. 162
CCPR2 Register ...................................................... 162
Software Interrupt Mode .......................................... 162
Special Event Trigger .............................. 157, 162, 254
Timer1/Timer3 Mode Selection ................................ 162
Computed GOTO ............................................................... 66
Configuration Bits ............................................................ 271
Configuration Register Protection .................................... 284
Context Saving During Interrupts ..................................... 116
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Conversion Considerations .............................................. 386
CPFSEQ .......................................................................... 304
CPFSGT .......................................................................... 305
CPFSLT ........................................................................... 305
Crystal Oscillator/Ceramic Resonator ................................ 29
D
Data Addressing Modes ..................................................... 78
Comparing Addressing Modes with the
Extended Instruction Set Enabled ..................... 82
Direct .......................................................................... 78
Indexed Literal Offset ................................................. 81
Indirect ....................................................................... 78
Inherent and Literal .................................................... 78
Data Memory ..................................................................... 69
Access Bank .............................................................. 71
and the Extended Instruction Set ............................... 81
Bank Select Register (BSR) ....................................... 69
General Purpose Registers ........................................ 71
Map for PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Devices .............................................................. 70
Special Function Registers ........................................ 72
DAW ................................................................................. 306
DC and AC
Characteristics Graphs and Tables .......................... 379
DC Characteristics ........................................................... 353
Power-Down and Supply Current ............................ 346
Supply Voltage ......................................................... 345
DCFSNZ .......................................................................... 307
DECF ............................................................................... 306
DECFSZ ........................................................................... 307
Demonstration Boards
PICDEM 1 ................................................................ 340
PICDEM 17 .............................................................. 341
PICDEM 18R ........................................................... 341
PICDEM 2 Plus ........................................................ 340
PICDEM 3 ................................................................ 340
PICDEM 4 ................................................................ 340
PICDEM LIN ............................................................ 341
PICDEM USB ........................................................... 341
PICDEM.net Internet/Ethernet ................................. 340
Development Support ...................................................... 337
Device Differences ........................................................... 385
Device Overview .................................................................. 7
Features (table) ............................................................ 9
New Core Features ...................................................... 7
Direct Addressing ............................................................... 79
E
Effect on Standard PIC Instructions ................................. 334
Effects of Power Managed Modes on Various
Clock Sources ............................................................ 37
Electrical Characteristics .................................................. 343
Enhanced Universal Synchronous Asynchronous
Receiver Transmitter (EUSART). See EUSART.
Equations
A/D Acquisition Time ................................................ 250
A/D Minimum Charging Time ................................... 250
Errata ................................................................................... 5
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
EUSART
Asynchronous Mode ................................................ 218
12-bit Break Transmit and Receive ................. 224
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 221
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 219
Auto-Wake-up on Sync Break ......................... 222
Receiver .......................................................... 220
Setting up 9-Bit Mode with
Address Detect ........................................ 220
Transmitter ...................................................... 218
Baud Rate Generator (BRG) ................................... 213
Associated Registers ....................................... 213
Auto-Baud Rate Detect .................................... 216
Baud Rate Error, Calculating ........................... 213
Baud Rates, Asynchronous Modes ................. 214
High Baud Rate Select (BRGH Bit) ................. 213
Operation in Power Managed Modes .............. 213
Sampling ......................................................... 213
Synchronous Master Mode ...................................... 225
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 227
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 226
Reception ........................................................ 227
Transmission ................................................... 225
Synchronous Slave Mode ........................................ 228
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 229
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 228
Reception ........................................................ 229
Transmission ................................................... 228
Evaluation and Programming Tools ................................. 341
Extended Instruction Set
ADDFSR .................................................................. 330
ADDULNK ............................................................... 330
and Using MPLAB Tools ......................................... 336
CALLW .................................................................... 331
Considerations for Use ............................................ 334
MOVSF .................................................................... 331
MOVSS .................................................................... 332
PUSHL ..................................................................... 332
SUBFSR .................................................................. 333
SUBULNK ................................................................ 333
External Clock Input ........................................................... 30
External Memory Interface ................................................. 89
16-Bit Byte Select Mode ............................................ 93
16-Bit Byte Write Mode .............................................. 91
16-Bit Mode ............................................................... 91
16-Bit Mode Timing ................................................... 94
16-Bit Word Write Mode ............................................ 92
8-Bit Mode ................................................................. 96
8-Bit Mode Timing ..................................................... 97
and the Program Memory Modes .............................. 90
PIC18F8310/8410 External Bus,
I/O Port Functions .............................................. 90
F
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ........................................... 271, 282
Interrupts in Power Managed Modes ....................... 283
POR or Wake from Sleep ........................................ 283
WDT During Oscillator Failure ................................. 282
Fast Register Stack ........................................................... 66
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 391
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Firmware Instructions ....................................................... 287
Flash Program Memory
Associated Registers ................................................. 88
Operation During Code-Protect ................................. 88
Reading ...................................................................... 86
FSCM. See Fail-Safe Clock Monitor.
G
GOTO ............................................................................... 308
H
Hardware Multiplier ............................................................ 99
Introduction ................................................................ 99
Operation ................................................................... 99
Performance Comparison .......................................... 99
High/Low-Voltage Detect ................................................. 265
Associated Registers ............................................... 269
Characteristics ......................................................... 357
Current Consumption ............................................... 267
Effects of a Reset ..................................................... 269
Operation ................................................................. 266
During Sleep .................................................... 269
Start-up Time ................................................... 267
Setup ........................................................................ 267
Typical Application ................................................... 268
HLVD. See High/Low-Voltage Detect.
I
I/O Ports ........................................................................... 117
I2C Mode (MSSP)
Acknowledge Sequence Timing ............................... 202
Associated Registers ............................................... 208
Baud Rate Generator ............................................... 195
Bus Collision
During a Repeated Start Condition .................. 206
During a Start Condition ................................... 204
During a Stop Condition ................................... 207
Clock Arbitration ....................................................... 196
Clock Stretching ....................................................... 188
10-Bit Slave Receive Mode
(SEN = 1) ................................................. 188
7-Bit Slave Receive Mode
(SEN = 1) ................................................. 188
Effect of a Reset ...................................................... 203
General Call Address Support ................................. 192
I2C Clock Rate w/BRG ............................................. 195
Master Mode ............................................................ 193
Operation ......................................................... 194
Reception ......................................................... 199
Repeated Start Condition Timing ..................... 198
Start Condition ................................................. 197
Transmission .................................................... 199
Transmit Sequence .......................................... 194
Multi-Master Communication, Bus Collision
and Arbitration .................................................. 203
Multi-Master Mode ................................................... 203
Operation ................................................................. 182
Read/Write Bit Information (R/W Bit) ............... 182, 183
Registers .................................................................. 178
Serial Clock (RC3/SCK/SCL) ................................... 183
Slave Mode .............................................................. 182
Addressing ....................................................... 182
Reception ......................................................... 183
Sleep Operation ....................................................... 203
Stop Condition Timing .............................................. 202
Transmission ............................................................ 183
DS39635A-page 392
ID Locations ............................................................. 271, 285
Idle Modes
PRI_IDLE ................................................................... 44
INCF ................................................................................ 308
INCFSZ ............................................................................ 309
In-Circuit Debugger .......................................................... 285
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP) ...................... 271, 285
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
and Standard PIC18 Instructions ............................. 334
Indexed Literal Offset Mode ....................................... 81, 334
BSR ........................................................................... 83
Effect on Standard PIC18 Instructions ....................... 81
Mapping the Access Bank ......................................... 83
Indirect Addressing ............................................................ 79
INFSNZ ............................................................................ 309
Initialization Conditions for all Registers ...................... 57–60
Instruction Cycle ................................................................ 67
Clocking Scheme ....................................................... 67
Instruction Flow/Pipelining ................................................. 67
Instruction Set .................................................................. 287
ADDLW .................................................................... 293
ADDWF .................................................................... 293
ADDWF (Indexed Literal Offset mode) .................... 335
ADDWFC ................................................................. 294
ANDLW .................................................................... 294
ANDWF .................................................................... 295
BC ............................................................................ 295
BCF ......................................................................... 296
BN ............................................................................ 296
BNC ......................................................................... 297
BNN ......................................................................... 297
BNOV ...................................................................... 298
BNZ ......................................................................... 298
BOV ......................................................................... 301
BRA ......................................................................... 299
BSF .......................................................................... 299
BSF (Indexed Literal Offset mode) .......................... 335
BTFSC ..................................................................... 300
BTFSS ..................................................................... 300
BTG ......................................................................... 301
BZ ............................................................................ 302
CALL ........................................................................ 302
CLRF ....................................................................... 303
CLRWDT ................................................................. 303
COMF ...................................................................... 304
CPFSEQ .................................................................. 304
CPFSGT .................................................................. 305
CPFSLT ................................................................... 305
DAW ........................................................................ 306
DCFSNZ .................................................................. 307
DECF ....................................................................... 306
DECFSZ .................................................................. 307
Extended Instructions .............................................. 329
Syntax .............................................................. 329
General Format ........................................................ 289
GOTO ...................................................................... 308
INCF ........................................................................ 308
INCFSZ .................................................................... 309
INFSNZ .................................................................... 309
IORLW ..................................................................... 310
IORWF ..................................................................... 310
LFSR ....................................................................... 311
MOVF ...................................................................... 311
MOVFF .................................................................... 312
MOVLB .................................................................... 312
MOVLW ................................................................... 313
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
MOVWF ................................................................... 313
MULLW .................................................................... 314
MULWF .................................................................... 314
NEGF ....................................................................... 315
NOP ......................................................................... 315
Opcode Field Descriptions ....................................... 288
POP ......................................................................... 316
PUSH ....................................................................... 316
RCALL ..................................................................... 317
RESET ..................................................................... 317
RETFIE .................................................................... 318
RETLW .................................................................... 318
RETURN .................................................................. 319
RLCF ........................................................................ 319
RLNCF ..................................................................... 320
RRCF ....................................................................... 320
RRNCF .................................................................... 321
SETF ........................................................................ 321
SETF (Indexed Literal Offset mode) ........................ 335
SLEEP ..................................................................... 322
SUBFWB .................................................................. 322
SUBLW .................................................................... 323
SUBWF .................................................................... 323
SUBWFB .................................................................. 324
SWAPF .................................................................... 324
TBLRD ..................................................................... 325
TBLWT ..................................................................... 326
TSTFSZ ................................................................... 327
XORLW .................................................................... 327
XORWF .................................................................... 328
Summary Table ........................................................ 290
INTCON Register
RBIF Bit .................................................................... 120
INTCON Registers ........................................................... 103
Inter-Integrated Circuit. See I2C.
Internal Oscillator Block ..................................................... 32
Adjustment ................................................................. 32
INTIO Modes .............................................................. 32
INTOSC Frequency Drift ............................................ 32
INTOSC Output Frequency ........................................ 32
OSCTUNE Register ................................................... 32
Internal RC Oscillator
Use with WDT .......................................................... 279
Interrupt Sources ............................................................. 271
A/D Conversion Complete ....................................... 249
Interrupt-on-Change (RB7:RB4) .............................. 120
INTn Pin ................................................................... 116
PORTB, Interrupt-on-Change .................................. 116
TMR0 ....................................................................... 116
TMR0 Overflow ........................................................ 145
TMR1 Overflow ........................................................ 147
TMR2 to PR2 Match (PWM) .................................... 165
TMR3 Overflow ................................................ 155, 157
Interrupts .......................................................................... 101
Interrupts, Flag Bits
Interrupt-on-Change (RB7:RB4)
Flag (RBIF Bit) ................................................. 120
INTOSC, INTRC. See Internal Oscillator Block.
IORLW ............................................................................. 310
IORWF ............................................................................. 310
IPR Registers ................................................................... 112
L
M
Master Clear (MCLR) ......................................................... 51
Master Synchronous Serial Port (MSSP).
See MSSP.
Memory Organization ........................................................ 61
Data Memory ............................................................. 69
Program Memory ....................................................... 61
Memory Programming Requirements .............................. 355
Migration from Baseline to Enhanced Devices ................ 386
Migration from High-End to Enhanced Devices ............... 387
Migration from Mid-Range to Enhanced Devices ............ 387
MOVF .............................................................................. 311
MOVFF ............................................................................ 312
MOVLB ............................................................................ 312
MOVLW ........................................................................... 313
MOVSS ............................................................................ 332
MOVWF ........................................................................... 313
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian .................. 338
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger .................................. 339
MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator ................................................... 339
MPLAB ICE 4000 High-Performance Universal
In-Circuit Emulator ................................................... 339
MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software ............................................. 337
MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer ................................... 339
MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ............... 338
MSSP
ACK Pulse ....................................................... 182, 183
Control Registers (general) ..................................... 169
I2C Mode. See I2C Mode.
Module Overview ..................................................... 169
SPI Master/Slave Connection .................................. 173
SPI Mode. See SPI Mode.
SSPBUF .................................................................. 174
SSPSR .................................................................... 174
MULLW ............................................................................ 314
MULWF ............................................................................ 314
N
NEGF ............................................................................... 315
NOP ................................................................................. 315
O
OPTION_REG Register
PSA Bit .................................................................... 145
T0CS Bit .................................................................. 144
T0PS2:T0PS0 Bits ................................................... 145
T0SE Bit .................................................................. 144
Oscillator Configuration ..................................................... 29
EC .............................................................................. 29
ECIO .......................................................................... 29
HS .............................................................................. 29
HSPLL ....................................................................... 29
Internal Oscillator Block ............................................. 32
INTIO1 ....................................................................... 29
INTIO2 ....................................................................... 29
LP .............................................................................. 29
RC ............................................................................. 29
RCIO .......................................................................... 29
XT .............................................................................. 29
Oscillator Selection .......................................................... 271
LFSR ................................................................................ 311
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 393
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) ........................... 37, 53, 271
Oscillator Switching ............................................................ 34
Oscillator Transitions .......................................................... 35
Oscillator, Timer1 ..................................................... 147, 157
Oscillator, Timer3 ............................................................. 155
P
Packaging ........................................................................ 381
Details ...................................................................... 382
Marking .................................................................... 381
Parallel Slave Port (PSP) ................................................. 140
Associated Registers ............................................... 142
RE0/RD Pin .............................................................. 140
RE1/WR Pin ............................................................. 140
RE2/CS Pin .............................................................. 140
Select (PSPMODE Bit) ............................................ 140
PICkit 1 Flash Starter Kit .................................................. 341
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer .................... 340
PIE Registers ................................................................... 109
Pin Functions
AVDD .......................................................................... 28
AVDD .......................................................................... 19
AVSS .......................................................................... 28
AVSS .......................................................................... 19
OSC1/CLKI/RA7 .................................................. 12, 20
OSC2/CLKO/RA6 ................................................ 12, 20
RA0/AN0 .............................................................. 13, 21
RA1/AN1 .............................................................. 13, 21
RA2/AN2/VREF- .................................................... 13, 21
RA3/AN3/VREF+ ................................................... 13, 21
RA4/T0CKI ........................................................... 13, 21
RA5/AN4/HLVDIN ................................................ 13, 21
RB0/INT0 ............................................................. 14, 22
RB1/INT1 ............................................................. 14, 22
RB2/INT2 ............................................................. 14, 22
RB3/INT3 ................................................................... 14
RB3/INT3/CCP2 ......................................................... 22
RB4/KBI0 ............................................................. 14, 22
RB5/KBI1 ............................................................. 14, 22
RB6/KBI2/PGC .................................................... 14, 22
RB7/KBI3/PGD .................................................... 14, 22
RC0/T1OSO/T13CKI ........................................... 15, 23
RC1/T1OSI/CCP2 ................................................ 15, 23
RC2/CCP1 ........................................................... 15, 23
RC3/SCK/SCL ..................................................... 15, 23
RC4/SDI/SDA ...................................................... 15, 23
RC5/SDO ............................................................. 15, 23
RC6/TX1/CK1 ...................................................... 15, 23
RC7/RX1/DT1 ...................................................... 15, 23
RD0/AD0/PSP0 .......................................................... 24
RD0/PSP0 .................................................................. 16
RD1/AD1/PSP1 .......................................................... 24
RD1/PSP1 .................................................................. 16
RD2/AD2/PSP2 .......................................................... 24
RD2/PSP2 .................................................................. 16
RD3/AD3/PSP3 .......................................................... 24
RD3/PSP3 .................................................................. 16
RD4/AD4/PSP4 .......................................................... 24
RD4/PSP4 .................................................................. 16
RD5/AD5/PSP5 .......................................................... 24
RD5/PSP5 .................................................................. 16
RD6/AD6/PSP6 .......................................................... 24
RD6/PSP6 .................................................................. 16
RD7/AD7/PSP7 .......................................................... 24
RD7/PSP7 .................................................................. 16
RE0/AD8/RD .............................................................. 25
DS39635A-page 394
RE0/RD ..................................................................... 17
RE1/AD9/WR ............................................................. 25
RE1/WR ..................................................................... 17
RE2/AD10/CS ............................................................ 25
RE2/CS ...................................................................... 17
RE3 ............................................................................ 17
RE3/AD11 .................................................................. 25
RE4 ............................................................................ 17
RE4/AD12 .................................................................. 25
RE5 ............................................................................ 17
RE5/AD13 .................................................................. 25
RE6 ............................................................................ 17
RE6/AD14 .................................................................. 25
RE7/CCP2 ................................................................. 17
RE7/CCP2/AD15 ....................................................... 25
RF0/AN5 .............................................................. 18, 26
RF1/AN6/C2OUT ................................................. 18, 26
RF2/AN7/C1OUT ................................................. 18, 26
RF3/AN8 .............................................................. 18, 26
RF4/AN9 .............................................................. 18, 26
RF5/AN10/CVREF ................................................ 18, 26
RF6/AN11 ............................................................ 18, 26
RF7/SS ................................................................ 18, 26
RG0/CCP3 ........................................................... 19, 27
RG1/TX2/CK2 ...................................................... 19, 27
RG2/RX2/DT2 ...................................................... 19, 27
RG3 ..................................................................... 19, 27
RG4 ..................................................................... 19, 27
RG5 ..................................................................... 19, 27
RG5/MCLR/VPP ................................................... 12, 20
RH0/AD16 ................................................................. 27
RH1/AD17 ................................................................. 27
RH2/AD18 ................................................................. 27
RH3/AD19 ................................................................. 27
RH4 ........................................................................... 27
RH5 ........................................................................... 27
RH6 ........................................................................... 27
RH7 ........................................................................... 27
RJ0/ALE .................................................................... 28
RJ1/OE ...................................................................... 28
RJ2/WRL ................................................................... 28
RJ3/WRH ................................................................... 28
RJ4/BA0 .................................................................... 28
RJ5/CE ...................................................................... 28
RJ6/LB ....................................................................... 28
RJ7/UB ...................................................................... 28
VDD ............................................................................ 28
VDD ............................................................................ 19
VSS ............................................................................ 28
VSS ............................................................................ 19
Pinout I/O Descriptions
PIC18F6310/6410 ..................................................... 12
PIC18F8310/8410 ..................................................... 20
PIR Registers ................................................................... 106
PLL .................................................................................... 31
HSPLL Oscillator Mode ............................................. 31
Use with INTOSC ................................................ 31, 32
PLL Lock Time-out ............................................................. 53
POP ................................................................................. 316
POR. See Power-on Reset.
PORTA
Associated Registers ............................................... 119
Functions ................................................................. 118
LATA Register ......................................................... 117
PORTA Register ...................................................... 117
TRISA Register ........................................................ 117
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
PORTB
Associated Registers ............................................... 122
Functions ................................................................. 121
LATB Register .......................................................... 120
PORTB Register ...................................................... 120
RB7:RB4 Interrupt-on-Change Flag
(RBIF Bit) ......................................................... 120
TRISB Register ........................................................ 120
PORTC
Associated Registers ............................................... 125
Functions ................................................................. 124
LATC Register ......................................................... 123
PORTC Register ...................................................... 123
RC3/SCK/SCL Pin ................................................... 183
TRISC Register ........................................................ 123
PORTD ............................................................................ 140
Associated Registers ............................................... 128
Functions ................................................................. 127
LATD Register ......................................................... 126
PORTD Register ...................................................... 126
TRISD Register ........................................................ 126
PORTE
Analog Port Pins ...................................................... 140
Associated Registers ............................................... 131
Functions ................................................................. 130
LATE Register .......................................................... 129
PORTE Register ...................................................... 129
PSP Mode Select (PSPMODE Bit) .......................... 140
RE0/RD Pin .............................................................. 140
RE1/WR Pin ............................................................. 140
RE2/CS Pin .............................................................. 140
TRISE Register ........................................................ 129
PORTF
Associated Registers ............................................... 133
Functions ................................................................. 133
LATF Register .......................................................... 132
PORTF Register ...................................................... 132
TRISF Register ........................................................ 132
PORTG
Associated Registers ............................................... 135
Functions ................................................................. 135
LATG Register ......................................................... 134
PORTG Register ...................................................... 134
TRISG Register ........................................................ 134
PORTH
Associated Registers ............................................... 137
Functions ................................................................. 137
LATH Register ......................................................... 136
PORTH Register ...................................................... 136
TRISH Register ........................................................ 136
PORTJ
Associated Registers ............................................... 139
Functions ................................................................. 139
LATJ Register .......................................................... 138
PORTJ Register ....................................................... 138
TRISJ Register ......................................................... 138
Postscaler, WDT
Assignment (PSA Bit) .............................................. 145
Rate Select (T0PS2:T0PS0 Bits) ............................. 145
Switching Between Timer0 and WDT ...................... 145
2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Power Managed Modes ..................................................... 39
and Multiple Sleep Commands .................................. 40
Clock Sources ........................................................... 39
Clock Transitions, Status Indicators .......................... 40
Entering ..................................................................... 39
Exiting Idle and Sleep Modes .................................... 46
by Interrupt ........................................................ 46
by Reset ............................................................ 46
by WDT Time-out .............................................. 46
Without an Oscillator Start-up Delay ................. 46
Idle Modes ................................................................. 43
Run Modes ................................................................ 40
Selecting .................................................................... 39
Sleep Mode ............................................................... 43
Summary (table) ........................................................ 39
Power-on Reset (POR) .............................................. 51, 271
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) ................................. 53
Power-up Timer (PWRT) ................................... 53, 271
Time-out Sequence ................................................... 53
Power-up Delays ............................................................... 37
Power-up Timer (PWRT) ............................................. 37, 53
Prescaler, Capture ........................................................... 162
Prescaler, Timer0 ............................................................ 145
Assignment (PSA Bit) .............................................. 145
Rate Select (T0PS2:T0PS0 Bits) ............................. 145
Switching Between Timer0 and WDT ...................... 145
Prescaler, TMR2 .............................................................. 166
PRO MATE II Universal Device Programmer .................. 339
Program Counter ............................................................... 64
PCL, PCH and PCU Registers .................................. 64
PCLATH and PCLATU Registers .............................. 64
Program Memory ............................................................... 85
and the Extended Instruction Set .............................. 81
Code Protection ....................................................... 284
Control Registers ....................................................... 86
TABLAT (Table Latch) Register ........................ 86
TBLPTR (Table Pointer) Register ...................... 86
Erasing External Memory (PIC18F8X10) .................. 87
Instructions ................................................................ 68
Two-Word Instructions ....................................... 68
Interrupt Vector .......................................................... 61
Look-up Tables .......................................................... 66
Map and Stack (diagram) .......................................... 61
Memory Access for PIC18F8310/8410 Modes .......... 63
Memory Maps for PIC18FX310/X410 Modes ............ 63
PIC18F8310/8410 Memory Modes ............................ 62
Reset Vector .............................................................. 61
Table Reads and Table Writes .................................. 85
Writing and Erasing On-Chip Program
Memory (ICSP Mode) ........................................ 87
Writing To
Unexpected Termination ................................... 87
Write Verify ........................................................ 87
Writing to Memory Space (PIC18F8X10) .................. 87
Program Memory Modes
Extended Microcontroller ........................................... 90
Microcontroller ........................................................... 90
Microprocessor .......................................................... 90
Microprocessor with Boot Block ................................ 90
Program Verification and Code Protection ...................... 284
Associated Registers ............................................... 284
Programming, Device Instructions ................................... 287
PSP.See Parallel Slave Port.
Pulse-Width Modulation. See PWM (CCP Module).
PUSH ............................................................................... 316
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 395
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
PUSH and POP Instructions .............................................. 65
PUSHL ............................................................................. 332
PWM (CCP Module)
Associated Registers ............................................... 167
Duty Cycle ................................................................ 166
Example Frequencies/Resolutions .......................... 166
Period ....................................................................... 165
Setup for PWM Operation ........................................ 166
TMR2 to PR2 Match ................................................ 165
Q
Q Clock ............................................................................ 166
R
RAM. See Data Memory.
RC Oscillator ...................................................................... 31
RCIO Oscillator Mode ................................................ 31
RCALL .............................................................................. 317
RCON Register
Bit Status During Initialization .................................... 56
Register File ....................................................................... 71
Register File Summary ................................................. 73–76
Registers
ADCON0 (A/D Control 0) ......................................... 245
ADCON1 (A/D Control 1) ......................................... 246
ADCON2 (A/D Control 2) ......................................... 247
BAUDCON1 (Baud Rate Control 1) ......................... 212
CCPxCON (Capture/Compare/PWM Control –
CCP1, CCP2, CCP3) ....................................... 159
CMCON (Comparator Control) ................................ 255
CONFIG1H (Configuration 1 High) .......................... 272
CONFIG2H (Configuration 2 High) .......................... 274
CONFIG2L (Configuration 2 Low) ............................ 273
CONFIG3H (Configuration 3 High) .......................... 275
CONFIG3L (Configuration 3 Low) ............................ 275
CONFIG3L (Configuration Byte 3 Low) ..................... 62
CONFIG4L (Configuration 4 Low) ............................ 276
CONFIG5L (Configuration 5 Low) ............................ 276
CONFIG7L (Configuration 7 Low) ............................ 277
CVRCON (Comparator Voltage
Reference Control) ........................................... 261
Device ID Register 1 ................................................ 278
Device ID Register 2 ................................................ 278
HLVDCON (HLVD Control) ...................................... 265
INTCON (Interrupt Control) ...................................... 103
INTCON2 (Interrupt Control 2) ................................. 104
INTCON3 (Interrupt Control 3) ................................. 105
IPR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Priority 1) ........................ 112
IPR2 (Peripheral Interrupt Priority 2) ........................ 113
IPR3 (Peripheral Interrupt Priority 3) ........................ 114
MEMCON (Memory Control) ...................................... 89
OSCCON (Oscillator Control) .................................... 36
OSCTUNE (Oscillator Tuning) ................................... 33
PIE1 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 1) ........................ 109
PIE2 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 2) ........................ 110
PIE3 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 3) ........................ 111
PIR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Request
(Flag) 1) ........................................................... 106
PIR2 (Peripheral Interrupt Request
(Flag) 2) ........................................................... 107
PIR3 (Peripheral Interrupt Request
(Flag) 3) ........................................................... 108
PSPCON (Parallel Slave Port Control) .................... 141
RCON (Reset Control) ....................................... 50, 115
RCSTA1 (EUSART Receive Status
and Control) ..................................................... 211
DS39635A-page 396
RCSTA2 (AUSART Receive Status
and Control) ..................................................... 233
SSPCON1 (MSSP Control 1, I2C Mode) ................. 180
SSPCON1 (MSSP Control 1, SPI Mode) ................. 171
SSPCON2 (MSSP Control 2, I2C Mode) ................. 181
SSPSTAT (MSSP Status, I2C Mode) ...................... 179
SSPSTAT (MSSP Status, SPI Mode) ...................... 170
Status ........................................................................ 77
STKPTR (Stack Pointer) ............................................ 65
T0CON (Timer0 Control) ......................................... 143
T1CON (Timer1 Control) ......................................... 147
T2CON (Timer 2 Control) ........................................ 153
T3CON (Timer3 Control) ......................................... 155
TXSTA1 (EUSART Transmit Status
and Control) ..................................................... 210
TXSTA2 (AUSART Transmit Status
and Control) ..................................................... 232
WDTCON (Watchdog Timer Control) ...................... 280
Reset ................................................................................. 49
MCLR Reset, Normal Operation ................................ 49
MCLR Reset, Power Managed Modes ...................... 49
Power-on Reset (POR) .............................................. 49
Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR) .................... 49
RESET Instruction ..................................................... 49
Stack Full Reset ......................................................... 49
Stack Underflow Reset .............................................. 49
Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset .................................. 49
Resets .............................................................................. 271
RETFIE ............................................................................ 318
RETLW ............................................................................ 318
RETURN .......................................................................... 319
Return Address Stack ........................................................ 64
Return Stack Pointer (STKPTR) ........................................ 65
Revision History ............................................................... 385
RLCF ............................................................................... 319
RLNCF ............................................................................. 320
RRCF ............................................................................... 320
RRNCF ............................................................................ 321
Run Modes
PRI_RUN ................................................................... 40
RC_RUN .................................................................... 42
SEC_RUN .................................................................. 40
S
SCK ................................................................................. 169
SDI ................................................................................... 169
SDO ................................................................................. 169
Serial Clock, SCK ............................................................ 169
Serial Data In (SDI) .......................................................... 169
Serial Data Out (SDO) ..................................................... 169
Serial Peripheral Interface. See SPI Mode.
SETF ................................................................................ 321
Slave Select (SS) ............................................................. 169
SLEEP ............................................................................. 322
Sleep Mode
OSC1 and OSC2 Pin States ...................................... 37
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM) ................................... 338
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM30) ............................... 338
Special Event Trigger. See Compare (CCP Module).
Special Features of the CPU ........................................... 271
Special Function Registers ................................................ 72
Map ............................................................................ 72
SPI Mode (MSSP)
Associated Registers ............................................... 177
Bus Mode Compatibility ........................................... 177
Effects of a Reset .................................................... 177
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Enabling SPI I/O ...................................................... 173
Master Mode ............................................................ 174
Master/Slave Connection ......................................... 173
Operation ................................................................. 172
Serial Clock .............................................................. 169
Serial Data In ........................................................... 169
Serial Data Out ........................................................ 169
Slave Mode .............................................................. 175
Slave Select ............................................................. 169
Slave Select Synchronization .................................. 175
Sleep Operation ....................................................... 177
SPI Clock ................................................................. 174
Typical Connection .................................................. 173
SS .................................................................................... 169
SSPOV ............................................................................. 199
SSPOV Status Flag ......................................................... 199
SSPSTAT Register
R/W Bit ............................................................. 182, 183
Stack Full/Underflow Resets .............................................. 66
Standard Instructions ....................................................... 287
SUBFSR .......................................................................... 333
SUBFWB .......................................................................... 322
SUBLW ............................................................................ 323
SUBULNK ........................................................................ 333
SUBWF ............................................................................ 323
SUBWFB .......................................................................... 324
SWAPF ............................................................................ 324
T
Table Pointer Operations (table) ........................................ 86
Table Reads/Table Writes ................................................. 66
TBLRD ............................................................................. 325
TBLWT ............................................................................. 326
Time-out in Various Situations (table) ................................ 53
Timer0 .............................................................................. 143
16-Bit Mode Timer Reads and Writes ...................... 144
Associated Registers ............................................... 145
Clock Source Edge Select (T0SE Bit) ...................... 144
Clock Source Select (T0CS Bit) ............................... 144
Operation ................................................................. 144
Overflow Interrupt .................................................... 145
Prescaler. See Prescaler, Timer0.
Timer1 .............................................................................. 147
16-Bit Read/Write Mode ........................................... 149
Associated Registers ............................................... 151
Interrupt .................................................................... 150
Low-Power Option ................................................... 149
Operation ................................................................. 148
Oscillator .......................................................... 147, 149
Oscillator Layout Considerations ............................. 150
Overflow Interrupt .................................................... 147
Resetting, Using a Special Event
Trigger Output (CCP) ....................................... 150
TMR1H Register ...................................................... 147
TMR1L Register ....................................................... 147
Use as a Real-Time Clock ....................................... 150
Using as a Clock Source .......................................... 149
Timer2 .............................................................................. 153
Associated Registers ............................................... 154
Interrupt .................................................................... 154
Operation ................................................................. 153
Output ...................................................................... 154
PR2 Register ............................................................ 165
TMR2 to PR2 Match Interrupt .................................. 165
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Timer3 ............................................................................. 155
16-Bit Read/Write Mode .......................................... 157
Associated Registers ............................................... 157
Operation ................................................................. 156
Oscillator .......................................................... 155, 157
Overflow Interrupt ............................................ 155, 157
Special Event Trigger (CCP) ................................... 157
TMR3H Register ...................................................... 155
TMR3L Register ...................................................... 155
Timing Diagrams
A/D Conversion ....................................................... 378
Acknowledge Sequence .......................................... 202
Asynchronous Reception ................................. 221, 239
Asynchronous Transmission ........................... 219, 237
Asynchronous Transmission
(Back to Back) ......................................... 219, 237
Automatic Baud Rate Calculation ............................ 217
Auto-Wake-up Bit (WUE) During
Normal Operation ............................................ 223
Auto-Wake-up Bit (WUE) During Sleep ................... 223
Baud Rate Generator with Clock Arbitration ............ 196
BRG Overflow Sequence ........................................ 217
BRG Reset Due to SDA Arbitration
During Start Condition ..................................... 205
Brown-out Reset (BOR) ........................................... 365
Bus Collision During a Repeated
Start Condition (Case 1) .................................. 206
Bus Collision During a Repeated
Start Condition (Case 2) .................................. 206
Bus Collision During a Start
Condition (SCL = 0) ......................................... 205
Bus Collision During a Start
Condition (SDA Only) ...................................... 204
Bus Collision During a Stop
Condition (Case 1) ........................................... 207
Bus Collision During a Stop
Condition (Case 2) ........................................... 207
Bus Collision for Transmit and
Acknowledge ................................................... 203
Capture/Compare/PWM
(All CCP Modules) ........................................... 367
CLKO and I/O .......................................................... 362
Clock Synchronization ............................................. 189
Clock/Instruction Cycle .............................................. 67
Example SPI Master Mode (CKE = 0) ..................... 368
Example SPI Master Mode (CKE = 1) ..................... 369
Example SPI Slave Mode (CKE = 0) ....................... 370
Example SPI Slave Mode (CKE = 1) ....................... 371
External Clock (All Modes Except PLL) ................... 360
External Memory Bus for SLEEP
(16-Bit Microprocessor Mode) ........................... 95
External Memory Bus for SLEEP
(8-Bit Microprocessor Mode) ............................. 98
External Memory Bus for TBLRD
(16-Bit Extended Microcontroller Mode) ............ 94
External Memory Bus for TBLRD
(16-Bit Microprocessor Mode) ........................... 94
External Memory Bus for TBLRD
(8-Bit Extended Microcontroller Mode) .............. 97
External Memory Bus for TBLRD
(8-Bit Microprocessor Mode) ............................. 97
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ........................................... 283
High/Low-Voltage Detect (VDIRMAG = 1) ............... 268
High/Low-Voltage Detect Characteristics ................ 357
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 397
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
High/Low-Voltage Detect Operation
(VDIRMAG = 0) ................................................ 267
I2C Bus Data ............................................................ 372
I2C Bus Start/Stop Bits ............................................. 372
I2C Master Mode (7 or
10-Bit Transmission) ........................................ 200
I2C Master Mode (7-Bit Reception) .......................... 201
I2C Master Mode First Start Bit ................................ 197
I2C Slave Mode (10-Bit Reception, SEN = 0) .......... 186
I2C Slave Mode (10-Bit Reception, SEN = 1) .......... 191
I2C Slave Mode (10-Bit Transmission) ..................... 187
I2C Slave Mode (7-bit Reception, SEN = 0) ............. 184
I2C Slave Mode (7-Bit Reception, SEN = 1) ............ 190
I2C Slave Mode (7-Bit Transmission) ....................... 185
I2C Slave Mode General Call Address
Sequence (7 or 10-Bit Address Mode) ............. 192
I2C Stop Condition Receive or
Transmit Mode ................................................. 202
Master SSP I2C Bus Data ........................................ 374
Master SSP I2C Bus Start/Stop Bits ........................ 374
Parallel Slave Port (PSP) Read ............................... 142
Parallel Slave Port (PSP) Write ............................... 141
Program Memory Read ............................................ 363
Program Memory Write ............................................ 364
PWM Output ............................................................ 165
Repeat Start Condition ............................................. 198
Reset, Watchdog Timer (WDT), Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST) and
Power-up Timer (PWRT) ................................. 365
Send Break Character Sequence ............................ 224
Slave Synchronization ............................................. 175
Slow Rise Time (MCLR Tied to VDD,
VDD Rise > TPWRT) ............................................ 55
SPI Mode (Master Mode) ......................................... 174
SPI Mode (Slave Mode, CKE = 0) ........................... 176
SPI Mode (Slave Mode, CKE = 1) ........................... 176
Synchronous Reception
(Master Mode, SREN) .............................. 227, 242
Synchronous Transmission .............................. 225, 240
Synchronous Transmission
(Through TXEN) ....................................... 226, 241
Time-out Sequence on POR w/PLL Enabled
(MCLR Tied to VDD) ........................................... 55
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Not Tied to VDD, Case 1) ....................... 54
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Not Tied to VDD, Case 2) ....................... 54
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Tied to VDD, VDD Rise TPWRT) .............. 54
Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock .......................... 366
Transition for Entry to PRI_IDLE Mode ...................... 44
Transition for Entry to SEC_RUN Mode .................... 41
Transition for Entry to Sleep Mode ............................ 43
Transition for Two-Speed Start-up
(INTOSC to HSPLL) ......................................... 281
Transition for Wake from Idle to Run Mode ............... 44
Transition for Wake from Sleep (HSPLL) ................... 43
Transition from RC_RUN Mode to
PRI_RUN Mode ................................................. 42
Transition from SEC_RUN Mode to
PRI_RUN Mode (HSPLL) .................................. 41
Transition to RC_RUN Mode ..................................... 42
USART Synchronous Receive
(Master/Slave) .................................................. 376
DS39635A-page 398
USART Synchronous Transmission
(Master/Slave) ................................................. 376
Timing Diagrams and Specifications
A/D Conversion Requirements ................................ 378
AC Characteristics
Internal RC Accuracy ....................................... 361
Capture/Compare/PWM Requirements
(All CCP Modules) ........................................... 367
CLKO and I/O Requirements ........................... 362, 363
Example SPI Mode Requirements
(Master Mode, CKE = 0) .................................. 368
Example SPI Mode Requirements
(Master Mode, CKE = 1) .................................. 369
Example SPI Mode Requirements
(Slave Mode, CKE = 0) .................................... 370
Example SPI Slave Mode Requirements
(CKE = 1) ......................................................... 371
External Clock Requirements .................................. 360
I2C Bus Data Requirements (Slave Mode) .............. 373
I2C Bus Start/Stop Bits Requirements
(Slave Mode) ................................................... 372
Master SSP I2C Bus Data Requirements ................ 375
Master SSP I2C Bus Start/Stop Bits
Requirements .................................................. 374
PLL Clock ................................................................ 361
Program Memory Write Requirements .................... 364
Reset, Watchdog Timer, Oscillator
Start-up Timer, Power-up Timer and
Brown-out Reset Requirements ...................... 365
Timer0 and Timer1 External
Clock Requirements ........................................ 366
USART Synchronous Receive
Requirements .................................................. 376
USART Synchronous Transmission
Requirements .................................................. 376
Top-of-Stack Access .......................................................... 64
TRISE Register
PSPMODE Bit .......................................................... 140
TSTFSZ ........................................................................... 327
Two-Speed Start-up ................................................. 271, 281
Two-Word Instructions
Example Cases .......................................................... 68
TXSTA1 Register
BRGH Bit ................................................................. 213
TXSTA2 Register
BRGH Bit ................................................................. 234
V
Voltage Reference Specifications .................................... 356
W
Watchdog Timer (WDT) ........................................... 271, 279
Associated Registers ............................................... 280
Control Register ....................................................... 279
During Oscillator Failure .......................................... 282
Programming Considerations .................................. 279
WCOL ...................................................... 197, 198, 199, 202
WCOL Status Flag ................................... 197, 198, 199, 202
WWW, On-Line Support ...................................................... 5
X
XORLW ............................................................................ 327
XORWF ........................................................................... 328
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
ON-LINE SUPPORT
Microchip provides on-line support on the Microchip
World Wide Web site.
The web site is used by Microchip as a means to make
files and information easily available to customers. To
view the site, the user must have access to the Internet
and a web browser, such as Netscape® or Microsoft®
Internet Explorer. Files are also available for FTP
download from our FTP site.
SYSTEMS INFORMATION AND
UPGRADE HOT LINE
The Systems Information and Upgrade Line provides
system users a listing of the latest versions of all of
Microchip’s development systems software products.
Plus, this line provides information on how customers
can receive the most current upgrade kits.The Hot Line
Numbers are:
1-800-755-2345 for U.S. and most of Canada and
1-480-792-7302 for the rest of the world.
Connecting to the Microchip Internet
Web Site
042003
The Microchip web site is available at the following
URL:
www.microchip.com
The file transfer site is available by using an FTP
service to connect to:
ftp://ftp.microchip.com
The web site and file transfer site provide a variety of
services. Users may download files for the latest
Development Tools, Data Sheets, Application Notes,
User’s Guides, Articles and Sample Programs. A variety of Microchip specific business information is also
available, including listings of Microchip sales offices,
distributors and factory representatives. Other data
available for consideration is:
• Latest Microchip Press Releases
• Technical Support Section with Frequently Asked
Questions
• Design Tips
• Device Errata
• Job Postings
• Microchip Consultant Program Member Listing
• Links to other useful web sites related to
Microchip Products
• Conferences for products, Development Systems,
technical information and more
• Listing of seminars and events
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
DS39635A-page 399
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip product. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter and ways in which our documentation
can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150.
Please list the following information and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document.
To:
Technical Publications Manager
RE:
Reader Response
Total Pages Sent ________
From: Name
Company
Address
City / State / ZIP / Country
Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________
FAX: (______) _________ - _________
Application (optional):
Would you like a reply?
Y
N
Device: PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
Literature Number: DS39635A
Questions:
1. What are the best features of this document?
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)?
7. How would you improve this document?
DS39635A-page 400
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410 PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
PART NO.
X
/XX
XXX
Device
Temperature
Range
Package
Pattern
Examples:
a)
b)
Device
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410(1),
PIC18F6310/6410/8310/8410T(2);
VDD range 4.2V to 5.5V
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410(1),
PIC18LF6310/6410/8310/8410T(2);
VDD range 2.0V to 5.5V
Temperature Range I
E
Package
=
=
PT =
c)
PIC18LF6410-I/PT 301 = Industrial temp.,
TQFP package, Extended VDD limits,
QTP pattern #301.
PIC18F8410-I/PT = Industrial temp., TQFP
package, normal VDD limits.
PIC18F8410-E/PT = Extended temp., TQFP
package, normal VDD limits.
-40°C to +85°C (Industrial)
-40°C to +125°C (Extended)
TQFP (Thin Quad Flatpack)
Note 1:
Pattern
QTP, SQTP, Code or Special Requirements
(blank otherwise)
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.
Preliminary
2:
F = Standard Voltage Range
LF = Wide Voltage Range
T = in tape and reel
DS39635A-page 401
WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE
AMERICAS
China - Beijing
Korea
Corporate Office
Unit 706B
Wan Tai Bei Hai Bldg.
No. 6 Chaoyangmen Bei Str.
Beijing, 100027, China
Tel: 86-10-85282100
Fax: 86-10-85282104
168-1, Youngbo Bldg. 3 Floor
Samsung-Dong, Kangnam-Ku
Seoul, Korea 135-882
Tel: 82-2-554-7200 Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or
82-2-558-5934
China - Chengdu
200 Middle Road
#07-02 Prime Centre
Singapore, 188980
Tel: 65-6334-8870 Fax: 65-6334-8850
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Tel: 480-792-7200
Fax: 480-792-7277
Technical Support: 480-792-7627
Web Address: www.microchip.com
3780 Mansell Road, Suite 130
Alpharetta, GA 30022
Tel: 770-640-0034
Fax: 770-640-0307
Rm. 2401-2402, 24th Floor,
Ming Xing Financial Tower
No. 88 TIDU Street
Chengdu 610016, China
Tel: 86-28-86766200
Fax: 86-28-86766599
Boston
China - Fuzhou
2 Lan Drive, Suite 120
Westford, MA 01886
Tel: 978-692-3848
Fax: 978-692-3821
Unit 28F, World Trade Plaza
No. 71 Wusi Road
Fuzhou 350001, China
Tel: 86-591-7503506
Fax: 86-591-7503521
Atlanta
Chicago
333 Pierce Road, Suite 180
Itasca, IL 60143
Tel: 630-285-0071
Fax: 630-285-0075
Dallas
4570 Westgrove Drive, Suite 160
Addison, TX 75001
Tel: 972-818-7423
Fax: 972-818-2924
Detroit
Tri-Atria Office Building
32255 Northwestern Highway, Suite 190
Farmington Hills, MI 48334
Tel: 248-538-2250
Fax: 248-538-2260
Kokomo
2767 S. Albright Road
Kokomo, IN 46902
Tel: 765-864-8360
Fax: 765-864-8387
Los Angeles
18201 Von Karman, Suite 1090
Irvine, CA 92612
Tel: 949-263-1888
Fax: 949-263-1338
San Jose
1300 Terra Bella Avenue
Mountain View, CA 94043
Tel: 650-215-1444
Fax: 650-961-0286
Toronto
6285 Northam Drive, Suite 108
Mississauga, Ontario L4V 1X5, Canada
Tel: 905-673-0699
Fax: 905-673-6509
ASIA/PACIFIC
Australia
Suite 22, 41 Rawson Street
Epping 2121, NSW
Australia
Tel: 61-2-9868-6733
Fax: 61-2-9868-6755
China - Hong Kong SAR
Unit 901-6, Tower 2, Metroplaza
223 Hing Fong Road
Kwai Fong, N.T., Hong Kong
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
Singapore
Taiwan
Kaohsiung Branch
30F - 1 No. 8
Min Chuan 2nd Road
Kaohsiung 806, Taiwan
Tel: 886-7-536-4818
Fax: 886-7-536-4803
Taiwan
Taiwan Branch
11F-3, No. 207
Tung Hua North Road
Taipei, 105, Taiwan
Tel: 886-2-2717-7175 Fax: 886-2-2545-0139
EUROPE
China - Shanghai
Austria
Room 701, Bldg. B
Far East International Plaza
No. 317 Xian Xia Road
Shanghai, 200051
Tel: 86-21-6275-5700
Fax: 86-21-6275-5060
Durisolstrasse 2
A-4600 Wels
Austria
Tel: 43-7242-2244-399
Fax: 43-7242-2244-393
Denmark
China - Shenzhen
Regus Business Centre
Lautrup hoj 1-3
Ballerup DK-2750 Denmark
Tel: 45-4420-9895 Fax: 45-4420-9910
Rm. 1812, 18/F, Building A, United Plaza
No. 5022 Binhe Road, Futian District
Shenzhen 518033, China
Tel: 86-755-82901380
Fax: 86-755-8295-1393
China - Shunde
Room 401, Hongjian Building, No. 2
Fengxiangnan Road, Ronggui Town, Shunde
District, Foshan City, Guangdong 528303, China
Tel: 86-757-28395507 Fax: 86-757-28395571
China - Qingdao
Rm. B505A, Fullhope Plaza,
No. 12 Hong Kong Central Rd.
Qingdao 266071, China
Tel: 86-532-5027355 Fax: 86-532-5027205
India
Divyasree Chambers
1 Floor, Wing A (A3/A4)
No. 11, O’Shaugnessey Road
Bangalore, 560 025, India
Tel: 91-80-22290061 Fax: 91-80-22290062
Japan
Benex S-1 6F
3-18-20, Shinyokohama
Kohoku-Ku, Yokohama-shi
Kanagawa, 222-0033, Japan
Tel: 81-45-471- 6166 Fax: 81-45-471-6122
France
Parc d’Activite du Moulin de Massy
43 Rue du Saule Trapu
Batiment A - ler Etage
91300 Massy, France
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20
Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
Germany
Steinheilstrasse 10
D-85737 Ismaning, Germany
Tel: 49-89-627-144-0
Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Italy
Via Quasimodo, 12
20025 Legnano (MI)
Milan, Italy
Tel: 39-0331-742611
Fax: 39-0331-466781
Netherlands
Waegenburghtplein 4
NL-5152 JR, Drunen, Netherlands
Tel: 31-416-690399
Fax: 31-416-690340
United Kingdom
505 Eskdale Road
Winnersh Triangle
Wokingham
Berkshire, England RG41 5TU
Tel: 44-118-921-5869
Fax: 44-118-921-5820
05/28/04
DS39635A-page 402
Preliminary
 2004 Microchip Technology Inc.